HiPath 3000 V1.2 3.0, System Description V3.0 Siemens Hi Path

User Manual: 3000 V3.0

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 762 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]

April 2002
System Description
HiPath 3000
Version 1.2-3.0
G281-0788-00
April 2002
Job No. 5197
No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by
any means, mechanical, electronic, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without prior written permission of
Siemens. The software described in this publication is furnished under a license agreement and may be used
only in accordance with the terms of that agreement.
Request Siemens publications from your Siemens representative or the Siemens branch serving you. Publi-
cations are not stocked at the address below.
Siemens Information and Communication Networks, Inc.
1700 Technology Drive
San Jose, CA 95110
(408) 492-2000
1 (800) 765-6123
Fax: (408) 492-3430
Siemens and optiset are registered trademarks and HiPath is a trademark of Siemens AG.
All other trademarks and company names are the property of their respective owners.
Copyright Siemens Information and Communication Networks, Inc. 2002. All rights reserved.
Warning
Hackers who unlawfully gain access to customer telecommunications systems are criminals. Currently, we do
not know of any telecommunications system that is immune to this type of criminal activity. Siemens Informa-
tion and Communication Networks, Inc. will not accept liability for any damages, including long distance charg-
es, which result from unauthorized use. Although Siemens has designed security features into its products, it
is your sole responsibility to use the security features and to establish security practices within your company,
including training, security awareness, and call auditing.
Siemens sales and service personnel, as well as Siemens business partners, are available to work with you
to help you guard against this unauthorized use of your telecommunications system.
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-1
Contents
Contents 0
Figures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-15
Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-19
1 Important Notices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1 About This Manual. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.2 Major New Features in Version 3.0 of HiPath 3000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
1.2.1 Extended Functionality of HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
1.2.2 New Features for HiPath 3000 V3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
1.2.3 HiPath 3000 in the LAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.2.4 Upgrading to HiPath 3000 V3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.2.5 New optiPoint 500 Product Family (V3.0 SMR-3 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
1.3 Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
1.3.1 Hardware optimization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
1.3.1.1 Systems for free-standing installation (HiPath 3750 only) and wall mounting 1-5
1.3.1.2 Systems for installation in 19’’ cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
1.3.1.3 Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
1.3.1.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR for HiPath 3000 (Not for U.S. and Canada). 1-15
1.3.2 Extended Functionality of HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300 V1.2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
1.3.3 New Features for HiPath 3000 V1.2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
1.3.4 Optimization of the HiPath cordless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
1.3.5 HiPath 3000 in the LAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
1.3.6 Upgrading to HiPath 3000 V1.2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
1.4 Sales-Oriented Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
1.5 Technical Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
1.6 Information from the Intranet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
1.7 Privacy and Data Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
1.8 Feedback/Comments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
2 System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2.1 System-Related Capacity Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
2.2 HiPath 3750 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
2.2.1 Hardware Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
2.2.2 Board Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
2.2.2.1 Distribution of PCM Segments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
2.2.3 Central Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
2.2.3.1 CBCPR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11
2.2.3.2 UPSM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
2.2.3.3 LIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
2.2.4 Peripheral Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.2.4.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
2.2.4.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
2.2.4.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
2.2.4.4 Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
2.2.5 Additional System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.2.5.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.2.5.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.2.5.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply UPSM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-18
2.3 HiPath 3550 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.1 Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
2.3.2 Central Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
2.3.2.1 CBCC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-23
2.3.2.2 UPSC-D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
2.3.3 Peripheral Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
2.3.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
2.3.3.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
2.3.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
2.3.3.4 Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
2.3.4 Additional System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.3.4.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.3.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
2.3.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
2.3.5 Additional Power Supply from the EPSU2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31
2.4 HiPath 3350 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.4.1 Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
2.4.2 Central Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
2.4.2.1 CBCC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
2.4.2.2 PSUP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
2.4.2.3 UPSC-D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36
2.4.3 Peripheral Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
2.4.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
2.4.3.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
2.4.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
2.4.3.4 Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
2.4.4 Additional System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.4.4.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.4.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.4.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
2.5 HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
2.5.1 System Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
2.5.2 Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
2.5.3 Central Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
2.5.4 SBSCO. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
2.5.4.1 PSU One . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
2.5.5 Peripheral Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47
2.5.6 Additional System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-3
Contents
2.5.6.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
2.5.6.2 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
2.5.6.3 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
2.6 HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
2.6.1 System Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
2.6.2 Hardware Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
2.6.3 Central Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
2.6.3.1 SBSCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51
2.6.3.2 PSU One . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52
2.6.4 Additional System Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
2.6.4.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
2.6.4.2 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
2.6.4.3 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
2.7 HiPath 3700 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
2.7.1 Hardware Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
2.7.2 Board Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
2.7.2.1 Distribution of PCM Segments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
2.7.3 Central Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
2.7.3.1 CBCPR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
2.7.3.2 UPSM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60
2.7.3.3 LIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-61
2.7.4 Peripheral Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62
2.7.4.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62
2.7.4.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63
2.7.4.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64
2.7.4.4 Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64
2.7.5 Additional System Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-66
2.7.5.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-66
2.7.5.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-66
2.7.5.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply UPSM . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-66
2.7.5.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-69
2.8 HiPath 3500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
2.8.1 Hardware Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
2.8.2 Central Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
2.8.2.1 CBRC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71
2.8.2.2 UPSC-DR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72
2.8.3 Peripheral Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
2.8.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
2.8.3.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
2.8.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
2.8.3.4 Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
2.8.4 Additional System Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
2.8.4.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
2.8.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
2.8.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
2.8.4.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77
2.9 HiPath 3300 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
2.9.1 Hardware Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
2.9.2 Central Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79
2.9.2.1 CBRC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79
2.9.2.2 UPSC-DR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-80
2.9.3 Peripheral Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-81
2.9.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-81
2.9.3.2 Trunk Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
2.9.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
2.9.3.4 Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83
2.9.4 Additional System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.9.4.1 System-related capacity limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.9.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.9.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
2.9.4.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-85
2.10 HiPath cordless. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-86
2.10.1 Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-86
2.10.2 System Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-87
2.10.2.1 System Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-87
2.10.2.2 Multi-cell Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-87
2.10.2.3 System Networking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-88
2.10.2.4 Important Features of HiPath cordless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-90
2.10.3 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-91
2.10.4 Components of HiPath cordless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
2.10.4.1 Mobile Telephones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
2.10.4.2 Base Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
2.11 Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-94
2.12 Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-95
2.13 Interface-to-Interface Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-97
2.14 Numbering Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-98
2.15 Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-99
2.15.1 CE Compliance (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-99
2.15.2 SAFETY International. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-99
2.15.3 Environmental Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-99
3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
3.1 Features for All Traffic Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
3.1.1 Call Hold. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
3.1.2 Call Park. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21
3.1.3 Toggle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23
3.1.4 Unscreened Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24
3.1.5 Screened Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26
3.1.6 Conference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-5
Contents
3.1.7 Music on Hold (Internal or External Source) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30
3.1.8 Announcements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32
3.1.9 Consultation Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34
3.1.10 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35
3.1.11 Setting the Signaling Method for Analog Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36
3.1.12 optiPoint Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37
3.1.13 Busy Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39
3.1.14 Overload Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41
3.1.15 Shared Transfer Switch (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-42
3.2 Features for General Incoming Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43
3.2.1 ANI (for U.S. only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43
3.2.2 Distinctive Ringing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44
3.2.3 Call Waiting Tone/Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-46
3.2.4 Call Management (CM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48
3.2.5 Call ForwardingNo Answer (CFNA) With a Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-53
3.2.6 Call Forwarding (CF)Busy and No Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-56
3.2.7 Call Forwarding (CF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-58
3.2.8 Subscriber Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-61
3.2.9 Group Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-62
3.2.10 Group Call with Busy Signaling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-64
3.2.11 Hunt Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-65
3.2.12 Leave Group Call/Hunt Group (Stop Hunt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-67
3.2.13 Uniform Call Distribution (UCD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-68
3.2.13.1 UCD Queues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-70
3.2.13.2 UCD Call Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-71
3.2.13.3 UCD Subscriber States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-72
3.2.13.4 Leave UCD Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-74
3.2.13.5 Work Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-75
3.2.13.6 Recorded Announcement/Music on Hold (MOH) with UCD . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-76
3.2.13.7 Overflow With UCD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-78
3.2.13.8 Automatic Incoming Call Connection (AICC) With UCD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-79
3.2.13.9 UCD Night Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-81
3.2.13.10 UCD Group Status Display (Calls in Queue) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-82
3.2.13.11 UCD Home Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-83
3.2.13.12 Transfer to UCD Groups. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-84
3.2.14 Silent Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-85
3.2.15 Do Not Disturb (DND) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-86
3.2.16 Ringer Cutoff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-88
3.2.17 Caller List/Station Number Storage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-89
3.2.18 Call Pickup Within Call Pickup Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-91
3.2.19 Targeted Call Pickup Outside of a Pickup Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-93
3.2.20 Call Pickup from an Answering Machine. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-94
3.2.21 Fax Waiting Message/Answering Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-95
3.2.22 Deferring a Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-96
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
3.2.23 Station Number Configuration Using Assistant T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-97
3.2.24 Reject Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-98
3.3 Features for General Outgoing Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-99
3.3.1 Dual-Tone Multifrequency Transmission (DTMF)/Temporary Signaling Method
Changeover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-99
3.3.2 Individual Telephone Lock (Changeover). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-101
3.3.3 System Telephone Lock (Changeover) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-103
3.3.4 Hotline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-105
3.3.5 Mobile PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-106
3.3.6 B Channel Allocation (V3.0 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-108
3.4 Features for General External Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-109
3.4.1 Multi-Device Connection (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-109
3.4.2 Multi-Device Connection (for U.S. Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-110
3.4.3 Trunk Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-113
3.4.4 Trunk Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-115
3.4.5 Call Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-117
3.4.6 Transit Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-118
3.4.7 Translate Station Numbers to Names for System Speed Dialing. . . . . . . . . . . . 3-120
3.4.8 Message Waiting Indication (MWI) at the Trunk Interface (V3.0 and later) . . . . 3-121
3.5 Features for Incoming External Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-122
3.5.1 Call Allocation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-122
3.5.2 Group Ringing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-123
3.5.3 Night Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-125
3.5.4 Direct Inward Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-128
3.5.5 Selective Seizure of a DID Number Using a MUSAP Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-129
3.5.6 Signaling of Direct Inward Dialing Numbers for Incoming Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-130
3.5.7 Direct Inward System Access (DISA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-131
3.5.8 Intercept Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-133
3.5.9 Dual-Tone Multifrequency Direct Inward Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-136
3.5.10 Announcement Before Answering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-138
3.5.11 Collect Call Barring per Trunk (for Brazil Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-140
3.5.12 Collect Call Barring per Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-141
3.5.13 Analog Direct Inward Dialing via MFC-R2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-142
3.5.14 Centralized Attendant Service CAS (for U.S. only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-144
3.6 Features for Outgoing External Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-146
3.6.1 Last Number Redial (LNR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-146
3.6.2 System Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-149
3.6.3 System Speed Dialing in Tenant Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-152
3.6.4 Station Speed Dialing in System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-154
3.6.5 Trunk Seizure Type and Prime Line On (Automatic Line Seizure). . . . . . . . . . . 3-156
3.6.6 En-Bloc Dialing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-158
3.6.7 Dial Tone Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-159
3.6.8 End-of-Dialing Recognition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-161
3.6.9 Trunk Signaling Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-162
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-7
Contents
3.6.10 Configurable Toll Restriction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-163
3.6.11 Traffic Restriction Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-166
3.6.12 Private Trunk. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-168
3.6.13 Trunk Queuing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-169
3.6.14 Temporary Station Number Display Suppression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-171
3.6.15 Denied List for Undialed Trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-173
3.6.16 Assigning Speed-Dialing Numbers to ITR Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-174
3.6.17 Intercept With Telephone Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-175
3.6.18 Keypad Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-176
3.6.19 E911 Emergency Call Service for the USA (for U.S. only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-178
3.6.20 Automatic Call Completion on No Reply (CCNR) on the Trunk Interface (V3.0 and
later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-180
3.6.21 CLIP no screening (V3.0 and later). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-181
3.7 Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-183
3.7.1 Carrier Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-184
3.7.1.1 Mercury Communications Limited Single Stage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-184
3.7.1.2 Mercury Communications Limited Two Stage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-185
3.7.1.3 Dial-In Control Server (DICS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-186
3.7.1.4 Corporate Network (CN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-187
3.7.1.5 Primary Carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-187
3.7.2 Routing Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-188
3.8 Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-195
3.8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-195
3.8.2 Carrier Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-197
3.8.3 Using Alternate Carriers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-198
3.8.3.1 Carrier Access Methods Supported . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-198
3.8.4 LCR Time of Day Evaluation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-199
3.8.5 LCR Outdial Rules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-199
3.8.6 Expensive Route Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-200
3.8.7 Overflow Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-200
3.8.8 LCR Class of Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-200
3.8.9 Carrier-Select Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-200
3.8.10 Handling of Numbers and Destinations and Trunk Group Access Codes. . . . 3-200
3.8.11 Correlation With Other Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-200
3.8.11.1 Station-Related Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-201
3.8.11.2 Trunk-Related Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-201
3.8.12 Routing Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-202
3.8.13 LCR Dial Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-202
3.8.13.1 Rules for Creating LCR Dial Plan Entries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-203
3.8.14 Route Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-204
3.8.15 Time Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-205
3.8.16 Outdial Rule Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-205
3.8.17 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-208
3.9 Features for Internal Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-210
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
3.9.1 Internal Traffic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-210
3.9.2 Direct Station Selection (DSS)/Repertory Dial Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-212
3.9.3 Names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-214
3.9.4 Automatic Callback When Free or Busy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-215
3.9.5 Entrance Telephone/Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-217
3.9.6 Speaker Call/Handsfree Answerback/Internal Paging (OptiPage) . . . . . . . . . . . 3-218
3.9.7 Transfer from Announcement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-219
3.9.8 Radio Paging Equipment (PSE) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-220
3.9.8.1 Simple Radio Paging Equipment/Simple PSE (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . 3-220
3.9.8.2 Radio Paging Equipment via ESPA/Enhanced Radio Paging Equipment (Not for
U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-221
3.9.9 Message Texts/Mailboxes/Message Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-222
3.9.10 Advisory Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-225
3.9.11 Internal Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-227
3.9.12 Room Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-229
3.9.13 Editing the Telephone Number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-231
3.10 Tenant Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-232
3.10.1 Tenant Service Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-233
3.11 Other Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-236
3.11.1 Voice Channel Signaling Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-236
3.11.2 Date and Time Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-237
3.11.3 Relays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-239
3.11.4 Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-243
3.11.5 Multilingual Text Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-245
3.11.6 Associated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-247
3.11.7 Associated Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-248
3.11.8 Display Number of Stations with Direct Trunk Access (for Austria Only) . . . . . 3-250
3.11.9 Services in the Talk State. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-251
3.11.10 Reset Activated Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-252
3.11.11 Relocate (Hoteling). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-254
3.11.12 Automatic Wake-up System/Timed Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-257
3.11.13 Delete All Station Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-259
3.11.14 Team/Top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-261
3.11.14.1 Team Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-261
3.11.14.2 Top Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-268
3.11.14.3 MULAP Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-277
3.11.15 Storing Procedures on Procedure Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-289
3.11.16 Customer-Specific Display (V3.0 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-293
3.12 Networking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-294
3.12.1 Satellite CS Capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-296
3.12.2 Tie Trunk Via TIEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-298
3.12.3 Closed Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-299
3.12.4 Toll Restriction with CorNet-N . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-300
3.12.5 Call Detail Recording With Networking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-302
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-9
Contents
3.12.6 Incoming Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-303
3.12.7 Consultation Hold/Transfer/Pickup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-304
3.12.8 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-305
3.12.9 Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-306
3.12.10 Distinctive Ringing in the Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-307
3.12.11 Callback on Free/Busy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-308
3.12.12 Station Number/Name Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-309
3.12.13 Call Forwarding With Rerouting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-310
3.12.14 Toggle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-312
3.12.15 Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-313
3.12.16 Central Attendant Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-314
3.12.17 Sharing System Speed Dialing in a Gateway System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-315
3.12.18 Sharing a Central Voice Mail Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-316
3.12.19 QSig (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-317
3.12.19.1 Basic Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-318
3.12.19.2 Central Attendant Position/Attendant Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-319
3.12.19.3 Intercept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-319
3.12.19.4 Originator of the Intercept. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-319
3.12.19.5 Busy Override. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-320
3.12.19.6 Recall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-320
3.12.19.7 Message Waiting Indication (MWI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-320
3.12.19.8 Central Cross-System Busy Signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-321
3.12.19.9 System Telephone Lock-Reset Code (V3.0 SMR-3 and later). . . . . . . . 3-321
3.12.19.10 COS Changeover (V3.0 SMR-3 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-322
3.13 Features for Call Detail Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-323
3.13.1 Silent Reversal at Start and End of Call (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-323
3.13.2 Advice of Charges at Station During Call (AOC-D) (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . 3-324
3.13.3 Call Duration Display on Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-326
3.13.4 Call Detail Recording at Station (CDRS) (Not for U.S.). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-327
3.13.5 Call Detail Recording, Attendant (CDRA) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-329
3.13.6 Call Detail Recording Per Trunk (CDRT) (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-332
3.13.7 Account Code (ACCT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-334
3.13.8 Call Detail Recording Central (CDRC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-338
3.13.9 Toll Fraud Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-353
3.13.10 Printer Pipe Mode (V.24 [RS-232] Range Extension for Call Data) . . . . . . . 3-354
3.13.11 Call-Charge Display With Currency (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-355
3.14 Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-357
3.14.1 Direct Inward Dialing (DID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-358
3.14.2 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-359
3.14.3 Default Station Number Instead of Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN) . . . . . 3-360
3.14.4 Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-361
3.14.5 Calling Line Identification Restriction (CLIR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-362
3.14.6 Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-363
3.14.7 Connected Line Identification Restriction (COLR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-364
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
3.14.8 Advice of Charge (AOC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-365
3.14.9 Call Forwarding (CF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-366
3.14.10 External Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-368
3.14.11 Call Deflection (CD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-369
3.14.12 Subaddressing (SUB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-370
3.14.13 Malicious Call Identification (MCID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-371
3.14.14 Competition of Calls to Busy Subscribers (CCBS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-372
3.14.15 Call Hold (CH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-373
3.14.16 Three Party Service (3PTY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-374
3.14.17 Call Waiting (CW). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-375
3.14.18 Telephone Portability (TP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-376
3.14.19 User to User Signaling (UUS1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-377
3.14.20 Explicit Call Transfer (ECT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-378
3.14.21 Point-to-Point Connection on the User Side. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-379
3.14.22 Programming National and International Codes for Outgoing Calls. . . . . . . . 3-380
3.14.23 Caller ID After Release (Police) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-381
3.14.24 Collect Call Barring for ISDN Trunks (V3.0 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-382
3.15 U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-383
3.15.1 PRI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-384
3.15.2 BRI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-389
3.16 U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-392
3.16.1 Multi-Device Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-392
3.16.2 Call-By-Call Service Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-393
3.16.3 Dedicated (Pre-Provisioned) Service Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-394
3.16.4 Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-395
3.16.5 Camp-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-396
3.16.6 Conference Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-397
3.16.7 Equal Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-398
3.16.8 Special Access Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-399
3.16.9 Direct Inward Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-400
3.16.10 Multiple Subscriber Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-401
3.16.11 Calling Line Identification Presentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-403
3.16.12 Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-404
3.16.13 Call Hold. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-405
3.16.14 Three-Party Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-406
3.16.15 Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-407
3.16.16 Connected Line Identification Presentation and Restriction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-408
3.16.17 Dialed Number Identification Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-409
3.16.18 B Channel Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-410
3.16.19 Originating B Channel Selection Implementation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-411
3.16.20 Terminating B Channel Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-412
3.16.21 B Channel Cut-Through Operation Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-413
3.16.22 Digital Keypad to DTMF Conversion on PRI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-414
3.16.23 En-Bloc Sending. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-415
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-11
Contents
3.16.24 Data Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-416
3.16.25 Basic Electronic Key Telephone System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-417
3.16.26 Call Appearance Call Handling Electronic Key Telephone System . . . . . . . 3-418
3.16.27 Called and Calling Party Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-419
3.16.28 Connected Party Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-420
3.16.29 Message Waiting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-421
3.16.30 Internal Voice Mail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-422
3.17 Host Link Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-423
4 HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
4.2 LAN Connecting Capabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.2.1 LAN Connection using an LIM board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
4.2.2 LAN Connection using HiPath HG1500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4.2.2.1 Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
4.2.2.2 Definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
4.2.2.3 Hardware Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.2.2.4 System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.2.2.5 System Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.2.2.6 Interfaces and Protocols. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
4.2.2.7 Supported Voice over IP Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
4.2.2.8 Determining the number HiPath HG 1500 boards necessary. . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
4.3 IP Trunking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
4.3.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
4.3.2 Features of IP Networking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8
4.3.3 Network-wide Features with IP Networking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
4.3.4 Requirements of the IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
4.4 IP Payload Switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
4.5 Workpoint Clients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
4.5.1 optiClient 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
4.5.2 optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
4.6 Wireless LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
4.6.1 HiPath Wireless BreezeNET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
4.6.2 Implementation Scenarios. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
4.6.2.1 Mobile optiClient 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
4.6.2.2 Wireless LAN Network Between Two HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
4.6.3 Main Components of HiPath Wireless BreezeNET. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
4.6.3.1 Access Point PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
4.6.3.2 PCMCIA-PC Card PRO.11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
4.6.3.3 Station Adapter PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
4.6.3.4 Workgroup Bridge PRO.11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
4.6.3.5 Wireless Base Unit BU-DS.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
4.6.3.6 Wireless Bridge RB-DS.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
4.6.4 Extension of a Wireless LAN Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30
4.7 Applications over IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
4.7.1 Call Detail Recording Central (CDRC) via IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
4.7.1.1 TFTP Client in HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
4.7.1.2 TCP Client in HiPath 3000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
4.7.1.3 TFTP Server in HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
4.7.2 CSTA via IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
4.8 Administration & Fault Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
4.8.1 Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
4.8.2 SNMP Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
4.8.2.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
4.8.2.2 Overview of SNMP Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
4.8.3 Administering HiPath 3000 via the LAN Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
4.8.4 Remote Administration of HiPath 3000 via PPP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39
4.8.5 Remote Administration of Plus Products via PPP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
5 Serviceability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1
5.2 System Administration Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
5.2.1 System Administration from a System Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.2 System Administration using the Service PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
5.2.3 Administration of the HiPath HG1500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5
5.3 Options in the Service Department . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.1 Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.1.1 Automatic Customer Data Backup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.1.2 Manual Customer Data Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
5.3.2 Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.3.2.1 Transferring an APS by Replacing the MMC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.3.2.2 APS Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
5.3.3 Diagnosis Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.3.3.1 Recording Board Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.3.3.1.1 Central Control Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
5.3.3.1.2 Power Supplies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.3.3.1.3 Peripheral Boards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
5.3.3.2 Recording Trunk Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
5.3.3.3 Recording Station Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
5.3.3.4 Recording the Status of the V.24 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
5.3.3.5 Trace Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15
5.3.3.6 Error History. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.3.3.7 Testing Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.3.3.8 Analyzing System-wide Use of Feature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
5.3.4 Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17
5.3.5 Correcting Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
5.3.5.1 Automatic Error Correction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
5.3.5.2 Manual Error Correction Without HiPath 3000 Manager E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18
5.3.5.3 Manual Error Correction With HiPath 3000 Manager E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
5.3.6 Remote Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
3000sbTOC.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-13
Contents
5.3.6.1 Remote System Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
5.3.6.1.1 Remote Administration with HiPath 3000 Manager E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
5.3.6.1.2 DTMF Remote Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22
5.3.6.2 Remote Correction of System Software (APS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.6.3 Remote Error Signaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.6.4 Remote Administration and Access Using PPP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.6.4.1 Remote System Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.6.4.2 Remote Administration of Plus Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.6.4.3 Remote Error Signaling Using SNMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
5.3.7 Access Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
5.3.7.1 Logon With User Name and Password. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
5.3.7.2 Pre-determined User Groups and Their Access Rights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26
5.3.7.3 System Access Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-28
5.3.7.4 Customer Data Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30
5.3.8 Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-31
5.3.8.1 Logging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-31
5.3.8.1.1 Format Identification and Command Entry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-31
5.3.8.2 Issuing and Saving Log Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34
6 Desktop Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
6.2 optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
6.2.1 optiPoint 500 Telephones without Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
6.2.2 optiPoint 500 Telephones with Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5
6.2.3 Comparison of Features on all optiPoint 500 Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
6.2.4 optiPoint 500 Add-On Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9
6.2.5 optiPoint 500 Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
6.2.6 Restrictions for Using optiPoint 500 Adapters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
6.2.7 Comparison of optiset E adapters and optiPoint 500 adapters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
6.3 Accessories for optiPoint 500 Telephone Solutions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.3.1 Local Power Supplies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.3.2 Headsets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
6.3.3 Part Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18
6.4 optiset E. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
6.4.1 optiset E Telephones Without Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20
6.4.2 optiset E Telephones with Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-21
6.4.3 Comparison of Features on all optiset E Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24
6.4.4 optiset E Add-On Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25
6.4.5 optiset E Adapters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27
6.4.6 Restrictions for Using optiset E Adapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-31
6.4.7 Electronic Notebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33
6.5 Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34
6.6 Telephones for HiPath cordless. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-35
6.6.1 Gigaset 2000C Feature Handset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-35
6.6.2 Gigaset 2000C pocket Feature Handset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37
Contents
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbTOC.fm
6.6.3 Gigaset active Robust Handset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
6.6.4 Gigaset 3000 Comfort Feature Handset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41
6.6.5 Gigaset 3000 Micro Feature Handset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43
6.6.6 Gigaset 2000L Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44
6.6.7 Gigaset 2000L pocket Charger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44
6.6.8 Gigaset 3000L Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45
6.6.9 Gigaset 3000L Micro Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45
6.7 Attendant Consoles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46
6.7.1 HiPath Attendant B Braille Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46
6.7.2 optiClient Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48
6.7.3 optiPoint Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-51
6.8 LAN Telephones/Adapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53
6.8.1 optiClient 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53
6.8.2 optipoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53
6.8.3 optiPoint IPadapter (supported up to and including V1.2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53
7 Plus Products and Applications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
8 Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
9 Output Formats for Call Detail Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-1
9.2 Compressed Output Format for Call Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
9.3 Long Output Format for Call Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Y-1
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Z-1
3000sbLOF.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-15
Figures
Figures 0
Figure 1-1 HiPath 3750. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Figure 1-2 HiPath 3550. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Figure 1-3 HiPath 3350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Figure 1-4 HiPath 3250. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
Figure 1-5 HiPath 3150. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9
Figure 1-6 HiPath 3700. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Figure 1-7 HiPath 3500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Figure 1-8 HiPath 3300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Figure 1-9 Expansion cabinet rack ECR (not for U.S. and Canada) . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Figure 1-10 Base Station BS3/1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
Figure 2-1 System Overview HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Figure 2-2 HiPath 3750 with Expansion Cabinets and Main Distribution Frame
(MDFU-E) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Figure 2-3 Slot Numbers and Widths in 8-Slot BC, EC1, and EC2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Figure 2-4 PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Figure 2-5 PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Figure 2-6 PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Figure 2-7 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of one HiPath 3750 Cabinet. 2-18
Figure 2-8 Connecting the UPSM to Battery Packs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19
Figure 2-9 Connecting UPSM, Ext. Charging Rectifiers and Battery Packs. . . . . . . 2-20
Figure 2-10 Dimensions and Slots in the HiPath 3550 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-22
Figure 2-11 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3550. . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
Figure 2-12 Dimensions and Slots in the HiPath 3350 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Figure 2-13 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3350 with
PSUP/UPSC-D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Figure 2-14 HiPath 3250 System Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43
Figure 2-15 HiPath 3250 Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Figure 2-16 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3250. . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Figure 2-17 HiPath 3150 System Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
Figure 2-18 HiPath 3150 Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
Figure 2-19 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3150. . . . . . . . . . . 2-53
Figure 2-20 HiPath 3700 Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Figure 2-21 Slot numbers and widths in 8-Slot BC, EC1, and EC2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
Figure 2-22 PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57
Figure 2-23 PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57
Figure 2-24 PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58
Figure 2-25 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of one HiPath 3700 Cabinet. 2-66
Figure 2-26 Connecting the UPSM to Battery Packs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67
Figure 2-27 Connecting the UPSM, Ext. Charging Recitifiers and Battery Packs . . . 2-68
Figure 2-28 HiPath 3500 Dimensions and Slots. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70
Figures
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbLOF.fm
Figure 2-29 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3500 . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76
Figure 2-30 HiPath 3300 Dimensions and Slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78
Figure 2-31 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption ofHiPath 3300 . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-84
Figure 2-32 Basic Architecture of a HiPath cordless System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-87
Figure 2-33 HiPath cordless - Network-wide Roaming and Handover . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-89
Figure 2-34 Base Station BS3/1 S30807-H5482-X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-92
Figure 3-1 Call Management Relationships (Blocks 1 and 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-49
Figure 3-2 Call Management Relationships (Blocks 3 and 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50
Figure 3-3 E911 Expanded Emergency Call Service E911 (for USA only). . . . . . . 3-179
Figure 3-4 Sample LCR Flow Diagram (Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-190
Figure 3-5 General LCR Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-192
Figure 3-6 General LCR Flow (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-196
Figure 3-7 Sample LCR Flow Diagram (for U.S. Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-209
Figure 3-8 Example of a Team with Two Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-261
Figure 3-9 Example of a Team with Eight Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-264
Figure 3-10 Team with Eight Members: Default Key Assignments for Tel. A on
key module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-265
Figure 3-11 Example of Top with One Executive and One Secretary . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-268
Figure 3-12 Example of Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries. . . . . . . . . . 3-270
Bild 3-13 Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assignments
for Executive 1 on key module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-271
Figure 3-14 Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assignments
for Secretary 1 on key module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-272
Figure 3-15 Default Display in Idle State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-293
Figure 3-16 Example of a Customer-Specific Display in Idle State . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-293
Figure 3-17 HiPath 3000 - Interfaces for Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-424
Figure 4-1 LAN Connection using the LIM Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Figure 4-2 LAN Connection using HiPath HG1500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Figure 4-3 IP Trunking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
Figure 4-4 Options for Implementing the optiClient 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19
Figure 4-5 optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Figure 4-6 Mobile optiClient 130 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Figure 4-7 Wireless LAN Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Figure 4-8 Access Point AP-10 PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Figure 4-9 PCMCIA-PC Card SA-PCR PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Figure 4-10 Station Adapter SA-10 PRO.11 and SA-40 PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28
Figure 4-11 Workgroup Bridge WB-10D PRO.11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29
Figure 4-12 CDRC via IP - TFTP Client in HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Figure 4-13 CDRC via IP - TCP Client in HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
Figure 4-14 CDRC via IP - TFTP Client in HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32
Figure 4-15 HiPath 3000 - CSTA via IP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33
Figure 4-16 HiPath 3000 - Administration over LAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
Figure 4-17 HiPath 3000 - Administration via the LAN Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38
Figure 4-18 Remote Administration of HiPath 3000 via PPP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39
3000sbLOF.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-17
Figures
Figure 4-19 Remote Administration of Plus Products via PPP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40
Figure 5-1 System Administration Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Figure 5-2 Example of Remote Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
Figure 6-1 The User Interface for the optiPoint 500 Telephone with Display . . . . . . . 6-5
Figure 6-2 optiPoint 500 - Possible Configurations for Add-On Devices . . . . . . . . . 6-11
Figure 6-3 optiPoint 500 - Option bays (Adapter Slots) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12
Figure 6-4 Headset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17
Figure 6-5 The User Interface for the optiset E Telephone with Display . . . . . . . . . 6-21
Figure 6-6 optiset E - Add-On Devices: Possible Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-26
Figure 6-7 optiLog 4me. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29
Figure 6-8 Display of an ENB Entry (Example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33
Figure 6-9 Feature Handset Gigaset 2000C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-35
Figure 6-10 Feature Handset Gigaset 2000C pocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37
Figure 6-11 Robust Handset Gigaset active. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-39
Figure 6-12 Feature Handset Gigaset 3000 Comfort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41
Figure 6-13 Feature Handset Gigaset 3000 Micro . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43
Figure 6-14 Connecting a Braille Console to optiClient Attendant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-46
Figure 6-15 Jacks for optiPoint IPadapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53
Figure 6-16 Main Connections for the optiPoint IPadapter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54
Figures
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbLOF.fm
3000sbLOT.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-19
Tables
Tables 0
Table 1-1 Sales-oriented documentation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Table 1-2 List of available technical documentation for HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27
Table 1-3 Information from the intranet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
Table 2-1 HiPath 3000 - System-Related Capacity Limits (Maximum Numbers) . . . 2-4
Table 2-2 Number of Time-Division Multiplex Channels Required Per Board. . . . . . 2-8
Table 2-3 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3750. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Table 2-4 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3750. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Table 2-5 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3750 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
Table 2-6 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3750. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-16
Table 2-7 UPSM bridging times with different battery packs per cabinet . . . . . . . . 2-18
Table 2-8 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3550. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
Table 2-9 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3550. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26
Table 2-10 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3550 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Table 2-11 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3550. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Table 2-12 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Table 2-13 EPSU2 - Technical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31
Table 2-14 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Table 2-15 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Table 2-16 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3350 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Table 2-17 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Table 2-18 Capacity and bridging period for UPSC-D. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Table 2-19 Number of Time-Division Multiplex Channels Required Per Board. . . . . 2-56
Table 2-20 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3700. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62
Table 2-21 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3700. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63
Table 2-22 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3700 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64
Table 2-23 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3700. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-64
Table 2-24 UPSM Bridging Times with Different Battery Packs per Cabinet . . . . . . 2-66
Table 2-25 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73
Table 2-26 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Table 2-27 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3500 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-74
Table 2-28 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3500. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-75
Table 2-29 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-DR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77
Table 2-30 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-81
Table 2-31 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
Table 2-32 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3300 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-82
Table 2-33 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-83
Table 2-34 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-DR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-85
Table 2-35 HiPath cordless - System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-91
Table 2-36 Technical Data for Various Base Stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-93
Table 2-37 Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-94
Tables
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbLOT.fm
Table 2-38 Subscriber Line Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-95
Table 2-39 Trunk and Tie Traffic Interfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-95
Table 2-40 Interfaces for Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-96
Table 2-41 Telephone Interface-to-Interface Ranges (with J-Y (ST) 2x2x0,6, 0.6 mm
diameter) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-97
Table 2-42 Cable Lengths for Direct Trunk and CorNet-N Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-97
Table 2-43 Numbering Plan for HiPath 3000 V1.2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-98
Table 2-44 HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Distribution of Station Numbers . . . . . . . 2-98
Table 3-1 Sample Entries in a Dial-Plan Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-202
Table 3-2 Sample Entries in a Dial-Plan Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-203
Table 3-3 Sample Outdial Rule Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-206
Table 3-4 HiPath 3000Deleting Station Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-259
Table 3-5 Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set)
(Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-262
Table 3-6 Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for U.S. Only)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-263
Table 3-7 TeamSequence of Operations for Consultation Hold on Second Line 3-263
Table 3-8 Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set)
(Not for U.S.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-269
Table 3-9 Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for U.S. Only). .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-269
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields . . . . . . . . . 3-345
Table 3-11 Long output format - explanation of output fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-352
Table 3-12 Supported LEC Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-385
Table 3-13 Supported IEC Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-386
Table 3-14 Inter-Exchange (IEC) Protocol Calling Services. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-387
Table 3-15 Local Exchange (LEC) Protocol Calling Services. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-388
Table 4-1 Number of required B-channels (HiPath HG 1500 boards) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6
Table 4-2 Services Provided Across the Communications Platform with
Networking 4-11
Table 5-1 Technical Requirements for the Service PC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4
Table 5-2 Run LED - Meaning of the LED Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
Table 5-3 Power Supply Status Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Table 5-4 HiPath 3000 Manager E - Example of Status Display of Peripheral Boards . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11
Table 5-5 Variable Password: Pre-determined User Groups and Their Access Rights
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26
Table 5-6 Fixed Password: Fixed User Groups and Their Access Rights . . . . . . . . 5-27
Table 6-1 optiPoint 500 Telephones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Table 6-2 Comparison of Features on all optiPoint 500 telephones. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8
Table 6-3 Comparison of optiset E and optiPoint 500 adapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
Table 6-4 Part Numbers for optiPoint 500 Telephones and Accessories . . . . . . . . . 6-18
Table 6-5 optiset E Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19
Table 6-6 Comparison of Features on all optiset E telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24
3000sbLOT.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 0-21
Tables
Table 6-7 Available optiset E adapter configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-31
Table 6-8 Adapter Implementation in Primary and/or Secondary Telephone . . . . . 6-32
Table 6-9 Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34
Table 6-10 optiPoint Attendant - Total Number of Function Keys after Addition of Key
Modules and BLFs 6-52
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000 . . . . . . . 7-2
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . 8-1
Table 8-2 Hardware Capacities HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields . . . . . . . . . . . 9-5
Table 9-2 Long output format - explanation of output fields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12
Tables
G281-0788-00, April 2002
0-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbLOT.fm
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-1
About This Manua
l
Important Notices
1 Important Notices
1.1 About This Manual
This manual describes the features and hardware of HiPath 3000, which consists of
the following systems:
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
Country-specific features and released applications may vary.
The Sales Information is therefore the only document that contains a binding de-
scription of the available features and the hardware scope for your country.
Major New Features in Version 3.0 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.2 Major New Features in Version 3.0 of HiPath 3000
1.2.1 Extended Functionality of HiPath 3000
HiPath 3000 V3.0 is the IP convergence platform for small and medium-sized busi-
ness. The new version optimizes the use in IP environments and its expansion capa-
bilities increase the range of possible uses.
1.2.2 New Features for HiPath 3000 V3.0
The maximum number of call destination lists for call forwarding destinations has
been increased to adapt to the increased expansion capabilities
(Section 3.2.4 on page 3-48):
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700: 500 call destination lists
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500: 376 call destination lists
HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300: 70 call destination lists
The maximum number of Team/Top configurations for HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700 has been increased from 150 to 500 (see Section 3.11.14 on page 3-261).
Customer-specific display (Section 3.11.16 on page 3-293)
Collect call barring for ISDN trunks (Section 3.14.24 on page 3-382)
SMR-3 and later: B channel allocation (Section 3.3.6 on page 3-108)
SMR-3 and later: Message waiting indication (MWI) at the trunk interface
(Section 3.4.8 on page 3-121)
SMR-3 and later: Automatic call completion on no reply (CCNR) on the trunk in-
terface (Section 3.6.20 on page 3-180)
SMR-3 and later: CLIP no screening (Section 3.6.21 on page 3-181)
SMR-3 and later: QSig networking (not for U.S.):
System telephone lock-reset code (Section 3.12.19.9 on page 3-321)
COS changeover (Section 3.12.19.10 on page 3-322)
Version 3.0 is purely a software version and is provided for all models of the HiPath
3000 product family.
Major New Features in Version 3.0 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-3
Important Notices
1.2.3 HiPath 3000 in the LAN
IP Payload Switching (see Section 4.4)
IP payload switching optimizes communication between LAN-based IP workpoint cli-
ents.
In the past, two B-channels (with two DSP resources) in the HiPath HG 1500 and Hi-
Path 3000-internal switching network were seized for internal network calls.
In HiPath 3000 V3.0 and later, VoIP voice data (payload) is transferred directly be-
tween two IP workpoint clients in the network. When this happens, both IP workpoint
clients have full access to all system features.
Payload switching is also implemented for IP networking (PBX routing).
By ceasing to use B-channels, we have managed to preserve HiPath HG 1500 re-
sources and facilitate a higher volume of network-internal call traffic.
Section 4.2.2.8 contains information on determining the required number of HiPath
HG1500 boards (B channels) using the available IP Workpoint Clients.
1.2.4 Upgrading to HiPath 3000 V3.0
Upgrading from HiPath 3000 V1.2
Upgrade by replacing the system software.
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E Office Rel. 1.0/2.2/3.0 or Hicom 150 H V1.0
see Section 1.3.6 on page 1-24
1.2.5 New optiPoint 500 Product Family (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
optiPoint 500 telephones (see Section 6.2 on page 6-2) handle the digital communi-
cation of voice and data (voice communication only for optiPoint 500 entry and opti-
Point 500 economy). The three dialog keys and the display guarantee convenient and
interactive operation. Furthermore, the key lamp principle visualizes the activated
functions.
With the exception of optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy, the optiPoint
500 telephones have a USB 1.1 interface. This allows for PC-supported telephoning
and Internet access over the USB interface of a PC.
The add-on devices optiPoint key module and optiPoint BLF allow you to increase the
number of available function keys.
Major New Features in Version 3.0 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
The different optiPoint 500 adapters provide a flexible extension to the telephone
workstation. Additional devices (such as personal computers, fax equipment, tele-
phones, headsets) can be connected quickly because it is easy to build them on to
the bottom of the telephones (not optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy)
and because the adapters are plugnplay.
The optiPoint 500 telephones are compatible with the optiset E telephones. It is pos-
sible to operate both telephone families on one UP0/E board. You can also use tele-
phones from the two families in mixed host-client configurations (earlier called the
master-slave or primary-secondary configuration).
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-5
Important Notices
1.3 Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000

1.3.1.1 Systems for free-standing installation (HiPath 3750 only) and wall mounting
HiPath 3750 (see Section 2.2 on page 2-6)
New CBCPR control board:
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
The first V.24 interface on the control board has been changed to a 9-pin
connector; the second V.24 interface is still a 25-pin connector.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
or CMI (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (Com Server V1.0 or later) (op-
tional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
Alternative music on hold using the MPPI module (optional)
You can have up to four SLC16 boards and up to 250 handsets for each system.
Unless otherwise indicated, the new features listed below are available in Version
1.2.
Figure 1-1 HiPath 3750
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
HiPath 3550 (see Section 2.3 on page 2-21)
New CBCC control board:
2 S0 interfaces integrated on the CBCC
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
The first V.24 interface has been integrated into the control board (9-pin); the
second V.24 interface (25-pin) is optional.
Up to 7 new BS3/1 base stations (max. 32 handsets) can be connected to
the UP0/E ports on the control board.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
and/or CMI (2-channel single-cell solution with BS3/S at the UP0/E port) (op-
tional)
The CMA clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for CMI and net-
working (4-channel multi-cell solution with BS3/1 at UP0/E port) (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (V.24/E module) (optional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
You can connect up 16 base stations (for example, 16 x BS3/1 or 5 x BS3/3 +
1 x BS3/1 or 8 x BS2/2 or 8 x BS3/3 over 2 UP0/E) using the SLC16 (max. 64
handsets).
New UPSC-D uninterruptible power supply.
Figure 1-2 HiPath 3550
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-7
Important Notices
HiPath 3350 (see Section 2.4 on page 2-33)
New CBCC control board:
2 S0 interfaces integrated on the CBCC
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
The first V.24 interface has been integrated into the control board (9-pin); the
second V.24 interface (25-pin) is optional.
Up to 3 new BS3/1 base stations (max. 32 handsets) can be connected di-
rectly to the UP0/E ports on the control board.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
and/or CMI (2-channel single-cell solution with BS3/S at UP0/E port) (option-
al)
The CMA clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for CMI and net-
work (4-channel multi-cell solution with BS3/1 at UP0/E port) (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (V.24/E module) (optional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
New UPSC-D uninterruptible power supply
Figure 1-3 HiPath 3350
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
HiPath 3250 (see Section 2.5 on page 2-43)
New housing
New SBSCO control board
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the integrated flash memory
Up to 3 new BS3/1 base stations (max. 8 handsets) can be connected direct-
ly to the UP0/E ports on the control board
A 9-pin V.24 interface (V.24 adapter cable no longer required)
CMS clock module for CMI (2-channel cordless solution with BS3/S and
BS3/1 at UP0/E ports) (optional)
LIM module for LAN connection to central administration system (optional)
Figure 1-4 HiPath 3250
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-9
Important Notices
HiPath 3150 (see Section 2.6 on page 2-49)
New housing
New SBSCS control board
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the integrated flash memory
A 9-pin V.24 interface (V.24 adapter cable no longer required)
CMS clock module for single-cell solution with a BS3/S at the UP0/E port
(optional)
LIM module for LAN connection to central administration system (optional)
Figure 1-5 HiPath 3150
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.3.1.2 Systems for installation in 19’’ cabinets
To increase the options for using the system, additional 19’’ models are provided. The
housing designs have been optimized for integration into 19’’cabinets.
HiPath 3700 (see Section 2.7 on page 2-54)
New CBCPR control board:
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
The first V.24 interface on the control board has been changed to a 9-pin
connector; the second V.24 interface is still a 25-pin connector.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
or CMI (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (Com Server V1.0 or later) (op-
tional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
Alternative music on hold using the MPPI module (optional)
You can have up to four SLC16 boards and up to 250 handsets per system.
New ECR expansion cabinet rack (not for U.S. and Canada)
You can install a battery pack (48 V/7 Ah, 4 x 12 V) to run the UPSM as an unin-
terruptible power supply unit. You will required one ECR for each system cabinet.
Figure 1-6 HiPath 3700
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-11
Important Notices
HiPath 3500 (see Section 2.8 on page 2-70)
New CBRC control board:
2 S0 interfaces have been integrated into the CBRC
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
The V.24 interface has been integrated into the control board (9-pin)
Up to 7 new BS3/1 base stations (max. 32 handsets) can be connected di-
rectly to the UP0/E ports on the control board.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
and/or CMI (2-channel single-cell solution with BS3/S at the UP0/E port) (op-
tional)
The CMA clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for CMI and net-
working (4-channel multi-cell solution with BS3/1 at the UP0/E port) (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (V.24/E module) (optional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
New ECR expansion cabinet rack (not for U.S. and Canada)
You can install a battery pack (48 V/7 Ah, 4 x 12 V) to run the UPSC-DR as an
uninterruptible power supply unit.
New uninterruptible power supply: UPSC-DR
New peripheral boards: HXGSR2, SLU8R, 8SLAR, TLA4R, TS2R, STLS4R
New options: EXMR, UAMR, OPALR, STRBR
Figure 1-7 HiPath 3500
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
HiPath 3300 (see Section 2.9 on page 2-78)
New CBRC control board:
2 S0 interfaces have been integrated into the CBCC
The 16-MB MMC multimedia card replaces the FMC 8/10 flash card
V.24 interface has been integrated into the control board (9-pin)
Up to 3 new BS3/1 base stations (max. 32 handsets) can be connected di-
rectly to the UP0/E ports on the control board.
The CMS clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for networking
and/or CMI (2-channel single-cell solution with BS3/S at the UP0/E port) (op-
tional)
The CMA clock module replaces the CGMC clock generator for CMI and net-
working (4-channel multi-cell solution with BS3/1 at the UP0/E port) (optional)
The LIM module replaces the LAN interface (V.24/E module) (optional)
The IMODC integrated analog modem replaces the IMOD (PCMCIA) (op-
tional)
New ECR expansion cabinet rack (not for U.S. and Canada)
You can install a battery pack (48 V/7 Ah, 4 x 12 V) to run the UPSC-DR as an
uninterruptible power supply unit.
New uninterruptible power supply: UPSC-DR
New peripheral boards: HXGSR2, SLU8R, 8SLAR, TLA4R, STLS4R
New options: EXMR, UAMR, OPALR, STRBR
Figure 1-8 HiPath 3300
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-13
Important Notices
1.3.1.3 Boards
New control boards
A new hardware platform with optimized control boards is now available for the entire
range of models. Essentially, a new microprocessor system has been integrated to
guarantee the performance of the system for the enhanced functionality of future ver-
sions.
The control boards of the basic HiPath 3550, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3350 and HiPath
3300 systems have 2 S0 interfaces. This means that the slot, otherwise required for
a S0 board, is available for other peripheral boards.
The UP0/E ports on the control boards have been modified so you can now connect
up the new BS3/1 and BS3/S base stations directly for the integrated cordless solu-
tions.
The first V.24 interface has been integrated into the control boards for all models. Me-
chanical design: 9-pin sub-D connector.
The second V.24 interface is still the same in all models (apart from HiPath 3250 and
HiPath 3150) and is still available as an option (standard in HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700). Mechanical design: 25-pin sub-D connector.
New Peripheral Boards
Implementation of integrated Voice Mail System Xpressions Compact using the fol-
lowing new boards:
IVML8/IVML24 for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
IVMP8 for HiPath 3350
IVMP8R for HiPath 3300
IVMS8 for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350
IVMS8R for HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
The new MMC multimedia card with a capacity of 16 MB is now be-
ing used in all models in the range. The increased memory capacity
of the multimedia card also provides memory for the log files of the
Security feature by default.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
New Options
In connection with the control boards, the following new optional boards are available.
CMS (Clock Module Standard)
The CMS module replaces the old CGMC clock generator. The
CMS must be used in the following situations:
Clock generator for the master system in the network
Clock generator for HiPath cordless during operation with the
SLC16 board
Clock generator for a single-cell cordless solution (2-channel
mode) with BS3/S base station
CMA (Clock Module ADPCM)
The CMA module is implemented exclusively in the HiPath 3550,
HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems. The module
is required as a clock generator for HiPath cordless (4-channel
mode) with the BS3/1 base station when the new control boards
are connected directly to the UP0/E ports.
LIM (LAN Interface Module)
The LIM module enables you to integrate all HiPath 3000 models
into TCP/IP-based LANs economically for
central system administration (TCP)
call detail recording (CDRC)
APS transfer or
fault management.
A 10BaseT interface (10 Mbit) with an RJ45 jack is available for
connecting to the LAN.
IMODC (Integrated analog modem)
The format of the printed-circuit board on the integrated analog
modem for remote maintenance (remote access via analog
trunks) is new. The module is plugged into the appropriate slots
on the control boards (this is not possible in HiPath 3250 or Hi-
Path 3150).
MPPI (optional music on hold from Beyertone)
The plug-in MPPI module can be used universally in all HiPath
3000 models making an economical solution available for an al-
ternative music on hold.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-15
Important Notices
1.3.1.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR for HiPath 3000 (Not for U.S. and Canada)
When installing the system, an ECR (see also Section 2.8.4.4 on page 2-77) in the
19’’ cabinet is required if
emergency battery operation is necessary during a power failure or if the system
requires uninterruptible power. The necessary battery pack (48 V/7 Ah, 4 x 12 V)
is installed in the ECR.
the EPSU2-R external power supply unit is necessary. EPSU2-R is installed in
the ECR.
One ECR per system is required for both HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 and one ECR
per system cabinet is required for HiPath 3700.
Four height units are required for mounting an ECR in a 19’’ cabinet (one height unit
is approximately 1.7’’ = 43 mm).
Figure 1-9 Expansion cabinet rack ECR (not for U.S. and Canada)
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.3.2 Extended Functionality of HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300 V1.2
Extended Capacity Limits (HiPath 3350 only)
Now that hardware restrictions have ceased to apply, the following maximum techni-
cal configuration is possible:
Up to 36 analog subscribers and 8 digital subscribers (with UPSC-D only)
OR
Up to 24 digital subscribers and 4 analog subscribers.
Additional subscribers can be connected up using optiPoint 500 adapters or optiset
E adapters (with a local power supply only).
CSTA interface
This is the same as the CSTA interface in the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 systems.
optiClient Attendant
The PC attendant console optiClient Attendant can be implemented to the same ex-
tent as in the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 systems.
Hicom Attendant BLF
The busy lamp field Hicom Attendant BLF can be implemented to the same extent as
in the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 systems.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-17
Important Notices
1.3.3 New Features for HiPath 3000 V1.2
The functionality has been extended to include the following features:
New features in Hicom 150 H V1.0 or later
(Delta: Hicom 150 E Office Release 2.2 > Hicom 150 H V1.0)
Optimized user interface for the CMI handset (see Section 6.6):
The simulation of the optiset E user interface on the CMI comfort handset en-
ables users to use the system features that they are already familiar with
from their optiset E telephones.
You can receive and send internal text messages on the CMI handset.
A CMI handset can now be operated at the same time as an optiPoint 500 or
optiset E telephone using a single number.
Extended line keys (MULAP) (see Section 3.11.14)
The extra MULAP functionality provides optimized trunk keys for teams and ex-
ecutive/secretary configurations.
Mobile PIN (Flex Call) (see Section 3.3.5)
The mobile PIN makes it possible for an employee to make calls using col-
leagues telephones in which case the CDR information is assigned to his or her
own connection.
Relocate (see Section 3.11.11)
This feature allows an optiPoint 500 or optiset E station to use a procedure to
change the assignment between the physical telephone port and the logical sta-
tion data (user profile).
Advice of charges at start of call (AOC-S) (see Section 3.13.2)
The AOC-S feature makes information on the expected charges available at the
start of the call. A prerequisite for this is that the call detail information must be
sent by the public exchange or by the carrier. AOC-S is provided in addition to
advice of charges during call (AOC-D) and advice of charges at end of call
(AOC-E).
Dual key assignment on the optiset E key module (see page 6-19)
External telephone numbers can be assigned to the second level of both the keys
on the optiset E key module and the programmable keys on the optiset E tele-
phone. The first level is still available for programming with features or telephone
numbers.
Central system administration using SNMP (Section 4.8.3)
All products in the HiPath 3000 family can be administered in TCP/IP-based
LANs using SNMP (simple network management protocol) from a central office.
The system is connected to the LAN using either the optional LIM module (LAN
interface) or the HiPath HG1500.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
Extension of the CSTA functionality (see Section 3.17)
The CSTA interface has been extended to include the CSTA Phase 3 protocol to
ISO. The Phase 2 protocol to ECMA is still supported. The CSTA interface is
available on all systems for V1.2 or later (with the exception of HiPath 3250 and
HiPath 3150).
New features in HiPath 3000 V1.2 or later
(Delta: Hicom 150 H V1.0 > Hicom 150 H V1.2)
Editing dialing/en-bloc dialing (see Section 3.9.13)
This feature allows users at optiPoint 500 and optiset E telephones with displays
to delete digits already entered and to enter new ones. Dialing commences when
you press the OK button or when you lift the handset. If the handset has already
been picked up, dialing commences when you press the speaker key. If this fea-
ture is activated, en-bloc dialing only can be executed on the telephone; automat-
ic dialing is not available.
Reject calls (see Section 3.2.24)
In the ringing state, initial incoming calls (internal or external) can be rejected by
pressing a button. The rejected call then follows the entries in Call Management
(e.g. the call is forwarded immediately to voicemail).
Procedures on keys (see Section 3.11.15)
Users can store procedures on programmable keys (first level only). This is done
in the same sequence used when executing the procedure normally.
Saving the account code for last number redial (see Section 3.6.1)
Automatic storage of the account code in the redial memory can be activated
throughout the system. If this feature is activated, the account code is stored au-
tomatically and can be re-used by means of the last number redial.
Extended functionality of V4.0 of the optiClient Attendant (see Section 6.7.2)
New features:
Names have replaced telephone numbers in the busy indication fields
Display for internal/external busy
Identification of the recall from parked (shown in the status line)
An external call that has been parked or put on hold is connected to the
optiClient Attendant party
Displays for reject and recall in the talk state
Status displays for call forwarding during ringing state (the party you are
looking for is displayed)
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-19
Important Notices
Extension of the central call data record (see Section 3.13.8)
The CDRC call data record has been extended to allow you to display calls > 24
hours. Allocation of sections of the call to the basic call after an internal/external/
external conference has been implemented.
Call priorities for internal calls from voicemail/auto attendant (see Section 3.2.3,
immediate call waiting when busy)
You can define a code which will ensure that internal calls from voicemail/auto
attendant to the attendant console, for example, will be given the same priority as
external calls.
This new code is also used for immediate call waiting when busy. If the code has
been configured for the called party, the caller gets immediate call waiting with a
ring tone instead of a busy tone.
Optimization of serviceability (see Section 5.3)
Various features in the HiPath 3000 Manager E system have been optimized:
Improved error diagnosis using Tracestop at the telephone
Improved efficiency in the service due to faster APS transfer
Controlled release of remote connection
Administration of Plus Products using joint service access
Extension of the ISDN message decoder
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.3.4 Optimization of the HiPath cordless
The integrated cordless solution HiPath cordless has been enhanced to include a
new range of features and functions and network-wide features (see Section 2.10 on
page 2-86).
New Base Stations
The current BS2/2 base station is being replaced by the new base stations that have
been developed:
BS3/1 base station:
with one UP0/E port
designed for multi-cell mode (with handover)
two or 4 voice channels depending on the connection (CMS/CMA)
BS3/S base station:
with one UP0/E port
exclusively for single-cell mode (no handover)
two or 4 voice channels depending on the connection (CMS/CMA)
BS3/3 base station:
with three UP0/E ports
designed for multi-cell mode (with handover)
up to 12 voice channels depending on the connection
The BS3/3 base station can only be operated on the SLC16 board.
Figure 1-10 Base Station BS3/1
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-21
Important Notices
Outdoor housing for base stations
A special outdoor housing (with no heating) is provided for installing the base station
outside buildings or inside buildings with particularly harsh environmental conditions
(splash water or dust for example).
Enhanced cordless configuration for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
Up to 4 SLC16 boards can be implemented for Version 1.2 or later. This means that
the cordless configuration can be extended as follows:
up to 64 BS3/1 base stations (21 to 32 BS3/3 base stations depending on the
connection of the base station)
up to 250 handsets (max. 120 per SLC16 board)
Cordless networking features
Network-wide roaming
Version 1.2 and later of the HiPath 3000 system family support network-wide
roaming for up to 16 nodes. (Network-wide roaming is also available in conjunc-
tion with HiPath 4000.)
Network-wide handover
HiPath 3000 supports the handover function for switching radio cells between two
systems during the course of a call. The clocks in the systems are synchronized
by means of air synchronization of two base stations in close proximity. This func-
tion supports up to 4 nodes.
The synchronization base stations must be able to "see" one another electroni-
cally. In other words, the radio ranges of these base stations have to overlap. The
base stations for air synchronization are only used for exchanging clock informa-
tion; calls are not processed by these base stations.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.3.5 HiPath 3000 in the LAN
In the LAN network the following features are available in V1.2 and later:
Implementation of the LAN interface module LIM (see
Section 4.2.1 on page 4-2)
Allows the HiPath 3000 to be implemented in a LAN network
with applications such as administration using IP (TCP), fault
monitoring (SNMP) and display of call details (CDRC).
HiPath Gateway 1500 V2.0 (HiPath HG1500) (see
Section 4.2.2 on page 4-3)
HiPath HG1500 V2.0, the successor to the extremely popular
HiPath HG1500 V1.1, has been integrated into HiPath 3000
as a board. This means that HiPath 3000 migrate to commu-
nication servers in the corporate LAN. HiPath HG1500 allows
Ethernet LANs (10/100 Mbit/s) to connect directly to HiPath
3000. Modified hardware with a second LAN interface
(10 Mbit/s) is used with the new version 2.0 of the HiPath
HG1500.
IP Trunking (see Section 4.3 on page 4-7)
Implementation of the HiPath HG 1500 board allows HiPath
3000 systems to be networked over IP (CorNet-N tunneling
over IP with a maximum of 16 nodes and 1000 telephone
numbers).
The main advantage for users of IP telephony is a significant
cost saving through an infrastructure for data and voice. In
addition, the IP trunking functionality offers network-wide fea-
tures such as call pickup, group call and other similar fea-
tures.
HiPath AllServe 150
HiPath AllServe 150 is a solution within the framework of the
Siemens Enterprise convergence architecture. HiPath
AllServe 150 provides various applications on the basis of a
standard platform (PC server) for distributed network compo-
nents and their users. At the same time, HiPath AllServe 150
allows communication and information systems (HiPath
3000) to be networked over the IP network and creates a
standard communication platform with distributed compo-
nents.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-23
Important Notices
optiClient 130 (see Section 4.5.1 on page 4-19)
The PC client optiClient 130 V2.0 allows innovative voice/
data communication over IP-based corporate networks. opti-
Client 130 V2.0 is available to the customer with two different
interfaces:
The Phone user interface simulates all of the functions
of an optiset E telephone.
The Office user interface is practically identical to the
user interface of the old optiClient 130 V1.x.
HiPath Wireless BreezeNET (see Section 4.6.1 on
page 4-24)
Siemens HiPath Wireless products provide a wireless net-
work platform over which PCs, notebooks and local sub-net-
works can be networked with one another without the use of
wires. In addition, this platform can be used within the HiPath
environment for the mobile networking of IT terminals (hand-
held units, mobile IP telephones, clients and similar prod-
ucts). The radio components are fully compatible with the Hi-
Path products and make available all LAN solutions in the
HiPath environment as mobile units.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 3000
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.3.6 Upgrading to HiPath 3000 V1.2
Upgrades are available for wall-mounted models only.
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficePro Rel. 1.0/2.2/3.0 or HiPath 3750 V1.0
The upgrade package consists of a CBCPR control board, an MMC multimedia card
with system software V1.2 and customer documentation on CD-ROM. The following
components have to be replaced:
the control board (the new CBCPR control board will be used)
the system cabinets to allow unrestricted expansions (Germany only)
the following option boards, if available:
the CGM/CGMC clock generator replaces the CMS module
the IMOD analog modem replaces the IMODC
the LAN interface com server replaces the LIM module
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficePoint/Com Rel. 1.0
When upgrading, the basic unit has to be replaced.
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficeCom Rel. 2.2/3.0 or HiPath 3550 V1.0
The upgrade package consists of the CBCC control board, an MMC multimedia card
with system software V1.2 as well as customer documentation on CD-ROM. The fol-
lowing components have to be replaced:
the control board (the new CBCC control board CBCC will be used)
the following optional boards, if available:
the CGM/CGMC clock generator replaces the CMS module
the IMOD analog modem replaces the IMODC
the LAN interface com server replaces the LIM module
An existing SLC16 board for cordless base stations does not need to be replaced.
Base stations (old BS2/2 or new BS3/1) must only be operated in this case at the
SLC16 ports.
Major New Features in Version 1.2 of HiPath 300
0
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-25
Important Notices
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficePoint Rel. 2.2/3.0 or HiPath 3350 V1.0
The upgrade package consists of the CBCC control board, an MMC multimedia card
with system software V1.2 as well as customer documentation on CD-ROM. The fol-
lowing components have to be replaced:
the control board (the new CBCC control board will be used)
The new control board allows up to 3 base stations to be connected directly to spe-
cially designed UP0/E ports in the basic unit.
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficePointC Rel. 2.2/3.0 or Hicom 150 H OfficePointC V1.0
There are no plans for upgrading the OfficePointC system. In exceptional circum-
stances the upgrade package for HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3350 can be used.
Upgrading from Hicom 150 E OfficeOne/Start Rel. 1.0/2.2/3.0 or HiPath 3250/HiPath 3150
V1.0
When upgrading, the basic unit has to be replaced.
Sales-Oriented Documentation
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.4 Sales-Oriented Documentation
Store and ordering procedure for the following items:
German and English at the Fürth delivery center (LZF)
Fax: +49 911 654 4271
Mail: lzf@znnbg.siemens.de
Intranet: http://c4bs.spls.de/
Other languages and addresses
see list of stores at the following intranet address:
http://intranet.icn.siemens.de/vz_dc_2/en/lagerort.htm
Table 1-1 Sales-oriented documentation
Documentation Languages
Data sheets
You can access data sheets over the Internet using the following address
http://w4.siemens.de/networks/hipath/en/download/index.htm
HiPath 3000
HiPath 3750/HiPath 3550/HiPath
3700/HiPath 3500
Brazilian, German, English, Portuguese, Slo-
vakian, Spanish
HiPath 3000
HiPath 3350/HiPath 3250/HiPath
3150/HiPath 3300
German, English, Portuguese, Spanish
optiClient Attendant Danish, German, English, Portuguese, Swed-
ish
HiPath cordless German, English
HiPath HG1500 German, English
optiset E phones German, English, Spanish
optiPoint 500 phones German, English, Spanish
HiPath 3000 Manager C German, English
Brochures and promotional gifts
Please contact ICN EN Product Promotion.
Technical Documentatio
n
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-27
Important Notices
1.5 Technical Documentation
Store and ordering procedure for the following items:
Fürth delivery center (LZF)
Fax: +49 911 654 4271
Mail: lzf@znnbg.siemens.de
Intranet: http://c4bs.spls.de/
Table 1-2 List of available technical documentation for HiPath 3000
Documentation Order number
Medium:
P31003 = electronic
A31003 = paper
Language:
xx = Language code
(e.g. 76 for English)
Electronic service manual HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 on
CD-ROM in 7 languages (English, German,
French, Spanish, Portuguese, Italian, Dutch)
P31003-H1030-S403-*-6Z20
Electronic system description HiPath 3000 V1.2-
3.0 on CD-ROM in 2 languages (English, German)
P31003-H1030-X100-*-7418
Customer documentation V3.0 on CD-ROM
(Contains all customer documentation for HiPath
3000 V3.0 in 7 languages)
P31003-H1012-C130-*-6Z19
System accessory pack HiPath 3000 V3.0 for all
systems, including the following parts:
System administration Assistant TC
Operating instructions optiPoint Attendant
Operating instructions DTMF/DP telephones
Operating instructions ISDN telephones
A31003-H1012-C116-*-xx19
Accessory pack optiPoint 500 phones in 7 languag-
es
A31003-H8400-B989-*-6Z19
Accessory pack optiset E entry A31003-M1550-B829-3-xx19
Accessory pack optiset E basic A31003-M1550-B830-3-xx19
Accessory pack optiset E standard, optiset E ad-
vance plus/comfort, advance conference/confer-
ence
A31003-M1550-B831-3-xx19
Accessory pack optiset E memory A31003-M1550-B832-3-xx19
Operating and installation instructions
optiClient Attendant V5.0
A31003-M1551-B874-*-xx19
Information from the Intranet
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.6 Information from the Intranet
You can access the most up-to-date information on important topics over the
Siemens intranet. Here is a selection of what is available:
Table 1-3 Information from the intranet
Topic Intranet URL
http://www.hipath.com
ICN EN HO Product Portfolio http://netinfo4.wit.siemens.de/icnenho/product
Training Institute http://intranet.icn.siemens.de/central-sales/train-
ing/eng/index.htm
Documentation Center http://intranet.icn.siemens.de/vz_dc_2/en/in-
dex.htm
Electronic Documentation http://netinfo2.icn.siemens.de/e_doku/en/in-
dex.htm
TopInfo-T Productcatalog http://opus1.mchh.siemens.de:8118/
License Service Center Witten http://www.siewit.de
Sales Information
HiPath 3000 V1.2
http://netinfo4.wit.siemens.de/icnenho/product/
Hicom_150H_V1.2/sales_release_docu
Sales Information
HiPath 3000 V3.0
http://netinfo4.wit.siemens.de/icnenho/product/
hipath_3000_13/product/vf_doku
Service Information http://netinfo4.wit.siemens.de/icnenho/
info_service
Privacy and Data Securit
y
3000sb1.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 1-29
Important Notices
1.7 Privacy and Data Security
Handling Personal Data
This telephone system uses and processes personal data (as in call detail recording,
telephone displays and customer data records).
In Germany, the processing and use of such data is subject to various regulations,
including those of the Federal Data Protection Law (Bundesdatenschutzgesetz,
BDSG). Observe all applicable laws in other countries.
The objective of privacy legislation is to prevent infringements of an individuals right
to privacy based on the use or misuse of personal data.
By protecting data against misuse during all stages of processing, privacy legislation
also protects the material interests of the individual and of third parties.
Guidelines Applicable to Siemens AG Employees
Employees of Siemens AG are bound to safeguard trade secrets and personal data
under the terms of the companys work rules.
It is imperative to observe the following rules to ensure that the statutory provisions
relating to service (on-site or remote) are strictly followed. This safeguards the inter-
ests of the customer and offers added personal protection.
Guidelines Governing the Handling of Data
A conscientious and responsible approach helps protect data and ensure pri-
vacy:
Ensure that only authorized persons have access to customer data.
Use the password features of the system with no exceptions. Never give pass-
words to an unauthorized person orally or in writing.
Ensure that no unauthorized person can ever process (store, modify, transmit,
disable or delete) or use customer data.
Prevent unauthorized persons from gaining access to data media (such as back-
up diskettes or log printouts. This applies to service calls as well as storage and
transport.
Ensure that data media that are no longer needed are completely destroyed and
that documents are not stored or left in places which are accessible to the public.
Work closely with your customer contact; this promotes trust and reduces
your workload.
Feedback/Comments
Important Notices
G281-0788-00, April 2002
1-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb1.fm
1.8 Feedback/Comments
To continually improve this system description, the editorial team welcomes your
comments. We would particularly like to know your views on the following:
Areas that need more information or graphics.
Areas that have too many details.
Areas that are difficult to understand.
Issues you would like to include.
Outside of the U.S., please send your comments to:
Siemens AG
Fachredaktion
ICN EN HO DC 4
Hofmannstrasse 51
D-81359 Munich
GERMANY
Fax.: + 49 89 722 33959
Key word:
System Description HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0 (please also specify the part number)
Also include your address, telephone and fax number so we can contact you if nec-
essary. In the U.S., please refer to the reader comment form at the back of this doc-
ument for information on how to submit comments about this manual.
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-1
System Overview
2 System Overview
Electrical Environment and Applications
HiPath 3000 has been designed for use in dwellings, business and industry. When the
system is operated in an industrial environment, additional measures may be neces-
sary for ensuring immunity from electromagnetic radiation (refer to Section 2.15.3,
Environmental Conditions).
Figure 2-1 System Overview HiPath 3000
optiPoint 500 entry
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3350HiPath 3550
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
optiPoint 500 advance
optiPoint
acoustic adapter
analog adapter
recorder adapter
ISDN adapter
phone adapter
optiPoint BLF
optiPoint key module optiPoint 500 standard optiPoint 500 basic /
economy
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
System Families and Accompanying Models
The individual housing designs and the variable connecting capabilities allow the fol-
lowing HiPath 3000 systems to cover a wide customer range.
This system description contains information on all systems. Information on market-
ing individual models in different countries can be obtained at the responsible loca-
tions.
Systems for free-standing installation (HiPath 3750 only) and wall mount-
ing
HiPath 3750, which consists of one basic cabinet and up to two expansion
cabinets, is the most powerful and comprehensive system in this family. Up
to 384 subscriber lines are possible when it is used as a TC system. Up to
500 IP subscribers can be connected when it is used as a pure IP system.
HiPath 3550 is a communication system for medium capacity demands of
up to 72 digital or 108 analog subscriber lines when used as a TC system or
a maximum of 188 IP subscribers when used as an IP system.
HiPath 3350, which has a maximum of 24 digital or 36 analog subscriber
lines, is the scaled-down version of the HiPath 3550. It is capable of operat-
ing up to 16 mobile stations. As a pure IP system, up to 62 IP subscribers
can be connected.
HiPath 3250 offers a capacity of 16 subscriber lines (including 8 mobile sta-
tions) in a single-board solution. An external power supply unit provides the
power.
HiPath 3150 represents the smallest system in the family. This system offers
a capacity of 6 subscriber lines in a single-board solution (an HiPath 3250
board with less equipment). It can also operate up to 8 handsets by connect-
ing up a BS3/S base station.
To increase the options for using the system, additional 19’’ models are provided.
The housing designs have been optimized for installation in 19’’ cabinets.
Starting with Version 3.0, all models in the HiPath 3000 system family (not HiPath
3250 and HiPath 3150) can be operated either as conventional telecommunications
systems (TC systems) or as IP systems only. In this case, the IP station connects
directly to the HiPath HG 1500 boards.
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-3
System Overview
Systems for installation in 19’’ cabinets
HiPath 3700, which consists of one basic cabinet and up to 2 expansion cab-
inets, is the most power system in this family. Both housing cabinets are iden-
tical to those of the HiPath 3750. Up to 384 subscriber lines are possible
when used as a TC system. When used as a pure IP system, up to 500 IP
subscribers can be connected.
HiPath 3500, when used as a TC system, meets medium capacity demands
with up to 48 digital or 44 analog subscriber lines and 32 mobile stations.
When used as an IP system, it can support up to 188 IP subscribers.
HiPath 3300, with a maximum of 24 digital or 20 analog subscriber lines, is
the scaled-down version of the HiPath 3500. In addition, it can operate up to
16 mobile stations. As a pure IP system, up to 62 IP subscribers can be con-
nected.
System-Related Capacity Limits
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.1 System-Related Capacity Limits
The information in the following two tables applies for fully-equipped systems, where
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 are laid out as three-cabinet systems.
Deviating capacity limits can be determined for sales purposes.
Table 2-1 HiPath 3000 - System-Related Capacity Limits (Maximum Num-
bers)
System HiPath 3750 HiPath 3550 HiPath 3350 HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Stations/
Workpoint
Clients
(Any combi-
nations up to
the maximum
number are
possible.)
Analog 384 44 (1081)
1 only for specific countries or sales channels
12 (361)4 4
Digital 384 48 (721)16 (24
1)4 2
Additional stations over
phone adapter
116 48 (721)16 (24
1)4
IP 500 192 96 ––
Cordless 250 64 (BS on
SLC16) /
32 (BS on
CBCC)
16 8 8
Total stations TDM (Hosts
(master) incl. cordless)
384 84 (1561)44 (60
1)16 14
Base stations 64
on max.
4SLC16
16 on
SLC16
or
7 on CBCC
331
Trunks 120 digital
(B chan-
nels)
or
120 analog
60 digital
(B chan-
nels)
or
60 analog
16 digital
(B chan-
nels)
or
16 analog
4 digital
(B chan-
nels)
2 digital
(B chan-
nels)
HiPath HG 1500 boards 8 4 2 ––
IP network nodes/station numbers in the
LAN
max. 16 /
1000
max. 16 /
1000
max. 16 /
1000
––
V.24 interfaces 2
(1 x 9-pin,
1x 25-pin)
2
(1 x 9-pin,
1 x 25-pin)
2
(1 x 9-pin,
1x 25-pin)
1
(9-pin)
1
(9-v)
System-Related Capacity Limit
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-5
System Overview
System HiPath 3700 HiPath 3500 HiPath 3300
Stations/Work-
point Clients
(Any combina-
tions up to the
maximum num-
ber are possi-
ble.)
Analog 384 44 12 (201)
1 only for specific countries or sales channels
Digital 384 48 16 (241)
Additional stations over
phone adapter
116 48 16 (241)
IP 500 192 96
Cordless 250 32 16
Total stations TDM (Hosts
(Master) incl. cordless)
384 84 44
Base stations 64
on max.
4 SLC16
73
Trunks 120 digital
(B channels)
or
120 analog
60 digital
(B channels)
or
60 analog
16 digital
(B channels)
or
16 analog
HiPath HG 1500 boards 8 4 2
IP network nodes/station numbers in the LAN max. 16 / 1000 max. 16 / 1000 max. 16 / 1000
V.24 interfaces 2
(1 x 9-pin, 1 x
25-pin)
1
(9-pin)
1
(9-pin)
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.2 HiPath 3750
2.2.1 Hardware Overview
The HiPath 3750 system has a modular structure and as the requirements of the cus-
tomer grow, it can be extended to up to 384 subscriber lines by adding new boards or
cabinets. An additional cabinet is referred to as an expansion cabinet. A HiPath 3750
system can have a maximum of three cabinets. The figure below shows a HiPath
3750 system with a basic cabinet, two expansion cabinets, and a main distribution
frame (MDFU-E).
The basic cabinet has 7 slots for peripheral boards. Expansion cabinets with 8 slots
each for peripheral boards are implemented for expansions. As a result, when 2 ex-
pansion cabinets are implemented, a total of 23 slots are available for boards; with
the exception of slot 7 in the basic cabinet, which has an installation width of 45mm,
all slots have an installation width of 30mm.
Figure 2-2 HiPath 3750 with Expansion Cabinets and Main Distribution Frame
(MDFU-E)
Cabinet depth:
- MDFU-E: 126 mm
- System cabinet: 390 mm
EC1
BC
EC2
MDFU-E
approx. 328 mm approx. 410 mm
approx. 980 mm
approx. 670 mm
EC: Expansion cabinet
BC: Basic cabinet
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-7
System Overview
2.2.2 Board Slots
Nine board slots are available in each cabinet. The following boards are assigned per-
manent slots:
CBCPR central processor board -> slot 01 in the BC
UPSM power supply unit -> slot 09 in the BC, slot 18 in EC1, slot 27 in EC2.
Depending on their width, peripheral boards can be inserted in slots 02 to 08 in the
BC, 10 to 17 in EC1 and 19 to 26 in EC2 (the adhesive label beneath each slot iden-
tifies the slot) (see Figure 2-3).
Slots in Basic and Expansion Cabinets
2.2.2.1 Distribution of PCM Segments
Both expansion cabinets have the same HDLC address, which means that each ex-
pansion cabinet must be connected to a separate HDLC highway. The slots in the ba-
sic cabinet are assigned to HDLC highway 0. Because HDLC highway 0 is connected
to expansion cabinet 2 and the basic cabinet simultaneously, the basic cabinet re-
ceives its own collision-free HDLC addresses.
The new slot 7 implemented in basic 8-slot cabinets is connected in parallel with slots
5 and 6. This slot provides connections for a total of two S2M boards, which means
than only four B channels are available for the third slot (such as TIEL). In the expan-
sion cabinets, every two PCM highways are routed to two adjacent slots in both cab-
inets, providing 64 B channels for four slots in a three-cabinet system.
The basic and expansion cabinets are connected in a star configuration.
Figure 2-3 Slot Numbers and Widths in 8-Slot BC, EC1, and EC2
CBCPR
10
19
45/30
X10
02
11
20
30
X20
03
12
21
30
X30
04
13
22
30
X40
08
17
26
45/30
X80
UPSM
UPSM
UPSM
90
X90
BC:
EC1:
EC2:
mm
05
14
23
30
X50
06
15
24
30
X60
07
16
25
30
X70
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
To guarantee that the system operates without blocking, make sure when you do the
configuration that the boards on a PCM segment do not require more than the 64
time-division multiplex channels that are available. The following table lists the num-
ber of time-division multiplex channels that the different boards require.
Table 2-2 Number of Time-Division Multiplex Channels Required Per Board
Board Number of time-division multiplex channels re-
quired
CR8N 8
HXGM 16
IVML8 8
IVML24 24
SLA8N, SLA16N, SLA24N Depends on the number of stations
SLC16 Depends on the number of mobile telephones logged
on
SLMO8, SLMO24 Depends on the number of stations (hosts (master)
and clients (slaves))
STMD8 16
TIEL 4
TML8W 8
TMOM 1
TMS2 30
TMT1 24
Caution
To guarantee that the system operates without blocking, it is necessary that you ob-
serve the following rules for the configuration of boards:
SLC16
A maximum of one SLC16 per PCM segment; if possible, the SLC16 should
stay alone on the PCM segment.
IVML8, IVML24
A maximum of one IVML8 or IVML24 per system.
Only in the slot next to the UPSM in the basic cabinet (slot 08).
You may not insert an SLMO8, SLMO24, or SLC16 on the PCM segment
of the IVML8 or IVML24.
If there is a TMS2 on the PCM segment of the IVML8 or IVML24, only a
TIEL, TMOM, or TML8W is allowed on the free slot.
SLMO24
A maximum of two SLMO24s per PCM segment; the number of connected sta-
tions (hosts (master) and clients (slaves)) may not be more than 64.
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-9
System Overview
The illustrations below show the PCM segments (64 time-division multiplex channels
each) between the different HiPath 3750 system configurations.
PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System
PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System
Figure 2-4 PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System
Figure 2-5 PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
8-Slot cabinets
BC
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
8-Slot cabinets
1
0
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
7
U
P
S
M
1
4
1
5
1
6
BC EC1
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System
Figure 2-6 PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System
8-Slot cabinets
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
1
9
2
0
2
1
2
2
2
6
U
P
S
M
2
3
2
4
2
5
BC EC2
1
0
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
7
U
P
S
M
1
4
1
5
1
6
EC1
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-11
System Overview
2.2.3 Central Components
2.2.3.1 CBCPR
Introduction
The CBCPR board performs all central control and switching functions for HiPath
3750.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 4, 8 and 12 channel CMI connections using the SLC16 board of
the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer).
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem.
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
V.24 Interfaces
To connect a service PC, you can access the first V.24 interface (9-pin SUB-D
plug) on the CBCPR from the front of the basic cabinet (after removing the cov-
er).
You can access the second V.24 interface (25-pin SUB-D plug) via the back-
plane of the basic cabinet (X7).
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.2.3.2 UPSM
Introduction
Each cabinet in HiPath 3750 requires one UPSM (uninterruptible power supply mod-
ular). This board integrates the power supply and battery management functions. No
other components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term
battery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect one of the following to the UPSM:
One battery pack per system cabinet
One battery cabinet (BSG 48/38), including battery charger, or
One 48 Vdc network
An LED lights up to indicate that the UPSM is in operation. The UPSM must be re-
placed when defective (LED does not light up).
The UPSM is used in models for all countries. The ring frequency of the modular ring
generator can be parameterized to suit requirements.
Part Numbers
UPSM: S30122-K5950-S100, S30122-K5950-A100
Battery pack 4 x 12 V/7 Ah: S30122-K5950-Y200
(The connecting cable for the UPSM is part of the battery pack.)
Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 VAC - 240 VAC
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Max. input current consumption: 5.4 A - 2.7 A
Max. power consumption: around 430 W
Output voltage (battery charging voltage): 42.5 - 55.2 VDC
Output current (battery charge current): 0.8 A
(sufficient for battery set rating) = 7 Ah)
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-13
System Overview
Bridging times for power supplied via the battery pack 4 x 12 V or 7 Ah:
At 100% nominal load: approx. 60 min. bridging time
At 60% nominal load: approx. 100 min. bridging time
The battery recharging time is approx. 8.5 h.
Boundary conditions for the specified bridging times:
battery ambient temperature is approx. 22°C
The cut-off voltage is 1.7 V per cell
New batteries are fully charged.
Specifications of the Modular Ring Generator
Rated output voltages: 60/75 Vact
Output frequencies: 20/25/50 Hz
Output power
continuous: 4.0 VA
peak: 8.0 VA (3 minutes load/ 15 minutes pause)
BSG 48/38
You can use a BSG 48/38 battery cabinet in an upright housing instead of the battery
pack or a 48 V direct current supply to extend the bridging time in the event of a power
failure. The BSG 48/38 battery cabinet (S30122-K5950-F300) consists of
an upright housing
a charging rectifier
a 38 Ah/48 V battery set
The battery cabinet is designed for direct connection to the HiPath 3750 communica-
tion system.
2.2.3.3 LIM
The LAN interface module LIM (S30807-Q6930-X) is an optional subboard for all Hi-
Path 3000 central control boards (see also Section 4.2.1).
The board provides an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mb) LAN connection via an 8-pole
RJ45 jack.
You cannot operate the LIM module and a HiPath HG1500 board simultaneously in
one system.
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.2.4 Peripheral Components
2.2.4.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-3 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3750
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
IVML8 8 8 1 1 x x These boards are for the integrated voice mail func-
tions of the HiPath Xpressions Compact.
IVML24 24 24 1 1 x x
SLA16 16 6 15 x x Board for connecting up to 16 analog telephones to
the system; also for connecting fax machines, mo-
dems, radio paging equipment, equipment for exter-
nal music on hold, and voice mail systems.
SLA8N 8 6 18 x - Board with 8 analog interfaces1
1 250 stations are possible in the maximum configuration.
SLA16N 16 6 15 x x Board with 16 analog interfaces1
SLA24N 24 6 10 x x Board with 24 analog interfaces1
SLC16 16 64 12
2 Exception: basic cabinets can have 2 SLC16 boards.
4 x - Board for connecting up to 16 CMI base stations (mo-
bile telephones) to the system.
SLMO8 8 16 6 18 x - Board for connecting optiset E telephones. The
SLMO board comes in 8- and 24-port versions.
SLMO24 24 48 83
3 The maximum number of SLMO24 boards per cabinet depends on the number of slave stations.
16 x x
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x x ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for configuring
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers on the same
board.
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-15
System Overview
2.2.4.2 Trunk Boards
Table 2-4 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3750
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TML8W 8 81
1 4 boards max. per cabinet in the case of TML8W with installed GEE8.
15 x - Board with eight ports for connecting loop start
trunks.
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for configuring
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers on the same
board.
TMS2 30 30 4 4 x - Basic rate interface (BRI) board; can also be used for
tie trunk traffic.
TMST1 24 24 6 6 - x ISDN interface board
TMDID 8 3 9 - x Analog trunk board for direct inward dialing
TMGL8 8 6 15 - x Analog trunk board (ground/loop start)
TMAMF 8 x - Analog trunk board for direct inward dialing (MFC-
R2)
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.2.4.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
2.2.4.4 Options
Table 2-5 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3750
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TIEL 4 6 18 x x Board for providing four two-way analog tie trunk cir-
cuits with E&M signaling.
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for connecting
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers (no feeding)
on the same board.
HXGM2 2 16 6 8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3750 system directly to a local data network (Ether-
net).
TMS2 30 30 4 4 x - Basic rate interface (BRI) board; can also be used for
tie trunk traffic.
Table 2-6 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3750
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
TMOM Ports per
board
4 x - TMOM board with four ports which provides the inter-
face for connecting a radio paging system. Availability
is country-specific. Standards supported:
ESPA 4.4.3 and ESPA 4.4.5 (6-wire)
a,b,c,d interface
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-17
System Overview
TIEL Ports per
board
4 x x Board for connecting announcement equipment (with
start/stop signaling for announcement before answer-
ing) in addition to its tie trunk circuit function.
REAL Relay con-
nections
4 x x Board for relay connection (such as a door opener)
and power failure transfer (ALUM). The board is locat-
ed on the basic cabinet's backplane.
Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
1
PFT1 Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
1 x - PFT1 and PFT4 boards for connection to the main dis-
tribution frame unit (MDFU-E) and transferring calls
from analog trunks to a telephone in a power failure
(note the signaling method used).
PFT4 Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
4x -
GEE8 Number of
analog
trunks sup-
ported
8 x - Board for recording call charge pulses from the trunk
on a country-specific basis for up to eight trunks. The
board can be plugged into the TML8 analog trunk cir-
cuit board.
HXGM2
(Voice &
Data)
No. of B
channels
16 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3750
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HXGM2
(Data)
No. of B
channels
16 x x
CR8N x x The board has eight code transmitters and receivers.
LIM x x Ethernet (10BaseT) interface
Table 2-6 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3750
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.2.5 Additional System Data
2.2.5.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.2.5.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
2.2.5.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply UPSM
Please refer to Section 2.2.3.2 for details on the UPSM.
UPSM Bridging Times with Different Battery Packs per Cabinet
Figure 2-7 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of one HiPath 3750 Cab-
inet
Table 2-7 UPSM bridging times with different battery packs per cabinet
Number of Extensions Approximate Bridging Time
7 Ah battery set 38 Ah battery set
10 - 20 1 h 50 min 7 h 30 min
21 - 40 1 h 20 min 6 h 30 min
41 - 68 1 h 5 h
69 - 80 50 min 4 h 30 min
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 850 kJ/h
Maximum 430 W
88-264 Vac
Cabinet with UPSM
HiPath 375
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-19
System Overview
UPSM and Battery Packs with no Ext. Charging Rectifiers
Figure 2-8 Connecting the UPSM to Battery Packs
EC1
BC
48 V/7 Ah
48 V/7 Ah
48 V/7 Ah
Battery packs
UPSM
UPSM UPSM
EC2
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
S30122-K5959-Y200
Note: This diagram shows
only the schematic connec-
tions between the different
components.
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
HiPath 3750
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Connecting the UPSM with Battery Packs and Ext. Charging Rectifiers
Figure 2-9 Connecting UPSM, Ext. Charging Rectifiers and Battery Packs
EC1
EC2
48 V/38 Ah
Charging rectifier
External battery
UPSM
UPSM UPSM
48 V
48 V
48 V
e.g. BSG 4838
Note: This diagram shows
only the schematic connec-
tions between the different
components.
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz BC
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-21
System Overview
2.3 HiPath 3550
2.3.1 Hardware Overview
Mechanical Notes
The HiPath 3550 housing intended for wall mounting (Figure 2-10) contains one shelf
with six slot levels. The slot levels, numbered in ascending order from the attachment
side, have the following assignments:
Slot levels 1 to 3: peripheral boards (two slots per level).
Slot level 4: CBCC control board only.
Slot level 5: SIPAC slot (for HiPath 3750 boards).
Slot level 6: optional boards (up to 5 boards).
The power supply unit is located on the back of the subrack.
The connecting cables to the peripherals (telephones, trunk connections) can be con-
nected directly.
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Dimensions and Slots
Figure 2-10 Dimensions and Slots in the HiPath 3550
Mounting
surface
460 200
450
Notes:
When mounting the system on the wall, plan for at least 30 cm of clearance
on the board side for replacing the boards.
TS2 and TST1 boards can be installed in slot 7 and slot 9 only.
SLA8N, SLA16N, SLA24N, SLC16, and SLMO24 boards can be installed in
the SIPAC slot only.
Slot levels
Slot 4
Slot 5
Slot 8
2
16
345
Slot 9
Slot 6Slot 7
CBCC
PERIPHERAL BOARD
OPTIONS
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-23
System Overview
2.3.2 Central Components
2.3.2.1 CBCC
Introduction
The CBCC (Central Board with Coldfire Com) board performs all central control and
switching functions for HiPath 3550.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath
3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
supports all 4, 8 and 12 channel CMI connections using the SLC16 board in
the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
ADPCM (CMA) clock module
supports the 4-channel CMI connection over BS3/1 to the HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
in the same way as the CMS clock module small, provides the master clock
for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMA is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer)
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Interfaces
Eight UP0/E (digital subscriber line interfaces)
With HiPath 3000 V1.2 and later up to 7 BS3/1 base stations can be connected
directly for HiPath cordless
Four T/R (analog subscriber line interface)
Two S 0 interfaces (trunk or subscriber)
V.24 interfaces
Initial V.24 interface on the CBCC; the second interface is implemented using the
option V24/1.
2.3.2.2 UPSC-D
Introduction
This board combines the power supply and battery management functions. No other
components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term bat-
tery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack.
If an HiPath 3750 board has been installed in the HiPath 3550, the UPSC-D cannot
supply sufficient power to the system. Additional power can be made available by
connecting the external EPSU2 power supply (see Section 2.3.5). For this, the
EPSU2's DC connection needs to be connected to the special -48 V-DC input on the
UPSC-D. The UPSC-D's internal 48 V output is deactivated when the external power
supply is connected.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Ring generator: 75 Vac, 20/25/50 Hz
Partial voltages: +5 Vdc, 48 V
Battery charger: 4 x 12 V (40.8 V-55.2 V)
Power consumption: approx. 180 W
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-25
System Overview
2.3.3 Peripheral Components
2.3.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-8 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3550
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
4SLA 4 5 x - Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
8SLA 8 5 x x Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
16SLA 16 5 x - Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
IVMS8 8 8 1 x x Board for the integrated voice mail functions of the HiPath
Xpressions Compact.
SLU8 8 16 5 x x Board for connecting optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones (UP0/E)
STLS2 2 4 6 x - Board for providing ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers
(no feeding) on the same board is possible.
STLS4 4 8 6 x x
SLA8N 8 1 x - HiPath 3750 board for connecting eight analog stations
(a/b, T/R)
Can be installed in Slot level 5 only
SLA16N 16 1 x x HiPath 3750 board for connecting 16 analog stations (a/
b, T/R)
Can be installed in Slot level 5 only
SLA24N 24 1 x x HiPath 3750 board for connecting 24 analog stations (a/
b, T/R)
Can be installed in Slot level 5 only
SLC16 16 1 x - HiPath 3750 board for connecting 16 CMI base stations
Can be installed in Slot level 5 only
SLMO24 24 1 x x HiPath 3750 board for connecting 24 optiPoint 500 and
optiset E telephones (UP0/E)
Can be installed in Slot level 5 only
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.3.3.2 Trunk Boards
Table 2-9 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3550
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TLA 2 6 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
TLA4 4 6 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
TLA8 8 6 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
TS2 30 30 1 x - Board for primary rate access; can be used for tie trunk
traffic.
STLS2 2 4 6 x - Board for ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and stations (no
feeding) on the same board is possible.
STLS4 4 8 6 x -
TST1 1 24 1 - x PRI board
TMGL4 4 6 - x Trunk board for analog trunks
TMQ4 4 8 6 - x BRI board
TMAMF 8 - - x - Trunk board for analog direct inward dialing (MFC-R2)
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-27
System Overview
2.3.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
2.3.3.4 Options
Table 2-10 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3550
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TS2 30 30 1 x - Board for primary rate access; can be used for tie trunk
traffic.
STLS2 2 4 6 x - Board for ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and stations (no
feeding) on the same board is possible.
STLS4 4 8 6 x -
HXGS2
Voice
and
Data
2 8 4 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3550 sys-
tem directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
Table 2-11 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3550
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
ALUM4 Trunk failure
transfers
4 x x Trunk failure transfer lets you transfer loop start
trunks directly to internal analog stations in the
event of a power failure (note the signaling meth-
od used).
ANI4 Analog trunks 4 - x This board allows calling line identification (caller
ID) in conjunction with TMGL4.
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
GEE12 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (12 kHz) from the trunk.
GEE16 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (16 kHz) from the trunk.
GEE50 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (50 Hz) from the trunk.
OPAL x x Adapter for connecting the CBCC to the first op-
tions board.
V24/1 1 x x One serial V.24 (RS-232) interface for connecting
a PC, printer, or Plus Products.
STBG4 x - Current-limiting module for LS interface (France
only)
EXM Ports 1 x - External music on hold
EXMNA Ports 1 - x External music on hold (A-LAW)
MPPI x - Music on hold (MOH)
UAM x - Announcement before answering/music on hold/
relay/sensor
STRB Sensors 4 x x Control relay module; provides 4 relays and 4
sensors for controlling external devices or detect-
ing external control events.
Relays 4
HXGS2
Voice and
Data
No. of B chan-
nels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3550 system directly to a local data network
(Ethernet).
HXGS2
Data only
No. of B chan-
nels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3550 system directly to a local data network
(Ethernet).
Table 2-11 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3550
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-29
System Overview
2.3.4 Additional System Data
2.3.4.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.3.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
Figure 2-11 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3550
88-264 Vac
maximum 180W
HiPath 3550
Max. heat dissipation: approx. 360 kJ/h
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.3.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
To use the uninterruptible power supply UPSC-D you must connect it to a battery unit
with 48 V (4 x 12 V) using a connecting cable.
The battery charger of the USPC is designed for batteries of up to 1.3 Ah max.
Capacity and Bridging Period with Uninterruptible Power Supply
The specifications of the bridging period for batteries in the event of power failure
have been established under the following conditions:
60% of the power supply has been utilized in the systems,
the ambient temperature of the batteries is +20 degrees Celsius,
the cut-off voltage is 1. V per battery,
the batteries are fully charged when the power failure first occurs.
The following approximate bridging times have been calculated under consideration
of the above conditions:
Voltages per Battery Cell (Example of Yuasa Batteries)
The battery cell voltage is 2.0 V; the available capacity is drawn between 2.3 V and
1.7 V.
Table 2-12 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-D
System Capacity/
battery voltage
Bridging period
HiPath 3550 1.2 Ah/48 V 15 minutes
HiPath 3550 7 Ah/48 V 3 hours
HiPath 3550 12 Ah/48 V 6 hours
Charging voltage with charging current limit: 2.4 V
Charging voltage with no charging current limit: 2.275 V
Discharging voltage: 1.7 V
HiPath 355
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-31
System Overview
2.3.5 Additional Power Supply from the EPSU2
If the capacity of the UPSC-D (HiPath 3550) is not sufficient extra power can be fed
in using the external power supply EPSU2. To do this, connect the DC connection of
the EPSU2 to the special DC input on the UPSC-D.
The EPSU2 is always supplied with UPS batteries which, in the event of a power fail-
ure, will guarantee a bridging period of approximately 30 minutes.
If additional external power feeding is required for HiPath 3500 or HiPath 3300 (19''
housing), the EPSU2-R should be used. This is installed in the expansion cabinet
ECR.
EPSU2 Technical Specifications
Table 2-13 EPSU2 - Technical Specifications
EPSU2
Siemens part numbers S30122-X7221-X1(with UPS/battery packs)
Siemens part numbers, pow-
er cable
C39195-Z7001-C17 Euro angled
C39195-Z7001-C20 GBR angled
EPSU2 batteries V39113-W5123-E891
Scope of delivery AC/DC converter (EPSU2 with UPS batteries
loaded)
Operating instructions
AC connecting cable (protective grounding
plug, IEC-320 socket)
DC cable to UPSC-D (1 m/0.75mm², flexible,
tin-plated at both ends)
AC power 100 - 240 Vac
Frequency range 47 to 63 Hz
Connected output 200 W
Output power consumption/
nominal output
140 W
Mains/nominal voltage 54,2 V
HiPath 3550
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-32 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Battery operation:
Permitted batteries
Manufacturer/type num-
ber
Number of batteries
Size (Ah)
Nominal voltage
Overload protection
CSB/EVX-1270, Hitachi/HP6.5-12, Yuasa/
NP6-12, Varta/Noack 43720303, Sonnen-
schein/0719143200
4 units, 12 V each
1.25 Ah
48 V (fully charged 54 V, discharge to 44 V)
Melting fuse 5 x 20 mm, 2.5 A/slow-blowing
Nominal current 2.5 A
Overload protection Electronic current limiting circuit
Ambient temperature In buildings, + 5 to +45 °C
Humidity 95%/non-condensing
Cooling Natural convection
Protection IP 21 (DIN 40050)
AC port (input) IEC 320/16 (protective grounding power cable/IEC)
DC port (output) Screw terminals for insulated lines:
Rigid = 0.5 2.5 mm2
Flexible = 0.5 2.5 mm2
Housing dimensions (W x D x
H in mm)
250 x 114 x 317
Weight approx. 14.1 kg
Symbol CE
Personal safety, insulation EN60950 and IEC950
Grounding, shielding Protection class 1, output is floating against
ground.
Table 2-13 EPSU2 - Technical Specifications
EPSU2
HiPath 335
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-33
System Overview
2.4 HiPath 3350
2.4.1 Hardware Overview
The HiPath 3350 housing intended for wall mounting (Figure 2-12) contains one shelf
with three slot levels. The slot levels, numbered in ascending order from the attach-
ment side, have the following assignments:
Slot level 1: peripheral boards (two slots)
Slot level 2: CBCC central board only
Slot level 3: optional boards (up to 5 boards)
The power supply unit is located on the back of the subrack.
The HiPath 3350 does not need an external main distribution frame; the connecting
to the peripherals (such as telephones or trunks) connect directly to the boards.
Dimensions and Slots
Figure 2-12 Dimensions and Slots in the HiPath 3350
2
1
Slot levels
3
CBCC
Slot 4Slot 5
OPTIONS
Mounting
surface
460
450
128
Notes:
When mounting the system on the wall, plan for at least 30 cm of clearance on
the board side for replacing the boards.
HiPath 3350
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-34 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.4.2 Central Components
2.4.2.1 CBCC
Introduction
The CBCC (Central Board with Coldfire Com) board performs all central control and
switching functions for HiPath 3350.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath
3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
ADPCM (CMA) clock module
supports the 4-channel CMI connection over BS3/1 to the HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
in the same way as the CMS clock module small, provides the master clock
for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMA is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer)
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
HiPath 335
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-35
System Overview
Interfaces
Eight UP0/E (digital subscriber line interfaces)
With HiPath 3000 V1.2 and later up to 7 BS3/1 base stations can be connected
directly for HiPath cordless
Four T/R (analog subscriber line interface)
Tw o S 0 interfaces (trunk or subscriber)
V.24 interfaces
First V.24 interface on the CBCC; the second interface is implemented using the
option V24/1.
2.4.2.2 PSUP
The power supply point PSUP is intended for use in the wall-mounted housing. The
device plugs into a special slot and is secured by screws. It connects to the power
outlet using a modular power cord. A monitoring LED indicates the presence of the
5 V output voltage.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Ring generator: 75 Vac, 20/25/50 Hz
Partial voltages: +5 Vdc, 48 V
Power consumption: 60 W
HiPath 3350
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-36 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.4.2.3 UPSC-D
Introduction
This board combines the power supply and battery management functions. No other
components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term bat-
tery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Ring generator: 75 Vac, 20/25/50 Hz
Partial voltages: +5 Vdc, 48 V
Battery charger: 4 x 12 V (40.8 V-55.2 V)
Power consumption: approx. 90 W
HiPath 335
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-37
System Overview
2.4.3 Peripheral Components
2.4.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-14 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
4SLA 4 2 x - Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
8SLA 8 2 x x Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
16SLA 16 2 x x Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
IVMP8 8 8 1 x x Boards for the integrated voice mail functions of the Hi-
Path Xpressions Compact.
IVMS8 8 8 1 x x
SLU8 8 16 2 x x Board for connecting optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones (UP0/E)
STLS2 2 4 2 x - Board for ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and stations (no
feeding) on the same board is possible.
STLS4 4 8 2 x x
HiPath 3350
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-38 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.4.3.2 Trunk Boards
2.4.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
Table 2-15 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TLA2 2 2 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
TLA4 4 2 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
TLA8 8 2 x - Trunk board for analog trunks
STLS2 2 4 2 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for connecting
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers (no feeding) on
the same board.
STLS4 4 8 1 x -
TMGL4 4 2 - x Board for connecting analog trunks
TMQ4 4 8 2 - x BRI board
Table 2-16 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
STLS2 2 4 2 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for connecting
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers (no feeding) on
the same board.
STLS4 4 8 1 x -
HiPath 335
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-39
System Overview
2.4.3.4 Options
HXGS2
Voice and
Data
2 8 2 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3350
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
Table 2-17 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
ALUM4 Trunk failure
transfers
4 x x Trunk failure transfer; this board transfers loop
start trunks directly to internal analog stations in
the event of a power failure (note the signaling
method used).
ANI4 Analog trunks 4 - x This board allows calling line identification (caller
ID) in conjunction with TMGL4.
GEE12 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (12 kHz) from the trunk.
GEE16 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (16 kHz) from the trunk.
GEE50 Number of call
charge receiv-
ers
4 x - This optional board records the country-specific
call charge pulses (50 Hz) from the trunk.
Table 2-16 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
HiPath 3350
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-40 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
OPAL x x Adapter for connecting the CBCC to the first op-
tions board
V24/1 Interfaces 1 x x Serial V.24 (RS-232) interfaces for connecting a
PC, printer, or Plus Products
STBG4 x - Current-limiting module for LS interface (France
only)
EXM x - External music on hold
EXMNA - x External music on hold (A-LAW)
MPPI x - Music on hold (MOH)
UAM x - Announcement before answering/music on hold/
relay/sensor
STRB Sensors 4 x x Control relay module; provides 4 relays and 4 sen-
sors for controlling external devices or detecting
external control events.
Relays 4
HXGS2
Voice and
Data
No. of B chan-
nels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3350 system directly to a local data network
(Ethernet).
HXGS2
Data only
No. of B chan-
nels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3350 system directly to a local data network
(Ethernet).
Table 2-17 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3350
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
HiPath 335
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-41
System Overview
2.4.4 Additional System Data
2.4.4.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.4.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
2.4.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
The normal power supply unit PSUP can always be replaced with the UPSC-D unit.
To use the uninterruptible power supply UPSC-D you must connect it to a battery unit
with 48 V (4 x 12 V) using a connecting cable.
Figure 2-13 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3350 with
PSUP/UPSC-D
88-264 Vac
approx. 140 kJ/h
for op. with
PSUP
approx. 180 kJ/h
for op. with
UPSC-D
Max. heat dissipation:
Maximum 90 W
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3350
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-42 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Capacity and Bridging Period with Uninterruptible Power Supply
The specifications of the bridging period for batteries in the event of power failure
have been established under the following conditions:
60% of the power supply has been utilized in the systems,
the ambient temperature of the batteries is +20 degrees Celsius,
the cut-off voltage is 1. V per battery,
the batteries are fully charged when the power failure first occurs.
The following approximate bridging times have been calculated under consideration
of the above conditions:
Table 2-18 Capacity and bridging period for UPSC-D
System Capacity/
battery voltage
Bridging period
HiPath 3350 1.2 Ah/48 V 15 minutes
HiPath 3350 7 Ah/48 V 3 hours
HiPath 3350 12 Ah/48 V 6 hours
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-43
System Overview
2.5 HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.)
2.5.1 System Environment
Figure 2-14 HiPath 3250 System Environment
S0
terminal
Analog
terminals
optiPoint 500
optiset E
BS3/1 / BS3/S
Adapter
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
Service PC
Printer
S0(1)
a/b
UP0/E
Cornet TS
Euro ISDN
S0(2)
V. 2 4
4 x a/b
4 x UP0/E
SBSCO
CorNet slave
S0(2)
S0
option 3
S0
option 4
or
LAN
10BaseT
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0(1)
CorNet slave
S0(2)
S0
option 2
or
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0(1)
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
S0(2)
S0
option 1
or
S0
terminal S0(1)
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.)
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-44 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
The existing S0 interfaces can be used as follows:
Option 1:
S0 (1) for use as a digital trunk circuit
S0 (2) for use as a digital trunk circuit
Option 2:
S0 (1) for use as a digital trunk circuit
S0 (2) for use as a CorNet slave
Option 3:
S0 (1) for connecting an S0 terminal (not fed from the system)
S0 (2) for use as a CorNet slave
Option 4:
S0 (1) for connecting an S0 terminal (not fed from the system)
S0 (2) for use as a digital trunk circuit
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-45
System Overview
2.5.2 Hardware Overview
Mechanical Notes
The HiPath 3250 is a single-cabinet system for mounting on the wall. The system has
four analog and four digital subscriber lines (UP0/E). However, you can double the
number of digital lines by using phone adapters (primary/secondary arrangement).
The housing contains the single-board system and the MDF.
The cables to the peripherals (telephones, trunk connections or other devices) are
connected directly to the board and fed out.
Dimensions
Figure 2-15 HiPath 3250 Dimensions
Mounting
surface
365 mm
293 mm
67 mm
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.)
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-46 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.5.3 Central Components
2.5.4 SBSCO
Introduction
The SBSCO (single board system with coldfire one) S30810-Q2937-A201 is the sin-
gle-board module for HiPath 3250. The board provides the following features and out-
puts:
Functions
Signaling unit (SIU)
PCM highway switching and conference circuit
Battery-buffered real-time clock (approx. 100 hours backup time)
Interfaces
Four digital UP0/E subscriber lines
In HiPath 3000 V1.2 or later, up to three BS3/1 base stations can be connected
directly for HiPath cordless (see Section 2.10, HiPath cordless).
Four analog a/b (T/R) subscriber lines
Two digital S0 interfaces (CO (default) or station)
Clock generator: CMS
Supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350,
HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
Music on hold: MPPI
Announcement before answering: AM
V.24 interface
MMC multimedia card (APS and boot)
LIM LAN interface module
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-47
System Overview
2.5.4.1 PSU One
Introduction
The two following PSU types are used:
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
Technically, the two power supplies are identical and interchangeable.
The devices operating state (on or off) is indicated by a LED.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Power consumption: approx. 25 W
2.5.5 Peripheral Components
HiPath 3250 is the single-board solution (SBS) for a complete switching system. Be-
cause the subscriber line and trunk interfaces are integrated in the control board, no
peripheral boards are necessary.
HiPath 3250 (Not for U.S.)
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-48 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.5.6 Additional System Data
2.5.6.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.5.6.2 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
No uninterruptible power supply can be ordered at this time.
2.5.6.3 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
Figure 2-16 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3250
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 15 kJ/h
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 22 kJ/h
Desktop or plug-type
ac adapter
Maximum 25 W
88 -
264 Vac
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-49
System Overview
2.6 HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.)
2.6.1 System Environment
The existing S0 interfaces can be used as:
S0 (1) for use as a digital trunk circuit
S0 (2) for connecting an S0 terminal (not fed from the system)
Figure 2-17 HiPath 3150 System Environment
S0
terminal
Analog
terminals
optiPoint 500
optiset E
BS3/1 / BS3/S
Adapter
Digital trunk
Euro ISDN
Service PC
Printer
S0(2)
a/b
UP0/E
Cornet TS
Euro ISDN
S0(1)
V. 2 4
4 x a/b
2 x UP0/E
SBSCS
2 x S0
LAN
10BaseT
HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.)
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-50 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.6.2 Hardware Overview
Mechanical Notes
The HiPath 3150 is a single-cabinet system for mounting on the wall. The system has
four analog and two digital subscriber lines (UP0/E). However, you can double the
number of digital lines by using phone adapters (primary/secondary arrangement).
The housing contains the single-board system and the MDF.
The cables to the peripherals (telephones, trunk connections or other devices) are
connected directly to the board and fed out.
Dimensions
Figure 2-18 HiPath 3150 Dimensions
Mounting
surface
365 mm
293 mm
67 mm
HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-51
System Overview
2.6.3 Central Components
2.6.3.1 SBSCS
Introduction
The SBSCS (Single Board System with Coldfire Start) S30810-Q2937-B201 is the
single-board module for HiPath 3150. The board provides the following features and
outputs:
Functions
Signaling unit (SIU)
PCM highway switching and conference circuit
Battery-buffered real-time clock (approx. 100 hours backup time)
Interfaces
Two digital UP0/E subscriber lines
In HiPath 3000 V1.2 and later a single-cell solution can be connected directly with
a BS3/S for HiPath cordless (see Section 2.10, HiPath cordless).
Four analog a/b (T/R) subscriber lines
One digital S0 interface CO, one digital S0 interface station
Clock generator: CMS
Supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350,
HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
Music on hold: MPPI
Announcement before answering: AM
V.24 interface
MMC multimedia card (APS and boot)
LIM LAN interface module
HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.)
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-52 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.6.3.2 PSU One
Introduction
The two following PSU types are used:
S30122-K5837-M
S30122-K5837-S
Technically, the two power supplies are identical and interchangeable.
The devices operating state (on or off) is indicated by a LED.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Power consumption: approx. 25 W
HiPath 3150 (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-53
System Overview
2.6.4 Additional System Data
2.6.4.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.6.4.2 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
No uninterruptible power supply can be ordered at this time.
2.6.4.3 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
Figure 2-19 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3150
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 15 kJ/h
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 22 kJ/h
Desktop or plug-type
ac adapter
Maximum 25 W
88 -
264 Vac
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-54 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.7 HiPath 3700
2.7.1 Hardware Overview
The HiPath 3700 system has a modular structure and as the requirements of the cus-
tomer grow, it can be extended to up to 384 subscriber lines by adding new boards or
cabinets. An additional cabinet is referred to as an expansion cabinet.
You will need a special mounting kit for installing the system in a 19’’ cabinet.
A HiPath 3700 system can include a maximum of three cabinets. The 19’’ cabinets
must be placed beside one another and they must also be accessible from the rear.
The basic cabinet has 7 slots for peripheral boards. Expansion cabinets with 8 slots
each for peripheral boards are implemented for expansions. As a result, when 2 ex-
pansion cabinets are implemented, a total of 23 slots are available for boards; with
the exception of slot 7 in the basic cabinet, which has an installation width of 45mm,
all slots have an installation width of 30mm.
Dimensions
Figure 2-20 HiPath 3700 Dimensions
Depth of the system cabinet: 390 mm
Necessary height units per box for
19 cabinet assembly: 11
(one height unit corresponds to ap-
prox. 1.7 = 43 mm)
EC1
approx. 410 mm
approx. 980 mm
EC2 BC
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-55
System Overview
2.7.2 Board Slots
Nine board slots are available in each cabinet. The following boards are assigned per-
manent slots:
CBCPR central processor board -> slot 01 in the BC
UPSM power supply unit -> slot 09 in the BC, slot 18 in EC1, slot 27 in EC2.
Depending on their width, peripheral boards can be inserted in slots 02 to 08 in the
BC, 10 to 17 in EC1 and 19 to 26 in EC2 (the adhesive label beneath each slot iden-
tifies the slot) (see Figure 2-21).
Slots in Basic and Expansion Cabinets
2.7.2.1 Distribution of PCM Segments
Both expansion cabinets have the same HDLC address, which means that each ex-
pansion cabinet must be connected to a separate HDLC highway. The slots in the ba-
sic cabinet are assigned to HDLC highway 0. Because HDLC highway 0 is connected
to expansion cabinet 2 and the basic cabinet simultaneously, the basic cabinet re-
ceives its own collision-free HDLC addresses.
The new slot 7 implemented in basic 8-slot cabinets is connected in parallel with slots
5 and 6. This slot provides connections for a total of two S2M boards, which means
than only four B channels are available for the third slot (such as TIEL). In the expan-
sion cabinets, every two PCM highways are routed to two adjacent slots in both cab-
inets, providing 64 B channels for four slots in a three-cabinet system.
The basic and expansion cabinets are connected in a star configuration.
Figure 2-21 Slot numbers and widths in 8-Slot BC, EC1, and EC2
CBCPR
10
19
45/30
X10
02
11
20
30
X20
03
12
21
30
X30
04
13
22
30
X40
08
17
26
45/30
X80
UPSM
UPSM
UPSM
90
X90
BC:
EC1:
EC2:
mm
05
14
23
30
X50
06
15
24
30
X60
07
16
25
30
X70
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-56 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
To guarantee that the system operates without blocking, make sure when you do the
configuration that the boards on a PCM segment do not require more than the 64
time-division multiplex channels that are available. The following table lists the num-
ber of time-division multiplex channels that the different boards require.
Table 2-19 Number of Time-Division Multiplex Channels Required Per Board
Board Number of time-division multiplex channels re-
quired
CR8N 8
HXGM 16
IVML8 8
IVML24 24
SLA8N, SLA16N, SLA24N Depends on the number of stations
SLC16 Depends on the number of mobile telephones logged
on
SLMO8, SLMO24 Depends on the number of stations (hosts (master)
and clients (slaves))
STMD8 16
TIEL 4
TML8W 8
TMOM 1
TMS2 30
TMT1 24
Caution
To guarantee that the system operates without blocking, it is necessary that you ob-
serve the following rules for the configuration of boards:
SLC16
A maximum of one SLC16 per PCM segment; if possible, the SLC16 should
stay alone on the PCM segment.
IVML8, IVML24
A maximum of one IVML8 or IVML24 per system.
Only in the slot next to the UPSM in the basic cabinet (slot 08).
You may not insert an SLMO8, SLMO24, or SLC16 on the PCM segment
of the IVML8 or IVML24.
If there is a TMS2 on the PCM segment of the IVML8 or IVML24, only a
TIEL, TMOM, or TML8W is allowed on the free slot.
SLMO24
A maximum of two SLMO24s per PCM segment; the number of connected sta-
tions (hosts (master) and clients (slaves)) may not be more than 64.
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-57
System Overview
The illustrations below show the PCM segments (64 time-division multiplex channels
each) between the different HiPath 3700 system configurations.
PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System
PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System
Figure 2-22 PCM Segments for a One-Cabinet System
Figure 2-23 PCM Segments for a Two-Cabinet System
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
8-Slot cabinets
BC
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
8-Slot cabinets
1
0
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
7
U
P
S
M
1
4
1
5
1
6
BC EC1
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-58 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System
Figure 2-24 PCM Segments for a Three-Cabinet System
8-Slot cabinets
C
B
C
P
R
0
2
0
3
0
4
0
8
U
P
S
M
0
5
0
6
0
7
1
9
2
0
2
1
2
2
2
6
U
P
S
M
2
3
2
4
2
5
BC EC2
1
0
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
7
U
P
S
M
1
4
1
5
1
6
EC1
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-59
System Overview
2.7.3 Central Components
2.7.3.1 CBCPR
Introduction
The CBCPR board performs all central control and switching functions for HiPath
3700.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 4, 8 and 12 channel CMI connections using the SLC16 board in
the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer)
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
V.24 Interfaces
To connect a service PC, you can access the first V.24 interface (9-pin SUB-D
plug) on the CBCPR from the front of the basic cabinet (after removing the cov-
er).
You can access the second V.24 interface (25-pin SUB-D plug) via the back-
plane of the basic cabinet (X7).
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-60 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.7.3.2 UPSM
Introduction
Each cabinet in HiPath 3700 requires one UPSM (uninterruptible power supply mod-
ular). This board integrates the power supply and battery management functions. No
other components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term
battery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect one of the following to the UPSM:
One battery pack per system cabinet
One battery cabinet (BSG 48/38), including battery charger, or
One 48 Vdc network
An LED lights up to indicate that the UPSM is in operation. The UPSM must be re-
placed when defective (LED does not light up).
The UPSM is used in models for all countries. The ring frequency of the modular ring
generator can be parameterized to suit requirements.
Part Numbers
UPSM: S30122-K5950-S100, S30122-K5950-A100
Battery pack 4 x 12 V/7 Ah: S30122-K5950-Y200
(The connecting cable for the UPSM is part of the battery pack.)
Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 VAC - 240 VAC
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Max. input current consumption: 5.4 A - 2.7 A
Max. power consumption: around 430 W
Output voltage (battery charging voltage): 42.5 - 55.2 VDC
Output current (battery charge current): 0.8 A
(sufficient for battery set rating) = 7 Ah)
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-61
System Overview
Bridging times for power supplied via the battery pack 4 x 12 V or 7 Ah:
At 100% nominal load: approx. 60 min. bridging time
At 60% nominal load: approx. 100 min. bridging time
The battery recharging time is approx. 8.5 h.
Boundary conditions for the specified bridging times:
battery ambient temperature is approx. 22°C
The cut-off voltage is 1.7 V per cell
New batteries are fully charged.
Specifications of the Modular Ring Generator
Rated output voltages: 60/75 Vact
Output frequencies: 20/25/50 Hz
Output power
continuous: 4.0 VA
peak: 8.0 VA (3 minutes load/ 15 minutes pause)
BSG 48/38
You can use a BSG 48/38 battery cabinet in an upright housing instead of the battery
pack or a 48 V direct current supply to extend the bridging time in the event of a power
failure. The BSG 48/38 battery cabinet (S30122-K5950-F300) consists of
an upright housing
a charging rectifier
a 38 Ah/48 V battery set
The battery cabinet is designed for direct connection to the HiPath 3700 communica-
tion system.
2.7.3.3 LIM
The LAN interface module LIM (S30807-Q6930-X) is an optional subboard for all Hi-
Path 3000 central control boards (see also Section 4.2.1).
The board provides an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mb) LAN connection via an 8-pole
RJ45 jack.
You cannot operate the LIM module and a HiPath HG1500 board simultaneously in
one system.
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-62 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.7.4 Peripheral Components
2.7.4.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-20 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3700
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
IVML8 8 8 1 1 x x Boards for the integrated voice mail functions of the
HiPath Xpressions Compact.
IVML24 24 24 1 1 x x
SLA16 16 6 15 x x Board for connecting up to 16 analog telephones to
the system; also for connecting fax machines, mo-
dems, radio paging equipment, equipment for exter-
nal music on hold, and voice mail systems.
SLA8N 8 6 18 x - Board with 8 analog interfaces1
1 250 stations are possible in the maximum configuration.
SLA16N 16 6 15 x x Board with 16 analog interfaces1
SLA24N 24 6 10 x x Board with 24 analog interfaces1
SLC16 16 64 12
2 Exception: basic cabinets can have 2 SLC16 boards.
4 x - Board for connecting up to 16 CMI base stations (mo-
bile telephones) to the system.
SLMO8 8 16 6 18 x - Board for connecting optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones. The SLMO board comes in 8- and 24-port
versions.
SLMO24 24 48 83
3 The maximum number of SLMO24 boards per cabinet depends on the number of slave stations.
16 x x
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x x ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for configuring
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers on the same
board.
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-63
System Overview
2.7.4.2 Trunk Boards
Table 2-21 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3700
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TML8W 8 81
1 4 boards max. per cabinet in the case of TML8W with installed GEE8.
15 x - Board with eight ports for connecting loop start
trunks.
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for configuring
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers on the
same board.
TMS2 30 30 4 4 x - Basic rate interface (BRI) board; can also be used
for tie trunk traffic.
TMST1 24 24 6 6 - x ISDN interface board
TMDID 8 3 9 - x Analog trunk board for direct inward dialing
TMGL8 8 6 15 - x Analog trunk board (ground/loop start)
TMAMF 8 x - Analog trunk board for direct inward dialing (MFC-
R2)
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-64 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.7.4.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
2.7.4.4 Options
Table 2-22 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3700
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Boards per cabinet
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TIEL 4 6 18 x x Board for providing four two-way analog tie trunk cir-
cuits with E&M signaling.
STMD8 8 16 6 8 x - ISDN basic rate interface (BRI) board for connecting
ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers (no feeding)
on the same board.
HXGM2 2 16 6 8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath
3700 system directly to a local data network (Ether-
net).
TMS2 30 30 4 4 x - Basic rate interface (BRI) board; can also be used for
tie trunk traffic.
Table 2-23 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3700
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
TMOM Ports per
board
4 x - TMOM board with four ports which provides the inter-
face for connecting a radio paging system. Availability
is country-specific. Standards supported:
ESPA 4.4.3 and ESPA 4.4.5 (6-wire)
a,b,c,d interface
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-65
System Overview
TIEL Ports per
board
4 x x Board for connecting announcement equipment (with
start/stop signaling for announcement before answer-
ing) in addition to its tie trunk circuit function.
REAL Relay con-
nections
4 x x Board for relay connection (such as a door opener) and
power failure transfer (ALUM). The board is located on
the basic cabinet's backplane.
Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
1
PFT1 Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
1 x - PFT1 and PFT4 boards for connection to the patch
panel and transferring calls from analog trunks to a
telephone in a power failure (note the signaling method
used).
PFT4 Trunk fail-
ure trans-
fers
4x -
GEE8 Number of
analog
trunks sup-
ported
8 x - Board for recording call charge pulses from the trunk
on a country-specific basis for up to eight trunks. The
board can be plugged into the TML8 analog trunk cir-
cuit board.
HXGM2
(Voice &
Data)
No. of B
channels
16 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3700
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HXGM2
(Data)
No. of B
channels
16 x x
CR8N x x The board has eight code transmitters and receivers.
LIM x x Ethernet (10BaseT) interface
Table 2-23 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3700
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-66 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.7.5 Additional System Data
2.7.5.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.7.5.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
2.7.5.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply UPSM
Please refer to Section 2.7.3.2 for details on the UPSM.
UPSM Bridging Times with Different Battery Packs per Cabinet
Figure 2-25 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of one HiPath 3700 Cab-
inet
Table 2-24 UPSM Bridging Times with Different Battery Packs per Cabinet
Number of Extensions Approximate Bridging Time
7 Ah battery set 38 Ah battery set
10 - 20 1 h 50 min 7 h 30 min
21 - 40 1 h 20 min 6 h 30 min
41 - 68 1 h 5 h
69 - 80 50 min 4 h 30 min
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 850 kJ/h
Maximum 430 W
88-264 Vac
Cabinet with UPSM
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-67
System Overview
UPSM and Battery Packs with no Ext. Charging Rectifiers
Figure 2-26 Connecting the UPSM to Battery Packs
EC1
BC
48 V/7 Ah
48 V/7 Ah
48 V/7 Ah
Battery packs
UPSM
UPSM UPSM
EC2
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
S30122-K5959-Y200
Note: This diagram shows
only the schematic connec-
tions between the different
components.
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
HiPath 3700
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-68 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Connecting the UPSM to Battery Packs and Ext. Charging Rectifiers
Figure 2-27 Connecting the UPSM, Ext. Charging Recitifiers and Battery Packs
EC1
EC2
48 V/38 Ah
Charging rectifier
External battery
UPSM
UPSM UPSM
48 V
48 V
48 V
e.g. BSG 4838
Note: This diagram shows
only the schematic connec-
tions between the different
components.
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz BC
88-264 V ~
50-60/25 Hz
HiPath 370
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-69
System Overview
2.7.5.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada)
When installing the system, an ECR in the 19’’ cabinet is required if emergency bat-
tery operation is necessary during a power failure or if the system requires uninter-
ruptible power. The necessary battery pack is installed in the ECR.
One ECR for each system cabinet is required.
There are switches for the line and battery voltage on the front panel as well as a fuse
for protecting the battery circuit.
The jacks for the line and battery voltage are located on the rear of the housing. The
line voltage is only fed through and can be interrupted using a switch.
HiPath 3500
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-70 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.8 HiPath 3500
2.8.1 Hardware Overview
Mechanical Notes
The HiPath 3500 housing intended for use with 19 cabinets (Figure 2-28) contains
four slot levels with the following assignments:
Slot levels 1-3: slide-in shelves for peripheral boards (2 boards can be plugged
in on each level)
Slot level 4: slide-in shelf for CBRC control board
Slot level 5: optional boards (up to 3 modules)
The power supply is on the rear panel of the subrack.
The connection to peripherals (telephones, trunks, and others) is done using MW8
sockets in the front panels of the boards.
Dimensions and Slots
Figure 2-28 HiPath 3500 Dimensions and Slots
Necessary height units for 19 cabinet assembly: 4
(one height unit corresponds to approx. 1.7 = 43 mm)
Slot 4 Slot 5
Slot 8 Slot 9
Slot 6 Slot 7
Slots 1-3
Slot levels:
5 (options)
4 (CBRC)
3 (peripheral boards)
2 (peripheral boards)
1 (peripheral boards)
440 mm
380 mm
155 mm
HiPath 350
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-71
System Overview
2.8.2 Central Components
2.8.2.1 CBRC
Introduction
The CBRC (Central Board Rack with Coldfire Com) board performs all central control
and switching functions for HiPath 3500.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath
3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
ADPCM (CMA) clock module
supports the 4-channel CMI connection over BS3/1 to the HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
in the same way as the CMS clock module small, provides the master clock
for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMA is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer)
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
HiPath 3500
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-72 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Interfaces
Eight UP0/E (digital subscriber line interfaces)
Up to 7 BS3/1 base stations can be connected directly for HiPath cordless
Four analog a/b (T/R) subscriber lines
Two digital S0 interfaces (CO (default) or station)
One V.24 interface
2.8.2.2 UPSC-DR
Introduction
This board combines the power supply and battery management functions. No other
components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term bat-
tery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Ring generator: 75 Vac, 20/25/50 Hz
Partial voltages: +5 Vdc, 48 V
Battery charger: 4 x 12 V (40.8 V-55.2 V)
Power consumption: approx. 180 W
HiPath 350
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-73
System Overview
2.8.3 Peripheral Components
2.8.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-25 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3500
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
8SLAR 8 5 x x Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
IVMS8R 8 8 1 x x Board for the integrated voice mail functions of the HiPath
Xpressions Compact.
SLU8R 8 16 5 x x Board for connecting optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones (UP0/E)
STLS4R 4 8 6 x x Board for providing ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers
(no feeding) on the same board is possible.
HiPath 3500
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-74 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.8.3.2 Trunk Boards
2.8.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
Table 2-26 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3500
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TLA4R 4 6 x - Trunk board for analog lines including ALUM and call me-
tering receiving equipment board
TMGL4R 4 6 - x Trunk board for analog lines
TST1 1 24 1 - x PRI board
STLS4R 4 8 6 x x Board for providing ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers
(no feeding) on the same board is possible.
Table 2-27 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3500
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
HXGSR2
Voice and
Data
2 8 4 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3500
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HiPath 350
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-75
System Overview
2.8.3.4 Options
Table 2-28 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3500
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
ANI4R Analog
trunks
4 - x This board allows calling line identification (caller ID)
in conjunction with TMGL4R.
OPALR x x Adapter for connecting the CBRC to the first options
board.
EXMR x x External music on hold
MPPI x - Music on hold (MOH)
UAMR x - Announcement before answering/music on hold/relay/
sensor
STRBR Sensors 4 x x Control relay module; provides 4 relays and 4 sensors
for controlling external devices or detecting external
control events.
Relays 4
HXGSR2
Voice and
Data
No. of B
channels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3500
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HXGSR2
Data only
No. of B
channels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3500
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HiPath 3500
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-76 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.8.4 Additional System Data
2.8.4.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.8.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
2.8.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
To use the uninterruptible power supply UPSC-D you must connect it to a battery unit
with 48 V (4 x 12 V) using a connecting cable.
Capacity and Bridging Period with Uninterruptible Power Supply
The specifications of the bridging period for batteries in the event of power failure
have been established under the following conditions:
60% of the power supply has been utilized in the systems,
the ambient temperature of the batteries is +20 degrees Celsius,
the cut-off voltage is 1. V per battery,
the batteries are fully charged when the power failure first occurs.
The following approximate bridging times have been calculated under consideration
of the above conditions:
Figure 2-29 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption of HiPath 3500
88-264 Vac
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 180 kJ/h
Maximum 90 W
HiPath 3500
HiPath 350
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-77
System Overview
2.8.4.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada)
When installing the system, an ECR in the 19’’ cabinet is required if emergency bat-
tery operation is necessary during a power failure or if the system requires uninter-
ruptible power. The necessary battery pack is installed in the ECR.
There are switches for the line and battery voltage on the front panel as well as a fuse
for protecting the battery circuit.
The jacks for the line and battery voltage are located on the rear of the housing. The
line voltage is only fed through and can be interrupted using a switch.
Table 2-29 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-DR
System Capacity/
battery voltage
Bridging period
HiPath 3500 1,2 Ah/48 V 15 minutes
HiPath 3500 7 Ah/48 V 3 hours
HiPath 3500 12 Ah/48 V 6 hours
HiPath 3300
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-78 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.9 HiPath 3300
2.9.1 Hardware Overview
Mechanical Notes
The HiPath 3300 housing intended for use with 19 cabinets (Figure 2-30) contains
three slot levels with the following assignments:
Slot level 1: slide-in shelves for two peripheral boards
Slot level 2: slide-in shelf for CBRC control board
Slot level 3: optional boards (up to 3 modules)
The power supply is on the rear panel of the subrack.
The connection to peripherals (telephones, trunks, and others) is done using MW8
sockets in the front panels of the boards.
Dimensions and Slots
Figure 2-30 HiPath 3300 Dimensions and Slots
80 mm
440 mm
380 mm
Slot 4 Slot 5
Slots 1-3
Slot levels:
3 (options)
2 (CBRC)
1 (peripheral boards)
Necessary height units for 19 cabinet assembly: 2
(one height unit corresponds to approx. 1.7 = 43 mm)
HiPath 330
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-79
System Overview
2.9.2 Central Components
2.9.2.1 CBRC
Introduction
The CBRC (Central Board Rack with Coldfire Com) board performs all central control
and switching functions for HiPath 3300.
Subboards
Depending on the application, the following subboards (some of which are optional)
can be implemented:
CMS clock module small
supports all 2-channel cordless connections to the HiPath 3550, HiPath
3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
provides the master clock for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMS is used.
ADPCM (CMA) clock module
supports the 4-channel CMI connection over BS3/1 to the HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 systems.
in the same way as the CMS clock module small, provides the master clock
for digital networking.
Table 2-35 contains additional information on when CMA is used.
MMC multimedia card
This plug-in memory card contains the CDB backup and the version-specific
APS. It should be noted that the MMC can only be replaced by one of the multi-
media cards released by Siemens AG. Cards that have not been released may
have a different internal structure, which will affect timed access and some fea-
tures (for example, CDB backup and APS Transfer)
IMODC integrated modem card Columbus
This plug-in card allows remote service (analog mode up to 14.4 Kbps), without
having to use an external modem
LIM LAN interface module
This subboard makes available an Ethernet (10BaseT/10 Mbit) LAN connection
using an 8-pin RJ45 jack.
MPPI (music on hold)
HiPath 3300
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-80 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Interfaces
Eight UP0/E (digital subscriber line interfaces)
Up to 3 BS3/1 base stations can be connected directly for HiPath cordless
Four analog a/b (T/R) subscriber lines
Two digital S0 interfaces (CO (default) or station)
One V.24 interface
2.9.2.2 UPSC-DR
Introduction
This board combines the power supply and battery management functions. No other
components are required if operated as a power supply. To maintain short-term bat-
tery emergency operation after a power failure, that is, to use uninterruptible power
supply functions, you must also connect a battery pack.
Technical Specifications
Nominal voltage range: 100 Vac - 240 Vac
Nominal frequency: 50 Hz - 60 Hz
Ring generator: 75 Vac, 20/25/50 Hz
Partial voltages: +5 Vdc, 48 V
Battery charger: 4 x 12 V (40.8 V-55.2 V)
Power consumption: approx. 90 W
HiPath 330
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-81
System Overview
2.9.3 Peripheral Components
2.9.3.1 Subscriber Line Modules
Table 2-30 Subscriber Line Modules for the HiPath 3300
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
8SLAR 8 2 x x Board for connecting analog stations (a/b, T/R)
IVMP8R 8 8 1 x x Boards for the integrated voice mail functions of the Hi-
Path Xpressions Compact.
IVMS8R 8 8 1 x x
SLU8R 8 16 2 x x Board for connecting optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones (UP0/E)
STLS4R 4 8 1 x x Board for providing ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers
(no feeding) on the same board is possible.
HiPath 3300
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-82 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.9.3.2 Trunk Boards
2.9.3.3 Boards for Tie Trunk Traffic
Table 2-31 Trunk Boards for the HiPath 3300
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
TLA4R 4 2 x - Trunk board for analog lines including ALUM and call me-
tering receiving equipment board
TMGL4R 4 2 - x Trunk board for analog lines
STLS4R 4 8 1 x x Board for providing ISDN basic rate access.
Configuration of ISDN trunks, tie trunks, and subscribers
(no feeding) on the same board is possible.
Table 2-32 Tie Trunk Traffic Boards for the HiPath 3300
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Ports per board
B channels per board
Max. number of
boards per system
Rest of world
U.S.
HXGSR2
Voice and
Data
2 8 2 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3300
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HiPath 330
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-83
System Overview
2.9.3.4 Options
Table 2-33 Optional Boards for the HiPath 3300
Board
Name
Capacity Country Type/Description
Rest of world
U.S.
ANI4R Analog
trunks
4 - x This board allows calling line identification (caller ID)
in conjunction with TMGL4R.
OPALR x x Adapter for connecting the CBRC to the first options
board.
EXMR x x External music on hold
MPPI x - Music on hold (MOH)
UAMR x - Announcement before answering/music on hold/relay/
sensor
STRBR Sensors 4 x x Control relay module; provides 4 relays and 4 sensors
for controlling external devices or detecting external
control events.
Relays 4
HXGSR2
Voice and
Data
No. of B
channels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3300
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HXGSR2
Data only
No. of B
channels
8 x x HiPath HG1500 board for connecting the HiPath 3300
system directly to a local data network (Ethernet).
HiPath 3300
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-84 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.9.4 Additional System Data
2.9.4.1 System-related capacity limits
see Table 2-1
2.9.4.2 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption
2.9.4.3 Specifications for the Uninterruptible Power Supply
The power supply unit PSUP can always be replaced with the UPSC-D unit.
To use the uninterruptible power supply UPSC-D you must connect it to a battery unit
with 48 V (4 x 12 V) using a connecting cable.
Figure 2-31 Heat Dissipation and Power Consumption ofHiPath 3300
88-264 Vac
Max. heat dissipation:
approx. 180 kJ/h
Maximum 90 W
HiPath 3300
HiPath 330
0
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-85
System Overview
Capacity and Bridging Period with Uninterruptible Power Supplies
The specifications of the bridging period for batteries in the event of power failure
have been established under the following conditions:
60% of the power supply has been utilized in the systems,
the ambient temperature of the batteries is +20 degrees Celsius,
the cut-off voltage is 1. V per battery,
the batteries are fully charged when the power failure first occurs.
The following approximate bridging times have been calculated under consideration
of the above conditions:
2.9.4.4 Expansion Cabinet Rack ECR (Not for U.S. and Canada)
When installing the system, an ECR in the 19’’ cabinet is required if emergency bat-
tery operation is necessary during a power failure or if the system requires uninter-
ruptible power. The necessary battery pack is installed in the ECR.
There are switches for the line and battery voltage on the front panel as well as a fuse
for protecting the battery circuit.
The jacks for the line and battery voltage are located on the rear of the housing. The
line voltage is only connected through and can be interrupted using a switch.
Table 2-34 Capacity and Bridging Period for UPSC-DR
System Capacity/
battery voltage
Bridging period
HiPath 3300 1,2 Ah/48 V 15 minutes
HiPath 3300 7 Ah/48 V 3 hours
HiPath 3300 12 Ah/48 V 6 hours
HiPath cordless
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-86 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.10 HiPath cordless
2.10.1 Introduction
For Version 1.2 and later of HiPath 3000, HiPath cordless can be used on all systems
in the product line.
The newly developed BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X) base station can be
directly connected to the UP0/E interfaces in the central control boards for HiPath
3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
directly connected to the UP0/E interfaces in the SLC16 board for HiPath 3750,
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3700.
To ensure the operation of a maximum of one base station on the central control
boards UP0/E interfaces of the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150,
HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300, a BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100) single-cell base sta-
tion can be used. In this case, it is not possible to expand with additional base sta-
tions.
A mix of both the BS2/2 (S30807-H5471-X200), BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X), and BS3/
3 (S30807-H5485-X) base stations may be used on one SLC16 board.
However, the BS3/1 base station cannot be simultaneously connected to the SLC16
board and the CBCC within one HiPath 3550 system.
Up to four SLC16 boards can be used within HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700. These
boards provide complete cordless functionality (roaming and seamless connection
handover) (refer to Section 2.10.2.3).
The new air synchronization (DECT node synchronization DNS) feature is now avail-
able in all HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 systems that have CBCC and in all HiPath
3500 and HiPath 3300 systems that have CBRC. This feature connects networked
systems to one another using so-called synchronization base stations or SBS. This
enables system-wide handover. Air synchronization does not require additional hard-
ware.
HiPath cordles
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-87
System Overview
2.10.2 System Properties
2.10.2.1 System Connection
Depending on the expansion level, the system is connected up to the system control
via radio switching stations or directly. The entire cordless system is controlled and
the station data administered directly by the system software; the advantage of this
is that system administration is made very simple.
The number of base stations and handsets that are supported will depend on the ex-
pansion level. Each of the UP0/E interfaces can make available 2 or 4 voice channels
depending on the hardware configuration, which means that in the entire cordless
range with 4 radio switching stations up to 256 connections can be established. A
maximum of 7 base stations and up to 28 connections are possible with a direct con-
nection.
2.10.2.2 Multi-cell Technology
The radio coverage that is required in the building or in the companys grounds is pro-
vided by multi-cell technology. In this process, the radio cells of the base stations in-
stalled in the company overlap which means that calls in the whole cordless system
area can be set up and processed seamlessly even when you change location
(Roaming and Handover).
Figure 2-32 Basic Architecture of a HiPath cordless System
CorNet-N networking
System 1
BS3/1
BS3/1
HiPath 3000
V1.2
System 2
BS3/1
BS3/1
HiPath 3000
V1.2
HiPath cordless
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-88 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.10.2.3 System Networking
Up to four SLC16 boards can be implemented within the HiPath 3750 and the HiPath
3700 systems. Consequently, unlimited availability (Roaming and Handover) can be
achieved by a single system in a range with up to 64 base stations and 250 handsets
(mobile telephones).
Various versions of this functionality are also offered network-wide. Dedicated lines
must be available between the systems by means of the CorNet N protocol to be able
to use this functionality. Voice connections are switched through and data is ex-
changed over the dedicated line.
Network-wide Roaming
Network-wide roaming guarantees the connection within a network. When you
roam between the network nodes, the connection is interrupted. A total of up to 16
nodes can support the Network-wide roaming function.
Seamless Connection Handover
The Seamless Connection Handover function is also supported in the network by
the HiPath 3550 (without SLC16), HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 sys-
tems only. Up to 4 nodes are supported.
The networking range is limited to the receiving range of the base stations, which are
required for synchronizing the radio ranges.
In addition to the dedicated line for Network-wide roaming, you will also need to syn-
chronize the base stations in various nodes.
Feature HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
with
SLC16
HiPath 3550
without
SLC16
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
max. 16 networked systems
accessible using a common
station number (roaming
among the systems/nodes)
call interruption when changing
between systems/nodes
XXXX
HiPath cordles
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-89
System Overview
Feature HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
with
SLC16
HiPath 3550
without
SLC16
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
max. 4 networked systems
accessible using a common
station number (roaming
among the systems/nodes)
no call interruption when
changing between the sys-
tems/nodes (seamless con-
nection handover)
XX
Figure 2-33 HiPath cordless - Network-wide Roaming and Handover
HiPath cordless
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-90 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.10.2.4 Important Features of HiPath cordless
Access to the functionality of the communication systems HiPath 3000 such as
automatic recall, conference or call forwarding for example.
Personal preference settings
Each subscriber has his or her own station number
Area coverage throughout the network
High level of privacy through DECT/GAP standard
Voice quality matches that of a corded telephone
The user interface for the mobile telephones has been largely adapted to that of
the optiset E telephones.
HiPath cordles
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-91
System Overview
2.10.3 System Configuration
The following table indicates the maximum possible system configuration parameters
for the HiPath cordless. It also shows when
CMA or CMS is necessary.
an analog trunk access is possible.
Table 2-35 HiPath cordless - System Configuration
System SLC16 CMA/
CMS
Base stations Simultaneous calls per BS Maxi-
mum-
number
of MTs
Analog
trunk ac-
cess
BS3/1 BS3/S BS2/2
BS3/3
BS3/1 BS3/S BS2/2 BS3/3
HiPath 3150 CMS max.1 ––2–– 8no
HiPath 3250 CMS max. 3 ––2––– 8no
CMS max. 1 ––2–– 8no
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
CMS max. 1 ––2–– 8no
CMA max. 1 ––4–– 8yes
CMA max. 3 ––4––– 16 yes
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
CMS max. 1 ––2–– 8no
CMA max. 1 ––4–– 8yes
CMA max. 7 ––4––– 32 yes
HiPath 3550 max. 1 CMS max. 16 max. 8 4 812 64 yes
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
max. 4 CMS max. 64 max. 32 4 812250 (with
4SLC16)
yes
Comments:
BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X) is a new base station (Figure 2-34) that supports a maximum
of 4 calls simultaneously.
BS2/2 (S30807-H5471-X200) is a base station that facilitates up to 8 simultaneous calls.
BS3/3 (S30807-H5485-X) is a new base station that can only be operated using the
SLC16 board. The connection via at least two UP0/E interfaces is essential. It supports a
maximum of 12 calls when connected using three UP0/E interfaces.
BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100): The BS3/S single-cell base station guarantees the opera-
tion of a maximum of one base station on the UP0/E interfaces of the central board. It is
not possible to operate additional base stations.
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300: It is possible to operate the BS3/1
base station on the UP0/E interfaces of the central board only in connection with the CMA
clock module.
HiPath cordless
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-92 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.10.4 Components of HiPath cordless
2.10.4.1 Mobile Telephones
The mobile telephones in the Gigaset series can be used from 2000. A detailed de-
scription of these mobile telephones is provided in Section 6.6
2.10.4.2 Base Stations
Types
BS3/1 (S30807-H5482-X) is a new base station (Figure 2-34) that supports a
maximum of 4 calls simultaneously
BS2/2 (S30807-H5471-X200) is a base station that facilitates up to 8 simulta-
neous calls (only with upgrades).
BS3/3 (S30807-H5485-X) is a new base station that can only be operated using
the SLC16 board. The connection via at least two UP0/E interfaces is essential. It
supports a maximum of 12 calls when connected using three UP0/E interfaces.
Figure 2-34 Base Station BS3/1 S30807-H5482-X
HiPath cordles
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-93
System Overview
BS3/S (X30807-X5482-X100): The BS3/S single-cell base station guarantees
the operation of a maximum of one base station on the UP0/E interfaces of the
central board. It is not possible to operate additional base stations.
Technical Specifications
Table 2-36 Technical Data for Various Base Stations
Parameter BS3/1 and BS3/S BS3/3 Outdoor cover
Power supply voltage
range
42 to 54 V 42 to 54 V
Power consumption max. 1.70 W max. 3.20 W
Housing dimensions
(W x D x H in mm)
181 x 139 x 69 202 x 172 x 43 296 x 256 x 90
Weight approx. 0.3 kg approx. 0.5 kg approx. 1.0 kg
Temperature range for indoor use:
5 to + 50 oC
for outdoor use:
20 to + 45 oC
Relative humidity ––up to 95 %
Technical Specifications
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-94 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.11 Technical Specifications
The power consumption values for PSU and UPS apply at full load.
The UPS power consumption values include simultaneous battery charging. UPS
power consumption drops to PSU levels during maintenance charging.
Higher power consumption levels can be achieved by installing a UPSC-D in the Hi-
Path 3350 (PSU power consumption = 100 W and UPS power consumption = 130
W).
Table 2-37 Technical Specifications
Maximum sys-
tem values
HiPath
3750
HiPath
3550
HiPath
3350
HiPath
3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath
3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath
3700
HiPath
3500
HiPath
3300
Power consump-
tion of PSU
––60 W 25 W 25 W ––
Power consump-
tion of UPS1
1 UPS not for U.S.
430 W 180 W 90 W ––430 W 180 W 90 W
Line voltage 100 240 VAC (not for U.S); 120 VAC (for U.S. only)
AC line frequency 50 60 Hz (not for U.S); 60 Hz (for U.S. only)
Weight 22 kg
(48.46 lb.)
(per fully
equipped
cabinet)
8 kg
(17.62 lb.)
6 kg
(13.22 lb.)
0,7 kg
(1.54 lb.)
0,7 kg
(1.54 lb.)
22 kg
(48.46 lb.)
(per fully
equipped
cabinet)
8 kg
(17.62 lb.)
6 kg
(13.22 lb.)
Expansion cabinet rack ECR
(not for U.S. and Canada):
6.5 kg (14.32 lb.) without
battery pack
17.5 kg (38,54 lb.) with bat-
tery pack
Interface
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-95
System Overview
2.12 Interfaces
Table 2-38 Subscriber Line Interfaces
Station Interface Connection Protocol
Digital UPO/E (2-chan-
nel)
optiPoint 500 and optiset E tele-
phones with adapters or UP0/E
card
CorNet-TS
Analog a/b (T/R) Analog telephones, group 2, 3 fax,
Vtx, voice mail, data via V.24 (RS-
232) adapter (modem), announce-
ment devices, MOH
DTMF/DP
Cordless UPO/E CMI base station CorNet-TR
Digital (ISDN)
Nonvoice
S0 (2-channel) S0 PC card, group 4 fax, tele-
phones (no feeding)
DSS1
Table 2-39 Trunk and Tie Traffic Interfaces
Trunk traffic/
tie traffic
Interface Connection Protocol
Digital S2M FV (30-channel)
(FV = dedicated line)
ISDN trunk
Tie trunk networking
DSS1
CorNet N
QSig
Digital S0 FV (2-channel)
(FV = dedicated line)
ISDN trunk
Tie trunk networking
DSS1
CorNet N
QSig
Analog LS Analog trunk, PSE DTMF/DP
Analog E&M Analog tie trunk DTMF/DP
IP LAN 10BaseT 10/100 TCP/IP
Interfaces
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-96 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
Table 2-40 Interfaces for Options
Option Interface Connection Protocol
Profi-PSE ESPA PSE
Announcement
before answer-
ing
a/b (T/R)
E&M
Announcement device without start/
stop control or with start/stop control
V.24/CSTA V.24 (RS-232) Service PC (first V.24 (RS-232) inter-
face), applications (CSTA) or call de-
tail printer/call charge computer
(second V.24 (RS-232) interface)
optiClient Atten-
dant
UP0/E optiClient Attendant via UP0/E card or
control adapter
CorNet-
TS
Floating con-
tacts
Relays Door opener, messenger call, and
others, 4 floating contacts
ALUM Relays Analog power failure transfer for 4
trunks
Interface-to-Interface Range
s
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-97
System Overview
2.13 Interface-to-Interface Ranges
Telephone Interface-to-Interface Ranges
Trunk and CorNet-N Ranges
The table below provides the maximum cable lengths for direct trunk and CorNet-N
wiring. The values apply to ideal conditions, which means that there can be no joints.
The real conditions must be measured on-site.
Table 2-41 Telephone Interface-to-Interface Ranges (with J-Y (ST) 2x2x0,6,
0.6 mm diameter)
Telephone Interfaces Range in m Loop Resistance in
Ohms
ISDN-S0 point-to-point < 600 156
ISDN-S0 point-to-multipoint < 150 39
ISDN-S0 wall outlet to terminal < 10
Analog users < 2000 520
UP0/E exchange to primary telephone < 1000 230
UP0/E primary to secondary tele-
phone
< 100 23
Table 2-42 Cable Lengths for Direct Trunk and CorNet-N Wiring
Interface Cable Diameter Attenuation
per km
Max. Cable
Length
S0ICCS cable
J-2Y(ST)Y4x2x0,51 LG
ICCS Data5
0.51 mm 7.5 dB
at 96 kHz
800 m
Installation cable
J-2Y(ST)Y 10x2x0,6 ST
III BD
0.6 mm 6.0 dB
at 96 kHz
1000 m
S2M A-2Y0F(L)2Y 10x2x0,6
(full PE insulation, filled)
0.6mm 17dB
at 1 MHz
350 m
Numbering Plan
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-98 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
2.14 Numbering Plan
HiPath 3000 provide one default numbering plan for users.
Table 2-43 Numbering Plan for HiPath 3000 V1.2
Station Numbers HiPath
3750
HiPath
3550
HiPath
3350
HiPath
3250
HiPath
3150
HiPath
3700
HiPath
3500
HiPath
3300
Station numbers for users
(UP0/E primary, analog, S0,
CMI)
3841
1 For V3.0 and later, a maximum of 500 station number are possible for IP stations in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
188 20/188 20 3841188 20/188
Station numbers for adapters
or data terminals
(UP0/E secondary, TA analog,
TA S0,TA RS232, S0)
116 188 20/188 20 0 116 188 20/188
Station numbers for groups or
hunt groups
3002
2 For V3.0 and later, a maximum of 800 station numbers are possible for hunt groups.
150 20 8 3002150 20
Station numbers for users 3 digits 2/3 digits 3 digits 2/3 dig-
its
Maximum length of station
numbers
6 digits
Maximum length of numbers
for direct inward dialing (DID)
11 digits
Table 2-44 HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 - Distribution of Station Numbers
Port Type Station Number
Primary ports 100 - 349
Primary ports 500 - 633
Secondary ports 634 - 749
Groups 350 - 499
Groups 8600 - 8749
Complianc
e
3000sb2.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 2-99
System Overview
2.15 Compliance
2.15.1 CE Compliance (Not for U.S.)
The systems conform to the following guidelines:
2.15.2 SAFETY International
IEC 60950 + A1 + A2 + A3 + A4
2.15.3 Environmental Conditions
Operating Conditions (Electrical)
Operating limits
Room temperature: + 5 to + 40 °C (+ 41 to + 104° F)
Absolute humidity: 2 to 25 g H2O/m3
Relative humidity: 5 to 80%
System ventilation is by convection only. Forced-air ventilation is not required.
Operating Conditions (Mechanical)
The systems are intended for stationary use.
Guideline Standard
R&TTE-Direktive 1999/5/EEC EN 60950 + A1 + A2 + A3 + A4 (Safety)
EN 50082-1 (EMC Immunity Industrial)
ETS 300 329 (DECT Air Interface)
TBR 06 (DECT Air Interface)
Caution
Avoid exposing the system to direct sunlight and heaters (excessive heat may dam-
age the system).
If condensation has formed on a system, do not start up the system until the it has
thoroughly dried.
Compliance
System Overview
G281-0788-00, April 2002
2-100 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb2.fm
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-1
Features
3 Features
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the following topics:
(The information on the HiPath 3250 and HiPath 3150 does not apply to the U.S.)
Topic
Section 3.1, Features for All Traffic Types page 3-19
Section 3.2, Features for General Incoming Traffic page 3-43
Section 3.3, Features for General Outgoing Traffic page 3-99
Section 3.4, Features for General External Traffic page 3-109
Section 3.5, Features for Incoming External Traffic page 3-109
Section 3.6, Features for Outgoing External Traffic page 3-146
Section 3.7, Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.) page 3-183
Section 3.8, Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only) page 3-195
Section 3.9, Features for Internal Traffic page 3-210
Section 3.10, Tenant Service page 3-232
Section 3.11, Other Features page 3-236
Section 3.12, Networking page 3-294
Section 3.13, Features for Call Detail Recording page 3-323
Section 3.14, Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.) page 3-357
Section 3.15, U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only) page 3-383
Section 3.16, U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only) page 3-392
Section 3.17, Host Link Interface page 3-423
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
List of the described features in alphabetical order
Numerics
3PTY
See
three-party service
A
account code 3-334
ACCT
See
account code
ACD, see uniform call distribution 3-68
advice of charge 3-365
advice of charges during a call (not for U.S.) 3-324
advisory messages 3-225
AICC 3-79
allocation mode 3-386
alternate carriers (U.S. only) 3-198
analog direct inward dialing with MFC-R2 3-142
ANI4 (for U.S. only)
feature 3-43
announcement before answering 3-138
configuring 3-138
announcements 3-32
anti tromboning 3-304
AOC
See
advice of charge
AOC-D (not for U.S.) 3-324
assigning speed-dialing numbers to ITR groups 3-174
associated dialing 3-247
associated services 3-248
attendant consoles
network 3-314
audible tone monitoring 3-159
automatic call completion on no reply (CCNR) on the trunk interface 3-180
automatic call distribution, see uniform call distribution 3-68
automatic callback when free or busy 3-215
automatic incoming call connection with UCD 3-79
automatic line seizure 3-156
B
B channel allocation 3-108
babyphone 3-229
basic MULAP groups 3-277
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-3
Features
basic rate interface 3-383
CAID 3-389, 3-390
CO protocol 3-390
parameters 3-389
PDID 3-389
SPID 3-389, 3-390
basic-rate trunks
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
B-channel allocation mode 3-386
B-channel cut-through operation mode 3-413
B-channel selection 3-410
originating 3-411
terminating 3-412
booking a line 3-169
busy lamp field 3-213
busy override 3-39
C
CACH EKTS
See
call appearance call handling electronic key telephone system
CAID
See
call appearance identification
calculation accuracy 3-355
call allocation 3-122
call appearance call handling electronic key telephone system 3-418
call appearance identification 3-389
definition 3-390
call charges
display with currency 3-355
call deflection 3-369
call detail recording
at station 3-327
attendant (not for U.S.) 3-329
central 3-338
compressed output format 3-342
compressed output format (LAN) 3-345
long output format 3-352
per trunk (not for U.S.) 3-332
call detail recording, attendant 3-329
call distribution
See
uniform call distribution (UCD)
call duration display on terminal 3-326
call forwarding 3-58, 3-366
U.S. ISDN 3-404
call forwarding busy and no answer 3-56
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
call forwarding unconditional (CFU) 3-368
call forwarding-no answer
after a timeout 3-53
call hold 3-19, 3-373
call keys 3-117
least cost routing and (U.S. only) 3-201
call management
announcement before answering 3-138
feature 3-48
call park 3-21
call pickup
answering machine 3-94
from an answering machine 3-94
within call pickup groups 3-91
call waiting 3-46, 3-375
U.S. ISDN 3-407
call waiting tone 3-46
call-by-call service 3-393
called and calling party number display services 3-419
caller list/station number storage 3-89
calling line identification presentation 3-361, 3-403
calling line identification restriction 3-362
calls
data 3-416
calls in queue 3-82
camp-on
(U.S. ISDN only) 3-396
carrier access methods for LCR (U.S. only) 3-198
carrier types (LCR) 3-184, 3-197
corporate network (CN) 3-187
dial-in control server (DICS) 3-186
Mercury Communications Limited Single Stage (not for U.S.) 3-184
Mercury Communications Limited Two Stage (not for U.S.) 3-185
primary carrier 3-187
carrier-select override (U.S. only) 3-200
least cost routing 3-205
CAS centralized attendant service 3-144
CCBS
See
completion of calls to busy subscribers
CD
See
call deflection
CDRA
See
call detail recording, attendant
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-5
Features
CDRC
See
call detail recording central
CDRC outgoing without connection 3-338
CDRC ticket without connect 3-338
CDRS
See
call detail recording at station
CDRT
See
call detail recording per trunk (not for U.S.)
central office protocol 3-390
central voice mail server, network 3-316
centralized attendant service CAS 3-144
CF
See
call forwarding
CFNA
See
call forwarding-no answer
CH
See
call hold
change display 3-293
changeover
individual telephone lock 3-101
system telephone lock 3-103
class of service 3-163
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-200
CLIP
See
calling line identification presentation
CLIP no screening 3-181
CLIR
See
calling line identification restriction
closed numbering 3-299
CM
See
call management
codes for outgoing calls 3-380
collect call barring for ISDN trunks 3-382
collect call barring per station 3-141
collect call barring per trunk 3-140
COLP
See
connected line identification and presentation
COLR
See
connected line identification restriction
completion of calls to busy subscribers 3-372
compressed output format for CDRC 3-342
compressed output format for CDRC via LAN 3-345
conference 3-28, 3-374
trunk to trunk 3-28
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
conference calls
U.S. ISDN 3-397
configurable toll restriction 3-163
connected line identification 3-408
connected line identification presentation 3-363
connected line identification restriction 3-364
connected party displays 3-420
consultation hold 3-34
converter (CSTA interface) 3-423
CorNet-N
access for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-198
call waiting 3-306
closed numbering 3-299
consultation hold 3-304
extension number 3-303
incoming calls 3-303
name display 3-309
number display 3-309
pickup 3-304
station name 3-303
toll restriction 3-300, 3-303
transfer 3-304
COS 3-163
credit card call access 3-399
CSO
see
carrier-select override
CSTA interface 3-423
currency
call charge display with 3-355
customer-specific display 3-293
CW
See
call waiting
D
data calls 3-416
date 3-237
date and time display 3-237
D-channel encoding type 3-386
dedicated service 3-394
deferring a call 3-96
delete all station numbers 3-259
denied list for undialed trunks 3-173
dial plan
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-202
dialed number identification service 3-409
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-7
Features
dial-in control server access for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199
DID
See
direct inward dialing
direct inward dialing 3-128, 3-358
U.S. ISDN 3-400
direct inward system access
description 3-131
direct station selection 3-212
DISA
See
direct inward system access
display
called party 3-419
connected party 3-419, 3-420
date and time 3-237
number of stations with direct trunk access (Austria only) 3-250
distinctive ringing 3-44
DND
See
do not disturb
DNIS
See
dialed number identification service
do not disturb 3-86
ringer cutoff 3-86
door opener 3-217
DSS
See
direct station selection
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing
selecting in least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
DTMF tones
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
dual-tone multifrequency
converting for PRI 3-414
dual-tone multifrequency direct inward dialing 3-136
dual-tone multifrequency transmission (DTMF) 3-99
E
E911 emergency call service for USA 3-178
ECT
See
explicit call transfer
editing station numbers 3-231
editing the telephone number 3-231
EKTS
See
electronic key telephone system
electronic key telephone system
DID 3-400
U.S. ISDN 3-417
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
electronic notebook
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
emergency call service ECS 3-178
emulation type 3-386
en-bloc dialing 3-158
en-bloc sending 3-415
end-of-dialing recognition 3-161
enhanced radio paging equipment (not for U.S.)
features 3-221
entrance telephones 3-217
equal access 3-398
Euro-ISDN features 3-357
executive MULAP groups 3-277
executive/secretary configuration, see Top configuration 3-268
expensive route identification (U.S. only) 3-200
explicit call transfer 3-378
external call forwarding 3-368
F
fax waiting message/answering machine key 3-95
features
correlation with least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-200
features in alphabetical order 3-2
flex call 3-106
flexible numbering 3-299
forced account codes
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
foreign exchange non-ISDN facility 3-393
frame/line/encoding 3-386
G
group call 3-62
group call with busy signaling 3-64
group ringing 3-123
H
handsfree answerback 3-218
hold 3-19, 3-373
U.S. ISDN 3-405
Host Link Interface 3-423
hoteling 3-254
hotline 3-105
hunt group 3-65
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-9
Features
I
incoming calls
CorNet-N 3-303
night answer 3-126
incoming preference 3-280
individual telephone lock (changeover) 3-101
intercept conditions 3-133
intercept position
network 3-314
Intercept with telephone lock 3-175
inter-exchange carriers
CAC 3-197
CIC 3-197
operator access 3-399
protocols 3-385
interfaces
BRI 3-383
PRI 3-383
internal directory 3-227
internal paging 3-218, 3-219
internal traffic 3-210
internal traffic restriction groups
feature 3-166
INWATS facility 3-393
IP networking 3-294
ISDN 3-383
CAID 3-389, 3-390
SDID 3-390
SPID 3-389
See also
U.S. ISDN or Euro-ISDN features
K
key programming 3-115, 3-117
keypad
converting DTMF for PRI 3-414
keypad dialing 3-176
keys
DSS 3-212
redial 3-146
repdial 3-212
L
LAN interface, PSTN interface 3-423
language settings 3-245
languages, loading 3-245
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
last number redial (LNR) 3-146
LCR
See
least cost routing
least cost routing 3-183
alternate carriers (U.S. only) 3-198
and basic-rate trunks (U.S. only) 3-201
and call keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and DTMF tones (U.S. only) 3-201
and electronic notebook (U.S. only) 3-201
and forced account codes (U.S. only) 3-201
and MUSAP keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and repertory dial keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and station redial (U.S. only) 3-201
and system speed-dialing (U.S. only) 3-201
and toll restriction (U.S. only) 3-201
carrier access methods (U.S. only) 3-198
carrier types 3-197
carrier-select override (U.S. only) 3-200, 3-205
CorNet-N (U.S. only) 3-198
correlation with other features (U.S. only) 3-200
dial plan (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-202
dial-in control server (U.S. only) 3-199
expensive route identification (U.S. only) 3-200
main carrier (U.S. only) 3-198
MCL single stage access (U.S. only) 3-198
MCL two stage access (U.S. only) 3-198
number handling (U.S. only) 3-200
operation (U.S. only) 3-208
outdial rules
letters (U.S. only) 3-205
parameters (U.S. only) 3-205
outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-204, 3-205
primary rate access (U.S. only) 3-199
route table (U.S. only) 3-204
route table paths (U.S. only) 3-204
route table search order (U.S. only) 3-204
routing tables (U.S. only) 3-202
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing (U.S. only) 3-201
time of day evaluation (U.S. only) 3-199
time table (U.S. only) 3-205
U.S. only 3-195
least cost routing class of service (U.S. only) 3-200
least cost routing overflow (U.S. only) 3-200
leave group call/hunt group (stop hunt) 3-67
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-11
Features
leave UCD group 3-74
letters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-205
local exchange carriers
carrier types 3-197
operator access 3-399
protocols 3-385
location identification number LIN 3-178
locking telephone
system 3-103
long output format for CDRC 3-352
M
main carrier for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-198
malicious call identification 3-371
manager/secretary configuration, see Top configuration 3-268
MCID
See
malicious call identification
MCL single stage carrier access (U.S. only) 3-198
MCL two stage carrier access (U.S. only) 3-198
message texts/mailboxes (information function) 3-222
message waiting 3-222
U.S. ISDN 3-421
voicemail 3-422
message waiting indication at the trunk interface 3-121
MFC-R2 trunk 3-142
mobile PIN 3-106
MSN
See
multiple subscriber numbers
MULAP 3-261, 3-277
multi-device connection 3-109, 3-392
multilingual text output 3-245
multiple subscriber numbers 3-359
configuring default station numbers instead 3-360
U.S. ISDN 3-401
MUSAP keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
music on hold
internal/external source 3-30
relays 3-239
MWI at the trunk interface 3-121
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
N
N11 access 3-399
names
assigning to stations 3-214
called party display 3-419
calling party display 3-419
translating station numbers for speed dialing 3-120
national and international codes for outgoing calls 3-380
networking 3-294
call forwarding with rerouting 3-310
call waiting 3-306
callback on free/busy 3-308
CDR with networking 3-302
central attendant console 3-314
closed numbering 3-299
conference 3-313
consultation hold/transfer/pickup 3-304
distinctive ringing in the network 3-307
incoming calls 3-302, 3-303
open numbering 3-299
recall 3-305
satellite capability 3-296
sharing central voice mail server 3-316
sharing system speed-dialing in a gateway system 3-315
station number/name display 3-309
toggle 3-312
toll restriction with CorNet N 3-300
night answer 3-125
activating 3-126
night service 3-125
number of B channels for PRI parameters 3-386
O
offset 3-350
open numbering 3-299
operation of least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-208
operator assisted credit card call access 3-399
optional control relay modules
relay 3-239
OptiPage 3-218
optiPoint 500
adapters
key module 3-212
optiPoint BLF 3-213
optiPoint Attendant 3-37
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-13
Features
optiPoint BLF 3-213
optiPoint key module 3-212
originating B-channel selection 3-411
outdial rules
least cost routing
letters (U.S. only) 3-205
parameters (U.S. only) 3-205
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204, 3-205
outdial rules for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199
outgoing calls
LNR 3-146
redial 3-146
outgoing preference 3-281
OUTWATS facility 3-393
overflow
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-200
overflow (UCD) 3-78
overload indication 3-41
P
paging 3-218
parameters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-205
park 3-21
path replacement 3-304
phantom direct inward dialing 3-389
assigning numbers 3-391
pickup
trunk key 3-116
point-to-point connection 3-379
PRI carrier access for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199
primary rate interface 3-383
B-channel allocation 3-386
D-channel encoding type 3-386
emulation type 3-386
frame/line/encoding 3-386
number of B channels 3-386
protocol type 3-385
trunk group calling service 3-387
priority calls 3-71
private trunk 3-168
procedure keys 3-289
project calls 3-334
protocol type, primary rate interface 3-385
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
PSE
See
radio paging equipment (not for U.S.)
PtP
See
point-to-point connection
public network trunks
setting up in least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
Q
QSig 3-317
basic features 3-318
busy override 3-320
central attendant position 3-319
COS changeover 3-322
intercept by central attendant position 3-319
resetting the lock code 3-321
R
radio paging equipment 3-220
PSE simple 3-220
via ESPA 3-221
recall 3-35
recorded announcement/music on Hold (UCD) 3-76
reject calls 3-98
relays 3-239
relocate 3-254
repdial
See
repertory dial keys
repertory dial keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
programming 3-212
reply text 3-225
reset activated services 3-252
resetting services 3-252
ringer cutoff 3-88
room monitor 3-229
route table
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
route table paths
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
route table search order
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
routing tables (LCR) 3-188
routing tables (U.S. only) 3-202
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-15
Features
S
screened transfer 3-26
search order
of LCR route table 3-204
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing in LCR (U.S. only) 3-201
selective seizure of a DID number via a MUSAP key 3-129
sending information text 3-222
sensors 3-243
service profile identifier 3-389
BRI 3-390
maximum values 3-390
services in the talk state 3-251
setting the signaling method for analog stations 3-36
shared transfer switch 3-42
signaling of direct inward dialing numbers for incoming calls 3-130
silent monitoring 3-85
silent reversal at start and end of call 3-323
simple PSE
See
radio paging equipment
speaker call 3-218
special access 3-399
speed dialing
network 3-315
station 3-154
system 3-149
station number configuration via Assistant T 3-97
station numbers, deleting 3-259
station redial
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
station speed dialing in system 3-154
stations
universal night answer 3-126
stimulus interface 3-176
storing procedures 3-289
SUB
See
subaddressing
subaddressing 3-370
subscriber groups 3-61
switch (relay) 3-239
system administration
activating services in the talk state 3-251
System number - incoming 3-181
System number - outgoing 3-181
system speed dialing
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
network 3-315
outgoing external traffic 3-149
sharing in a gateway system 3-315
system speed-dialing
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
system speed-dialing in tenant systems 3-152
system telephone lock
changeover 3-103
T
targeted call pickup outside of a PU group 3-93
Team configuration 3-261
example with 2 members 3-261
example with 8 members 3-264
Team keys 3-265
Team/Top 3-261
Teilehmerrufnummer unterdrücken 3-181
telephone lock
individual 3-101
system 3-103
temporary signaling method changeover 3-99
temporary station number display suppression 3-171
tenant services 3-232
configuring 3-233
terminal portability (TP) 3-376
terminating B-channel selection 3-412
text messages 3-222
three-party conference 3-374, 3-406
three-party service 3-374
tie trunk non-ISDN facility 3-393
TIEL 3-298
time 3-237
time of day evaluation for least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199
time table, LCR (U.S. only) 3-205
toggle 3-23
trunk key 3-116
toll fraud monitoring 3-353
toll restriction 3-163
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
Top configuration 3-268
example with 1 exec./1 secr. 3-268
example with 2 exec./2 secr. 3-270
Top keys 3-270
traffic restriction groups 3-166
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-17
Features
transfer
U.S. ISDN 3-395
UCD groups 3-84
transfer from announcement 3-219
transit traffic 3-118
translate station numbers to names for system speed dialing 3-120
TRGs
See
traffic restriction groups or internal traffic restriction groups
trunk group calling service 3-387
trunk groups 3-113
trunk keys 3-115
trunk queuing 3-169
trunk seizure type 3-156
trunk signaling method 3-162
trunks
setting up in least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
trunk-to-trunk conference 3-28
U
U.S. ISDN
B-channel allocation 3-386
BRI 3-383
CO protocol 3-390
D-channel encoding type 3-386
emulation type 3-386
frame/line/encoding 3-386
interfaces 3-383
multi-device connection 3-392
number of B channels (PRI) 3-386
PRI 3-383
protocol type 3-385
trunk group calling service 3-387
UCD
See
uniform call distribution
uniform call distribution 3-68
call prioritization 3-71
group status display 3-82
groups
AICC 3-79
home agent 3-83
night answer 3-81
queues 3-70
subscriber states 3-72
work 3-75
universal night answer position 3-126
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
unscreened transfer 3-24
user to user signaling (UUS1) 3-59, 3-377
V
V.24
range extension for call data 3-354
voice channel signaling security 3-236
voice mail
central network server 3-316
voicemail 3-422
W
work time (UCD) 3-75
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-19
Features
3.1 Features for All Traffic Types
3.1.1 Call Hold
Definition
Users can place an active call on hold. Placing a call on hold means that the call stays
connected, but in a waiting state, until the user retrieves it. After placing a call on hold,
the user can either retrieve the held call or place another call on the same line.
A distinction is made between common hold and exclusive hold.
With common hold, any party can retrieve the held call; with exclusive hold, only the
party who placed the call on hold can retrieve it.
The following describes other situations involving Hold states:
Call Waiting (refer to Section 3.2.3 for more details)
When a station is involved in a call and a second call is waiting to be answered,
you can scroll to and select the prompt
Call Waiting
. This places the first caller
on exclusive hold at your telephone and answers the incoming call. This is also
known as the feature Answer Hold. You can process the second call (transfer,
park) or Quit and Return to the held party and the incoming call is dropped.
Toggle and Automatic Hold (refer to Section 3.1.3 for more details)
When a station, using a trunk key or call key, is engaged in one conversation and
another call is incoming on another key, you can automatically place the current
call on exclusive hold and answer the incoming call by pressing the flashing key.
You can then toggle between the 2 calls at will. The lines are alternately on Con-
sultation Hold and the last call handled will recall if you go on-hook.
Alternatively, you can place your original caller on Common Hold, by first press-
ing the HOLD key before answering the incoming call. Anyone with an appear-
ance of the Trunk key or Call key can take the call by pressing the slowly flashing
key.
Consultation Hold and transfer (refer to Section 3.1.4 and Section 3.1.5 for
more details)
When a station is engaged in a conversation, whether or not the call is on an out-
side line button or not, you can place the current conversation on Consultation
Hold to consult with another internal or external party. The held party is on exclu-
sive hold on your telephone.
Hold and retrieve trunk (refer to Section 3.4.4 for more details)
This allows the display user to place an outside trunk call on hold whether there
is an appearance of the trunk or not on the telephone. Pressing the Hold/transfer
key, the trunk is placed on exclusive hold and the display provides the information
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
on the held trunk, which reads
Line held on xxx,
where
xxx
is the trunk number.
You can go on-hook. To retrieve the held line, press the
Retrieve
line button or
dial the access code followed by the trunk number.
Related Topics
Section 3.1.2, Call Park, on page 3-21
Section 3.1.3, Toggle, on page 3-23
Section 3.1.6, Conference, on page 3-28
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Trunk key, Retrieve
key
You can retrieve a call that was placed on hold by pressing
either a trunk key (when the LED is flashing slowly), by
pressing the Retrieve key, or by entering a code from the
Program/Service menu. The trunk to be seized must be
suffix-dialed (with the exception of the trunk key).
Internal calls
(for U.S. Only)
To place an internal call on hold, users must either park the
call or use an internal consult key.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-21
Features
3.1.2 Call Park
Definition
With call park, users can place both internal and external calls on hold. Parked calls
can be answered from any telephone in the system.
Users can activate the call park feature only when they are on another call. Users
must assign a virtual number (park slot 0 through 9) to the call that they want parked.
They must then enter the slot number to receive the call.
A parked call that is not retrieved within a given time (default is 160 seconds) recalls
the originator and follows the recall rules.
Related Topics
Section 3.1.1, Call Hold, on page 3-19
Section 3.1.3, Toggle, on page 3-23
Section 3.1.6, Conference, on page 3-28
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of calls
parked simultaneously
Max. 10 Max. 10 Max. 10 Max. 10 Max. 10
Subject Requirement or Condition
Park You cannot park an undialed trunk.
Park You must answer a call before you can park it.
Conference You cannot park a conference call.
Call forwarding In the case of a recall, a parked call does not follow call for-
warding.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
DTMF DTMF mode is not deactivated when you activate the park
feature. This applies both to the station that parked the call
and to the parked station.
Occupied park slots If the park slot selected for parking a call is already occu-
pied, a tone sounds, and the number does not appear on
the screen. Select another park slot.
DND A station in DND can place a call in a park location; how-
ever, if the parked call recalls and no other destination has
been identified in call management, the call automatically
is disconnected after the recall timer expires.
MOH Parked callers hear Music on Hold (MOH).
CorNet-N An incoming call over a CorNet-N link can only be placed
in a Park location at the destination node. A call parked in
one node cannot be retrieved from another node over the
CorNet-N link.
DISA The call park feature cannot be activated from a DISA con-
nection.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-23
Features
3.1.3 Toggle
Definition
Toggle enables a user to toggle between two parties, placing one of the parties on
hold. The toggle feature can be used for internal and external calls.
The rules for consultation hold also apply to the active call. Users cannot toggle be-
tween conference calls.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Hold If you are on hold, you cannot use the toggle feature.
DTMF DTMF is not deactivated when you activate the toggle fea-
ture.
Two incoming calls If the second party is also an incoming call, the user can
answer the incoming call by using the feature Call Waiting
(default access code is
*55
) then Toggle between the first
and second call as explained above.
Line keys Users with line keys (Call keys, Trunk keys) can toggle be-
tween one call and another by pressing the flashing line
key for the other incoming call, and
To g g l e
between both
by pressing one line key then the next. The lines are in ex-
clusive hold.
Exception: In the case of the General Call key appearanc-
es, users should always press the Hold button, followed by
the Release button, before pressing another General Call
key appearance. This places the first call on Common Call.
Otherwise the call remains on Consultation Hold.
Music on Hold MOH is always connected to the held party.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.4 Unscreened Transfer
Definition
Users can transfer an internal or external call to another internal station before the
called party answers. The other station can be in the same system or it can be in a
networked system (CorNet-N or QSig [not for U.S.]).
If the requested station is unavailable, the call will remain in a wait state until the line
is free (camp on). Only two calls can be transferred to a busy station simultaneously.
A telephone with display at the transfer destination can display the number of either
the station initially called or the calling party.
Calls transferred to a station which is call forwarded follow the forwarding mode set at
the internal destination.
A call transferred to an external destination over an analog loop start trunk does not
recall because the HiPath 3000 does not know the state of the final destination. In this
case, a pseudo answer is provided.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
External transfer des-
tination
You cannot place an unscreened transfer to an external
destination.
Recall If a transferred call is not answered within a certain period
of time, the system initiates a recall.
Recall timer A transferred call that is not answered recalls to the trans-
ferring station. The recall timer,
Callback timeout for trans-
fer before answering
(default is 45 seconds), is started
when the transferring station releases the call from the sta-
tion. This timer also controls the length of time that a caller
is camped on the destination station.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-25
Features
Call charges Toll charges are assigned to the switching station until the
call is picked up or released. After the destination station
answers, the charges are assigned to it.
Call charges If the destination is an external destination, the call charg-
es are assigned to the transferring station as long as the
destination answers the call.
DSS Pressing a
DSS
key from a talking state, results in an im-
mediate Consultation call with the party designated by the
DSS
key. In effect, it replaces the procedure:
Consult
+
destination
.
Do Not Disturb Transferring a call to a station in Do not Disturb results in
an immediate recall to the transferring station.
If the transferring station is itself in a Do Not Disturb state,
a
Recalling transferred call
overrides the DND function and
rings the telephone.
Music on Hold The called party hears MOH, if provided.
External destinations An external call can only be transferred to another external
destination (in the same system or in another node via
CorNet-N) if one of the trunks can provide release super-
vision (ground start, PRI, BRI, DID, T1).
Busy stations Only two calls can be transferred to a busy station simulta-
neously. On a display telephone, the state of the called par-
ty (if internal) is displayed
Busy
or
Do Not Disturb
.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.5 Screened Transfer
Definition
Users can use screened transfer by initiating a consultation call to an internal user (a
third party) after answering a call. After the third party answers, the user can hang up
the phone, transferring the call received.
Users can also transfer an internal call to an external destination. The receiving sta-
tion can be in the same system as the called party, or it can be in a different networked
system (CorNet-N). If the requested station is busy and the call is nevertheless trans-
ferred, the call camps on until the line is free.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call charges Toll charges are assigned to the switching station until the
call is transferred. After the destination station answers,
the charges are assigned to it.
External destination In the case of an external destination, the transfer must be
initiated.
DSS Pressing a DSS key from a talking state, results in an im-
mediate Consultation call with the party designated by the
DSS key. In effect, it replaces the procedure
Consult
+
des-
tination
.
Music on Hold The called party hears MOH, if provided.
External destinations An external call can only be transferred to another external
destination (in the same system or in another node via
CorNet-N) if one of the trunks can provide release super-
vision (ground start, PRI, BRI, DID, T1).
Busy stations Only two calls can be transferred to a busy station simulta-
neously. On a display telephone, the state of the called par-
ty (if internal) is displayed
Busy
or
Do Not Disturb
.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-27
Features
Transfer to CF station Calls transferred to a station that is call forwarded follow
the forwarding mode set at the internal destination. The
display on a display telephone indicates the final destina-
tion.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.6 Conference
Definition
A user can combine up to five stations into a conference call.
The user setting up the conference can individually disconnect stations from the con-
ference or release the conference entirely. In addition, the user can also exit the con-
ference without terminating it, even if the conference includes external stations (trunk-
to-trunk conference).
If internal stations still remain in the conference, the new conference leader is the user
who has been in the conference the longest. If only external stations remain in the
conference and no backward release criterion is present (on loop-start trunks), a tim-
er,
Time until warning tone, in main station interface transit con
, is started; the default
time is: 5 minutes. When this timer expires, the remaining stations receive a warning
tone and the conference is disconnected after default 10 seconds. This timer,
Time
from warning tone until release,
is variable from 0 to 42 min.
The initiator of the conference is designated as the Conference Master. If the confer-
ence master leaves the conference, control of the conference is passed on to the first
internal member which was part of the conference.
Members of the conference call can leave the conference by going on-hook or by an-
swering a call waiting. However, they must call the conference master to be added on
to the conference once again.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Conferences per sys-
tem
63333
Stations per confer-
ence
55555
External stations per
conference
44444
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-29
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Conference Internal users cannot participate in more than one confer-
ence in the system (except with CorNet-N).
Analog stations The following restrictions apply to HiPath 3350 and HiPath
3300:
Analog stations can set up no more than a three-party con-
ference. Up to four analog telephones can be passive par-
ticipants in a conference.
Analog stations Analog stations are not checked to see if they are voice de-
vices.
Voice, data transmis-
sion
You can set up a conference between voice stations only.
Call charges Toll charges are assigned to the party who set up the toll
call. When a call is transferred or released, the toll charges
are assigned to the remaining internal station from the mo-
ment the call is released.
Conference partici-
pants when external
applications are con-
nected via CSTA
CSTA Phase II places a limit on the length of CSTA mes-
sages. Conferences with more than three participants ex-
ceed this limit and can cause the connected applications
to malfunction when at least one station is monitored by
CSTA.
This is why the option to expand conferences to include
more than three participants is not offered in the menu and
will be rejected if you try to invoke it with a code.
DISA The conference feature cannot be invoked from an exter-
nal DISA station.
Park Conference calls cannot be parked.
Silent Monitoring Silent Monitoring limits the maximum number of confer-
ences. Maximum number of conferences possible in sys-
tem = maximum number of simultaneous Silent Monitoring
stations.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.7 Music on Hold (Internal or External Source)
Definition
An integrated music source (hardware module) makes it possible to play music for
waiting parties during switching operations.
As an alternative, you can use the following optional modules with HiPath 3350, Hi-
Path 3550, HiPath 3300 and HiPath 3500 (in the U.S., the EXMNA board is included
with every HiPath 3000 system):
EXMNA (connection option for an external music source) (for U.S. only)
EXM (connection option for an external music source) (not for U.S)
EXMR (connection option for an external music source)
MPPI (with music component) (not for U.S)
All HiPath 3000 models allow you to define up to six MOH sources on analog inter-
faces for the six possible ITR groups (Section 3.10.1, Tenant Service Configuration).
Devices other than Genius or Mozart must be connected to a 600 Ohm transformer.
The EXMNA card limits the level at which MOH can be heard over outside lines and
is therefore FCC compliant without external limiters.
Callers hear MOH if in Consultation Hold state, Park state, and in a transfer state if
configured. Also, queued callers in an UCD environment can hear MOH if so config-
ured.
MOH can be configured in one of three ways:
1. No Music on Hold: The held party will only hear silence.
2. MOH with ring tone: The held party will first hear MOH during the Consultation
process. When a call is transferred to the destination, the MOH is replaced by
ringback tone.
3. MOH without Ring Tone: The held party will hear MOH until the called party an-
swers the call.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-31
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Free analog subscriber ports
HW options SLA16,
SLA8/16/
24N,
TIEL
EXM,
EXMR,
EXMNA,
MPPI
––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
EXMNA EXMNA is used only in the U.S.
EXM, EXMR, EXMNA,
MPPI
Connecting the EXM, EXMR, EXMNA or MPPI board au-
tomatically switches the system over to the external music
source.
MOH You must unplug the external music source, EXM module,
or EXMNA module to activate internal music on hold.
MOH (not for U.S.) HiPath 3250 provides limited internal MOH.
MOH source You cannot use the logical port 0 as an MOH source.
MOH source at analog
ports
If the MOH source is turned on (loop active) you need to
disconnect and then reconnect it (interrupting the loop) af-
ter configuring the analog port.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-32 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.8 Announcements
Definition
For uniform call distribution (UCD), announcement before answering, and DTMF di-
rect inward dialing (DID), users can connect announcement equipment. This an-
nouncement replaces music on hold (MOH) in certain situations (such as during hold
or while a station is busy or being transferred).
Announcement devices can be connected to analog interfaces, or can be connected
using E&M in the HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 system. Start/stop control can be im-
plemented using relays and sensors or E&M. Up to 32 stations can be connected to
an announcement device.
Both interfaces provide sequenced messages (as opposed to barge-in); however, the
E&M interface can advise the announcement device to return to start when the queue
is empty. With the SLA interface method, the announcement device must reach the
end of its message before returning to start. This can be critical if the message is
lengthy.
The following types of announcement are available:
Recorded Announcement/Music on Hold (MOH) with UCD on page 3-76
Announcement Before Answering on page 3-138
Dual-Tone Multifrequency Direct Inward Dialing on page 3-136
Message Texts/Mailboxes/Message Waiting on page 3-222
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements free ana-
log sub-
scriber
ports (+
REAL for
Start/
Stop),
analog tie
traffic
TIEL
Free analog subscriber ports
(+ STRB/STRBR for Start/Stop)
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-33
Features
Announcement devic-
es
164111
Simultaneous an-
nouncements
30 30 30 30 30
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-34 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.9 Consultation Hold
Definition
This feature allows users to place a new internal or external call on hold and consult
with an existing caller on the same line by placing the existing caller on hold. The con-
sultation call ends when the user retrieves the held call. If the user hangs up instead
of retrieving the held call, the held call is transferred or recalled.
If users place an external call on hold and place another external consultation call,
they must use the telephone transfer feature to connect the two calls.
Analog telephones can connect external calls to external stations using the confer-
ence feature.
Related Topics
Section 3.1.4, Unscreened Transfer, on page 3-24
Section 3.1.5, Screened Transfer, on page 3-26
Section 3.1.6, Conference, on page 3-28
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Redial You can use the redial feature when you are in a consulta-
tion call.
Do not disturb It is not possible to set up a consultation call to a busy sub-
scriber who has activated
do not disturb
.
DTMF mode Initiating a consultation call will deactivate DTMF mode if it
is active; it is reactivated when a consultation call is termi-
nated.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-35
Features
3.1.10 Recall
Definition
A held call that is not answered or a call that was not switched successfully is signaled
at the initiating station as a recall. A display telephone at the initial callers location
can display the number of either the switched internal or external station or the num-
ber of the destination.
An automatic recall is always carried out if:
1. A call was parked for a certain period or was placed on common hold and was
not answered. The recall occurs when the hold/park timer expires (recall a
parked connection).
2. An unscreened transfer was placed to a party who did not answer the call within
a certain period (recall a transferred/switched trunk).
3. An unscreened transfer was placed to a station and the destination did not exist,
was busy with a second call, the telephone was defective (in the case of digital
telephones) or the transfer type was not allowed (transfer external call to external
destination). An immediate recall is carried out in these cases.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-36 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.11 Setting the Signaling Method for Analog Stations
Definition
After the system boots, all analog station ports are set to DTMF dialing. If users need
to change an analog station port to dial pulsing, they can use Assistant T or HiPath
3000 Manager E. Users do not need to reset the system after changing the signaling
method. The new signaling method is functional immediately.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Signaling method If a dial pulsing signal is detected, the code receiver re-
mains active so toll restrictions are not circumvented.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-37
Features
3.1.12 optiPoint Attendant
Definition
Users can configure up to six telephones in the HiPath 3000 system to carry out
switching services. The optiPoint Attendant telephone simultaneously serves as an
intercept position and an attendant console (AC). All calls are routed to the AC if direct
inward dialing is not available or if no station can be reached via the call allocation
algorithms in call management (intercept). The operator then redirects incoming calls
to the stations selected. For additional information, see also Section 6.7.3, optiPoint
Attendant
Users can also configure a PC as the attendant console (PC AC). This specially con-
figured PC is known as optiClient Attendant and is described in detail in Section 6.7.2
For the layout and assignment of function keys on the optiPoint Attendant, refer to
Section 6.7.3, optiPoint Attendant.
Individual Intercept positions can be configured for day operation and another for
night operation. Up to 4 optiPoint key modules can be connected to the optiPoint At-
tendant.
In general, external calls are directed to Call keys whereas internal calls appear on
DSS/Repdial keys on the optiPoint key modules.
Intercept and attendant positions can form Hunt Groups. A hunt group where all
members are busy, is not intercepted to the intercept position. The waiting calls re-
main in the queue.
Calls can be configured system-wide to be intercepted in the following conditions:
Ring No answer, Busy, Invalid number dialed, Incomplete number, on an unan-
swered recalls and when an attempt is made to dial from specific stations which
have activated CodeLock.
In the case of Ring No Answer, the system first checks the Call Management ta-
bles for further configured destinations. If there are no none, the call is then di-
verted to the intercept position.
CorNet-N
CorNet-N calls can be internal or external depending on their source. If the calling
party is an internal station in a remote node, the call is flagged as internal. If the call
is from a trunk in the remote node, the call is flagged as external.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-38 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital subscriber line module ––
General requirements optiPoint 500 standard, optiPoint 500 advance,
optiset E advance plus/comfort, advance conference/con-
ference, or memory telephone (system telephone)
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Overflow You can configure numeric and time overflow to a program-
mable overflow destination.
A maximum of 6 optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones can
be configured with overflow display.
Undialed trunk You can switch an undialed trunk.
Busy external line You can selectively release busy external lines.
Second number You can also reach the AC under a second station number
(default 9, USA/GBR 0).
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-39
Features
3.1.13 Busy Override
Definition
Authorized users and the current intercept position (day or night) can use a code or
key to override a call in progress at an internal station. The participating stations are
notified of the busy override by an alerting tone and a screen display.
The feature can be invoked during the busy signal or during the camp on state.
During an override condition,
if the called party goes on-hook, all parties are released.
if the party which was connected to the called party goes on-hook, the overridden
and overriding parties remain connected.
if the overriding party goes on-hook first, the original conversation can continue
and the conference bridge is removed.
If the called party had activated DND, the conversation will nevertheless be over-
ridden. However, a station authorized to use the Busy Override feature, cannot
override a station with DND active and in an idle state.
Any Voice terminal in the system can be configured for this capability.
A station with Data security (Assistant T) or Call Waiting rejection (HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E) active, cannot be overridden.
CorNet-N
Override cannot be invoked over a CorNet-N link.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-40 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Voice channel signal-
ing security
You cannot override a call if the called station or the inter-
nal party it is connected to is entered as a data station
(voice channel signaling security), or if the called party is
dialing a number.
Hunt group Busy override is not possible if all stations are busy when
a group or hunt group is called.
S0 station It is not possible to override an S0 station.
Attendant console The busy override feature is activated by default and can-
not be deactivated.
Features for All Traffic Type
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-41
Features
3.1.14 Overload Indication
Definition
Users can activate an overload indicator (attendant console) for a fixed station (first
station port in the system). When the user presses the key, the waiting calls are dis-
played (key LED). The following signaling types are possible:
Flashing: Waiting call and busy AC.
Flickering: Waiting call was not answered within 30 seconds; there are more calls
than can be processed by the attendant consoles.
Off: The AC is not overloaded.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital subscriber line module ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Overload indication An LED that is already flickering is not reset to flashing.
Features for All Traffic Types
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-42 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.1.15 Shared Transfer Switch (Not for U.S.)
Definition
A shared transfer switch allows an analog trunk connection to be used for two sta-
tions. The switch divides the signal into positive and negative half-waves and assigns
each to a station. The network provider (such as Deutsche Telekom AG in Germany)
installs the shared transfer switch.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Shared transfer switch This feature is for Germany only.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-43
Features
3.2 Features for General Incoming Traffic
3.2.1 ANI (for U.S. only)
Definition
The ANI feature (automatic number identification) displays the calling partys station
number, which is transmitted over analog trunks.
While the phone is ringing, the station number is transmitted by BFSK (binary fre-
quency shift keying) during the first ringing phase. HiPath 3000 support the feature
only until the called party lifts the handset. Internally, the system handles ANI data
just like an ISDN number.
To run the ANI feature, you must have the ANI4 (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350) or ANI4R
(HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300) options board, which is used in conjunction with the
TMGL4 or TMGL4R trunk board.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
HW requirements ANI4
ANI4R
ANI4
ANI4R
––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Country specifics Requires country-specific boards or firmware versions.
Trunk boards The trunk boards used must support call charging module
assignment GMZ (not for U.S.).
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-44 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.2 Distinctive Ringing
Definition
Distinctive tones indicate different call types. This enables the user to distinguish be-
tween incoming internal and incoming external calls. In ISDN systems, acoustic infor-
mation is secondary to displays on the screen because different features can have
the same ring signaling.
Depending on the telephone, three different types of acoustic signaling are possible:
for optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones:
Ring type 1 = External call CO (for example, double ring)
Ring type 2 = External call CO2 (for example, triple ring)
Ring type 3 = External call CO3 (for example, short/long/short)
for analog telephones (Germany only):
Ring type 1 = External call CO (for example, double ring)
Ring type 2 = Recall
Ring type 3 = Door bell ring
for analog telephones (not for Germany):
Ring type 1 = External call CO (for example, double ring)
Ring type 2 = External call CO (for example, double ring)
Ring type 3 = External call CO (for example, double ring)
The ring cadences depend on the country.
For U.S. Only: External cadences for optiset E telephones
Assistant T HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E
External call ring cadence
Type 1 External Call 125 ms ON/250 ms OFF,
125 ms ON/1500 ms OFF
Type 2 External Call CO 2 200 ms ON/ 100 ms OFF
200 ms ON/100 ms OFF
200 ms ON/1700 ms OFF
Type 3 External Call CO 3 100 ms ON/100 ms OFF
200 ms ON/100 ms OFF
100 ms ON/1900 ms OFF
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-45
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Country specifics Ring signals are country-specific and determined by the
approval authorities.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-46 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.3 Call Waiting Tone/Call Waiting
Definition
If a caller reaches a busy extension, a call waiting tone sounds after 5 s to let the
called party know that a call is waiting (camped-on). The called party then has the
option of answering the call without ending the call in progress. If the called party has
a display telephone, the display also indicates that the camped-on call is waiting.
An immediate call waiting tone is possible at a busy extension for V1.2 and later. The
appropriate flag must be set for the port. The calling party hears the ring tone imme-
diately instead of the busy tone.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of waiting
calls per station
16 16 16 16 16
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call waiting rejection If a station has activated call waiting rejection (signaling
security), a call cannot camp on.
CorNet-N CorNet-N calls are treated like internal calls.
Group call If one or more stations in a group call are free, the call will
be offered to them. The other group members are not sig-
naled. If all stations are busy, all of them receive a call wait-
ing signal.
Speaker call Speaker calls to busy stations are not possible.
Recall Recalls of low-priority external calls that cannot be sig-
naled are intercepted. Displaced internal calls are re-
leased.
Silent call waiting Users can deactivate the call waiting tone for external calls
using a procedure or HiPath 3000 Manager E. This setting
does not affect signaling on the display.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-47
Features
Call waiting Tone On/
Off
Individual stations can enable/disable the tone at their sta-
tion. Default is: Tone On.
Call Waiting Rejection
on
This station flag prevents any type of call waiting tone to be
injected in the conversation. This flag is also called
Data
Line Security
in the HiPath 3000 Manager E. When set,
this flag will also prevent this station from being overridden.
The calling station will only hear busy tone.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-48 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.4 Call Management (CM)
Definition
Call management (CM) determines how incoming calls are to be handled depending
on the trunk type and the day and night services. Call management consists of four
blocks:
Block 1: Two call allocation tables exist for calls on analog or digital (ISDN) trunks
without a direct inward dialing (DID) option (see Figure 3-1). One call allocation table
is evaluated during day service, and the other table during night service. For each
trunk, these tables contain a reference to further day and night lists. Call management
goes directly to these lists when a direct inward dialing (DID) call arrives. In the default
setting, DID calls on all trunks that lead to an intercept are signaled at the day or night
intercept position. Intercept criteria can also be entered in these tables.
Block 2: A total of three lists exist for day service, internal calls, and night answer (see
Figure 3-1). These lists contain references to one of the possible call destination lists.
Block 3: The call destination lists are seven-column table (see Figure 3-2). A row of
this table is also referred to as a CM element. The first four columns contain proce-
dures. The stations and groups entered in these columns are called consecutively de-
pending on the call forwardingno answer (CFNA) time.
The fifth column contains an entry that determines the time until CFNA occurs.
The sixth column contains an entry indicating the night bell type and the telephone
that should also be called.
The seventh column defines when the night bell entered in column six should be
called (either immediately or after the first CFNA time entered in column five).
Block 4: If group numbers have been entered in the call destination lists, the last call
management table handles any additional allocation. This table is provided for hunt
groups (linear and circular) and group calls (see Figure 3-2).
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-49
Features
Figure 3-1 Call Management Relationships (Blocks 1 and 2)
Block 1
16 = incoming calls
D A Y
N I G H T
1617 = Call allocation
trunk, night
23
.
L1
Lmax
Entries:
R1-Rn; G1-Gm
*
14
11
22
G7
.
L1
Lmax
Entries:
R1-Rn; G1-Gm
DID day
Without DID
during day
Without DID
during night
Internal
day/night
G8
14
5
14
3
Stn no. 11
22
Gm
Rn
16183 = ext. calls, day
16
16
16
1
Stn no. 11
24
Gm
Rn
16182
Internal calls
15
15
15
15
15
4
Stn no. 11
14
G1
Rn
16184
Ext. calls, night
Gm
Entries, call destination lists:
up to and including V1.2 = 70
V3.0 and later =
500 for HiPath 3750,
HiPath 3700
376 for HiPath 3550,
HiPath 3500
70 for all other systems
.
.
.
.
.
Call dest. list 14
Call dest. list 15
Call dest. list 16
Block 2
16 = incoming calls
1618 = call forwarding - no answer
1616 = call allocation trunk, day
DID
night
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-50 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Figure 3-2 Call Management Relationships (Blocks 3 and 4)
R7 G2 5R112
Block 3
16181 = call dest. lists
Block 4
16 = incoming calls
1618 = call forwarding - no answer
16 = incoming calls
1615 = hunt group or group call
W
W
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Call dest.
List 1
List 2
List 3
G1
(group 1)
G2
W = dialed
stn. number
Call dest.
List 14
List 15
List 16
Gm
(group)
11 23 12 37 –– –– 4
–– – ––– –– 1
12 37 ––– –– 1
Call management dest. 16187 = night bell, mode
1 = is called immediately
2 = is called after the first forwarding time (column 5)
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Entries:
= no entry
Rx = the port assigned to the
no. is called
Gx = group x with the call type
assigned there
.
.
.
..
.
.
R9 A2 A3 31
R1 G3 31
R4 G8 10 2
R20 3 21
W 31
123
4567 8
Call forwarding 1
to stn. no. 4
R4 G1 3R471
WR8 Gm 3*11
16151 = called stn.
16152 = call type
1 = circular hunt group
2 = linear hunt group
3 = group call
16186 = night bell, location
= no night bell
Rx = the port assigned to the no. is called
*1-*4 = relay option, relay 1 - 4
16185 = time until call forwarding
14 28 72 19 –– –– 1
. . . . .
max. list
see page 3-51
.
.
.
.
W(dial) = selected stn no. or stn.
S = system search
Ax = UCD group x (1-60) is called
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-51
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of call desti-
nation lists up to and
including V1.2
70
Number of call desti-
nation lists for V3.0
and later
500 376 70
Number of UCD
groups
60 60 10 ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call management CM does not treat a station as a call forwardingno an-
swer destination if its telephone has failed, if the user has
activated do not disturb or has activated data protection
and is busy, or if the user does not have trunk access (for
external calls).
Call management If CM cannot find a station to which it can switch the call, it
follows the intercept criteria.
Group/hunt group If no stations in a group or hunt group are available, the call
camps on at all telephones in the group.
Entrance telephone Stations that cannot be reached via direct inward dialing
(such as entrance telephones) should not be entered as
stations to which calls are allocated; otherwise, an inter-
cept will occur.
DTMF DID With DTMF DID/DISA, an analog call can be released be-
fore the call forwardingno answer process has conclud-
ed because the system uses fixed timers to prevent the
trunks from freezing up.
Night bell If a CM element does not have any entries in the first four
columns, the system immediately calls the night bell re-
gardless of the entry in the seventh column.
Call management If a system search is the item in a CM element, the system
ignores subsequent entries in this CM element.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-52 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Call management If a call can no longer be signaled in the system (due to an
AC failure, for example), the system sends a busy signal or
releases the call.
Solution:
Make an entry in the second column of the ACs call desti-
nation list.
System search The system searches all stations and:
Does not follow call forwarding
Skips executive stations
Routes only one call to each station
Ignores call ringing groups
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-53
Features
3.2.5 Call ForwardingNo Answer (CFNA) With a Timeout
Definition
With this feature, calls arriving at a specific destination are forwarded if they are not
answered within a specified period.
Call forwardingno answer in conjunction with direct inward dialing, call allocation,
and internal calls is carried out according to station numbers in call management.
Each call signaled at a station is also signaled at stations in the call ringing group; in
other words, the call is forwarded to these stations as well.
This type of forwarding is also referred as
Fixed call forwardingno answer
; in that,
once the destination has been set in the database, it cannot be activated/deactivated
or changed by the end user. The destination can only be changed by maintenance
personnel via Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E. Call Forwardingno answer in
conjunction with Direct inward dialing, Call allocation, and Internal calls is carried out
according to station numbers in Call Management. Up to three Call forwarding-no an-
swer destinations can be configured in the Call Management tables for the stations.
That is, if the initial station has assigned a
ring no answer
destination, the incoming
call forwards to that assigned destination. If in turn this second destination does not
answer, Call Management searches for a further destination to route the call.
Call forwardingno answer chaining is only possible between destinations in the CM
tables. That is, if a destination has Call Forwarding (CF) configured on the telephone,
the incoming call forwards to this destination, but will NOT forward to a further desti-
nation even if that destination is itself forwarded.
A call forward destination can be a voice mail hunt group.
If the last destination in CM is busy, the incoming call does not progress beyond the
ringing telephone until the busy telephone becomes idle. At which time, the call is for-
warded to the now idle telephone.
The external and internal call ring cadences are carried over from one destination to
the other.
Incoming Caller ID (PRI and BRI) is also carried over from one destination to the next.
Except if CF external: then Caller ID is not presented, just the original CF number
called.
Each call signaled at a station is also signaled at stations in the call ringing group.
That is, the calls are forwarded to these stations as well.
CorNet-N
Calls can be forwarded over a CorNet-N link.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-54 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Related Topic
Section 3.2.4, Call Management (CM), on page 3-48
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of CFNA des-
tinations per station
no.
33 333
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding - no
answer
If the CFNA destination is unavailable and no other call for-
warding operation is configured for the trunk, call forward-
ingno answer is not carried out.
External call forward-
ing
You can specify whether the system follows an external
call forwarding procedure that a station has programmed in
the CFNA table.
External call forward-
ing
If you activate external call forwardingno answer for the
entire trunk, the system circumvents internal call manage-
ment (for more information, refer to the ISDN features CFB
and CFNR).
DISA This feature cannot be activated/deactivated or changed
by other than the Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
DND A secondary destination which has activated DND, will be
skipped.
Analog telephones There is no indication at these telephones that the call be-
ing presented is a forwarded call.
Display telephones An incoming call to a forwarded telephone displays the
prompt:
Call from:xxx
. Secondary forwarding destinations
will display the prompt:
Call from:xxx,
where
xxx
is the orig-
inal destination dialed by the caller.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-55
Features
Hunting to external
call forwarding desti-
nation
The system-wide flag controls the call forwarding - no an-
swer if an external CF has been activated within a call des-
tination list.
If the flag is not set, the call forwarding - no answer ends at
the external CF destination.
If the flag is set, the call forwarding - no answer continues
out of the external CF destination to the station entered in
the call destination list.
Note: For CF on loop start trunks, the flag functions only if
you have entered a call cycle for the cal forwarding - no an-
swer.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-56 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.6 Call Forwarding (CF)Busy and No Answer
The following call forwarding types are available:
Call forwardingno answer
If an extension does not answer, the system forwards the call to an answering
machine or voice mail system after a programmable period of time.
Call forwardingbusy
Callers who call a busy extension receive a busy signal. The call destination list
determines whether the system carries out call forwardingbusy.
The following are special situations:
Group call
A group is always busy if all members of the group are busy.
Hunt group
A hunt group is always busy if all hunt group members are busy.
Free group
A free group is busy if at least one group member is busy and the caller reached
the group by dialing the group number.
UCD groups
The system does not check this parameter for UCD groups.
Announcements
This parameter has no effect on announcements.
if a station signals a call and the call forwarding destination is busy, the call remains
at the station. The system checks the call forwarding destination repeatedly until the
destination is free.
Incoming calls on trunks that do not support busy signaling are forwarded or inter-
cepted.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of CF desti-
nations per station no.
33333
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-57
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Conditions
Call forwarding - no
answer
If the call forwarding destination is unavailable and no oth-
er call forwarding operation is configured for the trunk, call
forwardingno answer is not carried out.
External call forward-
ing
You can specify whether the system follows an external
call forwarding procedure that a station has programmed in
the call forwarding table.
External call forward-
ing
If you activate external call forwardingno answer for the
entire trunk, the system circumvents internal call manage-
ment (for more information, refer to the ISDN features CFB
and CFNR).
Call waiting If a user has activated call waiting, the caller camps on
even if the user did not configure busy call forwarding in the
local call management table.
If call waiting is not possible for this user and the user has
not configured busy call forwarding, the caller receives a
busy signal.
Hunting to external
call forwarding desti-
nation
The system-wide flag controls the call forwarding - no an-
swer if an external CF has been activated within a call des-
tination list.
If the flag is not set, the call forwarding - no answer ends at
the external CF destination.
If the flag is set, the call forwarding - no answer continues
out of the external CF destination to the station entered in
the call destination list.
Note: For CF on loop start trunks, the flag functions only if
you have entered a call cycle for the cal forwarding - no an-
swer.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-58 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.7 Call Forwarding (CF)
Definition
Call forwarding (CF) enables users to forward all incoming calls (including speaker
calls) to another destination. Call forwarding is based on the station number, regard-
less of how the call reached the activating telephone. If trunk keys have been config-
ured, users can also activate CF individually for a specific trunk key. The following
destinations are possible:
Another subscriber station
The attendant console
An external destination
A voice messaging system
A hunt group
ACD groups (such as Hicom Agentline Office)/UCD groups
The user is notified when call forwarding is activated. Notification can be in the form
of a special dial tone, an indication on the display, or an LED signal.
Outgoing calls can still be made when call forwarding is activated.
End users can choose to forward only external calls or only internal calls. One single
access code is used to deactivate any of these choices.
Call forwarding is implemented on a station number basis, regardless of how the call
reached the activating telephone. If trunk keys have been configured, CF can also be
activated individually for a specific trunk key.
External Destination
The call forward destination can be an external party. Instead of entering an internal
station number, enter the trunk access code, followed by the external number. Since
it is possible that an incoming external call could be forwarded to an external destina-
tion, the system will check whether the combination of trunks can guarantee release
supervision. (See table below) If not, a timer is started
Time up to warning tone for
MSI - transit
and default is 300 seconds. When the timer expires, a warning tone is
heard by both parties and another timer is started
Time between warning tone and
release
, default of 10secs, after which time the trunks are released.
CorNet-N
Calls can be forwarded over a CorNet-N link.
If a call is forwarded to another node, and it in turn is forwarded back to the originating
node, the CorNet-N links will be released, if the function
Rerouting
is activated.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-59
Features
Incoming Caller ID (PRI, BRI) is passed from one destination to another within the
same system. It is not transferred over CorNet-N to a remote node. If a voice mail sys-
tem is located in a remote mode, and the call is forwarded, the voice mail system will
receive the station number of the original called party.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of simulta-
neous CFW opera-
tions
15050202020
Subject Requirement or Condition
Do not disturb (DND) You cannot program CF on a telephone where DND is ac-
tive.
Chaining Up to five call forwarding procedures can be chained.
MSN trunk forwarding In V1.0 and later, any user who has an assigned MSN for
direct inward dialing can forward this number to the trunk
(the feature must be requested from the carrier).
Ext. call forwarding You can program only one external CF destination key on
each telephone.
Ext. call forwarding When dialing external destinations, users must prefix the
destination number with the CO trunk group code.
External call forward-
ing
User to User Signaling UUS can be deactivated using the
flag Deactivate UUS per direction (routing parameters).
One effect is that the transmission of the A partys calling
number is suppressed for external call forwarding in a
User-to-User-Info-Element.
Prime Line If Prime Line (automatic trunk seizure) is active, you must
press the extension key before dialing an internal station
number. In this case, you need not enter the trunk group
code for external destinations.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-60 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Analog telephones When using analog telephones, S0 telephones (not for
U.S.), and CMI telephones (not for U.S.) telephones, you
must wait for a confirmation tone after entering external
destinations.
Appointment, auto-
matic wake-up system
When an appointment comes due, the reminder does not
follow call forwarding.
CF destination is an
ACD/UCD group
A call is not forwarded to an ACD/UCD group in the follow-
ing cases:
A station is a member of a hunt group. If the hunt
group is called and a station with CF to an ACD/UCD
group is next in line, the call is not forwarded; instead,
the next station in the hunt group is called directly.
A station is a member of a group call. If the group is
called, the call is not forwarded to the ACD/UCD
group.
A station is a member of a group call no answer. If the
group is called, the call is not forwarded to the ACD/
UCD group. Exception: The first station entered has
activated CF to the ACD/UCD group. In this case, the
call is forwarded.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-61
Features
3.2.8 Subscriber Groups
Definition
Subscriber groups are preconfigured in the HiPath 3000 systems. They are provided
as a common pool for the following features:
Group call (with or without busy signaling)
Hunt group (linear or circular)
Paging
The type of group determines how the system handles each group. This means that
each group can be either a group call or a hunt group. Names can be assigned to the
individual groups from the system administration.
Default numbers are provided in the Assistant T and E but can be changed:
General Hunt Group Call default call numbers are 350 to 499.
UCD group default call number are from 440 to 499 (within in the General Hunt
Group).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 150/20 150/20 20/8 20/8 20/8
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding When a call is forwarded to a group, the system ignores
call forwarding set by individual members of the group.
Call groups Stations can belong to more than one group.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-62 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.9 Group Call
Definition
Incoming internal and external calls are signaled simultaneously to all the stations in
a group. The first station to answer the call is connected to the calling party.
You can implement group call in call management.
Any type of telephone can be used in a Group Call group. The telephones must be
located in the same node.
Each Call Group can be assigned a name in database: 16 characters maximum.
The first station to answer the call is connected to the calling party. Subsequent calls
are signalled at the remaining idle extensions. When all members are busy, they are
signalled with Call Waiting tone. The first member to go on-hook will receive the wait-
ing call.
Feature Interaction
A member of a group can activate DND. This means that the telephone will no longer
ring when called through the Hunt Group number or when called directly.
Only display telephones can deactivate/activate Call Waiting Tone (#87/*87). They
will not be signalled of a call waiting, but will receive a waiting call when they go on-
hook.
Data Line security in Assistant T (Call Waiting rejection in HiPath 3000 Manager E)
can be configured for a member telephone. An idle telephone rings when a call enters
the group; however, a telephone is not advised of a call waiting, and if it goes on hook
and calls are waiting, the telephone does not ring until a new call enters the queue.
Individual members of a group can Call forward-all calls on their telephones. With this
feature active, the destination telephone becomes part of the group. However, if the
first member of the group Call forwards - no answer to an internal destination, all calls
to the pilot number of the group are immediately forwarded to that destination. Indi-
vidual members can be reached by their station numbers, except for the first member.
Only the forward destination can reach the first member through its station number.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-63
Features
Displays
Internal calls: At the calling party, the display shows the name of the group as-
signed via Assistant T (16-15-3) or HiPath 3000 Manager E (Incoming Call ->
Hunt Group -> Name). The group members with a display telephone see the sta-
tion number placing the call
Call from: xxx
.
External calls: The group members display will show the calling party number.
(same as call to a single station).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 150/20 150/20 20/8 20/8 20/8
Subject Requirement or Condition
Ext. call forwarding If at least one subscriber in a group has activated external
call forwarding, you cannot make an unscreened transfer
within the group.
Analog telephones The system does not check whether analog telephones
are present. As a result, you must log the telephone onto
the system by lifting the handset once.
Intercept If the call cannot be signaled at any station, it is intercept-
ed.
Call waiting Busy stations receive call waiting or ring injection if no oth-
er stations are available.
Group call on/off Each member of a group call can dial #85 to leave group
call and *81 to reenter group call.
Hunt group If a station is active in group call and a hunt group, any
changes (such as dialing *81 or #81) apply to both fea-
tures.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-64 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.10 Group Call with Busy Signaling
Definition
If a group member is busy, incoming calls to the group receive a busy signal. The call
also camps on at the busy station.
This type of group (defined in Assistant T as
Grp call, No answer
and in HiPath 3000
Manager E as
RNA
under
Ty p e
) functions in the similar manner as a
Group Call
ar-
rangement; that is, when a new call enters an idle group, all member telephones ring.
The first member to go off hook, is connected to the calling party.
However, if there are any subsequent calls to the pilot number while one member is
busy, the calls camp on to the busy extension. No other telephone in the group is sig-
nalled. The other members are nevertheless allowed to place outside calls and to re-
ceive calls if their individual station number is dialed.
This type of arrangement is useful where an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone is
associated with a wireless telephone.
Any type of telephone can be used in a Call Group.
Each Call Group can be assigned a name in database with 16 characters maximum.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 150/20 150/20 20/8 20/8 20/8
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call waiting rejection The call does not camp on if the busy station has activated
call waiting rejection.
Direct inward dialing If a station in the group is called directly, the call is signaled
at the dialed extension.
Group If an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone in the group is de-
fective, the group is treated as though it were busy.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-65
Features
3.2.11 Hunt Group
Definition
A hunt group implements a call distribution cycle within a subscriber group. The sta-
tions in the hunt group are linked so that a call to the group that reaches a busy mem-
ber or is not answered is forwarded to the next available station within the group.
The following hunt group options are available:
Circular selection: The search begins with the station after the last station se-
lected. If the call is not answered, it is forwarded to the next station after a timeout
(CFNA in call management).
Linear selection: When a call arrives, the search always begins with the first sta-
tion in the group.
The stations can be reached either by a hunt group number or by the users station
number, depending on the hunt group type.
You can set up hunt groups in call management.
Each Hunt Group can be assigned a name in database with 16 characters maximum.
The stations can be reached either by a hunt group pilot number or by the users sta-
tion number, depending on the hunt group.
In the case of a Linear Hunt group, the last member of the hunt can be a pseudo num-
ber leading to a voice mail system. The pseudo number is the call number which will
be transmitted to the voice mail system. It is also possible to have a call forwarding
within the destination list.
One station can simultaneously be a member of two groups. Calls from either group
are presented to the agent in the normal manner. If the user has a display telephone,
he or she can identify the source of the call by the name assigned to the trunk/trunk
group.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 150/20 150/20 20/8 20/8 20/8
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-66 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call waiting If all stations in a hunt group are busy, the call camps on at
all stations.
Call signaling If all hunt group stations hang up simultaneously, call sig-
naling begins at all stations that previously had waiting
calls.
Do not disturb (DND) If all stations in the hunt group activate DND, a call man-
agement procedure handles the call.
Hunt group Stations can belong to more than one group.
Queue If the number of calls directed to the hunt group exceeds
the number that can currently be processed, the excess
calls are placed in a queue. You can configure an an-
nouncement or music to be played for calls placed in the
queue (entry in call management before the hunt group).
Overflow, call forward-
ingno answer
You can use call management to set up an overflow station
as a CFNA destination for hunt groups.
Hunt group on/off Each member of a hunt group can dial #85 to leave the
hunt group and *85 to reenter the hunt group.
Group call If a station is active in group call and a hunt group, any
changes (such as dialing *85/#85) apply to both features.
Telephone type Any type of telephone can be used in a Hunt Group.
Group call on/off Each member of a group call can dial *85 to leave the
group call and #85 to join it again.
CDRC Same rules apply as in a normal conversation. Elapsed
time of call is assigned to last station which handled the
call.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-67
Features
3.2.12 Leave Group Call/Hunt Group (Stop Hunt)
Definition
An internal extension that is entered in call management as a member of one or more
groups (including MULAP groups) can:
leave and rejoin individual selected groups and
leave and rejoin all groups
by entering a code, using the service menu or pressing a key.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 150/20 150/20 20/8 20/8 20/8
Subject Requirement or Condition
User access The user must be part of a subscriber group to have ac-
cess to this feature.
Default access codes The default access codes are
#85
to leave the Hunt Group
and
*85
to rejoin the group.
DISA Users can activate this function from a DISA connection for
their station or for other stations (Associated Services).
Call Management If all members of a group invoke the
Leave Hunt Group
fea-
ture, internal callers are diverted to the next Call Manage-
ment destination, or if not defined, the call receives a busy
tone.
Leave selected groups Executive members cannot leave executive MULAP
groups.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-68 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13 Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
Definition
With uniform call distribution (UCD), incoming internal or external calls are automat-
ically assigned to the station (agent) idle longest in a UCD group.
If all stations in a UCD group are busy, any additional incoming calls are placed in the
queue and then distributed to the group members according to the priority of the call
and the length of time it has been waiting. Announcements or music can be played
for the waiting callers.
Users (agents) can log on from any telephone by entering an ID. After logging on, the
agent is available and is permanently assigned to that telephone until logged off. The
assignment is retained even after a system reset.
The UCD group can be forwarded (night answer for UCD).
There are 150 Subscriber groups in the system. Of which, 60 can be UCD groups.
The default access pilot numbers are 440 to 499.
The Pilot number can be changed but it must be a unique number, up to 6 digits in
length. A name can be given to each group, with up to 16 characters each.
The agents states are maintained in the event of a power failure.
Agents
Any type of telephone can be part of a UCD group. Analog connections can also be
used for remote agents (teleagents).
A UCD group contains agents that belong to a work group. Agent indexes are asso-
ciated with each of the UCD groups. Each index contains up to 32 agent IDs. A max-
imum of 150 agents can be active simultaneously in the system. Accordingly, 150
fixed agent IDs can be assigned to one of up to 60 UCD groups. An ID can only be
assigned to one group. Several IDs can be assigned to one agent, permitting the
agent to work in more than one UCD group; however, the agent can only be active in
one group at a time.
Certain system features are only available to UCD members.
An agent can logon/logoff from any optiset E, optiPoint 500 or analog telephone con-
nection in the system using an ID. The agent is available after logon, and is perma-
nently assigned to this device until logoff. An agent can only be logged on from one
UCD groups are handled differently from the Call/Hunt Groups in the system call
processing.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-69
Features
device at a time and only one agent can be logged on per device. Each agent is as-
signed to one work group only. After logging off, the agent is no longer available for
UCD calls.
At logon, this assignment to the UCD groups is checked. The port to which an agent
logs on is stored in the non-volatile memory in order to retain the assignments should
the system be reset.
Agent Indexes are defined in the following manner:
HiPath 3000 Manager E: Options ->Incoming Calls ->UCD groups ->members.
Assistant T: 31-1.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
UCD groups 60 60 10 ––
UCD agents Max. 150 Max. 150 Max. 150 ––
ID numbers 150 150 150 ––
Agents per station 1 1 1 ––
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-70 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.1 UCD Queues
Definition
If all stations (agents) in a UCD group are busy, incoming calls are placed on hold and
entered in a queue.
Agents of a UCD group can display the number of calls in the queue for their UCD
group. Waiting parties in the queue can receive an announcement or music on hold.
To display the number of UCD calls in queue, users with display telephones can pro-
gram a feature key or during a call, press
Program/Service
, scroll to and select
UCD?
,
and scroll to and select the wanted feature. Alternatively, during a conversation, users
can press the
Program/Service
key and dial the access code.
Non-display and analog telephone users must dial the access codes from an idle
state or, if during a conversation, they must temporarily put the calling party on Con-
sultation Hold by pressing the
Consultation
key followed by the access code. Or, in
the case of an analog telephone, a hookswitch flash must be performed.
Non-display telephones (optiset E or optiPoint 500) can have buttons on the tele-
phones programmed for specific features; however, this can only be done via HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Queues per UCD
group
111––
Number of calls in
queue (per UCD
group)
30
for UCD groups 1 to 59,
72
for UCD group 60
––
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-71
Features
3.2.13.2 UCD Call Prioritization
Definition
Within the queue, incoming internal and external calls for the UCD group are priori-
tized according to call type.
The system distributes waiting calls to the UCD group according to priority and then
the length of time they have been waiting. In other words, a high-priority waiting call
is answered before a low-priority call that has been waiting longer.
In the case of trunk circuits, the priorities are assigned according to trunk (per B chan-
nel).
A priority of 1 to 10 is allocated for the classification of internal calls. The system then
distributes the queued calls to the UCD group according to the priority and queue
time; that is, a queuing call with a high priority can be answered sooner than a call
queuing for a longer time but with a lower priority. With trunk circuits, the system as-
signs priorities on a per trunk basis (per B channel). The system evaluates incoming
calls for a UCD group by the priority established.
Priority levels are set in HiPath 3000 Manager E. The Internal call priority is also es-
tablished on the HiPath 3000 Manager E Priority screen, under Priorities for internal
calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Priority levels 10 10 10 ––
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-72 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.3 UCD Subscriber States
Definition
After a user (agent) logs onto the system, the current status of the UCD station where
the agent logged on appears on the display. The following states are possible:
Available: UCD calls are signaled to the UCD group member (agent).
Unavailable: The UCD member (agent) has logged off from the workstation (to
take a break or leave the group).
Work time: The user (agent) needs time to process a UCD call.
Autowork time: The member (agent) is automatically removed from the UCD
group for a certain period after processing a call.
UCD incoming call: The member (agent) is processing a UCD call (even after
transfer).
Non-UCD internal call: An internal non-UCD call is in progress.
Non-UCD external incoming call: An external non-UCD call is in progress.
Non-UCD external outgoing call: The member (agent) is engaged in an outgo-
ing external non-UCD call.
Removed: The telephone has physically failed.
Members (agents) can log off when they have completed their work and are no longer
available. They can still be reached directly via their direct inward dialing (DID) num-
ber.
After a user logs onto the system, the status of the UCD station is automatically set
to Available. The display prompt confirms this status. Whenever the agent changes
states, the change is displayed; however, the highest priority display (Available/not
available) appears and remains on the display.
The above list of UCD subscriber states do not represent the actual display prompts
on the telephone.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-73
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Do not disturb (DND),
call forwarding (CF)
Members (agents) who activate DND or CF are logged off.
Call forwardingno
answer (CFNA)
If a member (agent) does not accept a call, the system au-
tomatically treats the member like an unavailable agent
when CFNA is activated.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-74 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.4 Leave UCD Group
Definition
Members (agents) can temporarily leave a UCD group(for breaks, and so on) but still
remain logged on to the UCD group. The system continues to signal direct calls to this
agent. If necessary, the agent can send a message to any station, for instance to ask
for help.
When an agent logs on to the group, the agent is immediately and automatically
placed in the available state and can start processing calls.
Display telephones can program Feature keys Available/Not available on the optiset
E and optiPoint 500. Non-display telephones can have a key programmed using Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwardingno
answer (CFNA)
CFNA is activated when all members (agents) have left the
UCD group.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-75
Features
3.2.13.5 Work Time
Definition
With this feature, UCD members (agents) can temporarily prevent calls from being
assigned to their workstations. This allows them to leave the UCD group for short pe-
riods to complete paperwork following a call. The agent is still logged on to the UCD
group. Calls to the UCD group bypass any workstation that has this feature activated.
In addition, members (agents) can activate autowork time. In this case, the agent is
automatically removed from the UCD group for a certain period after processing a
call.
The automatic wrap up time is variable up to 100 seconds, in steps of 5 seconds (ring
cycle). At the end of the automatic wrap up time, the agent is placed back in the group.
An agent in the
Work
state can still be called by dialing the station number.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-76 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.6 Recorded Announcement/Music on Hold (MOH) with UCD
Definition
This feature allows customers to play a greeting message (announcement before an-
swering) to internal callers or external callers while they are being switched. Trunk-
by-trunk assignment of announcement devices is possible.
With UCD, music and/or further announcements can be played to callers if they can-
not be switched immediately. These announcements (or music) can be played in any
order (up to seven) until a group member (agent) becomes available.
It is possible to play music on hold or announcements from a connected external an-
nouncement device using the following types of devices:
Devices that always start at the beginning of the message when activated (such
as greeting messages).
Continuous playback devices (for announcements and music on hold).
The announcements can be assigned to each UCD group individually.
The HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 supports access for 16 unique announcements
and one MOH source. The HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 supports 4 announcements
and one MOH source. Each UCD group can be configured with up to 7 announce-
ment steps. A unique announcement and the duration of the announcement can be
defined for each step. The time is defined as ring cycles, that is in increments of 5
seconds. The announcement script can be configured to play a single time or contin-
ue to cycle until the call is answered; this is configured in the UCD group parameter
Announcement change
.
Analog ports can be configured as a digital announcer interface. E&M Tie line ports
can also be used in the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 as the interface to the digital
announcer.
The STRB option board can be used in the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 to control
the start of the external announcement device in lieu of the contacts on the TIEL cir-
cuit card in the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
Announcement devices are configured with a start time and a listen duration time.
Music on Hold devices are endless loop type recordings with continuous play at-
tributes. Up to 32 parties held in queue can hear an announcement.
The
Announcement Delay Time
parameter is used to configure the delay before a
queued call is switched to the recorded announcement device (allowed value 0-600
seconds). Each call to an UCD Group gets an announcement. If no announcement
device is configured, the internal MOH is sent to the calling party. To suppress the an-
nouncement, the delay should be configured to the maximum value, assuming that
the call will be answered within this time.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-77
Features
For more information, refer to Music on Hold (Internal or External Source) on page 3-
30.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Free ana-
log subs.
ports
TIEL
EXM, EXMR, MPPI
(not for U.S.), free ana-
log subs. ports
––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Ann. devices 16 4 1 ––
Max. no. of announce-
ments per group
777––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Seven announce-
ments per group in Hi-
Path 3550
Although only four announcement devices can be connect-
ed to HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500, seven announce-
ments can be used per group by connecting an individual
announcement device or combining the four devices.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-78 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.7 Overflow With UCD
Definition
If a call in the queue is not answered within a specific period, the agent is switched to
unavailable mode and the call is transferred to the next available UCD member
(agent). The call is forwarded to an overflow destination (CFNA destination) only if all
UCD agents are unavailable. Users can specify the destination and time in call man-
agement.
Users can also define a maximum number of waiting calls. If this maximum limit is ex-
ceeded, any new calls are forwarded to the overflow destination.
The overflow destination can also activate external call forwarding.
The overflow destination can be a voice mail system. The number forwarded to the
voice mail system is the original called partys number.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Overflow per group 3 3 3 ––
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-79
Features
3.2.13.8 Automatic Incoming Call Connection (AICC) With UCD
Definition
This feature allows members (agents) to answer incoming calls without performing
any operator actions. To do this, the member must have a headset and an enable key
on the telephone. A tone in the headset lets the UCD member know that a call has
arrived, and the call is then automatically switched through.
Automatic incoming call connection (AICC) can be configured separately for each
UCD group. This feature activates automatically if a headset is detected or configured
at a station.
Automatic incoming call connection (AICC) can be configured separately for each
UCD group and applies to the whole group. Using Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E, stations must be individually configured for headset operation; however, if the
HiPath 3000 systems detect a headset adapter, the system automatically sets the
headset flag in the database. AICC activates automatically if a headset is detected or
configured for a telephone. The headset flag is set in the
Set up Station
tab in the Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
The system routes calls to agents configured for AICC whether there is a headset
physically connected or not.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
General requirements optiPoint 500 or optiset E,
headset, release key
––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog telephones Analog stations cannot use this feature because the sys-
tem cannot guarantee that a telephone is physically con-
nected to the port.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-80 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Display telephones A brief tone is heard in the headset, signalling to the agent
that a call has arrived, and the call is answered automati-
cally.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-81
Features
3.2.13.9 UCD Night Answer
Definition
UCD groups can activate a group-specific night answer independent of system night
answer. If agents have activated the night answer feature for their own UCD group, all
calls for this group are routed to the appropriate UCD night station.
Each user can activate or deactivate group-specific night answer. All users remain
logged on after night answer has been activated. If system night answer is active si-
multaneously, it has priority, and call management follows it.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Agent status If you activate the night answer feature, your current status
does not change.
System night answer UCD night answer can be activated independently of sys-
tem night answer and vice versa. If a call reaches a UCD
group by way of system night answer, the call remains in
the UCD group independently of UCD night answer.
Group-specific night
answer destination
The group-specific night answer destination can be an in-
ternal, external, or any other UCD group.
Calls currently being
processed
Calls that are being processed during activation of UCD
night answer are not affected.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-82 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.10 UCD Group Status Display (Calls in Queue)
Definition
Users can use a procedure or code to display the number of calls waiting in the
queue.
Users can program a feature button on the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone for
this feature.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Digital subscriber line module ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 with dis-
play
––
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-83
Features
3.2.13.11 UCD Home Agent
Definition
Users can integrate an off-premises extension (analog telephone) into the UCD group
as a home agent.
The off-premise station (OPS) telephone is configured in Call Management.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
UCD Only the most important functions are accessible via
codes (logon, work, unavailable).
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-84 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.13.12 Transfer to UCD Groups
Definition
Internal and external calls can be transferred to a UCD group. If the call is not an-
swered within a certain period, a recall is carried out. This time is fixed and cannot be
changed.
Announcements can be played for the external transferred calls.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Max. number of UCD
groups
60 60 10 ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Announcements Internal transferred calls do not receive announcements.
Recall The recall time for transferring calls to UCD groups is long-
er than for other stations.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-85
Features
3.2.14 Silent Monitoring
Definition
An authorized user can monitor a call in progress at any internal station without the
other partys knowledge.
For V1.2 and later, it is possible for all stations in the system to use the Silent Moni-
toring capability, rather than just one station. Set the appropriate flag for each autho-
rized station.
The monitoring station can only be an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone; monitored
telephones can be of any type.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Some states require that the outside caller be advised that the call may be moni-
tored.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.2 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Silent Monitoring This feature can be used in the following countries only:
Australia, Brazil, France, Great Britain, Hong Kong, India,
Ireland, Malaysia, the Netherlands, Singapore, South Afri-
ca, Thailand, USA, international markets.
Silent monitoring The call can be overridden only using code
*944
+ station
number (not from a menu).
Signaling The call is not signaled at the overridden station (no dis-
play, no alerting tone, no sound).
Conference Silent Monitoring limits the maximum number of confer-
ences. Maximum number of conferences possible in sys-
tem = maximum number of simultaneous Silent Monitoring
stations.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-86 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.15 Do Not Disturb (DND)
Definition
Users can activate do not disturb (DND) on their stations so that no incoming calls
are put through.
A user who has activated DND hears a special dial tone after lifting the handset.
When the feature is active, the message
Do not disturb
is also displayed on optiset E
or optiPoint 500 telephones with display. On all other optiset E or optiPoint 500 tele-
phones, the station LED indicates a busy state.
The attendant console, night station, or any authorized station can override DND. In
this case, the caller first hears a busy signal after dialing the number. The call is then
signaled to the station that has activated DND. If the station has activated the ringer
cutoff feature, the call is signaled visually only. If the station with do not disturb acti-
vated is engaged in a call, the incoming call is signaled as call waiting.
A caller who dials a telephone with DND activated receives a busy signaland is not
allowed to camp on.
The
Flags
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway of the HiPath
3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) status in-
formation. You can use the
Flags
screen to see if a station has activated DND or not.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
AC, night station The AC and night station cannot activate DND.
Call forwarding You cannot specify DND if call forwarding is active on the
same telephone.
Call forwarding You cannot activate call forwarding to a telephone with
DND.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-87
Features
Callback If a callback is initiated to a station with DND activated, the
callback is not executed until DND is deactivated. If the
subscriber with DND activated initiates a callback, this will
override the DND function.
Appointment, auto-
matic wake-up system
If a station has set an appointment and activated DND, an
audible signal is sent to the telephone when the appoint-
ment comes due.
DISA The feature can be activated by users for their own sta-
tions, or can be activated by one user for another (Associ-
ated Services).
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-88 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.16 Ringer Cutoff
Definition
If this feature is activated by an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display, in-
coming calls are signaled with a brief alerting tone and then shown in the display only.
The
Flags
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway of the HiPath
3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) status in-
formation. You can use the
Flags
screen to see if a station has activated Ringer Cutoff
or not.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 with display
Subject Requirement or Condition
Ringer cutoff You can only activate this feature for optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephones with display.
Appointment, auto-
matic wake-up system
If a station has activated ringer cutoff and an appointment
comes due, it is signaled audibly.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-89
Features
3.2.17 Caller List/Station Number Storage
Definition
Unanswered calls to an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone can be automatically
stored in a chronological caller list. The time of each call is specified, and the user
can dial the entered callers directly.
Users can also manually store incoming and outgoing calls in the caller list.
You can program a system parameter so that the telephone also automatically stores
external calls that were answered. Because the parameter is system-wide, this set-
ting applies to all caller lists in the system.
Each new entry can be automatically indicated by an LED. In addition, unanswered
entries can be displayed on the screen by pressing a preprogrammed key. The LED
is deactivated as soon as the user retrieves the list.
On telephones with a 2-line display, the oldest entry is displayed first.
This feature is valid only for display telephones.
By default, the feature is active for all telephones and stores all incoming internal and
incoming external ISDN calls (which have caller ID information from the CO). Any sta-
tion can be prohibited from using the feature by changing the station default. Also, a
system-wide flag can change the Caller List mode to store only external call informa-
tion instead of internal and external.
The Caller List operates in a first-in-first-out (FIFO) manner. If the List is full, and an-
other call rings in, the oldest call in the list is deleted, and so on.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn. UP0/E stn.
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
Subscriber group Maximum of 10 entries
Lists/entries 650/10 650/10 100/10 100/10 100/10
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-90 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog trunk Only calls with a station number or a name are recorded
(calls on analog trunks are not recorded).
Power failure The entries are deleted in the case of a power failure or a
system reset.
Internal/external calls You can store either external calls only or both internal and
external calls.
Repeated calls If a subscriber calls repeatedly, only the time of the entry is
updated.
Group If you belong to a group, you can access the groups caller
list in addition to your own caller list.
Storing an external
answered call
You can access the store station number function manu-
ally from the service menu.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-91
Features
3.2.18 Call Pickup Within Call Pickup Groups
Definition
Calls that are signalled acoustically at a station in a call pickup group are simulta-
neously indicated by an LED (next to the programmed key) and signaled on the dis-
plays of the other group members. The call can be picked up by pressing the pro-
grammed key or dialing a code. Acoustic pickup signaling (after 5 rings) can also be
configured system-wide.
The time from start of ring to acoustic notification of all group members, is not vari-
able. If there are several calls ringing the group, they are picked up in order of arrival.
Calls destined for Call Keys, Trunk Keys or General Call Keys, can be picked up by
another user. The LED on these keys will indicate busy after the pick up. Calls direct-
ed to MUSAP keys can be picked up, but after pick up, they will show the key as idle.
The following versions of call pickup are also available:
Targeted Call Pickup Outside of a Pickup Group on page 3-93
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Groups/stations 32/32 32/32 8/8 8/8 8/8
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call pickup Only voice devices can be selected. A station can belong
to only one group.
Recall
Callback
Recall and callback calls are not signaled to the other
group members.
Do not disturb (DND) Stations that have activated DND do not receive call pickup
signaling.
Transfer Unscreened transfer calls cannot be picked up within the
group.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-92 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Groups All group members are authorized to pick up calls.
Call waiting A camped-on call can be picked up. If more than one call
is waiting, the first caller is always picked up.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-93
Features
3.2.19 Targeted Call Pickup Outside of a Pickup Group
Definition
Users can also pick up calls for other internal parties who do not belong to the same
call pickup group and therefore do not appear on the screen. This increases the like-
lihood that incoming calls are always answered. To pick up the call, the user must
press a programmed call pickup key or enter a code and then dial the selected partys
station number.
Display telephone users can program a feature key on their telephone for this feature
or as with non-display telephones, request that this feature key be installed via HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Calls destined for Call Keys, Trunk Keys or General Call Keys can be picked up by
another user. The LED on these keys will indicate busy after the pick up. Calls direct-
ed to MUSAP keys can be picked up, but after pick up, the key indicates it is idle.
The following versions of call pickup are also available:
Call Pickup Within Call Pickup Groups on page 3-91
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call waiting A camped-on call can be picked up. If more than one call
is waiting, the first caller is always picked up.
CDRC Charges and/or elapsed time incurred as a result of a
Picked up call, are assigned to the station which picked up
the call.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-94 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.20 Call Pickup from an Answering Machine
Definition
optiset E or optiPoint 500 users have the option of picking up a call that has already
been answered by an answering machine by pressing the appropriate
DSS
key. This
releases the connection to the answering machine.
Several optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones can have the appearance of the
An-
swering machine DSS
key, affording each the opportunity to pick up the call.
The purpose of this feature is to allow the answering device to act as a filter for incom-
ing calls. The called party can decide to accept the call or let the device record the
callers message.
optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephone users have the option of picking up a call that
was already answered by an answering machine by pressing the appropriate DSS
key. This releases the connection to the answering machine. Several optiset E and
optiPoint 500 telephones can have the appearance of this DSS key, affording each
the opportunity to pick up the call
An incoming call is received at the answering machine. The LED for the DSS key cor-
responding to the answering machine is lit at the users telephone. If users want to
talk to calling parties directly, they press the DSS key. This connects them to the call-
ing party and disconnects the answering machine.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E station
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone
Subject Requirement or Condition
Answering machine The answering machine port must be configured as an an-
swering machine in system administration.
Answering machine You must program an
Answering machine call pickup
DSS
key on the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone for this fea-
ture to work.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-95
Features
3.2.21 Fax Waiting Message/Answering Machine
Definition
A
Fax/Answering Machine
key has an LED to let the user know that a fax waiting mes-
sage or a call for the answering machine has arrived.
A call directed to an analog port configured as a FAX machine or as an Answering
Machine lights an LED at a station to advise the user that the FAX or the Answering
Machine has answered an incoming call. The LED is lit steadily.
The user can turn off the LED by pressing the key.
The HiPath 3000 Manager E can program a key on the optiset E or optiPoint 500. The
button name in the Key Programming tab is Message for FAX/answ.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E station
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone
Subject Requirement or Condition
Program key You must also enter the station number when program-
ming the key.
Analog port The analog port must be configured as a fax machine or
answering machine.
Info key The LED goes out when you press the key.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-96 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.22 Deferring a Call
Definition
While an incoming call is being signaled at a station, the called party can set up an
outgoing connection without answering the incoming call.
The waiting call is then signaled as a camped-on call.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E station
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
Subject Requirement or Condition
Deferring the call You must have trunk keys or at least two call keys pro-
grammed on the telephone.
Deferring the call An key for the feature must be available.
Features for General Incoming Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-97
Features
3.2.23 Station Number Configuration Using Assistant T
Definition
HiPath 3000 automatically assign the following:
Internal station numbers (depending on the configuration)
Internal group numbers (depending on the model)
Station number assignment does not need to be explicitly configured. This feature al-
lows users to modify the preset internal station numbers using Assistant T.
You can use the menu option Search for number to locate individual station numbers.
After you enter an internal station number, its logical port is displayed in the format
SSPP (SS = slot, PP = port).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. number of inter-
nal station numbers
In accordance with the HW configuration
Max. number of inter-
nal group numbers
150 150 150 20 20
Subject Requirement or Condition
Station number con-
figuration
An internal station or group number must always be unique
in the system and must not conflict with other station num-
bers in the numbering plan.
Features for General Incoming Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-98 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.2.24 Reject Calls
Definition
This feature allows internal and external incoming initial calls to be rejected by press-
ing
the release key on optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones with display or
the consult key on mobile telephones (CMI).
The rejected call then follows the Call Management. If there is no other call destina-
tion, the previously called destination is called again.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Topic HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display / mobile
telephone
SW requirements V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
V1.2 or
later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Recall, callback, park,
hold
Transferred recalls, queued callbacks, held or parked calls
cannot be rejected.
Group call, hunt group
call, MULAP
In these cases, the entire group call ends and follows Call
Management. The call is released if there is no other call
destination.
Call forwarding There is no immediate call forwarding after the call is re-
jected. The entries in Call Management determine the next
step.
Intercept This follows the intercept criteria in Call Management.
Features for General Outgoing Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-99
Features
3.3 Features for General Outgoing Traffic
3.3.1 Dual-Tone Multifrequency Transmission (DTMF)/Temporary Signaling
Method Changeover
Definition
When this feature is activated, all keystrokes that the user enters on the dialing key-
pad while engaged in an internal or external call are transmitted as DTMF digits.
Users can activate this feature:
System-wide (automatic DTMF).
Users are automatically switched over to DTMF mode after each successful con-
nection (even with CMI [not for U.S.]).
Individually while engaged in an internal or external call by pressing a key or en-
tering a code.
Afterwards, all keystrokes from the dialing keypad are transmitted as DTMF dig-
its. The feature is activated temporarily and is deactivated when the handset is
replaced.
DTMF mode remains activated even when the following features are activated:
Tr a n s fe r
Consultation hold
Toggle
Call pickup
Accepting a camped-on call
Users can configure the pulse/pause in the system. However, configuring the pulse/
pause is not recommended. Contact your second-level service organization if re-
quired.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-100 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Dial pulsing (DP) sta-
tion
DP stations cannot use this feature.
Station on hold A station on hold cannot transmit any DTMF signals.
Conference, call park,
recall
DTMF mode remains activated during a conference, dur-
ing a recall, or in call park mode.
Other features during
DTMF mode
When DTMF mode is active, you must always use the Pro-
gram/Service key to activate features during a call.
Voice mail DTMF mode is automatically activated when a station con-
figured as voice mail is selected.
US DTMF Default In the US, this default value for this feature is
On
.
Features for General Outgoing Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-101
Features
3.3.2 Individual Telephone Lock (Changeover)
Definition
Users can activate a telephone lock that restricts outgoing external calls (COS 1), al-
though they can continue to place internal calls and forward incoming calls to internal
stations. Users activate the telephone lock by pressing a key or dialing a code and
entering their 5-digit personal identification number (PIN).
System speed dialing remains active while the telephone lock is on.
While the Telephone Lock feature is activated, the user can only use the following fea-
tures:
System speed-dialing
Room Monitor
Speaker Call
internal calls
conferences with internal stations
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-102 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Extension trunk ac-
cess
After telephone lock is activated, the extension trunk ac-
cess is set to a system-wide class of service (default = 1).
Extension trunk ac-
cess
After telephone lock is activated, you can reduce the class
of service but not select a higher class of service.
Telephone lock While telephone lock is active, you cannot activate any fea-
tures that could result in charges being assigned to this sta-
tion. Exception: system speed dialing.
Telephone type This feature works with any type of telephone in the system.
Non-display/analog
feature reminder
Upon going off-hook, broken dial tone is presented to the
user as a reminder that a feature is active on the telephone.
Invoke from a talk
state
During a conversation, the user presses the
Consultation
key (or performs a switch hook flash in the case of an ana-
log telephone), putting the current conversation on Consul-
tation Hold. The user then dials the access code and the
PIN and confirmation tone is returned. The user can then
return to the held party by pressing the
Consultation
key
once again.
Features for General Outgoing Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-103
Features
3.3.3 System Telephone Lock (Changeover)
Definition
An authorized user can lock a telephone for an internal station. This feature has the
same function as the individual telephone lock. The telephone lock can be deactivat-
ed from the attendant console or the station.
System speed dialing remains active while the telephone lock is on.
While the Telephone Lock feature is activated, the user can only use the following fea-
tures:
System speed-dialing
Room Monitor
Speaker Call
internal calls
conferences with internal stations
The function
#0
= Reset all services does not deactivate this feature. It is not possible
to change the PIN from a locked telephone.
If the authorized station has activated a Telephone Lock, the authorized user must
first deactivate the Telephone Lock feature before attempting to activate/deactivate
another stations Telephone Lock.
To activate/deactivate another stations telephone lock, the authorized station does
not need to know or use the individuals PIN. No PIN is required to activate/deactivate
the other stations Telephone Lock.
Related Topics
Section 3.3.2, Individual Telephone Lock (Changeover)
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-104 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Extension trunk ac-
cess
After telephone lock is activated, the extension trunk ac-
cess is set to a system-wide COS (default = 1).
Extension trunk ac-
cess
After telephone lock is activated, you can reduce the class
of service but not select a higher class of service.
Telephone lock While telephone lock is active, you cannot activate any fea-
tures except for system speed dialing, room monitor,
speaker call, and conferences with internal stations.
Feature Active Notice At the destination telephone, the user is advised of a fea-
ture activation by hearing broken dial tone when going off
hook, or if the user has a button for this feature, the LED
will be lit. If the telephone is unlocked, the broken dial tone
is removed and/or the LED is extinguished.
Non-display/analog If the authorized station is a non-display or analog tele-
phone, the user, from an idle state, can access the feature
by dialing
*943
, followed by the destination station for
which Telephone Lock is to be activated/deactivated, fol-
lowed by * to activate or # to deactivate. Confirmation tone
is returned only after all digits have been dialed. Error tone
will not be returned if the authorized station inadvertently
attempts to lock an already locked telephone, or attempts
to unlock an already unlocked telephone
Features for General Outgoing Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-105
Features
3.3.4 Hotline
Definition
With the hotline feature, the telephone automatically connects to a predefined internal
or external destination after the user lifts the handset. Users can also configure the
feature so that the two locations connect only after a defined period (hotline after tim-
eout). This delay is configured centrally and can be activated and deactivated on each
station.
Call forwarding and call forwardingno answer are evaluated at the destination.
If the Hotline Delayed station (originator) dials a digit before the timeout limit, the timer
is cancelled and the station is not forwarded to the Hotline destination whether anoth-
er digit is dialed or not.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements/Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Hotline destinations 6 6 1 1 1
Subject Requirement/Condition
DND If the destination station is in
Do not disturb
(DND), the
caller hears busy tone.
Destination If the internal destination is busy, the caller camps on.
If the internal destination is a display telephone, the
destinations display shows
Call from: xxx
, where
xxx
is the Hotline originators station number.
The destination can be an internal station, an external
destination (up to 32 digits can be programmed in Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E or Assistant T) or a Subscriber
group.
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-106 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.3.5 Mobile PIN
Definition
This feature allows a user (active station) to conduct internal or trunk calls (flex calls)
from a remote telephone (passive station) using his or her own user profile (station
number, name, toll restriction, call detail recording). The call detail data (CDRC/
CDRS) is assigned to the active station.
To activate this feature, perform one of the following steps on the remote terminal:
Enter Mobile PIN code + local station number + PIN
Call service menu + enter local station number + enter PIN
Press the programmed key + enter local station number + enter PIN
The feature remains activated until the active station terminates the call.
As long as this feature is activated, the current telephone (passive station) cannot be
reached under its actual station number. Do not disturb is activated.
An active station can be a:
Station
MULAP (in this case, the PIN of the primary station in the MULAP group is re-
quested)
An active station cannot be a:
Hunt group
ACD group
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for General Outgoing Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-107
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Services This feature supports only the voice service.
Call detail data Call detail data (CDRC/CDRS) is assigned to the station
number of the active station. The passive station number
is supplied as additional information.
If the active station is the primary station in a MULAP
group, call charges are recorded just as though the MU-
LAP primary station had placed the call.
Recall A recall is signaled on the passive station telephone but is
no longer part of the flex call. For this reason, it is conduct-
ed using the profile of the passive station (number, name
and classes of service).
Busy indication Busy indication applies to the passive station telephone.
Only the trunk of the active station is signaled as busy.
Features that can be
used after flex call is
activated
Speaker call (paging)
Conference
Busy override (busy override class of service taken
from active station)
To g g l e
Park
Consultation hold
Transfer
Call pickup (during a flex call, calls are picked up using
the profile of the active station)
Do not disturb
Call forwarding
Send message (message waiting)
Callback
Station number suppression
Group ringing
Features for General Outgoing Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-108 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.3.6 B Channel Allocation (V3.0 and later)
Definition
This feature allows you to allocate outgoing connection B channels on an S2M link to
different trunk groups.
For outgoing calls, only B channels that also correspond to the trunk group are se-
lected (by the code-selected trunk group, overflow trunk group, or LCR-selected trunk
group). If there is no free B channel available for this trunk group, the system rejects
the connection request and reacts in the way it has been configured.
Incoming calls are always accepted if a B channel in the corresponding S2M line is
available, regardless of the trunk group. This is usually the B channel offered by the
partner. If the remote system or the public network does not support B channel allo-
cation, there is no guarantee that the call will be correctly assigned to the right trunk
group.
HiPath 3000 Manager E allocates an S2M link to the trunk groups; a route can be as-
signed to each line (B channel).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx–––
HW requirements TMS2 TS2 /
TS2R
–––
SW requirements V3.0 SMR-3 and later –––
Subject Requirement or Condition
IP networking B channel allocation is not useful in IP networking because
it is not possible at this time to assign incoming calls to the
correct trunk group.
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-109
Features
3.4 Features for General External Traffic
3.4.1 Multi-Device Connection (Not for U.S.)
Definition
HiPath 3000 can be operated on an ISDN multi-device connection (S0 bus). This al-
lows parallel operation with other ISDN devices located on the same connection. You
can program a DID number up to 11 digits long (multiple subscriber number [MSN] of
the multi-device connection).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements STMD8 S0 trunks
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
ISDN terminals Any parallel-connected ISDN terminals must be given an
MSN to ensure unique call assignments.
Trunk groups with PP
and PMP
If you connect different basic access points (point-to-point
and point-to-multipoint) to the system, they must be en-
tered in different trunk groups.
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-110 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.4.2 Multi-Device Connection (for U.S. Only)
Definition
The HiPath 3000 systems support ISDN data and video devices using an Industry
standard ST interface. The ISDN terminal devices are connected to the system using
the ISDN adapter or a port on an S0 interface card:
STLS4 for the HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3550
STLS4R for the HiPath 3300 and HiPath 3500
STMD8 on the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
The ISDN devices are assigned a call number for internal dialing and an 11-digit Mul-
tiple Subscriber Number (MSN) for incoming DID applications.
Each ST port consists of two 64 Kbps channels. Two devices can be connected to the
ISDN adapter. Eight devices can be connected to an S0 port on an interface card. The
devices connected on an S0 port share the 128 Kbps bandwidth for video and data
calls.
Basic Rate Interface (BRI) Operation
In a BRI environment, each CO B channel is assigned a Special Profile Identifier
(SPID) number and a Terminal Identifier (TID) for identification purposes from the
Public Network. The SPID and TID received from the network provider must be asso-
ciated with the call number assigned to the data or video equipment connected to the
ST interface. If a system is equipped with three BRI trunks, the maximum number of
ISDN data sessions is either three 128 Kbps sessions or six 64 Kbps sessions. Typ-
ically CACH (Call Appearance Call Handling) values or Phantom Directory numbers
are required for Voice terminals only. In some COs, CACH values or Phantom Direc-
tory numbers can be required for the ST data devices as well.
Due to the complexity of BRI configuration, it is recommended that ST applications
be limited to 128 Kbps. The call number for each ST port must be associated with a
Public Network SPID. This means that the number of 64-Kbps channels that can be
called up is limited to the number of Public Network SPIDs.
Refer to the Configuration Note for
S
0
Device Installation
.
Usually the ST device is connected to an ISDN NT-1 adapter and the SPID-TID num-
bers assigned by the CO are programmed in the device. However, since the ST de-
vice is located behind the switch on an ST bus, the HiPath 3000 provide SPID-TID
The STLS4 module is used also as a trunk interface in Europe. For subscriber ap-
plications, the receive and transmit leads must be reversed before connecting to the
first device on the bus. This crossover is already performed in the ISDN adapter.
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-111
Features
identification control. Each ST channel used by the ST device requires a Call Number
for internal dialing. An MSN number also is required to enable the ST device to com-
municate with the HiPath 3000 system.
The protocol should always be set to ATT NI-1 in the ST device. The HiPath 3000 per-
form all protocol conversions.
Primary Rate Interface (PRI) Operation
In a PRI or CorNet-N environment, SPIDs, TIDs and CACH values are not required.
Internal SPID/TID entries called Multiple Subscribers Numbers (MSN) are used by
the ST devices for call setup. DID numbers must be assigned to each channel that
connects to an ST device.
The DID numbers can be assigned from the numbers received from the CO. The DID
number can be from 1 to 11 digits. The DID numbers are required to set up incoming
calls to the device.
Assign a call number to each
No-Port
station port used for the ST device. The call
number can be from 1 to 6 digits. The call number does not need match the DID num-
ber.
An MSN number must be assigned to the ST device for each B-Channel required for
the application. The MSN numbers act as SPIDs for the ST device. The MSN number
can be from 7 to 14 digits. If the entry is 9 to 14 digits, the last 2 digits are used as the
TID number. The last 2 digits should be 00 for B channel 1, and they should be 01 for
B channel 2 on each ST interface used.
It is suggested that the MSN number consists of the DID number, followed by 5 zeros,
followed by a 2-digit TID number.
Related Topic
Section 3.16.10, Multiple Subscriber Number, on page 3-401
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements S0 board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-112 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements/Conditions
Subject Requirement/Condition
ISDN terminals Any parallel-connected ISDN terminals must be given an
MSN to ensure call assignments.
Trunk groups with PP
and PMR
If you connect different basic access points (point-to-point
and point-to-multipoint) to the system, they must be en-
tered in different trunk groups.
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-113
Features
3.4.3 Trunk Groups
Definition
The external trunks in the system can be combined into trunk groups by B channels.
The order in which the trunk groups are seized can be linear (always the first free
trunk) or circular (after the last trunk seized in the outgoing direction). An overflow
trunk group can be configured for each of the trunk groups. If all the trunks in a trunk
group are busy during a seizure attempt, the search for trunks continues in the over-
flow trunk group. The search is performed in the specified overflow trunk group only.
If all the trunks are busy in this trunk group as well, no additional overflow attempts
are made.
It is common practice to seize outgoing trunks starting with the highest numbered
trunk, whereas incoming trunks will seize the lowest numbered trunks first. In the
case of Key Systems, this reduces the risk of glare, or collision on loop start trunks.
A trunk group key can be assigned for these trunk groups. The key is for outgoing
calls only. A maximum of 10
Trunk group
keys can be configured on one station.
Trunk
group
keys can appear on more than one optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone. These
keys can only be installed on display telephones.
Calls placed on
Trunk group
Keys are subject to COS toll restriction levels and rules.
The system can monitor the line for the presence of dial tone. If not present, the sys-
tem releases the trunk, and an error message is generated and recorded. The display
user is presented with the text
Not possible
and reselect the
Trunk group
key to seize
another trunk.
It is possible to turn off the detection and set fixed delay; contact your second-level
Service group if this is recommended.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-114 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Trunk groups 16 trunk
groups
with up to
72 B chan-
nels per
trunk
group
16 trunk
groups, 64
B chan-
nels
8 trunk
groups
with max.
all B chan-
nels per
trunk
group
4 trunk groups with
max. all B channels
per trunk group
No. of trunk group
keys on optiset E or
optiPoint 500
66644
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog trunks You must physically disconnect analog trunks from the
trunk group.
optiset E or optiPoint
500, trunk group key
You can program up to 6 or 4 trunk group keys on an op-
tiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone. If all trunks in a trunk
group are busy, its trunk group key lights up.
Overflow If a trunk group is busy and overflow for this trunk group is
entered in the system, the system continues searching in
the overflow trunk group. If all trunks in this trunk group are
also busy, no second overflow operation is performed.
Prime Line on (auto-
matic line seizure)
With prime line, trunks can be programmed in other trunk
groups. You cannot define an overflow from trunk group 1
to another trunk group.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-115
Features
3.4.4 Trunk Keys
Definition
On optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones, users can program trunk keys by B channel.
This enables them to answer a call or seize a trunk by pressing the trunk key. The
LED signals the trunk status.
Users can use the trunk keys for the following features:
Call pickup
Retrieve trunk on exclusive hold
Retrieve trunk on common hold
Answer calls
Toggle between several different trunks
A
Tr u n k
key is used for receiving incoming trunk calls and placing outgoing calls on
the selected trunks. A
Trunk
key represents an analog CO trunk appearance, a BRI
link appearance, a T1 DS0 channel, or an analog E&M Tie line channel.
A
Tr u n k
key can appear on more than one station. All stations with the appearance of
the
Tr u n k
key can also ring on an incoming call, if they are programmed in a Call
Group, otherwise they only have LED signalization.
A user can place a trunk appearance on Common Hold by pressing the
Hold
key and
going on-hook. The trunk appearance will flash slowly at all other appearances of the
Trunk
key.
Calls placed on
Tr u n k
keys are subject to COS toll restriction levels and rules.
LED Meaning
Off Trunk is free
Continuously lit Trunk is busy
Flickering Incoming call or recall
Flashing slowly Trunk is on hold
Flashing rapidly Call waiting mode; call is at own station
A Trunk key can not be programmed on the same station that is using Call Keys to
manage the trunk group associated with the trunk appearance.
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-116 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Tr u n k
keys can be used in a Centrex environment. The system can cut through im-
mediately to the Centrex CO to allow the user to hear if special tones, indicating Mes-
sage Waiting. In this case, Dial Tone Detection must be turned off because the special
CO tones are not recognized by the HiPath 3000 as dial tone.
Feature Interaction:
Call pickup: An incoming call ringing on a
Tr u n k
key can be picked from another
station via the feature Call Pickup - Group or via Call Pickup - Directed.
Retrieve trunk on exclusive hold: A
Tr u n k
key is placed on exclusive hold at
the station which put it on Hold by pressing another flashing
Tr u n k
key which re-
sults in a Toggle operation. To retrieve the held trunk, the user needs only to
press the flashing key.
Retrieve trunk on common hold: Another user with the appearance of the
same
Tr u n k
key, can retrieve a trunk call on Common Hold (Appearance flashing
slowly) by pressing the flashing key.
Answer calls: Any user with the appearance of the trunk can answer an incom-
ing call on the
Tr u n k
key by pressing the flickering
Tr u n k
key.
Toggle between several different trunks: If a user has an appearance of sev-
eral
Tr u n k
keys on his or her telephone, the user can toggle between any of the
trunks by pressing the desired
Tr u n k
key. The first trunk is placed on Consultation
Hold at the station. Any subsequent depression of another Trunk key places the
last call on Consultation Hold at that telephone. If the user goes on-hook at any
point, the last held party is immediately recalled per the Consultation Hold pro-
cedure.
Call Forwarding: An incoming call appearing on a
Tr u n k
key can be forwarded
by the station to another destination. If the forward destination does not have an
appearance of the trunk, the user can handle the call via the dialog keys as a nor-
mal incoming call. If the forward station answers the call, the LED on all appear-
ances of the
Tr u n k
key will be steadily lit.
If the station has forwarded the external calls to a voice mail system, the original
destinations station number is forwarded to the voice mail system.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E telephone
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-117
Features
3.4.5 Call Keys
Definition
Users can program up to 10 call keys (together with multiple subscriber numbers out-
side of the U.S. and MUSAP keys in the U.S.) on an optiset E or optiPoint 500 tele-
phone. These keys are used for incoming and outgoing calls. The call keys are as-
signed to trunks virtually; that is, the trunks are not permanently assigned to a specific
key (like trunk group keys). When performing an outgoing external seizure, users
press a call key to seize a trunk group. When users connect without a call key, an
available call key is automatically seized, depending on the trunk group. With incom-
ing calls, an available call key corresponding to the trunk group is also assigned.
The call keys should be viewed as temporary trunk keys that allow quick access to
the following features:
Answering and signaling calls and recalls
Toggle
Cancel consultation hold
Pickup
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital telephone
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of call keys
per optiset E or opti-
Point 500 telephone
10 10 10 10 10
Subject Requirement or Condition
Trunk groups, busy
state
The busy state is not displayed for the entire trunk group.
Unscreened transfer,
recall
The call key is reassigned if the internal destination is not
reached following unscreened transfer and a recall occurs.
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-118 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.4.6 Transit Traffic
Definition
Transit traffic refers to external voice calls that are handled by the telephone system
in the incoming and outgoing directions. External connections can be set up to either
the central office or to a networked system.
It is possible to handle transit traffic both manually and automatically over digital
trunks and analog lines with a backward release criterion. Transit traffic can also be
processed on analog trunks without a backward release criterion (loop start) by using
timeout control followed by automatic release (maximum time is 42 minutes). Transit
traffic is needed in the following situations:
Networked systems
Trunk-to-trunk connections (including DISA)
Transition from a private network to the public network and vice versa
Transit traffic is used in conjunction with the following features:
Call forwarding
Tr an s fe r
Callback (CorNet-N and QSig networks; if supported on the trunk side, transit
traffic can be used externally as well)
Message waiting for central voice mail servers in CorNet-N and QSig (not for
U.S.) networks.
Definition of Features Associated with Transit Traffic
Call forwarding: A trunk-to-trunk connection is possible using Call Forwarding -
No Answer (only with a pseudo port) or Call Forwarding (CF) to an external des-
tination. Care should be taken concerning the release capability of the trunks.
Using LCR, an incoming call can also be forwarded (CF or CNA) to a CorNet-N
link to a station in the remote node, to the Attendant in the remote node, to a voice
mail system in the remote node, or rerouted to an external destination by the re-
mote node. When calls from a HiPath 3000 are routed through a CorNet-N link
to internal and external destinations, the CorNet-N channels must be split be-
tween these functions. In the case of a transfer to a remote voice mail system,
the HiPath 3000 sends the originally called destinations station number to the
voice mail to activate the proper answer message.
External access from a remote node is not possible over HiPath 3550 or HiPath
3500 BRI trunks. Such calls are intercepted to the HiPath 3550 or HiPath 3500 in-
tercept position.
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-119
Features
Transfer: It is possible for the user to transfer calls (screened and un-screened)
to an external destination or to a remote node, via a CorNet-N link.
The transfer can also be initiated by a voice mail call processing feature or by an
IVR which automatically transfers, unscreened, a call to an external or CorNet-N
destination.
Callback: If Callback was activated by the user to a CorNet-N user in a remote
node (a closed numbering scheme is required to activate this feature), the Call-
back will be activated the same as an internal Callback activation. (This feature
is not available with connections to a ROLM 9005.)
Message waiting for central voice mail servers in CorNet-N networks: Mes-
sage Waiting notification is possible from a remote voice mail system connected
via CorNet-N links. In the case of PhoneMail, the SW version must be 6.3 or high-
er.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Always refer to the latest CorNet-N Configuration Note or the CorNet-N Sales Posi-
tioning Guide for the latest information.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0/S2M board TLA board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Loop-start trunks
(loop-start/ground-
start in U.S)
Loop-start trunks are automatically released after a pro-
grammable period (default: 310 seconds. A tone sounds
10 seconds before release). The time parameters only can
be changed by using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Features for General External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-120 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.4.7 Translate Station Numbers to Names for System Speed Dialing
Definition
With system speed-dialing calls, the name of the destination programmed in the sys-
tem speed-dialing facility is displayed after outgoing dialing instead of the speed-dial-
ing number. If the station number of an incoming call corresponds to a station number
in system speed dialing, the name of the caller appears on the display.
This feature only applies to systems with ISDN trunk connections or with Analog Call-
er ID on the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300.
The HiPath 3000 filters out the access code in the System Speed Dial table; however,
the rest of the number must be an exact match to the incoming number for this feature
to function.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of speed-dial-
ing numbers
1000 1000 300 300 300
Features for General External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-121
Features
3.4.8 Message Waiting Indication (MWI) at the Trunk Interface (V3.0 and
later)
Definition
You can use this function only if the public exchange supports it.
You can activate and delete the Mailbox key.
This function supports sending (service menu or code) from the idle, ringing, busy,
and talk states and supports the receiving of messages.
On the receiver side, telephones with a display show the message Please call back.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements digital trunk connection
SW requirements V3.0 SMR-3 and later
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-122 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5 Features for Incoming External Traffic
3.5.1 Call Allocation
Definition
Within call management, two call allocation tables are provided for incoming calls on
analog or digital trunks. One of these tables is evaluated for day service and the other
for night service. These tables define the station to which a call should be forwarded.
This feature can also be used to assign a trunk to a specific station.
The Ringing Assignments screen in HiPath 3000 Manager E is used to determine
which stations (or groups) are assigned to each of the system trunks. Each port is
assigned a call number in the Stations/Groups: Line Assignments table. This call
number can be the internal call number of an active or an inactive station or group.
Different call numbers can be assigned for day and for night. The call number in this
table tells the system that when a call comes in through that port, it should be sig-
naled, not at this station, but according to the Call Destination List for this station.
Refer to Section 3.2.4, Call Management (CM) for details.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
DTMF DID An analog call may be released before call forwardingno
answer is completed. This is due to the permanent timers
that prevent trunks from becoming frozen.
Call allocation table A number of calls can be waiting simultaneously at the sta-
tions entered in the call allocation tables.
Intercept Calls are intercepted if they cannot be switched because
there are no available stations.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-123
Features
3.5.2 Group Ringing
Definition
Users can administer a personal list of internal station numbers that are also called
when their stations are signaled.
In this list, users can also enter their own station numbers. They might do this, for ex-
ample, if a station number is permanently routed to another station (executive/secre-
tary).
This feature is available to all types of telephones.
A feature button can be programmed on the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones to
activate/deactivate the feature. More than one
Group Ringing
button can be pro-
grammed on one telephone to allow for different variations. More than one button can
be activated at one time, however, the maximum number telephones to ring cannot
exceed five.
The
Forwarding
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway in Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) sta-
tus information. You can use the Call Forwarding screen to see if a station has a Ring
Group activated or if it is part of a Ring Group.
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection by its own station
user or for another user with the aid of the feature Associated Services.
Group Ringing can be invoked during a conversation by following the above proce-
dure using the
Program/Service
key.
If the feature is used frequently, the user can place the feature on a vacant button on
the telephone. The feature button name is
Ringing Group On
in the button menu.
When the feature is active, the LED is lit.
The station flag no group ringing on busy determines which stations in a call ringing
group receive a call when the primary telephone (the one activating the feature) is
busy, and which ones do not.
If the same station or smartset is in the ringing group of more than one master tele-
phone, the flag applies to all calls signaled at this station or smartset.
If the flag is not set, group ringing always takes place, provided that the station in the
call ringing group is available (default).
If the flag is set, group ringing depends on the availability of the primary telephone:
If the primary telephone is available, group ringing takes place immediately
If the primary telephone has activated call waiting, group ringing takes place after
a 5-second delay.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-124 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
If the primary telephone cannot receive a call, or if call waiting is inactive, call
ringing does not take place.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Recall
System search
Callback
Group ringing is not carried out with an immediate recall
(operator error), system search, or callback.
Call forwarding (CF) If the station that activated group ringing has also activated
call forwarding, group ringing is not carried out.
Do not disturb (DND) If the station in the call ringing group has activated DND,
group ringing is not carried out at that station.
Appointment An active timed reminder does not follow group ringing.
No group ringing when
busy
If the flag is set, no group ringing will take place if the sta-
tion is busy.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-125
Features
3.5.3 Night Answer
Definition
Night answer forwards all calls that reach the attendant console to a predefined des-
tination. Users can define either an individual station or a group as a destination. Us-
ers can also use a central bell in conjunction with night answer to alert any personnel
(night shift) to night calls.
HiPath 3000 distinguishes between day service, fixed night answer, and variable night
answer.
In the case of day service and fixed night answer, incoming external calls follow the
tables and call destination lists entered in CM for day service and night answer, re-
gardless of the station type.
With variable night answer to a voice station, calls follow the call destination lists for
fixed night answer and are then intercepted by the variable night station. All other call
destinations for fixed night answer are considered to be invalid and are replaced by
the variable night station. As a result, the system behaves in every respect in the
same way as it would for call forwarding to a night destination.
A list for night answer controls external DID calls. This method is also known as
as-
signed night answer because it enables users to assign different night destinations to
individual lines.
Night Service
The Night Service function defines how calls are handled when the system is placed
in night service mode.
The maximum number of stations that can be authorized to place the system into
night service is five. The list can be changed via HiPath 3000 Manager E (
Authorized
Station for Night Service
list).
An Intercept station can also be defined for Night Service. This station does not need
to be the same station called during Night Service. This intercept position can be an
individual station or a group. Separate intercept positions can be entered for day calls
and for night calls. The Night Intercept position will intercept the same type of calls as
the Day Intercept position. The Day Intercept position can be programmed to inter-
cept any or all of the following types of calls:
no answer
busy
wrong number
incomplete
recall
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-126 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
System Administration assigns which trunks ring into which station (See Call Man-
agement) in Day mode and in Night mode. When the system is switched to night ser-
vice, the system checks against the
Call Allocation - Night
list in Assistant T (
Ringing
Line Assignments
list in HiPath 3000 Manager E) to see where to send the incoming
call. The destinations can be either an individual station or a group.
Users can also use a central bell in conjunction with Night answer to alert any per-
sonnel (night shift) to night calls. In Call Management, an additional station can be
called by means of the
Additional call number
entry shown as
Second Target
in
Call
Destination Lists
in HiPath 3000 Manager E. This entry supports the
common ringer
function. An actuator (relay) or an additional extension at which a call is also to be
signaled is entered here. The last field
Ty p e
defines when ringing assignment takes
place (immediate or after CF timeout).
The night bell (instead of a telephone) may be physically connected to the station in-
terface, in which case, the night bell can be answered by dialing the station number
or by call Pick up, if so configured.
A Night answer station can be any type of telephone, providing their COS allows, at
minimum, for incoming calls.
When in Night mode, all stations use the Night COS table. The table, similar to the
Day COS table, also has 15 classes to choose from. (Refer to Section 3.6.10, Con-
figurable Toll Restriction for details).
A variable night station (universal night answer position) can be specified. The vari-
able night station can be configured by any of the stations authorized to place the sys-
tem in Night Service mode.
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection by the station user.
If the feature is used frequently, the user can place the feature on a vacant button on
the telephone. The feature button name is
Night answer on
in the button menu. During
programming of the button, it can be configured to activate the default destination(s)
or a variable destination. The variable destination can still be overwritten by the ac-
cess code. In either case, the LED on the key remains lit.
An external night bell adapter may be required to prevent excessive current from
damaging the station interface.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-127
Features
Night Service Security
To prevent unauthorized deactivation of Night Service (returning the system to its nor-
mal day COS toll Restriction scheme), the authorized user can activate Individual
Telephone Lock at the telephone.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
If there are several authorized stations, they must all activate Telephone Lock to en-
sure security.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding Calls follow call forwarding if activated on the night station.
Night station An intercom only phone cannot be entered as a night sta-
tion.
Lines Variable night answer makes no distinction between the in-
dividual trunks; that is, calls on all trunks reach the night
station.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-128 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.4 Direct Inward Dialing
Definition
With direct inward dialing (DID), an incoming call can reach a station without interven-
tion by the attendant console.
This feature is handled in call management. The internal and external numbering sys-
tems are defined in the numbering plan.
Public Networks require that DID calls to a station that is out of service, or is otherwise
unreachable (for example, do not disturb) must be intercepted to a station, an answer-
ing position, or to an announcement device. It is therefore necessary to program in-
tercept destinations for DID stations.
In HiPath 3000 Manager E and Assistant T, the DID number corresponding to an in-
ternal call number can up to 11 digits in length.
For an incoming call on an ISDN PRI line, the PBX number is blanked out to the left
of the incoming call number. The remaining portion of the call number is interpreted
by the system as a DID number.
DID calls can appear on
MUSAP
keys. Refer to Section 3.5.5, Selective Seizure of a
DID Number Using a MUSAP Key.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Outside of U.S.: S0 trunk board
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Entrance telephone,
MOH, room monitor,
speaker telephone
type
These stations cannot be reached from the outside by di-
rect inward dialing.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-129
Features
3.5.5 Selective Seizure of a DID Number Using a MUSAP Key
Definition
For users to seize one of the system DID numbers for outgoing calls, they must either
use a procedure or configure a multiple station appearance (MUSAP) key. This key is
assigned a DID number in the system. However, pressing this key is not sufficient for
seizure. The trunk group, trunk, or Prime Line must be suffix-dialed for seizure to oc-
cur.
For incoming calls, the MUSAP key functions as a call key. The LED is activated in
the same way as for trunk keys, call keys, or DSS keys, depending on the status of
the trunk key to which it is connected. Features such as toggle and consultation hold
are possible.
For outgoing calls, the MUSAP key functions as a call key after the external seizure
is completed.
A MUSAP key is used as a target location for incoming DID calls from the public net-
work. The key can also be used as a target for incoming calls from a CorNet-N loca-
tion. If the station is assigned a MUSAP key, the DID number associated with the key
is sent to the ISDN Public Network on BRI and PRI outgoing calls.
Up to 10 MUSAP keys can be programmed on the same station to support rollover
buttons for additional calls to the same DID number. A maximum of 10 MUSAP and/
or Call Keys can be programmed on an optiset E and optiPoint 500.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of MUSAP
keys per telephone
10 10 10 10 10
Subject Requirement or Condition
MUSAP MUSAP keys do not seize trunk groups directly. After you
press the key, you must dial the trunk group separately.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-130 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.6 Signaling of Direct Inward Dialing Numbers for Incoming Calls
Definition
When an internal station receives an external call, the direct inward dialing (DID)
number that the caller originally dialed is displayed. A variety of acoustic signaling
methods are also available to signal the call. The LED assigned to the appropriate
MUSAP key (see Section 3.5.5) also signals the call.
Three different types of acoustic signaling are possible depending on the telephone.
Refer to Section 3.2.2.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E station or analog station
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Signaling Not for S0 stations (not for U.S.).
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-131
Features
3.5.7 Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
Definition
Direct inward system access (DISA) enables users to use features in the HiPath 3000
system via an external connection. External callers must enter a password to gain ac-
cess to the system. They can then use certain system features just like an internal
user. They can also set up an outgoing external seizure via the incoming external
connection.
Users can use the following features via DISA:
Direct services for internal stations:
Send message texts, relay on/off, night answer on/off, advisory message on/off,
group ringing on/off, telephone lock on/off, do not disturb on/off, call forwarding
on/off, leave/join hunt group, reset services.
Associated services:
Advisory message on/off, group ringing on/off, telephone lock on/off, do not dis-
turb on/off, call forwarding on/off, leave/join hunt group, reset services.
An internal station can also be reached via DISA. In the case of a fixed numbering
plan (such as in France), virtual networking is also possible.
The DISA access line can be configured as dedicated, or it can be accessed during
day or night operation; these parameters are set in the General Flags of
Lines/Net-
working/Parameters
tabs in HiPath 3000 Manager E; in the
DISA day/night
field, code
receiver (CR) parameters can be configured for each line.
One of the following options may be selected:
Line always has CR connected
Line has CR connected during day only
Line has CR connected during night only
Line has no CR connection
The DISA trunk is released at the completion of each function/feature. The user must
reenter the system if another function needs to be accomplished.
The stations authorized to access the system via DISA must first be configured in
System Administration.
A DISA trunk can be a DID number or a LS/GS trunk. If the DISA trunk is a DID num-
ber, this number is programmed in
System parameters
. The field allows up to 12 dig-
its. If the trunk is LS/GS, the trunk is programmed in the Ringing Assignments.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-132 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
A password is required to log onto the system. This password consists of the internal
station call number and the Telephone Code lock PIN. Entry of the password is only
acknowledged after a timeout or entry of the end symbol #. This selection is system-
wide and is done in the System Parameters.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog trunk
Night answer
Analog trunks can be programmed for DISA access. They
can be used as normal analog trunks during the day and
then switched over to DISA mode when the night answer
function is activated.
Call data output DISA calls are specially marked in call data output.
System speed dialing The system speed-dialing memory can be used via DISA.
Trunk The trunk is released each time you activate the service.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-133
Features
3.5.8 Intercept Conditions
Definition
Intercept forwards incoming calls to another destination. A call is intercepted if the
original destination is invalid or if limitations exist.
Users can specify the following as intercept destinations:
PC AC
Station
Hunt group
Announcement (external announcement device)
If an intercept position or AC is configured in the system, calls are routed to this inter-
cept position during an intercept. If an intercept position has not been configured, in-
tercepted calls are signaled at the station that has a call assignment for the intercept-
ed trunk.
During intercepts, call management is entered using the intercept station as the ba-
sis. If the intercept position cannot be reached, the call is signaled at a night bell, if
entered, or the call waits in a queue at the intercept position.
Users can activate the intercept feature under the following conditions:
Intercept no answer
If there is no answer, the call follows the entries in call management. If the end of
the CM elements is reached, the system determines whether or not an intercept
after timeout should occur. If the system cannot find a station to which it can route
the call, the call is intercepted.
Intercept busy, if no additional forwarding is possible.
If a station is busy, the system determines whether or not call waiting is possible.
If call waiting is not possible (signaling security or intercept criterion), the call fol-
lows the entries in call management. If the call cannot be signaled at any station,
the system determines whether the call should be intercepted or released.
In general, intercept busy only applies to the first call, not to switched or outgoing
connections. A recall of an external station is not immediately intercepted when
the destination station is busy; instead, call waiting is activated.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-134 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Intercept if incomplete or invalid number dialed
When an incorrect station number was dialed, the system determines whether
the call should be intercepted or released. Calls are always intercepted with
pseudo-DID.
Intercept if no number dialed
If no station number is dialed within a timeout, the system determines whether
the call should be intercepted or released. If an intercept position has not been
configured, the interception follows the call assignment per trunk.
Intercept with Serial FWD
It is not possible to chain calls for forwarding; an attempt to initiate this procedure
is rejected on activation. For example, if a station has activated external call for-
warding and the call destination has also forwarded its calls, you have a chained
calls situation. This is not allowed by the system. If this flag is turned on, these
calls are intercepted.
Codelock Diversion
If the telephone lock for a station is active, and a trunk group code is dialed from
that station, the call is immediately forwarded to the intercept destination. The
Codelock Diversion function is set individually for each station through the
Flags
screen in the
Set up Station
Parameters.
One intercept position can be configured for Day operation. During Night Service, the
same destination or a different destination can be configured as the intercept posi-
tion.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-135
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Hunt group Intercepts cannot extend beyond a hunt group; the call is
forwarded to the first hunt group station and always re-
mains in the hunt group.
Release Calls with the service ID
data service
(ISDN message) are
released, not intercepted.
Incomplete dialing Not evaluated in the case of a central intercept position.
Tenant service When a tenant service is configured, users can only con-
figure intercepts on a cross-system basis. This means that
intercept no answer (for example) applies to all system us-
ers.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-136 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.9 Dual-Tone Multifrequency Direct Inward Dialing
Definition
This feature enables users to use direct inward dialing (DID) on non-DID trunks such
as analog trunks. This type of pseudo-DID is achieved by suffix-dialing dual-tone mul-
tifrequency (DTMF) digits.
External calls that reach the system via this feature are released after a timeout if they
are not answered. This prevents analog trunks from freezing up. The timer R
elease
if no dialing
is activated when the trunk answers. Default time is 10 seconds.
An announcement lets callers know that they can use DID. A customized announce-
ment is available in the system. This feature requires an external announcement de-
vice.
Operating
The user calls the trunk number flagged as
DTMF DID
. The system answers. No tone
is presented to the user. The user dials the station number and is connected. If the
call is not answered within 60 seconds (not variable) the trunk is automatically re-
leased.
If a recorded announcement has been configured for callers, the caller can be pre-
sented with an audio message and can start dialing. During the announcement a
Code Receiver is on line to detect dialing.
The announcement device is connected to an analog port and must be able to
present an open loop to the system at the end of the message.
Refer also to Section 3.5.10, Announcement Before Answering.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-137
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Analog trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
DTMF DID If the incoming call is not answered within 60 seconds, the
trunk is released.
Intercept The trunk is released 30 seconds after the call is intercept-
ed.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-138 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.10 Announcement Before Answering
Definition
This feature plays an announcement for external callers from an optional external an-
nouncement device. This applies to both analog and digital trunks.
The announcement can be played either parallel to ringing or only if the call is placed
in the announcement device queue. The announcement begins after a programmable
period and can be heard by several callers simultaneously.
Users can configure an announcement before answering to relieve an intercept sta-
tion. For this purpose, users connect an announcement device, which is capable of
answering an incoming call and forwarding it to a specific station. This feature is con-
figured with call management.
Users must configure the subscriber ports that connect to announcement devices as
answering machines. If the announcement device is connected to an analog port and
it must be able to present an open loop to the system at the end of the message.
The UCD feature can also be used to start the announcement only after a program-
mable period. The announcement can be heard by several callers simultaneously.
The feature can be used to present callers with a company message before being an-
swered, for example, by the Attendant or by a group.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements TIEL or
anlaog
port
Analog port
SW requirements V1.0 or later
No. of callers who can
hear an announce-
ment simultaneously
30 30 30 30 30
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-139
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Group/station If the announcement port is entered as a call forwarding
no answer destination, the appropriate announcement is
played if the group or station is busy. The call is then for-
warded to the next station or the programmed intercept cri-
teria apply.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-140 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.11 Collect Call Barring per Trunk (for Brazil Only)
Definition
This feature provides for automatic release of incoming collect calls; users can con-
figure it individually for each analog trunk (loop start). If this feature is enabled for a
trunk, the system opens the loop for 2 s (default value) one second (default value) af-
ter an incoming call is accepted. This ensures that collect calls are released in the
network, while other calls continue unaffected.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx–––
HW requirements Analog
trunk
(loop
start)
Analog
trunk
(loop
start)
–––
SW requirements V1.0
or later
V1.0
or later
–––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Collect call barring per
trunk
Only available in Brazil. This setting is ignored in all other
countries.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-141
Features
3.5.12 Collect Call Barring per Station
Definition
This features allows automatic release of incoming collect calls. Users can configure
it separately for each station, even in combination with functions such as call forward-
ing, call pickup, or intercept.
Users can also program collect call barring system-wide. This applies if a caller dials
a hunt group instead of an individual station or misdials a number.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
HW requirements TMAMF TMAMF
(HiPath
3550 only)
–––
SW requirements V1.0 or
later
V1.2 or
later
–––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Collect call barring per
trunk
Neither the system-wide parameters for collect call barring
nor the setting made for the stations affect trunk calls (an-
alog trunks).
Collect call barring per
trunk
Only for MFC R2 countries that offer this feature.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-142 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.13 Analog Direct Inward Dialing via MFC-R2
Definition
An MFC-R2 trunk is an analog trunk interface for direct inward dialing that allows ex-
ternal callers to reach extensions directly without the assistance of an attendant.
The system supports MFC-R2 (SMFC) as the default setting, MFC-R2 with caller ID,
tone dialing, and dial pulsing. It is not possible to use tone dialing and MFC-R2 (with
or without caller ID) simultaneously.
To implement the CLIP feature (see Section 3.14.6) for incoming calls, you can enter
the calling party number when MCF-R2 (SMFC) is active. When receiving calls for
which the trunk supplies this information, the calling partys number appears on the
screen of the called partys telephone.
This feature must be configured for each trunk (signaling method parameter set to
MFC-R2 with caller ID).
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx–––
HW requirements TMAMF TMAMF
(HiPath
3550 only)
–––
SW requirements V1.0 or
later
V1.2 or
later
–––
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-143
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog direct inward
dialing with MFC-R2
Available in Brazil, India, Malaysia, Singapore and ATEA
countries only. The setting is ignored in all other countries.
The ATEA countries listed below require country initializa-
tion with the international country code = 21. In addition,
parameter PAR_05 (System status - System-wide -
Boards: MFC/R2 table) must be set in HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E expert mode.
Egypt = 05h (default)
Nigeria = 06h
Oman = 07h
Saudi Arabia = 08h
Syria = 09h
Tunesia = 0Ah
United Arab Emirates = 0Bh
Caller ID Displayed exactly as received from the trunk. The system
does not add any digits (such as trunk access codes or dis-
criminating digits) or remove any digits (such as the local
area code supplied by the central office). Likewise, the dis-
played station number cannot be redialed directly and
does not appear in the caller list.
Caller ID Not available in Singapore.
Features for Incoming External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-144 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.5.14 Centralized Attendant Service CAS (for U.S. only)
Definition
This feature allows for the conservation of T1 TIE line trunks when the attendant at a
center PBX system answers a call that originated at the store PBX (branch) and whos
destination extension is also at the store PBX. Without the CAS feature, this type of
scenario would force the system to use 2 T1 channels for every call that was trans-
ferred back to the branch. CAS will conserve the T1 channels by releasing the T1
channel after the call is transferred so that no T1 channels are in use for the duration
of the call after transfer.
The typical CAS application for a Federated store consists of the CAS store PBX
(branch), the CAS center PBX (center) and a minimum of two tie lines that function
as release link trunks RLT.
The typical RLT is a channel on a T1 card in the branch PBX that is mapped in a pri-
vate network to a CAS center to be answered by a pool of operators.
A typical store (branch PBX) would have a T1 card with the first 8-12 channels
mapped as tie trunks to one hub to carry standard tie line traffic. 2 or more of the re-
maining channels on the same T1 card are mapped as RLTs.
Example for an incoming call: A customer calls the branch PBX on the main DID num-
ber. The branch PBX then routes this DID call to a RLT. The RLT carries the call to the
CAS center and the CAS operator answers the call. The operator finds out what our
customer is calling for and then transfers the call to the appropriate extension in the
branch PBX.
If all RLTs are busy then the call will que. The caller will hear a recording all operators
are busy please hold. When a RLT becomes idle then the queued call hits the RLT.
The transfer process consists of:
1. The CAS center operator hits the CAS flash key after have talked to the cus-
tomer and found out which extension number to transfer the call to.
2. The CAS center PBX transmits a hook switch flash over the RLT.
3. The branch PBX recognizes the hook switch flash and puts the DID trunk on
hold and gives dial tone back to the CAS operator.
4. The CAS center operator dials the destination extension number.
5. The branch PBX receives the extension number and starts to ring the phone.
6. At this point the CAS center operator can
stay on the call and wait for answer and do a supervised transfer, or
release the call and let the transfer finish as unsupervised transfer.
7. When the CAS operator releases the call the RLT drops, the branch PBX finishs
the transfer.
Features for Incoming External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-145
Features
8. The DID trunk is directly connected to the destination extension.
9. The RLT is idle and ready for the next call.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
HW requirements TMST1 TST1
SW requirements V1.0 V1.0 ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
CAS store PBX
(branch)
HiPath 3000 supports the CAS store PBX (branch) of the
application.
CAS center PBX (cen-
ter)
Support for the CAS center PBX (center) of the application
is supplied by another type of PABX (e. g. Rolm 9005 or a
Lucent switch) that supports the center where the atten-
dants are located in the application.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-146 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6 Features for Outgoing External Traffic
3.6.1 Last Number Redial (LNR)
Definition
Each time users place an outgoing call, the dialed number is stored. On optiset E or
optiPoint 500 telephones with displays, the system stores the last three numbers di-
aled.
To retrieve a specific number and use it to set up another call, press the Redial key.
Press the key once to dial the last number dialed.
Press the key twice to dial the next-to-the-last number dialed.
Press the key three times to dial the number that was stored the longest.
On optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones without displays, the system stores only the
last number dialed.
For V1.2 and later, the system also uses the last number redial memory to store ac-
count codes ACCT that were entered. This is true only if the appropriate system-wide
flags are set.
Last Number Redial
This feature applies only to non-display optiset E or optiPoint 500 models; however, it
uses the same feature key (Redial) as the
Expanded Redial
feature for display tele-
phones.
Only external calls are saved. Every new outgoing call overwrites the previous num-
ber stored. This is also true if System or Station speed dial is used. When using LCR
access, only the number dialed by the station is stored in the LNR memory.
A call to a user in a networked system over a CorNet-N link is stored in LNR memory;
likewise, an external call routed via CorNet-N to a trunk in another node, is also
stored.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
Each time users place and dial an external destination, the number is stored. If the
destination was busy or not reachable, users can press the redial key to redial the
same number.
This feature can only be invoked from the
Redial
key. No feature access code is pos-
sible.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-147
Features
Expanded Redial
This feature applies only to display optiset E or optiPoint 500; however, it uses the
same feature key (Redial) as the
Last Number Redial
feature for non-display tele-
phones.
The system stores the last three external calls dialed by a display telephone. The ex-
panded redial memory operates in a first-in-first-out (FIFO) manner; that is, the fourth
external call number placed from that telephone is placed at the top of the redial table,
and the oldest call is removed from memory, and so on.
Only external calls are saved. This is also true if System or Station speed dial is used.
A call to a user in a networked system over a CorNet-N link is stored; likewise, an ex-
ternal call routed via CorNet-N to a trunk in another node is also stored.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
Any post-dialed digits beyond the initial destination, (for example, digits sent to a con-
nected voice mail system) are not stored in expanded redial memory. In the case of
a call routed through LCR, only the number dialed by the station is stored.
This feature can only be invoked from the
Redial
key. No feature access code is pos-
sible.
To reach the last number dialed, the user presses the
Redial
key once, and after a
brief delay the number is dialed. Alternatively, the user can view the last three entries
by pressing the
Redial
key successively and selecting the number to be redialed.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements UP0/E telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max length of stored
number
25 digits+code
Maximum number of
entries
33333
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-148 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
LNR DTMF signals are not considered dialing information and
are not stored. This does not apply to mobile telephones,
which store DTMF signals in the internal redial memory.
LNR After CO through-connect to the initial destination, further
post-dialed digits are not stored.
System speed dialing Speed-dialing numbers overwrite redial memory.
Telephone lock You cannot use redial if the telephone lock is active.
Internal calls Internal calls have no effect on the redial memory.
Telephones without
displays
Only the last number dialed can be stored.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-149
Features
3.6.2 System Speed Dialing
Definition
Users can store frequently dialed station numbers in system memory. For conve-
nience, the system uses a short code to represent each station number so that the
user does not need to dial the complete number.
Speed-dialing numbers are predefined in the system. Users can dial the codes from
any subscriber station that is assigned to a speed-dialing group.
Use the redial key or the pound (#) key to program a dial pause and DTMF
changeover.
Only external calls can be stored.
A name can be associated with each destination.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
System Speed Dial overrides the COS Toll Restriction rules.
System Speed Dial feature is system-wide and cannot be split, for example in the
case of Tenant Service.
The default access code is
*7
followed by the index number. The abbreviated
speed dial numbers are therefore:
A feature button can be programmed on an optiset E and optiPoint 500. The but-
ton simulates the dialing of the access code (*7). The user is then prompted (dis-
play) to enter the index number.
System model Abbreviated number
HiPath 3350 *7 000 to *7 299
HiPath 3550 *7 000 to *7 999
HiPath 3750 *7 000 to *7 999
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-150 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Speed-dialing entries
in the system
1000 1000 300 300 300
Max. length of speed-
dialing entries
25 digits
+
6 digit
trunk ac-
cess code
25 digits 25 digits 25 digits 25 digits
Max. no. of charact-
ters per name
16 16 16 16 16
Subject Requirement or Condition
External station num-
bers
Speed-dialing destinations can contain external station
numbers only.
External station num-
bers
The external station number must include the trunk group
or seizure code.
Translation of station
numbers to names
You can assign a name to each speed-dialing destination.
Tenant service If a tenant service is implemented via toll restrictions, the
system does not check whether trunk seizures are autho-
rized. If speed dialing is used, the system automatically
seizes the next free trunk, regardless of whether or not the
user is authorized to seize this trunk. As a result, an incor-
rect system number may be displayed at the destination.
For this reason, users should only implement tenant ser-
vice via ITR groups.
Entrance telephone The entrance telephone cannot access speed-dialing
numbers.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-151
Features
Assistant T If using Assistant T, enter the speed dial number first, then
enter the corresponding name. Assistant T will not allow a
name to be entered for a specific index unless a number
has been previously entered. Names can only be entered
using the memory telephone or the HiPath 3000 Manager
E.
Disallowed digits Assistant T and HiPath 3000 Manager E both check the
first digit(s) of the speed-dial number you are programming
against the default or current digits used in your database
for external access codes. For example: entering the
speed dial number 71 510 555 1212, may be disallowed if
the digits 7 or 71 or 715 are not CO access codes.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-152 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.3 System Speed Dialing in Tenant Systems
Definition
This feature lets you select specific speed-dialing destinations, depending on the in-
ternal traffic restriction (ITR) groups. To do this, you can assign a range of speed-di-
aling numbers to internal traffic restriction groups using HiPath 3000 Manager E or
system administration.
When a user dials a speed-dialing number, the system identifies the ITR group for the
number, which determines whether the user is authorized to dial this number. If not,
an error message appears and the dialing attempt is rejected.
The speed-dialing number ranges can overlap in the ITR groups.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Speed-dialing entries
in system
1000 1000 300 300 300
Max. length of speed-
dialing entry
25 digits
+
6-digit
trunk ac-
cess code
25 digits 25 digits 25 digits 25 digits
Subject Requirement or Condition
External station num-
bers
Speed-dialing destinations can contain external station
numbers only.
External station num-
bers
The external station number must include the trunk group
or seizure code.
Translation of station
numbers to names
You can assign a name to each speed-dialing destination.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-153
Features
Tenant system If a tenant service is implemented using toll restrictions,
the system does not check whether trunk seizures are au-
thorized. If speed-dialing is used, the system automatically
seizes the next free trunk, regardless of whether or not the
user is authorized to seize this trunk. As a result, an incor-
rect system number may be displayed at the destination.
For this reason, users should implement tenant service
only via ITR groups.
Entrance telephone The entrance telephone cannot access speed-dialing
numbers.
ITR groups You cannot enter more than one speed-dialing number
range for the same ITR group.
ITR groups By default, all speed-dialing numbers are assigned to ITR
group 1.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-154 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.4 Station Speed Dialing in System
Definition
The user can create a separate speed-dialing list for frequently dialed numbers.
Users can enter external numbers in the system database. Access depends on the
stations dial-up access rights. Users must enter the trunk group code before the sta-
tion number.
There is only one list of maximum 10 numbers per telephone. The HiPath 3000 sys-
tems have a pool of dial entries which is shared with the feature
Repdial
. (HiPath
3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 = 2000 entries, HiPath 3350 and
HiPath 3300 = 300 entries). The system does NOT dedicate 10 Station speed dial en-
tries per telephone. Any unused entries remain in the entry pool and can be used by
other stations. It is therefore possible that a station user may not be able to program
an entry on the telephone even though not all entries in the list have been used. This
could indicate that the system pool of entries has been fully used up.
All types of telephones have access to this feature.
Station speed-dial numbers are stored in the system but must be entered by the indi-
vidual user from the telephone. System Administration cannot enter these numbers
for a user. Only external calls can be stored. A name can be associated with each
destination.
This feature cannot be invoked if Telephone Lock has been activated.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-155
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
station speed-dialing
entries per station
10 10 10 10 10
Maximum length of
station speed-dialing
entry
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
25
digits +
code
Maximum number of
speed-dialing entries
in the system
2000 2000 300 300 300
Subject Requirement or Condition
Telephones without
display
Following station number entry, telephones without a dis-
play must wait for the confirmation tone.
Analog telephones
(with DP),
S0 stations
Station speed dialing is not possible.
Internal station num-
bers, features
You cannot store internal station numbers and features in
the station speed-dialing list.
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephones
In the case of optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones, users
can store station speed dialing using codes or the tele-
phones programmable keys.
Repdial keys, station
speed-dialing memory
Station speed-dialing destinations can be assigned until
station speed-dialing memory in the system is exhausted.
Speed-dialing memory is used for both repdial keys and
station speed-dialing destinations.
Rotary dial analog
telephones
Station speed-dialing is not possible.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-156 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.5 Trunk Seizure Type and Prime Line On (Automatic Line Seizure)
Definition
The HiPath 3000 systems permit trunk seizure via the trunk keys or call keys on an
optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone.
Trunk seizure is also possible from any telephone using the trunk or trunk group
codes. To seize the second trunk using a trunk or call key, Prime Line must be active
and a second trunk group assigned.
Trunk seizure via trunk group code is not possible by entering the trunk group code
and pressing the trunk group key.
When the system receives a seizure request, it searches for an available trunk in the
trunk group. If a trunk is available, it is seized.
Prime Line
The
Prime Line
feature is a system-wide feature that allows users to dial directly to
external destinations without the use of
Tr u n k
or
Trunk Group
keys. The external ac-
cess code is automatically dialed by the system. Only one outgoing Trunk Group is
possible with this arrangement. To dial internal stations, the user must first press the
Internal
key and dial the station number.
When this feature is NOT active in the system, the reverse operation is true; that is,
internal stations can be dialed directly, while outside connections require a
Tr u n k
,
Trunk Group
key or an access code.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Trunks You must use system administration to cancel nonexistent
or physically disconnected trunks.
COS changeover If you activate a telephone lock, you cannot seize a trunk.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-157
Features
Entrance telephone You cannot seize a trunk from an entrance telephone.
Hold/park An undialed or partially dialed trunk cannot be parked or
placed on hold.
Automatic line seizure
(Prime Line on)
optiset E entry and optiset E basic, and optiPoint 500 tele-
phones cannot use this feature.
Prime Line on (auto-
matic line seizure)
With automatic line seizure, you can program trunks in dif-
ferent trunk groups. You cannot define an overflow from
trunk group 1 to another trunk group.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-158 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.6 En-Bloc Dialing
Definition
With en-bloc dialing, the digits dialed are combined to form a block, stored in the sys-
tem, and forwarded when they are recognized as complete.
If no additional digits are entered within a certain period (timer:
End of Dial on Incom-
plete dialing
; the default time is 15 seconds), the system interprets the last number
entered as the last digit in the block.
When the timer expires (when the last dialed digit is recognized), dialing automatically
begins. Dialing can also be started manually by entering the end-of-dialing code (#).
In the case of PRI, en-bloc dialing to the central office is mandatory. Block dialing is
also used in Cornet-N networks.
Timing parameters are only accessible via the Expert Level in HiPath 3000 Manager
E. Contact your second-level service group if a change is required.
Related Topics
Section 3.7, Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.), on page 3-183
Section 3.8, Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only), on page 3-195
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
CorNet-N En-bloc dialing is used in CorNet-N networks.
QSig En-bloc dialing is used in QSig networks.
USA, PRI En-bloc dialing is required with PRI in the USA.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-159
Features
3.6.7 Dial Tone Detection
Definition
The system always links analog trunk connections to the
Dial Tone Detection
routine.
The system checks the trunk to determine whether the audible tone is present. The
dialing information is not transmitted to the trunk until this check has been performed.
The reason for this is that the time until the CO dial tone is received can differ depend-
ing on the network operator and network status.
Dial Tone Detection is performed:
After trunk seizure
After dialing of administrable digits (for example, discriminating digit in the main
communications server, LCR)
When a second dial tone is monitored
Dial Tone Detection may not be appropriate, for example, in a Centrex environment,
where different tones (to indicate CO Call Forwarding activation, etc.) need to be
heard by the user. In such cases, the
Trunk Supervision
flag (
Dial Tone Detection
)
must be turned off. Then a trunk seizure delay can be programmed before dialing can
begin. If trunk supervision is activated, the system waits until a dial tone is detected,
even if
No pause
is selected in this field.
The Trunk Seizure delay choices are
No Pause, 1, 3, 6
or
9
seconds.
If
Trunk Supervision
is activated, and dial tone is not detected (timer:
Dial Tone Mon-
itoring time
, default 10 seconds), this line is taken out of operation if there is no dial
tone after seizure. Thereafter, the system checks at cyclical intervals whether a dial
tone is once again present. When it is, the line in question is put back into operation.
Dial tone monitoring time.
The
Dial Tone Monitoring
timer is only accessible via the Expert Level in HiPath 3000
Manager E. Contact your second-level service group if a change is required.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Analog trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-160 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Audible tone If audible tone monitoring is not possible or not desired,
you can configure a
pause before dial
.
Audible tone You can modify the monitoring of a second audible tone
and the audible tone monitoring time only using HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-161
Features
3.6.8 End-of-Dialing Recognition
Definition
As in the case of en-bloc dialing, the end of dialing is signaled either automatically
after the timer expires or manually when the user enters the end-of-dialing code (#).
The timer invoked in this case is
End-of-dial on incomplete dialing
. If dialing is not
continued within the specified timeout, an end-of-dial is generated automatically. The
default is 15 seconds.
Timing parameters are only accessible via the Expert Level in HiPath 3000 Manager
E. Contact your second-level service group if a change is required.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
End-of-dialing time The longer the time for end of dialing, the longer it takes for
the final digit to be transmitted on an analog trunk.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-162 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.9 Trunk Signaling Method
Definition
The signaling methods currently in use are:
Dial pulsing (DP)
Dual-tone multifrequency (DTMF)
Pulses are analyzed in the case of DP, while tones are analyzed in the case of DTMF.
When the system uses analog trunk boards, the signaling method is automatically de-
tected as long as the user has not configured a signaling method or
pause before dial
.
Otherwise, the signalling method can be set on a per trunk basis.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Analog trunk board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Signaling method If you set the trunk to PABX (communications server), the
DTMF method is activated.
Pause before dial If you configure
pause before dial
, the DP signaling meth-
od is activated.
Power reset (power
failure)
The signaling method that is detected is stored until the
next power reset (power failure).
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-163
Features
3.6.10 Configurable Toll Restriction
Definition
Each user in a communications server can be assigned different toll restrictions. Each
time a station attempts to seize a trunk, that stations class of service (COS) is
checked (toll restriction). The system distinguishes between 15 different classes of
service:
0 = no trunk access
1 = outward-restricted trunk access
2 to 7 = allowed lists
8 to 13 = denied lists
14 = unrestricted trunk access
The following list describes the classes of service in greater detail.
No trunk access
Users can make internal calls only. Users can use speed-dialing destinations.
Cannot make calls via CorNet-N link.
Outward-restricted trunk access (incoming authorized)
Users can only answer external calls. Users can use speed-dialing destinations.
Allowed lists
Allowed lists define the station numbers that the user is allowed to dial. If no num-
bers are entered in an allowed list, the station functions like a telephone with out-
ward-restricted trunk access.
Denied lists
Denied lists define the station numbers that the user is not allowed to dial. If no
numbers are entered in a denied list, the station functions like a telephone with
unrestricted trunk access.
Unrestricted trunk access
Users can answer and set up incoming and outgoing calls without restriction.
The Allowed numbers lists contain the digit sequences which may appear at the start
of a call number. The maximum length of the digit sequence is seven digits (0..9, *,#).
A maximum of 100 entries can be made in the allowed numbers list no. 1 and the lists
numbered 2-6 each contain a maximum of 50 entries.
System configurations with CorNet-N and/or a fax server use class of service 7 for
these trunks and devices. In this case, you should not assign class of service 7 to a
subscriber with restricted access. Instead, use classes of service 0 to 6 and 8 to 14
for these subscribers.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-164 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The Barred numbers lists contain the digit sequences which cause a call number to
be rejected. The maximum length of the digit sequence is seven digits (0..9,*,#). A
maximum of 50 entries can be made in the barred numbers list no. 1 and the lists
numbered 2-6 each contain a maximum of 50 entries.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Trunk connection ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of classes of
service
15 15 15 15 15
Number of characters
in list entries
25 25 25 25 25
Total number of al-
lowed lists
66666
Allowed lists, long
100 entries
11111
Allowed lists, short
10 entries
55555
Total no. of denied lists 6 6 6 6 6
Denied lists, long
50 entries
11111
Denied lists, short
10 entries
55555
Subject Requirement or Condition
System speed dialing You can use system speed-dialing destinations regardless
of the COS.
Toll restriction The toll restriction classes of service regulate which de-
nied or allowed lists are used for the stations for each trunk
group. The classes of service apply to data and voice sta-
tions.
CS/CorNet-N/QSig If the trunk group for networking is set to communications
server (CS), the toll restriction check is not performed.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-165
Features
CorNet-N/QSig With networking, you should enter the trunk access code
of the main communications server as a second trunk ac-
cess code so that the toll restriction will be checked when
a trunk in the main communications server is seized.
Toll restriction for two
networked systems
When there is an external seizure of a station from the sat-
ellite CS (with COS 2-13) over the main CS, the main CSs
first denied list always does the seizing.
For this reason, keep the first denied line of the main CS
free for the assessment of the stations from the satellite
CS.
The system keeps COS 0, 1 and 14 of the satellite CS.
Least cost routing
(LCR)
A distinction is made between classes of service and the
LCR class of service; if both are configured, both apply..
Telephone lock After telephone lock is activated, you can reduce the class
of service but not select a higher class of service.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-166 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.11 Traffic Restriction Groups
Definition
Multiple traffic restriction groups (ITRs), also known as Connection Groups (CON),
are provided in the system for all stations. These groups define information on toll re-
striction and trunk group reference (incoming or outgoing) for stations and trunks.
An ITR matrix defines whether a station
Is authorized to seize a trunk
Can seize a trunk only in the incoming or only in the outgoing direction
Can seize a trunk in the incoming and outgoing directions
Is authorized to seize certain speed-dialing destinations
Can access another station internally
The CON matrix permits or suppresses traffic between stations/lines within a sub-
system and between subsystems. The CON matrix is configured system-wide.
The system default setting assigns all stations and trunks to ITR group 1. That is, all
stations are allowed to seize all trunks in the system. Which of the six groups can con-
nect to which other groups is entered in the matrix.
Tenant Service call restrictions would be defined with the ITR (CON).
Related Topic
Section 3.6.10, Configurable Toll Restriction, on page 3-163
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
No. of ITR groups 6 6 6 6 6
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-167
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
ITR group All stations and trunks are assigned to ITR group 1 by de-
fault.
MOH devices Up to six MOH devices can be defined for the six possible
ITR groups. This means that the analog interfaces used for
connection are part of the ITR groups. The particular MOH
device used depends on the ITR group of the station that
places the call on hold.
MOH source You cannot use the logical port 0 as an MOH source.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-168 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.12 Private Trunk
Definition
The private trunk feature provides a station with immediate access to a trunk via a
programmable feature key.
Users can program toll restrictions for private trunks by using the traffic restriction
group (ITR) feature or by configuring a separate trunk group.
Care should be exercised when configuring a Private Trunk. By definition, a Private
Trunk implies that it will only terminate at one station. However, because features are
implemented on a device-basis, activation of some features could impact the opera-
tion of the Private Trunk, for example, DND, Call forward, intercept.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-169
Features
3.6.13 Trunk Queuing
Definition
If users receive a busy signal following a trunk seizure request (because no free trunk
is available), they can use a procedure to queue on a seized trunk (book a line). As
soon as the trunk becomes available, the system recalls the first user in the queue.
The user hears the CO dial tone and can set up the external connection.
It is not possible to invoke Trunk Queueing if the attempted call was placed through
LCR.
Trunk Queueing can be invoked when all trunks on a
Trunk group
key show busy.
If the user is busy at the time of the recall, the trunk will camp on to the busy station
and if the
camp-on to
is not answered within the default 20 seconds, the reservation
is cancelled and the trunk is offered to the next station in the queue list.
If the user activated DND prior to receiving a recall from a queued trunk, the trunk
reservation is cancelled and the trunk is offered to the next station in the queue list.
If the user had invoked Call forward (CFNA or CF), the recalling trunk will ignore the
call forward and continue to ring at the requesting station. If not answered within de-
fault 20 seconds, the trunk reservation is cancelled.
A recalling trunk cannot be picked up by either Call Pick up - group or Call pick up -
Directed.
If a reservation is placed against a trunk which has an appearance at one or more
stations, the
Tr u n k
keys LED flashes at the recall rate at the station that invoked the
queue request. The LED will be lit steadily at all other appearances.
Only one queue/reservation request is possible per telephone. If a second reserva-
tion is attempted, it overwrites the first.
A system-wide flag,
Trunk reservation
, enables/disables this feature
This feature can be invoked in one of the following two ways:
Manual reservation (for display telephones)
Automatic reservation (for all other types of telephones)
Trunk ReservationAutomatic
When this flag is activated and if a station is not assigned a free trunk after the usual
trunk seizure procedures (random or specific), Busy tone is signaled at the station.
After a fixed period (5 seconds), a positive acknowledgment tone is applied and the
trunk is reserved, provided that the station has the appropriate CO call privilege.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-170 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Trunk ReservationManual
This feature is available only to display telephones.
This feature does not need to be configured in the database.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Trunk reservation is not possible in hands-free mode. In this case, the system inter-
rupts call setup when it recognizes that the line is seized.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Queue trunk A station can queue only one trunk.
Queue trunk Trunk queuing does not apply to S0 (not for U.S.).
Recall A recall does not follow call management.
Speakerphone mode Users can also use trunk queuing in speakerphone mode
Trunk If a number of stations queue a trunk, the trunk is assigned
in the order that the requests were received.
LCR If LCR is active, trunks can not be queued.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-171
Features
3.6.14 Temporary Station Number Display Suppression
Definition
This feature prevents a calling or called party from receiving a station number display.
The feature is designed as a changeover function; the changeover applies until it is
deliberately canceled (changeover repeated).
This feature applies only to incoming from or outgoing calls to an ISDN public network
connection. The system-wide flag,
Call Number suppression on,
can be set to sup-
press the system Caller ID display. The default setting is
off
; that is, the number is not
suppressed.
The feature is designed as a changeover function; that is, the changeover applies un-
til it is deliberately canceled (changeover repeated).
All types of telephones can invoke this feature.
The
Flags
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway of HiPath
3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) status in-
formation. You can use the
Flags
screen to see if a station has activated Number Sup-
pression or not.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
The system-wide flag Call Number Suppression Override does not apply in the US.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Station number trans-
mission
Temporary station number suppression must be supported
by the trunk.
System-wide station
number display sup-
pression
If station-wide station number display suppression is acti-
vated (CLIR and COLR), it cannot be overridden.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-172 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
CLIR It is possible to ignore an activated CLIR setting and dis-
play the station number of the calling station. This feature
is helpful in various situations, as in of emergency calls.
Default access codes *86 to suppress, #86 to display the number
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-173
Features
3.6.15 Denied List for Undialed Trunks
Definition
This feature restricts the dial-up access rights for a trunk selected by the attendant
console. An attendant console may seize an outside line and transfer it to an internal
station. This feature restricts the dial-up access rights for a trunk selected by the at-
tendant console; the user receiving the transferred trunk will not be able to reach the
destinations denied by the class of service (COS) level.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Class of service The class of service of the selected reference station ap-
plies.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-174 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.16 Assigning Speed-Dialing Numbers to ITR Groups
Definition
You can assign a specific speed-dialing number to a specific user or a specific trunk.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Number of speed-dial-
ing groups
You can configure up to six speed-dialing groups (from
KWZx to KWZy), including overlapping ones.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-175
Features
3.6.17 Intercept With Telephone Lock
Definition
If a station with an activated telephone lock (codelock) dials a trunk group code, the
system immediately forwards the call to the entered intercept destination. If the sta-
tion makes a call to a destination for which it is unauthorized, the extension indicated
always receives a signal.
The Codelock intercept function can be configured for each station individually us-
ing Set up station: Parameters.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-176 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.18 Keypad Dialing
Definition
In some countries, network provider services are controlled using keypad dialing in-
stead of functional control. To activate these services in the central office, you can use
the so-called stimulus interface for V1.2 and later of the HiPath 3000.
The user acknowledges the message traffic using the display. As a result, keypad di-
aling can be done only on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display, mobile
telephones (HiPath cordless) with optiset E or optiPoint 500 menu navigation and IP
telephones with stimulus interfaces.
An authorized station can activate keypad dialing using the service menu or using the
*503 code. This is possible only in the idle state. Then the station must select an ISDN
trunk that the feature can use.
Model-Specific Data
The actions carried out using keypad dialing are not subject to any system control.
HiPath 3000 cannot prevent improper use, such as call charges fraud or trunk block-
ing.
The customer must be informed that Siemens AG accepts no liability whatsoever for
damages resulting from the improper use of this feature!
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements digital trunk connection
optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display, mobile
telephone (HiPath cordless) with optiset E or optiPoint 500
menu navigation, or IP telephone with stimulus interface
SW requirements V1.2 or later
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-177
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Telephone lock Keypad dialing cannot be used when the telephone lock
has been activated.
ISDN telephones ISDN telephones are not supported.
Services Each network provider determines which services can be
used with keypad dialing.
Call detail recording Depending on the messages sent by the central office
(such as when connecting), keypad dialing entries can
have consequences for the call data recording. The num-
ber of the station using keypad dialing, the line used, and
the time period when the feature was executed are protoc-
olled.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-178 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.19 E911 Emergency Call Service for the USA (for U.S. only)
Definition
The E911 expanded emergency call service makes it possible to transmit information
about the physical location of a station in addition to the station number. Therefore
not only the number of the station placing the call is available in the emergency call
center, but the location too.
This requires that each subscriber line with a valid DID number be assigned a Loca-
tion Identification Number LIN. The LIN is an unambiguous number that corresponds
to the 10-digit NANP (North American Numbering Plan). Subscriber lines that are
physically close to one another are given the same LIN. The emergency call center
has a database that contains all the LINs and that uses the transmitted LIN to identify
the name and address of the one placing the emergency call.
V1.2 and later of HiPath 3000 supports this feature for analog (loop start protocol) and
digital trunks (Primary Rate Interface PRI).
Analog trunks require an additional converter (such as Telident STS) to translate the
transmitted DTMF characters (LS protocol) into the CAMA protocol used for the
Emergency Call Service ECS (see Figure 3-3).
Danger
In systems with the E911 emergency service activated for the USA, you are not al-
lowed to use the Relocate feature (see Section 3.11.11 on Page 3-254) if the system
has more than one Location Identification Number (LIN).
Danger
Quick help after an emergency call is possible only when valid information concern-
ing the location of the caller who is in trouble is available. For this reason, the correct
assignment of the LINs to the available DID number must always be guaranteed.
If the customer assumes the system administration, then the customer also as-
sumes the responsibility for the correct assignment of the LINs. In this case, the cus-
tomer must be informed that Siemens AG accepts no liability whatsoever for dam-
ages resulting from the improper use of this feature.
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-179
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Figure 3-3 E911 Expanded Emergency Call Service E911 (for USA only)
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature for analog
trunks available in
xx––
HW requirements analog (LS) trunk con-
nection
––
SW requirements V1.2 or later ––
Feature for digital
trunks available in
xx–––
HW requirements digital (PRI) trunk con-
nection
–––
SW requirements V1.2 or later –––
Subject Requirement or Condition
E911 emergency call
service
for USA only
PRI
CorNet-N
Analog
Public
exchange
Database with
Automatic Location
Identification ALI
Converter
Station sends
emergency call
PRI
CorNet-N
Analog
Emergency
call center
HiPath 3000
HiPath 3000
Public
telecommunication network
PRI
PRI
CAMA
Analog
Loop Start (HKZ)
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-180 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.6.20 Automatic Call Completion on No Reply (CCNR) on the Trunk
Interface (V3.0 and later)
Definition
You can use this function only if the public exchange supports it.
An internal subscriber who reaches an available external subscriber can activate a
call completion request in the trunk. As a result, the system monitors the connection
of the called subscriber. As soon as the called subscriber initiates a connection setup
and then ends this connection, the system attempts to produce a connection between
the two subscribers.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements trunk connection
SW requirements V3.0 SMR-3 and later
Features for Outgoing External Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-181
Features
3.6.21 CLIP no screening (V3.0 and later)
Definition
The essential characteristic of this feature is that the HiPath 3000 System number -
outgoing does not have to be the same as the International/national system number
- incoming.
To make this possible, the System number parameter that has been used until now
has been split into System number - incoming and System number - outgoing for
V3.0 SMR 3 and later.
Incoming and outgoing calls usually use the same system number. In this case, the
entry under System number - outgoing is either empty or the same as the one under
System number- incoming. If this is not the case, you can
enter a different number under System number - outgoing.
use the routing parameter No. and type, outgoing to define whether the entered
System number - outgoing contains the station number without area code (sub-
scriber), with area code (national), or also with the international country code (in-
ternational).
You can also activate the flag Suppress station number for special customer appli-
cations. This prevents the system from sending out the DID number of the station
along with the Station number - outgoing.
Example: You want to prevent customers from directly reaching a service staff mem-
ber who is reached centrally with a general service number. To conceal his or her own
DID number, enter the general service number as System number - outgoing and
activate the Suppress station number flag. Then called subscribers see only the
general service number on their display as the CLIP.
In a Centrex environment, you generally enter the number of the Centrex group as
System number - outgoing and deactivate the Suppress station number flag. The
called subscriber then sees the Centrex number plus station DID number as the CLIP.
If the entry under System number - outgoing is empty, the system automatically
sends the entries under System number - incoming.
Features for Outgoing External Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-182 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements digital trunk connection
SW requirements V3.0 SMR-3 and later
Subject Requirement or Condition
CLIP no screening You must configure the no screening option for the trunk
connection in the public exchange.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-183
Features
3.7 Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Least cost routing provides HiPath 3000 with automatic control over the path of an
outgoing call. This path can be one of various public-network carriers or a private net-
work. Based on routing tables, the system seeks the least expensive connection path
for the outgoing call.
The system seizes a trunk only after it has scanned the routing tables. The system
sends dial tone as a function of the dial plan so that the station is informed of the
ready-to-dial condition. The signals dialed are buffered until the routing tables have
been scanned. Only then does the system make the connection.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of LCR class-
es of service
15 15 15 15 15
Subject Requirement or Condition
LCR If all the least expensive connection paths have been
seized, LCR automatically switches to defined more ex-
pensive paths. The system can signal user of this fact both
visually and acoustically.
LCR The dialed station number is displayed until the station
number information on the other party is received.
LCR If LCR is activated, the system checks for the least costly
route for every trunk seizure (except when a trunk code is
dialed).
LCR Digits can be transmitted either singly or en-bloc, depend-
ing on the access method and the dial plan.
LCR After an account code is entered, it applies to the entire
connection setup.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-184 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.7.1 Carrier Types
Since in many cases individual carriers provide specific connections and conditions
at different tariffs (sometimes with different signaling methods), least cost routing can
be used to automatically select the most economical connection or most economical
carrier for each outgoing phone call.
The following carrier types and networks are available for implementing least cost
routing (LCR).
3.7.1.1 Mercury Communications Limited Single Stage
Definition
With this type of LCR, a prefix is used to dial the desired network carrier and the sta-
tion number is subsequently dialed.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
LCR The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The
toll restriction check then refers to the digits dialed at the
station without considering the trunk group code.
LCR class of service The LCR class of service determines whether a station
can use the route recommended in the path table.
Prime Line on (auto-
matic line seizure)
LCR is not possible when Prime Line is active.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
MCL Single Stage Dialing is carried out in the D channel (with ISDN) or as
normal dialing (on analog trunks).
Subject Requirement or Condition
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-185
Features
3.7.1.2 Mercury Communications Limited Two Stage
Definition
With this type of least cost routing, the system initially selects the carrier using a con-
figurable access code (as with single stage). Afterwards, the system also waits for a
connect (synchronization during timeout).
After the connect, the system transmits an authorization code and the destination sta-
tion number as DTMF signals in the B channel.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
MCL With synchronization during timeout, you must program a
pause of 2 to 12 seconds.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-186 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.7.1.3 Dial-In Control Server (DICS)
Definition
With this type of least cost routing, the system uses the routing table to determine
whether the call should be made via the DICS or the public network. If the DICS is
used, the system dials the DICS using a configurable access code and an authoriza-
tion code and transmits the station number dialed by the station in the SUB address
(on the D channel). The DICS checks the authorization based on the CLIP informa-
tion and the transmitted authorization code.
If the DICS is not present during the first connection setup, the system reroutes the
connection to the public network. This alternative access must be configured.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Station number sup-
pression
Temporary or permanent station number suppression can-
not be activated.
ISDN/SUB addressing The ISDN feature SUB must be applied for or released in
the public network.
Analog trunk DICS can only be used with ISDN.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-187
Features
3.7.1.4 Corporate Network (CN)
Definition
A corporate network is an alternative network, such as a company-owned network,
that is connected directly to the HiPath 3000.
The LCR function determines the corresponding trunk group based on the station
number dialed and then routes the call either via the trunk group in the public ex-
change or via the trunk group in the corporate network.
If necessary, the system translates the station number.
Model-Specific Data
3.7.1.5 Primary Carrier
Definition
When a trunk is seized by the primary carrier, simplified dialing is performed by en-
bloc dialing or by dialing individual digits into the public network.
If primary carrier was the method selected in the outdial rule table, forwarding in the
trunk group table is not performed for entries after the route configured as a primary
carrier.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-188 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.7.2 Routing Tables
Definition
The routing tables evaluate the digits dialed by the user and determine the station
number that the system should dial. In the process, the digits are modified as neces-
sary. This modification can mean that digits are repeated, suppressed, added, or re-
ordered. It is also possible to add a dial pause and change the signaling method. A
distinction is made between the following types of routing tables:
Outdial rule table: This table determines how the digits dialed by the user will
be converted and dialed by the system. The following special characters can be
defined:
A: Repeat remaining fields (transmit). This letter causes all subsequent digit
fields to be transmitted. The point of reference is the last field pointer before
A
. The combination E1A is permitted only at the beginning of a string.
D (n): Dial digit sequence (1 to 25 digits). This letter can be inserted multiple
times and at any position in the string.
E (n): Repeat field from dial plan (from 1 to 10 times). This letter can be in-
serted multiple times and at any position in the string.
E
can also appear in
any order with relation to (n). A specific field can be addressed multiple
times, including in sequence. With the exception of
E1
, this letter can be sur-
rounded by any parameter.
P (n): Pause (1 to 60 times the system-wide pause unit). This letter can be
inserted multiple times and at any position in the string.
M (n): Authorization code (1 to 16). This letter must not be in the final posi-
tion.
S: Switch, changes signaling methods from DP to DTMF (with CONNECT,
PROGRESS or CALL PROC with PI). This letter can be inserted in the string
only once and may not be in the final position. The
C
parameter cannot be
used after
S
.
U: Use subaddress signaling method. This letter can be inserted in the string
only once and may not be in the final position. Subsequent characters are
again dialed in
INFO
. The
S, P,
and
C
parameters cannot be used after
U
.
C: Access code. This letter can be inserted in the string only once. The sub-
sequent characters are transmitted without a dial pause and are used for sin-
gle stage, two-stage, DICS (not for U.S.), BRI, and PRI carrier access.
Authorization code: The authorization code is divided into the carrier ID and
customer ID. The carrier ID is entered as one entry in the authorization code table
and the customer ID is entered as another entry in the authorization code table.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-189
Features
The authorization code entry in the outdial rule then consists of the two authori-
zation codes. Only a protected authorization code is supported (represented by
*****).
Class of service: Each station is assigned a class of service (COS). A station
can then seize a path only if its COS is greater than or equal to the COS in the
path table; for example, a station with a COS 7 cannot seize a path with COS 8.
Schedule: Up to eight time zones per day can be configured for each day of the
week to control LCR. A search is performed based on the schedule ID entered in
the path table to determine whether the current time matches the value entered
in the schedule. If it does and if the correct class of service is present, dialing is
performed as per the outdial rule entered in the path table.
Path table: Up to 254 path tables with 16 paths each can be created. Each path
in a path table is described by a combination of the trunk group, outdial rule, toll
restriction, schedule, and an option for warning against a more expensive route.
The table is scanned from top to bottom. The system checks to determine wheth-
er the trunk group is free and the station has the requisite class of service. If so,
the system dials per the outdial rule and schedule entered in the path table.
Depending on the entry in the path table, a warning can be issued to the station
informing the user that the call is being routed. This warning can be signaled by
a warning tone and a display message. The display shows the outdial rule name.
Dial plan: Each station number dialed for external traffic is checked against the
dial plan for up to 30 positions (including field separator and trunk group code).
If the number dialed matches an entry in the dial plan, LCR is handled in accor-
dance with the path table in the dial plan.
To use all available features (such as callback) in conjunction with LCR, the trunk
group code must be separated from the dialed station number by a dash () in
the dial plan (sample dial plan entry: 0CZ).
The following station number entries are valid:
0...9: Permissible digits
-: Field separator
X: Any digit from 0 to 9
N: Any digit from 2 to 9
Z: One or more digits to follow up to the end of dialing
C: Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
The first entry in a dial plan does not have to be a trunk group code; it can also be
a station number in a networked system.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-190 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
To block incoming external calls, enter a dash () in the Routing table field of the
dial plan.
Example:
Do not confuse the hyphen () in the Dialed digits field, which separates the digit
blocks in the number, with the dash in the Path table field, which blocks the numbers.
Dialed Digits
(Code + Station Number)
Path
Table
Explanation
9C1-900-XXX-XXX The dash () blocks all 900 numbers.
9C1-976-123-3456 The dash () blocks only the number
976-123-3456.
Figure 3-4 Sample LCR Flow Diagram (Not for U.S.)
A
Zeitplan
A
15
benötigte
Berechtigung
10
To n
War-
nung
keine
BT
Wahlregel
(Name)
MCL
Rtg. 1
Bündel
Rtg. 1
1
Digit analysis
3 - 1728134 - Z
Dialed digits
1
Path
table
Dial plan
Type
Outdial rule table
Primary carrier
MCL single stage
MCL two stage
DICS
DICS
Primary carrier
CN
Name
BT
MCL Easy
MCL
Telliance 1
Telliance 2
Te l e k o m
SCN
Outdial rule
A
D132A
D131P6SM1A
D904711UM2A
D904811UM2A
A
D900A
A
Sched-
ule
Path table
A
15
Requisite
class of serv.
10
Tone
Warning
None
BT
Outdial rule
(name)
MCL
TG 1
Tru nk
group
TG 1
1
2
...
50
1
2
...
514
1
254
...
Dialing
(if trunk group is free and the
class of service and sched-
ule are appropriate)
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-191
Features
The dialed call number is used as the criterion for the connection path to be used.
The system can evaluate up to 24 digits of the digit sequence plus up to 9 field sep-
arators. The digit sequence that can be dialed can consist of up to 32 digits. The eval-
uation can be carried out both
destination dependently
and
time dependently
and in
dependence on the station's LCR class of service (COS).
The system contains 254 route tables with 16 routes each. The LCR class-of-service
is evaluated hierarchically for LCR.
The outdial rule is described in the HiPath 3000 Manager E by its name, which con-
sists of not more than 16 characters, and in the System Administration by its index.
The station can cancel automatic selection by seizing a line directly (Carrier Select
Override - CSO). The LCR class-of-service cannot be transferred between CorNet-N
networked systems.
General Operating Principle
The system analyzes the number dialed to determine if the digits input are valid. If the
digits are recognized, a reference route table is scanned for Route group choices.
Once the Route group is selected, the availability of the route is checked against the
time schedule. If the Route group is available, the LCR COS requirement assigned to
the route group is compared to the LCR COS associated with the dialing device. If the
LCR COS associated with the dialing station is equal to or greater than the route
group COS, the Toll Restriction tables are checked for additional screening informa-
tion. This process is repeated for every call using the system LCR application.
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-192 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
A system-wide flag activates LCR via Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
When LCR is activated, the check is performed for every trunk seizure (except
when dialing a trunk code).
If all the least expensive connection paths have been seized, LCR automatically
switches to defined
more expensive
paths. The user can be signaled of this fact
both visually and acoustically.
Figure 3-5 General LCR Flow
Are there any toll re-
striction tables that pre-
vent you from dialing
the number on the se-
lected route group?
No: Try the next route
group or return busy
tone
Route group is select-
ed
Route table is selected
User dials access code
and number
Is your route available?
What time is it?
Is your LCRCOS equal
to or higher than the re-
quirement?
No: Try the next route
group or return busy
tone
Yes: Go to the toll re-
striction tables for anal-
ysis
Insert out-dial rule Call is processed
Expensive
warning tone?
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-193
Features
In the case of outgoing calls on the ISDN network, the dialed number continues
to be displayed until the destination number information on the other party is re-
ceived.
Digits can be transmitted either per digit or en-bloc, depending on the access
method and the dial plan.
Once an account code is entered, it applies to the entire connection setup.
The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The toll restriction check then
refers to the digits dialed on the station without the trunk group code.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
No. of path tables 254 254 254 254 254
Number of paths per
path table
16 16 16 16 16
No. of time zones 8 8 8 8 8
No. of outdial rules 254 254 254 254 254
Number of characters
per outdial rule
40 40 40 40 40
No. of dial plans 514 514 514 514 514
Number of digits di-
aled (including trunk
group code)
32 32 32 32 32
No. of digits evaluated 25 25 25 25 25
Least Cost Routing (LCR) (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-194 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
LCR With per-digit dialing, the last element in the outdial rule
cannot be E(n); it may be E(n)A.
Networking In networking with open numbering, route optimization
cannot be activated.
Least cost routing
(LCR)
If
primary carrier
is entered as a type in the outdial rule, re-
routing is not done in the path tables.
If routing should be carried out when the trunk is busy or
when S0 lines are disrupted, the type should be set to
Sin-
gle Stage
.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-195
Features
3.8 Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
3.8.1 Introduction
This section explains the definitions and procedures used by the HiPath 3000 least
cost routing (LCR) feature to control the path over which outgoing calls are routed to
the public network.
The system analyzes each trunk call placed using least cost routing. If the digits are
recognized, a reference route table is scanned for route-group choices. After the
route group is selected, the availability of the route is checked against the time sched-
ule. If the route group is available, the LCR class-of-service requirement assigned to
the route group is compared to the LCR class of service associated with the dialing
device. If the LCR class of service associated with the dialing device is equal to or
greater than the route-group class of service, the toll-restriction tables are then
checked for additional screening information.
The dialed call number is used as the criterion for the connection path to be used.
The system can evaluate up to 24 digits of the digit sequence plus up to 9 field sep-
arators. The digit sequence that can be dialed can consist of up to 32 digits. The eval-
uation can be carried out both
destination dependently
and
time dependently
and in
dependence on the station's LCR class of service (COS).
General Operating Principle
The system analyzes the number dialed to determine if the digits input are valid. If the
digits are recognized, a reference route table is scanned for Route group choices.
Once the Route group is selected, the availability of the route is checked against the
time schedule. If the Route group is available, the LCR COS requirement assigned to
the route group is compared to the LCR COS associated with the dialing device. If the
LCR COS associated with the dialing station is equal to or greater than the route
group COS, the Toll Restriction tables are checked for additional screening informa-
tion. This process is repeated for every call using the system LCR application.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-196 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
A system-wide flag activates LCR via Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
When LCR is activated, the check is performed for every trunk seizure (except
when dialing a trunk code).
If all the least expensive connection paths have been seized, LCR automatically
switches to defined
more expensive
paths. The user can be signaled of this fact
both visually and acoustically.
Figure 3-6 General LCR Flow (for U.S. Only)
Are there any toll re-
striction tables that pre-
vent you from dialing
the number on the se-
lected route group?
No: Try the next route
group or return busy
tone
Route group is select-
ed
Route table is selected
User dials access code
and number
Is your route available?
What time is it?
Is your LCRCOS equal
to or higher than the re-
quirement?
No: Try the next route
group or return busy
tone
Yes: Go to the toll re-
striction tables for anal-
ysis
Insert out-dial rule Call is processed
Expensive
warning tone?
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-197
Features
In the case of outgoing calls on the ISDN network, the dialed number continues
to be displayed until the destination number information on the other party is re-
ceived.
Digits can be transmitted either per digit or en-bloc, depending on the access
method and the dial plan.
Once an account code is entered, it applies to the entire connection setup.
The allowed and denied lists are also used for LCR. The toll restriction check then
refers to the digits dialed on the station without the trunk group code.
3.8.2 Carrier Types
Since in many cases the individual carriers provide specific connections and condi-
tions at different tariffs (with different signaling methods, when applicable), the least
cost routing feature can be used for automatically selecting the most economical con-
nection or most economical carrier for each outgoing telephone call.
The following carrier types and networks are available for implementing least cost
routing (LCR):
AT & T
MCI
Sprint
Westinghouse
U.S. Government Federal Telephone System FTS-2000
Connections to the local exchange carrier (LEC) are toll-free. Connections to the in-
ter-exchange carrier (IEC) are handled by the carriers listed above. The LEC has a
default IEC that it uses for long distance calls unless the user selects another carrier.
To select another carrier, the user must first dial the IECs Carrier Access Code (CAC)
and Carrier Identification Code (CIC).
There are two different types of CIC numbering schemes: one for a 3-digit CIC and
another for a 4-digit CIC. The four-digit code consists of the three-digit code preceded
by the number 0. For example, the CIC for MCI is 222 or 0222.
The CAC for a three-digit CIC is 10, and the CAC for a four-digit CIC is 101.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-198 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.8.3 Using Alternate Carriers
Alternate carriers may be connected to each trunk route group. The selection of the
carrier is defined in the least cost routing outdial-rule section.
3.8.3.1 Carrier Access Methods Supported
Main Carrier
When seizing a trunk using the main carrier, the system can use en-bloc dialing or
send single digits to the public network to set up the outgoing call. Note that this ac-
cess method is used when routing calls over the public switching network.
MCL Single Stage
The system calls the selected carrier using a prefix and then dials the destination
number. Digits are sent in the D channel when using ISDN service or as normal dial-
ing when using analog service. This selection may be used in CorNet applications for
advancing to public network facilities for overflow applications.
MCL Two Stage
The system calls the selected carrier using a prefix in this method as well. After a
short synchronization phase, it sends a programmable authorization code and then
the destination number using DTMF digits.
Corporate Network (CorNet)
When a corporate network (CN) method is used, the alternate network is connected
directly to the HiPath 3000. This can be seen as a company network. LCR determines
the trunk group by analyzing the number the user has dialed and routes the call either
over the CO trunk group or over the corporate network. This method allows both an
open and closed numbering plan to be implemented by manipulation of digits.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-199
Features
Dial-In Control Server
The system calls the selected carrier using a prefix and calls a dial-in control server
(DICS). The authorization code and the destination number are transmitted within the
SUB address. Dialing information is sent in the D channel.
Primary Rate Interface
The choice of a carrier or of a calling service is encoded in the following information
elements:
Network specific facility
Operator system access
Transit network selection
LCR Dial Plan
The dialed destination number serves as a criterion for the route group to be used.
The system can evaluate up to 24 digits in the dialed sequence plus the routing code.
The system evaluates and routes the call based on a time of day schedule and the
stations least cost routing class of service.
Destination-Dependent Evaluation
The dialed digit sequence may be converted to a new digit sequence after evaluation,
or it may be preceded by additional digits such as the carrier information of the des-
tination.
3.8.4 LCR Time of Day Evaluation
The time table allows the system to evaluate the availability of a selected route ac-
cording to a maximum of eight time zones. For each weekday, the number can be
evaluated in hour:minute intervals throughout the day.
3.8.5 LCR Outdial Rules
The dialed number can be converted to any new digit sequence (up to 40 digits). The
system can evaluate up to 514 digit sequences dialed from the station. Wildcards may
be used in the LCR dial-plan table. The system supports 254 outdial rules for digit
translation requirements as well.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-200 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.8.6 Expensive Route Identification
If the first route selection in the route table is busy, the LCR function can advance to
the next expensive path configured in the route group table. The system can notify the
user of this with an audible signal, an optical signal, or both. Users can then decide
whether they would like to use the assigned path or hang up.
3.8.7 Overflow Options
When the LCR function determines that the preferred trunk or tie-trunk group cannot
be used, it can select an alternate trunk group within the selected route-group table.
3.8.8 LCR Class of Service
Up to 15 station-specific trunk classes of service are possible. The class of service
setting controls access to the configured route groups in the LCR route-group table.
3.8.9 Carrier-Select Override
Carrier-select override (CSO) can be implemented using selective line seizure. In this
case a connection can only be set up via the main carrier.
3.8.10 Handling of Numbers and Destinations and Trunk Group Access
Codes
All numbers except internal station numbers are stored as an LCR digit string. All
numbers dialed by a user are displayed without routing information. The dialed num-
bers remain displayed until answer supervision is received from the central office. If
more than one trunk group access code is programmed for a trunk group, the first ac-
cess code is the default.
If the number of the called party during an outgoing connection is also stored in the
optiset E or optiPoint 500 caller list or if a callback is activated, the number dialed by
the user is stored instead of the destination number sent by the system. In this case,
the trunk group access code is also stored so that the system can recall the party
from the caller list using the correct access code.
3.8.11 Correlation With Other Features
This section describes how the least cost routing application interacts with other sys-
tem features
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-201
Features
3.8.11.1 Station-Related Features
System speed-dialing call numbers must be prefixed with the LCR access codes
for proper operation.
Station redial will insert the access code used for the original call.
Repertory dial keys to external destinations must have the LCR access code for
proper operation.
Electronic notebook entries on optiset E memory telephones must include an
LCR access code.
General call keys will be activated when the route is selected by the system.
Call keys will be activated when the route is selected by the system.
MUSAP keys may be used for external calling using the LCR access code.
DTMF tones may be input manually when answer supervision is received.
Toll restriction class of service is checked as part of the LCR analysis.
3.8.11.2 Trunk-Related Features
Basic rate ISDN trunks may be accessed by stations assigned CACH values or
PDID values.
Verified forced account codes may be requested before a selected route group is
accessed.
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing may be selected based on the outdial rule
Additional Information Concerning the Setup of Public Network Trunks
The class of service configured is valid on a locked terminal (code lock).
It is possible to send speed-dialing numbers after selecting the network.
If speed-dialing numbers are used without first selecting the network, the default
network is used (carrier-select override).
When LCR is activated, no trunk group overflow is performed. An alternative
route can be determined using the path table.
When LCR is activated, no digit repetition is performed; the routing tables are fol-
lowed instead.
Message waiting and automatic callback follow the rules for LCR.
An account code entered by the user is valid for the whole connection, even if
more than one route over different trunk groups was tried during connection set-
up.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-202 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
In the case of connections via other network providers or carriers, the provider or
carrier may not transmit the actual connection costs, i.e., it may send the HiPath
3000 only the charges to the dial-in node (such as a dial-in control server [Europe
only]).
3.8.12 Routing Tables
The routing tables evaluate the digits that the user has dialed and determine the des-
tination number to be dialed from the system. The digits may be changed (manipulat-
ed) during this process. Digit translation makes it possible to repeat, suppress, and
add digits or convert digit sequences. It is also possible to insert an inter-digit pause
and change the signaling method. A distinction is made between the routing tables
discussed in the following sections.
3.8.13 LCR Dial Plan
In the case of external calls, the system checks each number dialed up to a total of
25 digits, including field separators and trunk-group access codes. The dial-plan en-
try is associated with a route group for the destination number and the system as-
signs this path to the station for setting up the connection.
The dial plan may be separated into unique fields for identification and configuration
purposes using the outdial rules. Table 3-1 shows the numbers 4922000 and
14084922000 entered in the dial-plan table.
The following entries are valid for the destination:
Table 3-1 Sample Entries in a Dial-Plan Table
Field 1 Field 2 Field 3 Field 4 Field 5
9 C 492 2000
9C1408 492 2000
6265932
1
Reset boards
and port assign-
ments stored in
the system.
0 . . . 9 Allowed digits
Field separator (maximum of 10 fields per dial-plan entry)
C Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times). This entry is
also interpreted as a field separator.
X Any digit between 0 and 9
N Any digit between 2 and 9
Z One or more digits follow before end of dialing
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-203
Features
If Prime Line is used, no LCR is possible.
For the LCR dial plan to accurately select the route group, the dial-plan entries must
be entered as follows.
Entries should be placed in ascending numeric order from 0 to 9. Specific dialed num-
bers must precede wildcard entries to prevent conflicts in matches with wildcard en-
tries. Table 3-2 is an example of the suggested entry order.
The fields formed by the field separators “–” and C in the dial plan can be addressed
selectively to repeat, suppress, exchange, or insert digits.
3.8.13.1 Rules for Creating LCR Dial Plan Entries
The first field should contain only a programmed trunk group access code. It must
not contain any wildcards.
The wildcards N and X can occur more than once in any field except the first field.
C Simulated dial tone (can be entered up to three times)
Notes: The character # within a dial string means end of dialing or signaling method
changeover. For this reason, * and # are not valid entries. Outdial rules may be used
to insert the * and # in the dial string to the public network.
Do not confuse the dash (-) symbol in the destination field, which functions as a field
separator, with the dash in the Route Table field, which functions as a call blocker
(refer to Table 3-2).
Table 3-2 Sample Entries in a Dial-Plan Table
Entry No. Dialed Digits
(code + station no.) Route Table
19C0Z 1
29C011Z
3 9C492-5001 1
4 9CNXX-XXXX 1
5 9C1-NXX-XXX-XXXX 1
6 9C1-900-XXX-XXX -1
1 In this example, the dash (-) blocks all 900 numbers from being dialed.
7 9C1-976-123-3456 -2
2 In this example, the dash (-) blocks only the specific number (976-123-3456)
from being dialed.
...
254
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-204 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The wildcard Z can occur only in the last field. It represents an undetermined
number of suffix digits.
A digit sequence can be divided into a maximum of 10 fields.
3.8.14 Route Table
A route table contains up to 16 paths. Each path is described by a combination of the
following:
Route group
Outdial rule
Trunk access
Time schedule plan
Code for an expensive path
Paths
The system contains 254 path tables, each with 16 paths. LCR evaluates the trunk
access in hierarchical order.
Search Order
The system searches the path table from top to bottom. If the located path is busy, or
if the station does not have the proper class of service, the system continues to the
next path.
Outdial Rule
The outdial rule is described in HiPath 3000 Manager E by its name, which can be up
to 16 characters long, and by its index in system administration.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-205
Features
Carrier-Select Override
Users can deactivate automatic selection within the path by selecting a specific car-
rier (carrier-select override, CSO). For CSO to work, the requested carrier must be
located in the dial plan and the path table assigned by the dial plan, and the user must
have the required trunk access.
3.8.15 Time Table
To control LCR it may be necessary to configure up to eight time zones per day. These
time zones are programmable for every day of the week. Each day begins at 12:00
a.m. Entering the end time in each of the columns delineates the time zones.
3.8.16 Outdial Rule Table
Table 3-3 is a sample outdial rule table. The outdial rule table determines the follow-
ing:
The way the digits entered by the user are converted and dialed by the system
The route on which dialing will take place
The maximum amount of time the LCR function has to control dialing
Up to 254 outdial rules, each up to 40 characters long, can be defined.
Outdial rules are defined by the following parameters:
A: Repeat all remaining fields (transmit).
D (n): Dial a digit sequence (1 to 24 digits).
E (n): Repeat field (1 to 10) from dial plan.
M (n): Authorization code (1 to 16). This letter must not be in the final position.
P (n): Pause (1 to 60 times the system-wide pause unit)
S: Switch, changes signaling methods from DP to DTMF (with CONNECT,
PROGRESS or CALL PROC with PI).
C: Access code
U: Use subaddress signaling method.
N (n): Network SFG (1 to 5) or Band Number (1)
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-206 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The outdial rules provide access to different carriers via digit translation. The outdial
rules address the dial plan fields selectively for the following operations:
Repeating digits
Suppressing digits
Exchanging digits
Inserting digits
Inserting pauses
Switching the signaling method
Detecting a dial tone.
Using the
A
Parameter
The parameter
A
ensures that all subsequent digit fields are transmitted. The refer-
ence point is the last field indicator preceding
A
. The parameter
A
can occur more
than once in the string and can be placed in any position. The
AA
combination has
the same effect as
A
. The
E1A
combination is permitted only at the beginning of a
string.
Using the
D
Parameter
The parameter
D (n)
can occur more than once in the string and can be placed in any
position. The parameter
D (n)
can be surrounded by any other parameters. It should
be no more than 25 characters long.
Table 3-3 Sample Outdial Rule Table
Number Name Outdial Rule Type
1 Dial All A Main network provider
2 Dial Fld 2 Then 3 E2E3 Main network provider
3 Dial All _P_ D444 AP1D444 Main network provider
4 Dial 4 Dial All D4DA Corporate network
...
254
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-207
Features
Using the
E
Parameter
The parameter
E (n)
can occur more than once in the string and can be placed in any
position. The parameter
E (n)
can be arranged in any order, depending on
n
. A deter-
mining field can be addressed more than once, even consecutively. With the excep-
tion of the
E1A
combination,
E (n)
can be surrounded by any other parameters. The
n
can be any number between one and 10.
Using the
M
Parameter
The parameter
M (n)
can occur only once in the string. The parameter
M (n)
should
not be placed in the final position in the string. The n can be any number between one
and 16.
Using the
P
Parameter
The parameter
P (n)
can occur more than once in the string and can be placed in any
position. The parameter
P (n)
can be surrounded by any other parameters. The pause
length is
n
times the length of the system pause. The
n
can be any number between
one and 60.
Using the
S
Parameter
The parameter
S
can occur only once in the string and should not be placed in the
final position in the string. It cannot precede the
C
parameter.
Using the
C
Parameter
The parameter
C
can occur only once in the string. The digits following
C
are sent
without dial pause. The parameter
C
is used for carrier access with single stage, two
stage, DICS and PRI. It cannot be used after
S
.
Using the
U
Parameter
The parameter
U
can occur only once in the string. It should not be placed in the final
position in the string. The subsequent characters are re-selected in INFO. The follow-
ing parameters may not be used after
U
:
S
P
C
M
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-208 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Using the
N
Parameter
The parameter
N
can occur only once in the string and should not be placed in the
first position. The subsequent digits are the SFG or the band number, depending on
the calling service.
Authorization Code
Up to 16 authorization codes with a maximum of 16 digits can be entered for access-
ing services from different carriers. The codes may be used for accessing special
common carriers or adding additional digits to a dial string as part of the outdial rule.
Example: 53276543
One secure authorization code is provided (displayed as **********).
3.8.17 Operation
The system does not seize a trunk until it has completed the routing tables. To inform
the user that the telephone is ready for dialing, you can insert a dial tone into the LCR
dial plan using the letter
C
. The dialed digits are buffered until the system completes
the routing tables. Only then is a connection set up.
The route table (1 to 254) is first determined via the dial plan on the basis of the dialed
destination number. If the destination number is not found in the dial plan, the user
receives a busy signal.
The route table for each route element describes the following:
The trunk group assigned to the path
The outdial rule
The trunk access needed for seizure
The required time plan
The code of an expensive path (warning tone)
The out-dial rule determines the outgoing dialing procedure for the selected trunk
group. Selection may be unsuccessful for one of the following reasons:
Busy route group
Time-of-day restriction
LCR class-of-service restriction
In this case, another carrier can be selected via the alternative paths. You can config-
ure an expensive-path warning tone to sound when an expensive carrier is selected.
Least Cost Routing (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-209
Features
The destination number that the user dialed is generally displayed until the requested
party answers (ALERT or CONNECT). Then the destination number reached is dis-
played if available. The dialed destination number is stored in the station's redial
memory.
Figure 3-7 shows a sample LCR flow diagram.
Figure 3-7 Sample LCR Flow Diagram (for U.S. Only)
A
Sched-
ule
A
15
Requisite
class of serv.
10
Tone
Warning
None
BT
Outdial rule
(name)
MCL
TG 1
Trunk
group
TG 1
1
Digit analysis
9 - 5551222 - Z
Dialed digits
(code + stn. no.)
1
Route
table
Dial plan
Type
Outdial rule table
Main Provider
PRI
2-layer mode
PRI
CN
Primary carrier
CN
Name
PacBell
MCI
Sprint
AT & T
Siemens
AT & T
SCN
Outdial rule
A
D222A
D333P6SM1A
D288A
D10231UM2A
A
D900A
A
Sched-
ule
Route table
A
15
Requisite
class of serv.
10
Tone
Warning
None
PacBell
Outdial rule
(name)
Sprint
TG 1
Tru nk
group
TG 1
1
2
...
50
1
2
...
514
1
254
...
Dialing
(if trunk group is free and the
class of service and sched-
ule are appropriate)
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-210 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9 Features for Internal Traffic
3.9.1 Internal Traffic
Definition
Internal traffic refers to connections between two internal stations. If the system is
equipped with Prime Line on, users can set up an internal call on optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephones by using the extension key.
If Prime Line on is not configured, users can set up an internal call by dialing the in-
ternal station number.
The Prime Line feature is a system-wide feature that allows users to dial directly to
external destinations without the use of
Tr u n k
or
Trunk group
keys. The external ac-
cess code is automatically dialed by the system. Only one outgoing Trunk group is
possible with this arrangement. To dial internal stations, the user must first press the
Internal
key and dial the station number.
Model-Specific Data
Without Prime Line, outside connections require a Trunk, Trunk group key, or an ac-
cess code.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-211
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Extension key LED signaling is not assigned to the extension key.
Prime Line on (auto-
matic line seizure)
Prime Line is a system-wide feature that allows users to
dial directly to external destinations without the use of call
or trunk keys. The requisite trunk or trunk group code is au-
tomatically dialed by the system.
If Prime Line is deactivated, you must press a trunk or call
key or dial a trunk or trunk group code to set up an external
connection.
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-212 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9.2 Direct Station Selection (DSS)/Repertory Dial Key
Definition
The programmable function keys on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones (or key
modules) can be configured as direct station select (DSS) keys. In this case, users
program the keys with the number of an internal station or station group. Pressing the
DSS
key calls the destination station (direct station selection). The associated LED
indicates the call status of the station (ringing, busy, free).
The DSS key is also used as a means to quickly transfer an incoming call to another
station. The user, during a conversation with an external party, can press a
DSS
key;
this places the current call on Consultation Hold. The user can then transfer the call
screened or unscreened to the DSS destination. If the destination does not answer,
a recall is effected and the user can retrieve the call by pressing the
DSS
key once
again.
A DSS appearance can appear on multiple stations. A station cannot have a
DSS
key
with its station on the telephone.
The HiPath 3000 has programmable
Repertory Dial
(Repdial) keys.
Repdial
keys
store destination numbers. Feature access codes cannot be stored under a
Repdial
key. External destinations up to 25 digits, including the trunk, trunk group, and LCR
access code, can be stored under a
Repdial
key as well as internal Call Group num-
bers. When operating the repdial key, the LED is not functional.
Programming of RepDial destinations and
DSS
keys must be done via HiPath 3000
Manager E in the case of non-display telephones.
DSS
keys can also be programmed
by the user on a display telephone.
Model-Specific Data for optiPoint key module
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiPoint 500 basic, optiPoint 500 standard,
optiPoint 500 advance, optiset E advance plus/comfort, op-
tiset E advance conference/conference, optiset E memory
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. number of key
modules per tele-
phone
44444
Max. number of key
modules per system
100 100 30 30 30
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-213
Features
Model-Specific Data for optiPoint Busy Lamp Field BLF (optiPoint BLF)
Requirements and Conditions
Max. number of pro-
grammable keys per
key module
16 16 16 16 16
Number of key mod-
ules per cabinet
50 ––––
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
HW requirements optiPoint 500 basic,
optiPoint 500 stan-
dard,
optiPoint 500 advance
–––
SW requirements V1.0 or later –––
Max. number of opti-
Point BLFs per tele-
phone
21–––
Max. number of opti-
Point BLFs per system
12 6 ––
Max. number of pro-
grammable keys per
optiPoint BLF
90 90 –––
Number of optiPoint
500 telephones with
optiPoint BLF
66–––
Subject Requirement or Condition
DSS This feature functions on optiset E and optiPoint 500 tele-
phones only.
Pick up A call can be picked up by pressing the DSS key for that
station.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-214 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9.3 Names
Definition
Users can assign names to each station, to each station group, and to each trunk
group. These names are displayed for internal calls (including calls via CorNet-N). If
an incoming call does not contain station number information (analog trunk), the trunk
group name is displayed. If the incoming call contains station number information (IS-
DN), this information is displayed. Refer to Section 3.4.7, Translate Station Numbers
to Names for System Speed Dialing, on page 3-120 for more information.
A memory telephone is required as Assistant T to enter characters of the alphabet.
Characters which can be used: all letters found on the memory telephone keyboard,
digits 0-9, * , #.
If no name has been assigned to an internal station, the number is displayed instead.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
letters in station and
group names
16 16 16 16 16
Maximum number of
letters in trunk group
names
10 10 10 10 10
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-215
Features
3.9.4 Automatic Callback When Free or Busy
Definition
Users can activate an automatic callback to a free or busy internal station. When the
callback destination finishes its call (when busy) or initiates an outgoing call, the sys-
tem calls back. First, the system calls the user who initiated the call. After that user
answers, the system calls back the station the initiating user wishes to speak with. For
more information on external callbacks, refer to Section 3.12.11 on page 3-308.
A telephone can initiate up to two Callback requests and be the destination for up to
two requests. Further requests beyond these limits are rejected.
Callback requests are deleted when:
the call is completed
the initiator cancels the request
the system deletes daily at 11:57 p.m. all callbacks that were initiated towards
other CorNet-N nodes
Callback requests can be set on internal stations and groups, but not to groups locat-
ed in other CorNet-N nodes.
Callback Requests Set on a Group
A request set on a hunt group is set on the first member of the group.
A request set on a Group Call is set on the first member of the group.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Callbacks per station 65 65 65 65 65
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-216 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Callback The callback is not deleted until the call is completed or the
initiating station deletes the callback.
Callback Every night at 11:57 p.m., all callbacks that are not within
the system (CorNet) are deleted.
Callback A callback can be set to an internal group (not DSS1, Cor-
Net-N, or QSig [not for U.S.). The callback is stored with
the first station in the group.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-217
Features
3.9.5 Entrance Telephone/Door Opener
Definition
With this feature, the system signals a defined user (entrance telephone ring destina-
tion) when the doorbell function activates. Lifting the handset connects the user at the
entrance telephone with the user at the ring destination. The ring destination user can
then activate the door opener from the ring destination if desired.
In addition, users can activate the door opener from the entrance telephone by enter-
ing a 5-digit PIN using a hand-held DTMF transmitter. Users can also set up a voice
connection to the entrance telephone.
The following settings can be implemented:
Opener: In this configuration, the door opener is set up via an analog interface;
the entrance telephone must be connected via an adapter.
DTMF: This setting specifies whether the door opener is activated by a DTMF
transmitter.
Call forwarding: This specifies determines whether the call from the entrance
telephone is forwarded to an external call forwarding destination.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Entrance telephone or ET/A or ET w/amplifier
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Max. no. of entrance
telephones
4 4 4 1 1
Subject Requirement or Condition
Entrance telephone
ring destination
If a call is already indicating camp-on at the entrance tele-
phone ring destination, an intercept is performed. If the in-
tercept station is also busy, the system searches all optiset
E and optiPoint 500 telephones.
Night answer Night answer is not taken into account in the signaling.
HiPath 3250 (not for
U.S.)
Door busy and messenger call are possible using the op-
tiset E control adapter.
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-218 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9.6 Speaker Call/Handsfree Answerback/Internal Paging (OptiPage)
Definition
A speaker call allows an internal connection to be set up without the called user lifting
the handset; the speaker on the called users telephone is activated. Handsfree an-
swerback without lifting the handset can be done via phones with a microphone.
Through lifting the handset, the call becomes a normal two-party call.
Speaker calls permit announcements to groups (paging zones) of up to 20 stations.
This feature is also called internal paging. In this case, group members have no
handsfree answerback option. If a member of a paging group goes off hook during a
page, the call then becomes a normal two-party call. Group members can include op-
tiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones.
Speaker calls and internal paging are possible with internal optiset E or optiPoint 500
telephones with speakers. They are activated by means of a key or a code. For each
extension, it is possible to configure whether the user can receive a speaker call.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with speaker
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Handsfree answer-
back
When you dial *96, the microphone is automatically acti-
vated for each speaker call. You can deactivate this func-
tion by dialing #96.
Do not disturb (DND) You cannot use this feature with stations that have activat-
ed DND.
Toggle, consultation
hold, transfer
You cannot use toggle, consultation hold, or transfer with
this feature.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-219
Features
3.9.7 Transfer from Announcement
This feature lets you make announcements to groups (paging zones). It is also known
as internal paging. Members of the group can answer the call handsfree.
The procedure is as follows:
A user answers an external call.
The user places a consultation call and begins the group announcement.
The system sets up a two-party call when another party lifts the handset or turns
on the speaker, and the party who answered the call hangs up. The remaining
group members are removed from the call.
Speaker calls and internal paging are available on internal optiset E or optiPoint 500
telephones with speakers. You can use a key or code to activate the feature, and you
can program the speaker call capability separately for each extension.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with speaker
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Handsfree answer-
back
When you dial *96, the microphone is automatically acti-
vated for each speaker call. You can deactivate this func-
tion by dialing #96.
Do not disturb You cannot use this feature with stations that have activat-
ed DND. However, an authorized caller can override do not
disturb, in which case a busy signal sounds for five sec-
onds. The user then receives a call (not a speaker call).
Toggle, consultation
hold, transfer
The toggle, consultation hold, and transfer features are not
available.
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-220 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9.8 Radio Paging Equipment (PSE) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Radio paging equipment can be used to transmit type-dependent voice announce-
ments or alphanumeric data (test messages) to users with portable radio receivers.
Users being sought can use a procedure to answer this call from any telephone.
Radio paging equipment (PSE) can be connected via analog interfaces, analog trunk
circuits, or a special module (TMOM for enhanced radio paging equipment in HiPath
3750 and HiPath 3700 only). There are two types of PSE:
Simple radio paging equipment
Enhanced radio paging equipment (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 only with
TMOM)
3.9.8.1 Simple Radio Paging Equipment/Simple PSE (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Simple PSE allows users to transmit voice announcements and numeric data to the
PSE user. One of the two types of message informs PSE stations of waiting calls. Us-
ers being sought can use a procedure to answer the call from any telephone.
Radio paging equipment can be the destination for call forwarding or group ringing; it
can also be a member of a group.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Analog ports
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Simple radio paging
equipment
Does not support expanded call processing characteristics
such as those available with enhanced radio paging equip-
ment.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-221
Features
3.9.8.2 Radio Paging Equipment via ESPA/Enhanced Radio Paging Equipment (Not for
U.S.)
Definition
Enhanced radio paging equipment also includes certain communications server func-
tions. It offers the following options:
Transmission of alphanumeric data
Automatic connection setup to the paging subscriber after answering
Automatic transmission of paging subscribers number
Storage of up to 15 paging and answer requests
Radio paging for internal and external calls
Waiting for callback answer with handset on or off hook
Selectable displays and ring and paging procedures (selected when entering the
paging request)
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in x––––
HW requirements TMOM ––––
SW requirements V1.0
or later
––––
Subject Dependency/Limitation
Voice call Voice calls are not possible.
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-222 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.9.9 Message Texts/Mailboxes/Message Waiting
Definition
Sending a message
Internal extensions can select a text message from an internal system message
list and send the message to any internal optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone
with display. Users can transmit these messages in the idle, ringing, or busy
state, or during a call. (During a call, the station number information is omitted.)
A station that can be reached via a CorNet-N tie trunk is also considered to be
an internal station. The initiating party can also be an analog voice mail system
or central voice mail server in the CorNet-N network. A separate, fixed text is
available for messages from these devices.
Receiving a message
The system indicates the presence of a message depending on the type of tele-
phone. The following applies to the default setting:
On optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones with display, a waiting message is
signaled via the display and a
Mailbox
key, if programmed. In addition, there
is acoustic signaling using a special dial tone.
On optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones without display, a message is sig-
naled by the
Mailbox
key. In addition, there is acoustic signaling using a spe-
cial dial tone.
(Not for U.S.) On special analog telephones with a mailbox LED (special
board), a waiting message is signaled via the LED (not a key). These exten-
sions must be configured accordingly. An audible signal also sounds, like on
analog telephones. To signal messages with the mailbox LED, set the PSUI
ring voltage (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700) to 75 V.
On analog telephones, a waiting message is signaled by a special dial tone
(HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3250, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300) or
by the announcement Message waiting (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700).
On mobile telephones, a waiting message is signaled by an advisory ring
and the mailbox symbol appearing on the screen.
You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to adjust the optic and acoustic signaling in
the following way:
If the flag Status display for info message is not set, the status display Display
infos is not visible until you scroll in the system menu.
Use the Plus Products flag Acoustic message signaling to set whether the sig-
naling on optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones and other telephones should use
the special dial tone or an announcement (only for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700)
or if no signaling should be done.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-223
Features
Callback
On telephones with display, a caller can retrieve information such as the senders
name and number, text message, date, and time using a dialog menu. The user
can then call back the sender of the message without entering a station number.
To activate callback on analog telephones, users must use a procedure code; on
optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones without a display, users can press a
Mailbox
key.
Deleting a message
The sender and receiver can use a dialog menu or a procedure code to delete
the message. Otherwise, the message is deleted only if it results in a call to the
station.
Central voice mail server
A station in a satellite communications server can program use call forwarding or
call forwardingno answer to send its calls to the central voice mail server. Calls
received are then indicated at the station via message waiting. External station
numbers cannot be programmed in the call management lists. For this reason, a
pseudo port should be configured as a PhoneMail® port for call forwarding to the
external voice mail server.
The default text messages are:
0 = Please callback
1 = Someone is waiting
2 = Appointment
3 = Urgent call
4 = Do not Disturb
5 = Fax waiting
6 = Dictation please
7 = Please come see me
8 = Please make copies
9 = Ready to depart
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection, by its own station
user.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-224 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Maximum number of
simultaneous texts
100 100 30 30 30
Maximum number of
characters in text
24 24 24 24 24
No. of message texts 10 10 10 10 10
Max. no. of messages
on optiset E or opti-
Point 500 telephone
with display
55555
Max. no. of messages
on mobile telephones
555––
Max. no. of messages
on optiset E or opti-
Point 500 telephone
without display or ana-
log telephone.
1
+ voice
mail mes-
sage
1
+ voice
mail mes-
sage
1
+ voice
mail mes-
sage
1
+ voice
mail mes-
sage
1
+ voice
mail mes-
sage
Subject Requirement or Condition
Message texts The texts are automatically deleted when a call is set up
between the two stations.
Message texts Telephones with alphanumeric keyboards can also be
used to enter individualized texts that are not stored.
Voice mail A separate text is available for voice mail. The maximum
number of texts is not affected by the system.
Special dial tone/
announcement
With HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, an announcement is
issued instead of a special dial tone.
France The country-specific default for France is to use the special
dial tone as the acoustic signaling for all telephones.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-225
Features
3.9.10 Advisory Messages
Definition
optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display can activate an advisory message
that has been configured in the system. When a user calls a station that has activated
this type of message, the advisory message appears on the callers display.
Messages can contain variable parameters. The user enters the parameters (such as
the time) when activating the feature. Users can use the numeric keypad on the tele-
phone to enter additional characters.
With an optiset E memory telephone, users can enter and send, but not store, an ad-
ditional, individualized message.
The message is also displayed at the initiators telephone so that co-workers are also
advised. 10 default system-wide advisory messages are provided. These can be
changed via administration, using Assistant T, HiPath 3000 Manager C, and HiPath
3000 Manager E.
This feature can be activated/deactivated via a DISA connection, by its own station
user or for another user with the aid of the feature Associated Services.
The
Flags
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway of HiPath
3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) status in-
formation. You can use the
Flags
screen to see if a station has activated an Advisory
Message or not.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of advisory
messages in system
10 10 10 10 10
Max. no of characters
in advisory message
24 24 24 24 24
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-226 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding With call forwarding, the telephone displays the advisory
message of the called station.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-227
Features
3.9.11 Internal Directory
Definition
On all optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display, users can view a directory
of all internal stations with their names and numbers. In addition, users can view en-
tries from the system speed-dialing facility (name, destination station number), to
search for and call the desired station. The name of the desired station is entered di-
rectly using the GSM procedure.
After selecting the Directory option from the menu, you can enter the name of the
party you want to reach directly with the GSM procedure. To do this, press the key
containing the letter you wish to access. Press the key once to access the first letter,
twice to access the second letter, and three times to access the third letter (the one
farthest to the right).
You can also program a key to provide access to the feature, or you can select either
Internal stations?
or
System speed dial
. Then you scroll through each name by se-
lecting
Next?
or scroll to and select the first letter of the wanted name. Selecting a
name automatically dials the destination.
Users of optiset E memory telephones use the keys on the keyboard:
Dial
and
Enter
(
Return
) key: dials the number beside the cursor.
Card
key: Retrieves entries from the highlighted name.
End
key: Closes the telephone directory.
Up
and
Down
keys: moves the cursor up or down.
HiPath 3000 Manager E allows you to define whether a station number will appear in
the directory for each station individually.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-228 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Electronic directory After selecting the
Directory
menu command, users can
enter the name of the desired station directly using the
GSM procedure.
To do this, press the key displaying the required letter. If the
letter is in the first position, press the key once. If it is in the
second position, press the key twice. If the letter is in the
third position (that is, the farthest to the right), press the
key three times.
All the letters in the name can be entered consecutively,
using this procedure. Of course, scrolling through the dia-
log keys is also possible.
Electronic notebook
(ENB)
If you activate the telephones local ENB, you cannot use
the internal directory feature.
System speed dialing If system speed dialing is selected, names are displayed
only if the telephone directory is activated.
Directory On telephones with a two-line display, groups are formed
for the search. In the case of optiset E or optiPoint 500 tele-
phones with ENB, the keyboard can be used for a search.
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-229
Features
3.9.12 Room Monitor
Definition
The room monitor feature can be used to monitor a room. All telephone types can be
used for this purpose. Only internal stations can use room monitoring.
When a user monitors a room, the room monitor telephone receives no call signaling,
and the call is immediately through-connected.
A system-wide flag must be set via HiPath 3000 Manager E only.
To monitor a room, monitored telephones without a microphone must have the hand-
set off-hook.
If an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone calls a station activated as a room monitor,
in the standard configuration the microphone on the calling optiset E or optiPoint 500
telephone is deactivated.
If a call is received by a monitoring station, camp on tone is heard at the monitoring
station, but not at the monitored station. The user must disconnect from the monitored
station call connection to answer the incoming call. The user can once again call the
monitored station at a later time. The feature is still active at the monitored station until
it goes on-hook.
The
Flags
screen is one of three screens in the
System Status
pathway of HiPath
3000 Manager E that provides station-specific (rather than system-specific) status in-
formation. You can use the
Flags
screen to see if a station has activated Room Mon-
itor or not.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Room monitor To monitor a room, telephones without a microphone must
have the handset off-hook (exception: optiset E and opti-
Point 500 telephones with speakerphone function).
Features for Internal Traffic
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-230 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Hunt group If the room monitor station is in a hunt group, the station is
not taken into account for incoming calls to the hunt group.
Analog trunks If you connect an external station by consultation hold to a
station that has activated room monitoring, the external
trunk must have a backward release criterion.
Room monitor If an optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone calls a station ac-
tivated as a room monitor, the speakerphone function on
the calling telephone is deactivated in the standard config-
uration.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Internal Traffi
c
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-231
Features
3.9.13 Editing the Telephone Number
Definition
This feature allows the user to edit the station number digits before the digit transmis-
sion; this is common with mobile telephones, among others.
The user can edit after entering the first digit. After entering a sequence of digits, the
user can edit it from right to left by pressing a key; each time the key is pressed, one
digit is deleted. The user first enters the complete correct sequence of digits and then
presses the confirm key or lifts the handset to start the digit transmission.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.2 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call waiting Call waiting during editing is possible because the tele-
phone is in the digit input state and is busy for incoming
traffic.
Consultation hold After a consultation hold, the telephone is in the digit input
state. This makes it possible to edit station number digits.
Tenant Service
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-232 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.10 Tenant Service
The tenant service feature is implemented using existing features. This means that it
is not necessary for users to explicitly configure subsystems.
Users can control permitted and barred connections between individual stations and
trunks via traffic restriction groups.
The functionality of all features remains unchanged.
Features in tenant service include:
Intercept
System number
Caller list
Busy override
DISA
Speaker call
Call detail recording
Hotline destinations
Text messages, advisory messages
Internal calls
Internal directory
CDB printout
Night answer
optiClient Attendant
Park slot
Prime Line
Traffic restriction groups
Voice mail
Toll restriction
Tenant Servic
e
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-233
Features
3.10.1 Tenant Service Configuration
Definition
The HiPath 3000 systems can be used as a tenant service, which allows it to be used
simultaneously by more than one customer. All features have the same functionality
for all customers.
However, certain resources must be divided among the tenants (customers). They
can be assigned to one, several, or all tenants. The resources to be divided are:
Stations
Trunk groups
PC-AC (optiClient Attendant)
Intercept position
Announcement devices, voice mail
Traffic restriction matrix (ITR matrix)
Door opener
Hotline
DISA trunks
Traffic restriction groups determine the ability of tenants to access each other.
Hotline destinations can be configured for each system.
A PC-AC can be assigned to each tenant.
Six MOH devices can be defined for six possible ITR groups. This means that the
analog interfaces used for connection are part of the ITR groups. Which MOH de-
vice is used depends on the ITR group of the station that places the call on hold.
You cannot use the logical port 0 as an MOH source.
Tenant Service
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-234 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Number of tenant ser-
vice systems
333––
Hotline destinations 6 6 1 ––
Announcement devic-
es
16 4 1 ––
MOH-devices 6 6 6 ––
Trunk groups 16 16 8 ––
Number of trunk group
keys per optiset E or
optiPoint 500 tele-
phone
666––
Max. number of en-
trance telephones
444––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call detail recording
central (CDRC)
Only one CDRC exists for all tenants.
Internal calls Internal calls are possible between stations in different
systems if allowed by the traffic restriction groups.
Prime Line Prime Line can be configured only for the entire system.
CDB printout The database can only be printed for the entire system.
Internal directory The internal directory displays the names of all stations
and speed-dialing numbers in the system.
Switch It is not possible to transfer undialed trunks.
Simplified dialing Simplified dialing is not possible.
Speed transfer Speed transfer is not possible.
Intercept Intercept can be configured only for the entire system.
Tenant Servic
e
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-235
Features
Tenant Users can configure a maximum of three different tenants.
System configuration The system configuration can be changed from only one
telephone (programming telephone).
Subject Requirement or Condition
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-236 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11 Other Features
3.11.1 Voice Channel Signaling Security
Definition
This feature prevents tones from being injected in the voice channel, so that data on
the voice channel are not corrupted. With this feature, no tones can be injected in the
voice channel, and the connection cannot be overridden. A station configured as a
fax machine automatically receives signaling security.
optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones can also be protected by programming the
feature Call Waiting Rejection in the database.
Callers will not be able to camp on and will continue to receive busy tone.
This feature can only be set via database. For optiset E and optiPoint 500 display tele-
phones, refer to the Requirements/Conditions table below for an alternative.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
S0This feature does not function with ISDN terminals.
Recalls Recalls are postponed until the stations are free.
Call waiting Call waiting tone can also be suppressed from optiset E
and optiPoint 500 telephones with display, using a proce-
dure (*87=Call waiting tone off; #87=Call waiting tone on).
This has no effect on display signaling.
Call hold A station on hold always has signaling security.
Conference If a station in a conference has activated
call waiting rejec-
tion
, an unprotected station can still be camped-on.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-237
Features
3.11.2 Date and Time Display
Definition
The system contains a real-time clock and a calendar. Each optiset E and optiPoint
500 telephone with display indicates the time and date information based on this
clock.
In the case of digital trunks (not for U.S.), the date and time are set automatically, pro-
vided that the information is transmitted from the central office (during the first outgo-
ing call). The system changes automatically from standard time to daylight savings
time (and vice versa).
When manually setting the time of day, observe the following:
after a system boot
The ISDN time always overwrites the time that was manually set after a system
boot when the first outgoing ISDN trunk call is made.
when the system is running
If the time that was manually set differs from the ISDN time that is received by
2 - 70 minutes, the system uses the ISDN time.
If the difference is < 2 minutes or > 70 minutes, the system uses the time that
was manually set.
If it is not possible to synchronize using the ISDN trunk, the switchover data can be
entered in a table that is internal to the system. Edit the table using HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E.
The day and month when daylight savings time should begin or end is specified for
each year. The system switches over, as appropriate, at 2 or 3 a.m.
The date can be displayed in the following formats:
Europe: 20.JUN 01
USA: JUN 20.01
International: 20 JUN 01
International 2: 20.06.01
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-238 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Date/time Changes can be made from the configuration station only.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-239
Features
3.11.3 Relays
Definition
HiPath 3000 provide control outputs (relays) on an optional control relay module. This
enables you to perform the following functions from any connected telephone by en-
tering codes:
Manual switch on and off
Timer-controlled switch
Door opener control
Connection-controlled entrance telephone amplifier
Door busy display
Night bell
Announcement device start and stop control
External music on hold (MOH) control
second ringer simulation
simulation of call charge pulses
station active
The optional control relay modules STRB (with HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350) and
STRBR (with HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300) can be implemented with four control in-
puts and four outputs each for functions such as monitoring, alarm, control and ad-
justment. This can be used in security systems or Property Management Systems
(PMS). A control relay module can be connected for each system (HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300). The relay card REAL which provides four
control outputs is available for HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
The signal input function (control input) is triggered by closing any of the external
floating contacts. The external electric circuit is supplied by the control relay module
and electrically isolated from the system controller by means of an optocoupler.
The relays can be controlled via codes from every connected telephone and remotely
via the trunk line (DISA) by the station user associated with the relay function or for
with the aid of the feature Associated Services.
Assigning Functions to the Actuators (Relays)
No function type
The relevant actuator is either not operating or is entered as a common ringer un-
der
Call management, Call destination lists
.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-240 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Manually on and off type
The relay can be activated or deactivated for switching purposes by means of the
codes
Activate or deactivate selected switch
. In the case of key terminals this
function can also be programmed on one key. A specific station, a group or all
stations can be allocated to this relay type by selecting
NONE
. For this relay type,
shutdown can be delayed if a value greater than 0 is entered in the
Switching time
field. The switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
Automatic off after timeout type
The relay can be activated or deactivated as a time switch by means of the code
Activate selected switch
(see above). For key terminals this function can also be
programmed on a key. A specific station, a group or all stations can be allocated
to this relay type by selecting
NONE
. The switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
Door busy indicator type
The relay is activated if the allocated station ceases to be in the idle condition.
This means that the handset has been picked up, the loudspeaker is activated or
the extension is being called. The relay is deactivated when the allocated station
returns to the idle condition. This means that the handset has been replaced, the
loudspeaker has been deactivated and the extension is not being called. The re-
lay can also be activated directly by means of the code
Activate/deactivate se-
lected switch
. For system telephones, this function can also be programmed on
a key. If the relay was activated by means of a code or a key, the status of the
allocated station is ignored and the relay can only be deactivated again by means
of a code or a key.
Practical uses: Door busy indicator Do not disturb, Meeting, Conference, PC
connection for data transmission (power management). A specific station must
be allocated to this relay type. In the case of this relay type, shutdown can be de-
layed if a value greater than 0 has been entered in the switching time field. The
switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
Second ringer simulation type
The relay is activated for the allocated station if it is being called. This relay is de-
activated when the called party answers or the call is terminated. This relay is not
clocked. A specific station must be allocated to this relay type. In the case of this
relay type, shutdown can be delayed if a value greater than 0 has been entered
in the `switching time' field. The switching time is a multiple of 3 seconds.
Door opening system type
See Automatic after timeout type. The text
Door opening system
is displayed for
the allocated terminals.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-241
Features
Doorphone amplifier type
The relay is activated when connected to the doorphone. The relay is deactivated
when disconnected from the doorphone or entrance telephone/loudspeaker. This
makes it possible to control a doorphone amplifier so that it is only activated when
required. A doorphone or the loudspeaker port must be allocated to this relay
type.
Music-on-hold type
The relay is activated if at least one station or a line in the system is not in the
idle condition. The relay is deactivated if all stations and lines in the system are
in the idle condition.
Practical application: Activation of a tape device, CD player, PC connection
power management etc.
NONE
must be entered as allocated station for this relay
type, and it must only occur once in the system. In the case of this relay type,
shutdown can be delayed if a value greater than 0 has been entered for the
Switching time
field. The switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
Station active type
The relay is activated if the allocated station is active. This means that the hand-
set has been picked up or the loudspeaker has been activated. The relay is de-
activated if the allocated station resumes the idle condition. This means that the
handset has been replaced or the loudspeaker has been deactivated. The relay
can also be activated directly by means of the code
Activate/deactivate selected
switch
. For system telephones, this function can also be programmed on a key.
If the relay was activated by means of a code or a key, the status of the allocated
station is ignored and the relay can only be deactivated again by means of a code
or a key. A specific station must be allocated to this relay type. In the case of this
relay type, shutdown can be delayed if a value greater than 0 has been entered
in the
Switching time
field. The switching time is a multiple of 100ms.
Assigning Actuator Names
Any names (up to 16 characters) can be assigned to the actuators to be administered.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements REAL STRB / STRBR ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-242 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
DISA Relays can be controlled from the outside via trunk access.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-243
Features
3.11.4 Sensors
Definition
HiPath 3000 support control inputs (sensors) via an optional control relay module.
When a sensor is activated, the assigned station is called automatically. After the sta-
tion answers the call, a message can be played from an announcement device. The
signal input function activates when an external floating contact closes. Optocouplers
provide electrical isolation between the external circuit and the system controller.
The sensors can initiate the following functions:
Distinctive ringing on telephones
Message display on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display
Analysis of announcement device start and stop signals
Answering machine control
Automatic dialing with a predefined telephone number (internal number, group
ringing or external destination call number)
Activation of the following services for a STN (with
code
+
STN
):
Actuator on/off
Do-not-disturb feature on/off
Call forwarding on/off
Codelock on/off
Send message texts
Withdraw message texts
Night service on/off
Ring transfer on/off
Direct activation of the following services (without
code
+
STN
):
Actuator on/off
Use speed dialing system
Error signaling; the following types are possible:
Display of programmable error message (sensor name, max. 10 characters:
for example, Temp-Alarm) on a specific optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone
(no acoustic signaling)
Display of calls on a specific optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with error
message during call (destination station number)
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-244 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Error entry in error history (entry in error memory = activated)
Destination Call Number
An associated analog port is programmable for the sensors. This port is called by the
system once a setup signal has been received. The calling party then overrides this
connection. A recorded announcement can be activated via an answering machine
connected to this port, which informs the dialed station of the response of the sensor.
An analog port programmed in this way cannot be contacted from the outside.
If an external call number has been programmed for a sensor, but an analog port has
not, the external connection will be established but an audible signal in relation to the
response of the sensor is not transmitted. However, if necessary, the called STN can
identify the origin of the call on the basis of the call number (CLIP).
Message Texts Box Control Data
Input of the control string with a maximum of 24 characters for the Phonemail system
(mailbox call number). If the connection has been established, the control string is
transmitted to the recorded announcement port. If a recorded announcement port is
not available, the control string is transmitted to the destination.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
HW requirements STRB / STRBR ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Special ring If the notified station is an internal station, a special ring
sounds.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-245
Features
3.11.5 Multilingual Text Output
Definition
The language for display messages can be selected system-wide or for a specific sta-
tion only. Depending on the particular system, the following languages are available:
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300
(four fixed and four variable languages):
Dutch*, English (UK), English (US), French, German, Italian*, Portu-
guese*,Spanish*
HiPath 3250 with SBS, HiPath 3150 with SBS (two fixed and two variable lan-
guages):
English (UK), French*, German, Italian*
HiPath 3250 with SBSCO, HiPath 3150 with SBSCS (four fixed and four variable
languages):
Dutch*, English (UK), English (US), French, German, Italian*, Portuguese*,
Spanish*,
The languages marked * are variable and can be replaced (overloaded) by one of
the available languages from the list below. This is possible only with HiPath 3000
Manager E.
You cannot reload an individual text language. Variable languages that should not be
replaced (overloaded) must therefore always be specified separately. It is not possible
to reload a fixed language once it is already there.
Available languages: Catalan, Chinese, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English (UK), English
(US), Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hungarian, Italian, Latvian, Lithua-
nian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Russian, Serbo-Croatian, Slovak, Slovenian,
Spanish, Swedish, Telekom (Germany), Turkish.
Note the following with regard to system-wide and station-specific language settings:
Default language setting
You set the language when you enter the country initialization code during sys-
tem booting. The parameters for Germany are the defaults.
If the APS does not contain the local language set during country initialization, it
uses German as the default language until you replace one of the variable lan-
guages in the APS with the local language.
Changing the language setting system-wide
You can access system administration by entering a code or using the service
menu on the first two telephones with display in the system. Select the desired
language from the service menu to switch all stations to the new language.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-246 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Changing the language setting for an individual station
You can change language of individual stations only from the first two stations
with display in the system. To change the language of a station, specify the sta-
tion in the service menu and the language to be used.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
System administration The following languages are not available for system ad-
ministration: Czech, Serbo-Croatian, Slovenian, and Turk-
ish.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-247
Features
3.11.6 Associated Dialing
Definition
With a PC, users can have the system set up a voice connection from one station (typ-
ically their own, but not necessarily so) to another station within the system. With an-
alog telephones, the PC uses a dialing aid interface (Teleint in Germany). Another op-
tion is to connect a PC to an ISDN S0 application bus.
Any authorized station in the system can execute associated dialing for another sta-
tion. The user defines the station number of the destination station in the PC address
book and activates dialing. The PC seizes the ISDN S0 application bus and transmits
the station number to the system using an ISDN message.
The user accesses the function by dialing a code and specifying the station for which
a number should be dialed. The system then interprets this information as though the
specified station were dialing.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Trunk group Depending on the system configuration, you may have to
dial a trunk group code in order to seize a trunk.
Call forwarding A call waiting operation activated on the station for which
the number is to be dialed is not carried out.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-248 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11.7 Associated Services
Definition
An authorized user can activate or deactivate services for any other station in the sys-
tem using a procedure. Authorized users initiate access by entering a code and the
station number that they want to activate or deactivate. The system behaves the
same as if the initiating station were activating the feature for itself.
With this feature, users can control the following:
Do not disturb
Call forwarding
Telephone lock
Group ringing
Advisory message
Hunt group
Reset services
Actuators
Night answer
Timed reminder
All features set by another station can be deactivated from the station on which the
feature was set. If the destination station has the feature Telephone lock active, ser-
vices cannot be activated at that telephone. Likewise, a feature which was activated
at a telephone before the telephone was locked and is still active, cannot be deacti-
vated with the Associated Services feature.
The destination station must first be authorized in database (where this applies), in
order to use the feature/function.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-249
Features
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
ISDN terminal From an ISDN terminal, dial the substitute code (75) for the
asterisk (*).
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-250 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11.8 Display Number of Stations with Direct Trunk Access (for Austria
Only)
Definition
You can use system administration to display the number of stations with direct trunk
access available in the system. This includes all stations currently in operation which
have at least outward restricted trunk access.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Display Available in Austria only
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-251
Features
3.11.9 Services in the Talk State
Definition
During a call, a station can activate services or perform administrative tasks in the
system via system administration.
Users activate this feature by pressing the
Program/Service
key or, with a non-display
or an analog telephone, by pressing the
Consultation
key or hook switch flash.
The features that can be activated during a call are identified in each of the descrip-
tions.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call forwarding Call forwarding can be activated during a call.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-252 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11.10 Reset Activated Features
Definition
Users can reset all of the features currently set on the telephones by entering a code.
The following features can be reset:
Call forwarding
Send/cancel messages
Advisory message
Group ringing
Hunt group
Station number suppression
Silent camp-on
Do not disturb
Ringer cutoff
Timed reminder
Cancel all callbacks
The system can also reset the above features per telephone from a local or remote
location using the HiPath 3000 Manager E administration tool. The administrator first
downloads the information to HiPath 3000 Manager E and working off-line can selec-
tively view the state of each of the features activated on each telephone. In HiPath
3000 Manager E, the administrator can reset all these features on any telephone and
upload the file to the HiPath 3000 system.
The following table illustrates the features that can be reset from the station by dialing
the access code #0, individually.
Station HiPath 3000 Manager E
Call Forward Call Forward on
Received messages
Advisory message Answer text
Group Ringing
Leave Hunt Group Hunt Group
Caller ID suppression Suppress Calling ID
Call Waiting Tone Call Waiting Tone
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-253
Features
The additional features in the HiPath 3000 Manager E
System Status - Flags
screen:
Room Monitor, Lock Code, Call Connection and Direct answering will not be deacti-
vated.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Do Not Disturb Do Not Disturb
Ringer cutoff Disable incoming ring
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Send messages You can also use
Reset all services
to delete received
messages.
Sensors/send mes-
sages
A warning can be sent via a sensor to a station in the form
of a text message (send message) and then reset by a dif-
ferent relay.
Cancel all callbacks Access the procedure from
Reset all services
.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-254 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11.11 Relocate (Hoteling)
Definition
This is an expansion of the Relocate feature found in V1.0 or earlier.
The new Relocate feature allows an optiset E and optiPoint 500 station to use a pro-
cedure to change the assignment between the physical telephone port and the logical
station data (user profile).
Example: the telephone used by station 220 is connected to the second port of the
SLMO board in slot 01 (220 = 0102) and the telephone used by station 330 is on the
fourth port of the SLMO board in slot 03 (330 = 0304). After executing the relocate
function, the station data belonging to station 220 is assigned to the fourth port of the
SLMO board in slot 03 (220 = 0304) and the data belonging to station 330 is assigned
to the second port of the SLMO board in slot 01 (330 = 0102).
You can also use Relocate on preconfigured SLMO or SLU boards, which means on
boards that are not physically present, and on SLMO or SLU ports that do not have
telephones connected.
Examples: The feature is useful in companies that have a large number of field rep-
resentatives. These staff members are provided with a pool of workstations in the
company headquarters. Furthermore, a separate station configuration (station num-
ber, key programming, trunk access, etc.) is defined for each staff member. To carry
out work at the company headquarters, the staff member selects a workstation and
activates the Relocate feature on the accompanying optiset E or optiPoint 500 tele-
phone. This provides him or her with his or her personal user profile (station configu-
ration).
A customer has 24 hour help desk operation that does not use UCD. Each desk po-
sition will have three different users each day. With the Relocate feature enhancement
a user will be able to relocate a virtual port configuration to any desk that is available.
This will then allow the user to receive calls to the DID numbers assigned to that user.
Danger
In systems with the E911 emergency service activated for the USA (see Section
3.6.19 on Page 3-178), you are not allowed to use the Relocate feature if the system
has more than one Location Identification Number (LIN).
You may only exchange user profiles of the same type of optiset E or optiPoint 500
(key layout).
If you exchange user profiles from different types of optiset E or optiPoint 500s, in-
dividually programmed key functions on the basic device are replaced with the de-
fault values.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-255
Features
An additional application of this Relocate feature would be if two users decide to
change desk locations and both users share the same phone types. The users can
easily perform the Relocate operation without the assistance of a Telecommunica-
tions engineer.
If you want to use the Relocate feature, you must enable it system-wide. You can carry
out one of the following steps on the optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone to activate
it (the telephone lock PIN is not required if the PIN is set to the default 00000.):
Enter Relocate code + internal number of the destination station + telephone
lock PIN
Start the service menu, enter Relocate + internal number of the destination sta-
tion + telephone lock PIN
Press the appropriate programmed key and enter the internal number of the des-
tination station + telephone lock PIN
After you have entered the destination station number, no other stations may use the
feature until the procedure has completed. When executing the exchange, both tele-
phones involved are reset.
The display of the new station number (display Stn. number: XXXXX) on both tele-
phones signals that the feature has executed successfully.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 SMR-J and later
V1.2 SMR-E and later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Host-client configura-
tion (master-slave
configuration)
You can only initiate the feature on optiset E or optiPoint
500 host (master) telephones in the idle state.
The data from any client (slave) stations that may be con-
nected will also be exchanged. The affected client (slave)
telephones are reset during the execution of the exchange,
just as the hosts (master) are.
Assistant T It is not possible to execute the feature on telephones that
have programming authorization.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-256 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
UCD You cannot execute the feature if a UCD agent is logged on
to one of the (host (master)) telephones involved.
DISA You cannot execute the feature over DISA/DISA internal.
Associated services If the user confirms the feature with associated services
(default: *83<DID>#9419) the call does not follow the call
management for non-physical ports.
It is not possible to activate the feature via associated ser-
vices.
Physically not avail-
able stations
For incoming calls to stations, which are no longer physical-
ly available, the call follows the call management (CFW to
PM instead dropping the call to the intercept). This mecha-
nism is available 1 minute after proceeding with this feature
or 5 minutes after a system hard restart.
Display status infor-
mation
If a relocate session was successful the user will see in the
optiset E or optiPoint 500 display status information. Higher
prior display texts like View Messages cover up the status
indication.
Key LED The feature access can be set up on a key of an optiset E
or optiPoint 500 station. The LED of this key will be never
used.
Code lock Hoteling is possible with code lock active. To delete the sta-
tus indication, during code lock active, is possible.
Activation of relocate Activation of the feature is only possible if the station is idle.
Frst two SLMO or
SLU hardware ports
The feature cannot be accessed on the first two SLMO or
SLU hardware ports.
optiClient You cannot execute the feature with optiClient.
IP device You cannot execute the feature with any IP device.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-257
Features
3.11.12 Automatic Wake-up System/Timed Reminders
Definition
Each user can program an appointment. When activated, a timed reminder is issued
at the scheduled time. The appointment can be programmed for a single reminder
(once within a 24-hour period) or for regularly scheduled daily reminders.
The time format is four-digits. The first two digits are the hour, and the second two
digits are the minutes. A 12-hour clock mode is supported for the U.S.: users enter
the four digits and then select
am
(key 2) or
pm
(key 7). The default is
am
. The mode
for all other countries is the 24-hour clock system.
The default timed reminder sounds for 20 seconds and will repeat a maximum of five
repeats at 1-minute intervals. The timed reminder is cleared automatically as soon as
the user lifts the handset or presses the speaker button, or after the fifth repeat (num-
ber of repeats is configurable). Alternatively, a programmed timed reminder can be
canceled using a procedure. Display telephones also support queries.
The duration of signaling, the time between signals, and the number of repeats are
configurable.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Maximum no. of timed
reminders (system-
wide)
50 50 50 50 50
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-258 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Requirements and Conditions
Subject Requirement or Condition
Appointments Standard analog telephones, optiset E entry, optiset E ba-
sic, optiPoint 500 entry, and cordless telephones support
only programming of non-repeating (once only) appoint-
ments
Timed reminders A timed reminder which is due but cannot be signaled (us-
er busy, for example), is postponed until the next cycle.
Influence of other ac-
tive features
Activation of other features such as call forwarding, do not
disturb, group ringing, ringer cutoff has no effect on timed
reminder, in other words the timed reminder is always is-
sued at the telephone at which it was activated.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-259
Features
3.11.13 Delete All Station Numbers
Definition
This feature allows you to delete all station numbers quickly and easily (refer to Table
3-4).
Using this feature, it is much easier to customize the default numbering plan when in-
stalling a new system or retain an existing numbering plan when replacing a non-Si-
emens system.
Table 3-4 HiPath 3000Deleting Station Numbers
Type of Number Default Station Numbers Delete
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3250
HiPath 3150
HiPath 3300
Station numbers 100-349
500-749
100-278
500-687
11-30
51-70
Yes
Station DID numbers 100-349
500-749
100-287
500-687
11-30
51-70
Yes
Trunk numbers 7801-7920 7801-7860 801-816 Yes
Trunk group codes
(external codes)
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
No
80-84 80-84 82-88 Yes
850-859 850-859 --- Yes
USBS station number
Internal & DID
891 891 891 Yes
IMOD station number
Internal & DID
890 890 890 Yes
Digital modem
Internal & DID
879 879 77 & 879 Yes
Group numbers
Internal & DID
350-499 350-499 31-50 Yes
Internal attendant code
(intercept position)
9 = World
0 = U.S.
9 = World
0 = U.S.
9 = World
0 = U.S.
Yes
DID attendant code
(intercept station)
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
0 = World
9 = U.S.
No
Substitution for "*" 75 75 75 Yes
Substitution for "#" 76 76 76 Yes
Service codes *xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
*xxx
#xxx
No
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-260 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-261
Features
3.11.14 Team/Top
Definition
Team/Top is based on MULAP lines, which are generally looped via several tele-
phones. These telephones are combined in a MULAP group that has only one station
number in the system (for more information, refer to Section 3.11.14.3).
3.11.14.1 Team Configuration
Example of a Team with Two Members
Figure 3-8 Example of a Team with Two Members
MULAP 2 with
No. 202
Tel. A with No. **201 Tel. B with No. **202
0 0
MULAP 1 with
No. 201
DSS
Key
Te l . B
DSS
Key
Te l . A
Group Call On/Off
MULAP 201
Programmable
DSS Telephone B
MULAP 202
Programmable
Group Call On/Off
MULAP 202
Programmable
DSS Telephone A
MULAP 201
Programmable
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-262 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The Team configuration in Figure 3-8 includes the following components:
MULAP 1 and MULAP 2: MULAPs (basic MULAP groups) that appear on both
Telephone A and Telephone B.
DSS keys: Telephone A to Telephone B and Telephone B to Telephone A.
A group call key allows you to activate or deactivate incoming MULAP call signaling.
Table 3-5 Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set)
(Not for U.S.)
Operation Tel. A
M1
Tel. A
DSS Key B
Tel. B
M1
Tel. B
DSS Key A
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation, exclusive, common);
XXX = being called; XXXX = ringing
Tel. B is talking on M1 X X X
Tel. B presses DSS Tel. A key X XXXX XX X
Tel. B performs unscreened
transfer to Tel. A (1)
XXXX XXX XXX
or
Tel.A answers (2) X XXXX
Tel. B performs screened
transfer to Tel. A (3)
XXX
1) Tel. B performs unscreened transfer; call is transferred to M1.
2) Tel. A answers and could answer the call on hold on M1 by call pickup (menu).
3) Tel. B performs screened transfer to Tel. A and Tel. A continues to conduct the call on M1.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-263
Features
Table 3-6 Transfer in Team (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for
U.S. Only)
Operation Tel. A
M1
Tel. A
DSS Key B
Tel. B
M1
Tel. B
DSS Key A
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation, exclusive, common);
XXX = being called; XXXX = ringing
Tel. B is talking on M1 X X X
Tel. B presses DSS Tel. A key
(1)
X XXXX XX X
Tel. A answers (2) X X XX X
Tel. B goes on-hook (3) XX XX
Tel. A retrieves M1 (4) X XX
1) Tel. B switches lines (exclusive hold), switches to the local station number and calls Tel. A under
the local station number. M1 continues to be signaled as busy on Tel. A.
2) Tel. A can answer only by going off-hook or pressing the Tel. B DSS key. Tel. A then conducts
the call under the local station number.
3) If Tel. B goes on-hook, the connection to Tel. A is released and M1 is placed on common hold.
4) Tel. A can retrieve the held call by pressing M1.
Table 3-7 TeamSequence of Operations for Consultation Hold on Second
Line
Tel. A M1 M2 Explanation
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation,
exclusive, common);
XXX = being called; XXXX = ringing
Call on M1 X -
Consultation hold XX - Dial tone
Presses M2 - XX M1 is released, M2 is placed on consul-
tation hold, dial tone remains.
Call on M1 X -
Ringing on M2 X XXXX If ringing for MULAP 2 is activated on
Tel. A, Tel. A hears an advisory ring.
Consultation hold XX XXXX Dial tone
If ringing for MULAP 2 is activated on
Tel. A, Tel. A hears an advisory ring.
Presses M2 - XX M1 is released, consultation call on M2.
Call on M1 X -
Switches to M2 XX X Dial tone
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-264 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Example of a Team with Eight Members
Call on M2 XX X
Consultation hold XX XX Dial tone
Presses M1 XX - M2 is released, consultation call on M1.
Tel. B DSS Key A M2 Explanation
Conducts call with
Tel. A
X - Tel. A was called by means of DSS
key A.
Consultation hold XX - Dial tone
Presses M2 XX XX Consultation call on M21, dial tone re-
mains.
1 Because of dual signaling, DSS key A continues to indicate call on hold (state of local station num-
ber is always signaled as well).
Figure 3-9 Example of a Team with Eight Members
Table 3-7 TeamSequence of Operations for Consultation Hold on Second
Line
Tel. A M1 M2 Explanation
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation,
exclusive, common);
XXX = being called; XXXX = ringing
MULAP 1
Te l . H
0
Te l . G
0
Te l . E
0
Te l . F
0
Te l . A
0
Te l . B
0
Te l . D
0
Te l . C
0
MULAP 8
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-265
Features
Figure 3-10 Team with Eight Members: Default Key Assignments for Tel. A on
key module
The following options are available for assigning Team keys using HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E:
No key assignment
Assignment to first or second key module
A key module is automatically added (refer to example in Figure 3-10). If appli-
cable, existing keys are overwritten.
Assignment to first free keys
Free keys on the telephone and any existing key modules are used. If no keys
are available, key modules are added. Key assignment sequence for Team: Lo-
cal MULAP, Group Call key, other MULAPs, DSS keys.
DSS Tel. H
DSS Tel. B
Group Call On/Off
DSS Tel. G
DSS Tel. F
DSS Tel. D
DSS Tel. C
DSS Tel. E
MULAP 8
MULAP 2
MULAP 1
MULAP 7
MULAP 6
MULAP 4
MULAP 3
MULAP 5
Mikrofon ein/aus
Service
Wahlwiederhol.
Lautsprecher
Release
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-266 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Assistant T
Teams should normally be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E. Configuration
using Assistant T is possible only to a limited extent.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements ––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
Team/Top configura-
tions
500 50 10 10 10
Maximum number of
stations (members) in
a Team/Top configura-
tion
10 10 8 8 8
Maximum number of
telephones in a Team/
Top configuration
10 10 8 8 8
Maximum number of
MULAPs per tele-
phone
32 32 10 10 10
Subject Requirement or Condition
Manually configured
basic MULAP group
Members of a basic MULAP group can use key program-
ming to
Configure a MULAP key for the basic MULAP group.
Configure DSS keys to other members.
Program a Group Call key.
Universal Call Distri-
bution (UCD)
You cannot use MULAPs in the universal call distribution
system.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-267
Features
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
HiPath 3000 Manager E can be used to configure a default Team (Team/Top mask).
Members can be added to the team by drag and drop. The basic MULAP group(s)
and DSS keys are configured automatically. The basic MULAP groups are assigned
the station numbers of the primary station and the primary station is assigned a pseu-
do station number (examples: 4711 becomes **4711, 12345 becomes **2345,
654321 becomes **4321).
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step Action
1. Configure team (default)
Options
2. Incoming calls
3. Team/Top
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-268 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.11.14.2 Top Configuration
Example of a Top Configuration with One Executive and One Secretary
This Top configuration includes the following components:
Executive MULAP 201 with an executive and executive CMI as executives and
with a secretary as member.
Basic MULAP 202 with a secretary as primary station and an executive and ex-
ecutive CMI as members.
DSS keys: Secretary to executive (executive CMI) and executive to secretary.
Ring transfer keys: For controlling incoming MULAP call signaling. The default
setting for the ring transfer key is deactivated (LED off). Calls are signaled on
the secretary.
Figure 3-11 Example of Top with One Executive and One Secretary
Basic MULAP
(Secr. MULAP)
with No. 202
Exec. with No. **201 Secr. with No. **202
0 0
Exec. MULAP
with No. 201
Exec. CMI with No. 77801
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Secr. MULAP 202
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP
Exec. MULAP 201
DSS Secretary
DSS Executive
Group Call On/Off
Programmable
Secr. MULAP 202
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP
Exec. MULAP 201
Programmable
0
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-269
Features
In addition, incoming MULAP call signaling can be activated or deactivated by means
of a group call key (on non-executive telephones only). Ring transfer has priority,
meaning that the group call key is activated only when ring transfer is deactivated.
Table 3-8 Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Not Set) (Not
for U.S.)
Operation Executive Telephone Exec.
CMI
Mobile
Tel.
Secretary Telephone
Exec.
MULAP
Secr.
MULAP
DSS Key
Secretary
Secr.
MULAP
Exec.
MULAP
DSS Key
Executive
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation, exclusive, common); XXX = being called;
XXXX = ringing
Secr. is talking on exec. MULAP X X X
Secretary presses DSS Execu-
tive key (1)
X XXXX XXXX XX X
Secretary performs unscreened
transfer to exec. or exec. CMI (2)
XXXX XXXX XXX XXX
or
Executive answers (3) X X XX X
Secretary performs screened
transfer to executive (4)
XXX
1) Call signaled on executive MULAP and executive CMI.
2) Secretary performs unscreened transfer; call is transferred to executive MULAP.
3) Executive answers. Executive could also answer the held call on executive MULAP by call pickup (menu).
4) Secretary performs screened transfer to exec. and exec. continues to conduct the call on exec. MULAP.
Table 3-9 Transfer in Top (Switch Lines for DSS System Option Set) (for U.S.
Only)
Operation Executive Telephone Exec.
CMI
Mobile
Tel.
Secretary Telephone
Exec.
MULAP
Secr.
MULAP
DSS Key
Secr.
Secr.
MULAP
Exec.
MULAP
DSS Key
Executive
X = busy; XX = hold (consultation, exclusive, common); XXX = being called;
XXXX = ringing
Secr. is talking on exec. MULAP X X X
Secretary presses DSS Execu-
tive key (1)
X XXXX XXXX XX X
Executive answers X X XX X
Secretary hangs up after execu-
tive answers (2)
XX XX X
Executive retrieves executive (3) X X X
1) Secretary switches lines; executive is placed on exclusive hold; call signaled on exec. MULAP and exec. CMI.
2) Secretary goes on-hook; connection between exec. and secr. is released. Executive is placed on hold.
3) Executive can retrieve held call on executive MULAP.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-270 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Example of Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries
Figure 3-12 Example of Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries
The following options are available for assigning Top keys using HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E:
No key assignment
Assignment to first or second key module
A key module is automatically added (refer to examples in Figure 3-13 and Fig-
ure 3-14). If applicable, existing keys are overwritten.
Assignment to first free keys
Free keys on the telephone and any existing key modules are used. If no keys
are available, key modules are added. Key assignment sequence for Top: DSS
Executive 1, Exec. MULAP 1, Ring Transfer Exec. MULAP 1, DSS Secretary 1
(on executive telephone) or Group Call (on secretary telephone), DSS Execu-
tive 2, Exec. MULAP 2, etc.
Exec. 2
0
Executive MULAP 1
Secretary MULAP 1
Executive MULAP 2
Secretary MULAP 2
Exec. 1
0
Secr. 2
0
Secr. 1
0
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-271
Features
Bild 3-13 Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assign-
ments for Executive 1 on key module
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 2
DSS Executive 2
Programmable
Programmable
DSS Secretary 2
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 2
Secr. MULAP 2
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 1
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
DSS Secretary 1
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 1
Secr. MULAP 1
Mikrofon ein/aus
Service
Wahlwiederhol.
Lautsprecher
Release
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-272 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Figure 3-14 Top with Two Executives and Two Secretaries: Default Key Assign-
ments for Secretary 1 on key module
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 2
DSS Executive 2
Programmable
Programmable
DSS Secretary 2
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 2
Secr. MULAP 2
Programmable
Exec. MULAP 1
DSS Executive 1
Programmable
Programmable
Group Call On/Off
Ring Transfer
Exec. MULAP 1
Secr. MULAP 1
Mikrofon ein/aus
Service
Wahlwiederhol.
Lautsprecher
Release
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Programmable
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-273
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Maximum number of
Team/Top configura-
tions
50050101010
Maximum number of
stations (members) in
a Team/Top configura-
tion
10 10 8 8 8
Maximum number of
telephones in a Team/
Top configuration
10 10 8 8 8
Maximum number of
MULAPs per tele-
phone
32 32 10 10 10
Subject Requirement or Condition
Manually configured
executive MULAP
group
Members of an executive MULAP group can use key pro-
gramming to
Configure a MULAP key for the executive MULAP
group.
Configure DSS keys to other members.
Program a Group Call key.
Program a ring transfer key for each executive MULAP
group.
Note:
In an executive MULAP group, the executive should pro-
gram a DSS key to the secretary (station number) and the
secretary should program a DSS key to the executive (sta-
tion number).
Executive as primary
station
An executive can also be a primary station in a basic MU-
LAP group but can be defined as an executive only in an
executive MULAP group.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-274 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Executive ring If an executive in the executive MULAP group calls a non-
executive in the local executive MULAP group, the call is
signaled by a special, acoustic executive ring.
Group call key, incom-
ing MULAP call signal-
ing
In the executive MULAP group, incoming MULAP call
signaling can be administered only for non-executives.
Executives cannot configure a group call key (for acti-
vating and deactivating MULAP call signaling) for the
executive MULAP group.
If necessary, the ringer cutoff function can be used to
deactivate the acoustic ring on an executive tele-
phone. An advisory ring is issued.
Non-executives (secretaries) can configure a group
call key for activating and deactivating MULAP call sig-
naling. Ring transfer has priority, meaning that the
group call key is activated only when ring transfer is
deactivated. Signaling on the two keys is separate.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-275
Features
Call transfer key, in-
coming MULAP call
signaling
All members of an executive MULAP group can pro-
gram a local ring transfer key for each executive MU-
LAP. A secretary with multiple executives has multiple
executive MULAPs and, therefore, multiple ring trans-
fer keys.
The default setting for the ring transfer key is deacti-
vated (LED off). Calls are signaled on the secretary.
When the ring transfer key is pressed (LED on), MU-
LAP call signaling is transferred within the executive
MULAP group. Executives are signaled with MULAP
call signaling and non-executives are signaled visually.
Calls between members of the executive MULAP
group or within a Top are not affected by ring transfer:
Executives in the executive MULAP group always ring.
Calls to another executive MULAP group always take
ring transfer into account. Exceptions: Calls set up by
means of a DSS key.
Ring transfer can be activated or deactivated using a
Code: Analog telephones, CMI telephones, op-
tiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones.
Afterwards, the MULAP number must be suffix-di-
aled.
Menu (after dialing the ring transfer code): CMI
telephones, optiset E and optiPoint 500 tele-
phones with display.
The ring transfer state is not indicated by a special dial
tone.
Ring transfer has priority, meaning that the group call
key is activated only when ring transfer is deactivated.
Signaling on the two keys is separate.
Conversion to V1.0 Top functions (executive/secretary) from earlier releases of
Hicom 150 E Office (such as Rel. 2.2) cannot be converted
to HiPath 3000 V1.0.
Top configuration If the Top configuration has more than one executive and
one secretary, you need to use a key module.
Universal Call Distri-
bution (UCD)
You cannot use MULAPs in the universal call distribution
system.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-276 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Configuration Options
This feature can be configured using Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Configuring the Feature Using Assistant T
Tops should normally be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E. Configuration us-
ing Assistant T is possible only to a limited extent.
Configuring the Feature Using HiPath 3000 Manager E
HiPath 3000 Manager E can be used to configure a default Top (Team/Top mask).
Members can be added to the team by drag and drop. The executive MULAP group,
basic MULAP group and its MULAP key, and the ring transfer and DSS keys are con-
figured automatically. The basic and executive MULAP groups are assigned the orig-
inal station numbers of the primary station/executive and the primary station/execu-
tive is assigned a pseudo station number (examples: 4711 becomes **4711, 12345
becomes **2345, 654321 becomes **4321).
Configure the feature using HiPath 3000 Manager E as follows:
Step Action
1. Configure Top (default)
Options
2. Incoming calls
3. Team/Top
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-277
Features
3.11.14.3 MULAP Groups
There are two types of MULAP group:
Basic MULAP groups
These groups form the basis for Team configurations. In addition, secretary MU-
LAPs are configured by means of basic MULAP groups.
Members can be primary stations, primary station CMIs and non-primary sta-
tions.
Primary stations and primary station CMIs are automatically assigned the out-
going preference and incoming MULAP call signaling (tone, LED and display).
The following can be administered:
–“Outgoing preference (automatic outgoing seizure) for all primary stations
and primary station CMIs.
–“Incoming preference (automatic incoming seizure) for all members.
Incoming MULAP call signaling for all members.
DSS keys for all members.
All members can activate and deactivate MULAP call signaling for each MULAP
using a key (Group Call).
Executive MULAP groups
These groups form the basis for executive/secretary configurations (Top). All
members of the Top (CHESE) become members of the executive MULAP; the ex-
ecutive(s) function as primary stations.
The following members are possible: Executive 1, 2 ..., CMI executive 1, 2 ...,
conference corner tel. executive 1, 2 ..., secretary 1, 2 ..., CMI secretary 1, 2 ...
An executive MULAP group defines which members will be executives (= primary
stations). These members are automatically assigned the outgoing preference
without incoming MULAP call signaling (tone and display).
All non-executives (= non-primary stations) are automatically assigned incoming
MULAP call signaling (tone, LED and display).
The following can be administered:
–“Outgoing preference for all executives, CMI executives and conference cor-
ner telephone executives.
–“Incoming preference for all members.
Incoming MULAP call signaling for all non-executives.
DSS keys for all members.
Ring transfer key.
Non-executives can activate and deactivate MULAP call signaling using a key
(Group Call).
Secretary MULAPs are configured by means of basic MULAP groups.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-278 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Telephone Types
The following types of telephone can be defined as both primary stations and non-
primary stations in a basic or executive MULAP group:
Analog telephones
Cordless telephones (CMI)
all optiPoint 500 telephones described in Section 6.2 and the optiset E tele-
phones described in the Hicom 150 H V1.0 Service Manual
LED Statuses of a MULAP Key
The LED for the MULAP key indicates the status of the MULAP group and can as-
sume the following signaling statuses:
LED off = MULAP free (seizure possible).
LED on = MULAP busy (seizure not possible).
LED flickering = MULAP being called (call can be answered).
LED flashing slowly = MULAP on hold (call can be retrieved or picked up).
A key can be configured for a MULAP group number on each station (including on a
busy lamp field and optiClient Attendant).
LED Statuses of a DSS key
The LED for the DSS key indicates the status of the DSS destination as follows:
LED off = DSS destination is free.
LED on = DSS destination is busy (off-hook, in talk state, etc.) or the telephone
on which the DSS key was configured is calling the destination.
LED flashing rapidly = The telephone (DSS destination) is not being called by a
DSS key.
Example: Telephone A has a DSS key to telephone B. Telephone C calls tele-
phone B. The DSS key LED on telephone A flashes rapidly.
LED flickering = The telephone (DSS destination) is calling the telephone on
which the DSS key was configured.
LED flashing slowly = The telephone on which the DSS key was configured has
placed a destination on hold.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-279
Features
General MULAP Functionality
Incoming Calls to a Free MULAP
All the members of the
MULAP group have de-
activated the MULAP
ring (group call off) and/
or have activated do not
disturb.
The MULAP is busy and the caller receives a busy sig-
nal. There is no call signaling on the MULAP.
At least one member of
the MULAP group has
activated the MULAP
ring (group call on) and
deactivated do not dis-
turb.
The call is signaled on all members of the MULAP group
(LED).
Members of the MULAP group who are currently
free, have activated the MULAP ring, and have not
activated do not disturb are also signaled by an
acoustic ring and display.
Members of the MULAP group who are free and
have activated the ringer cutoff feature are also sig-
naled by an advisory ring.
Busy stations in the MULAP group (busy on another
line) that have activated the MULAP ring and have
not activated do not disturb are signaled by
An acoustic advisory ring (single ring) and, af-
ter scrolling, an Accept waiting call message
on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones.
An advisory tone (single short tone) on analog,
CMI and optiset E and optiPoint 500 tele-
phones without display.
The latter is not affected by do not disturb.
Note:
The advisory ring is also issued for calls to the local sta-
tion number (for example, call to DSS key or call to gen-
eral call key).
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-280 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Incoming Calls to a Busy MULAP
All the members of the
MULAP group are busy.
An internal caller receives a busy signal and camps
on after a timeout. An external caller camps on im-
mediately.
The busy members of the MULAP group are sig-
naled by:
A call waiting tone and, after scrolling, an Ac-
cept waiting call message on optiset E and op-
tiPoint 500 telephones.
A call waiting tone on analog, CMI and optiset
E and optiPoint 500 telephones without display.
In the case of busy MULAP group members who
have activated do not disturb, the caller receives a
busy signal regardless of whether the station has
activated or deactivated the MULAP ring.
There is no change in signaling for any other
members of the MULAP group.
Answering of Incoming Calls
Signaled MULAP key
(LED with call signaling)
Calls can be answered by going off-hook, pressing the
speaker key or pressing the MULAP key.
If the user goes off-hook or presses the speaker key, the
incoming preference applies (automatic incoming sei-
zure).
An incoming call (LED with or without call signaling) can
always be answered using the MULAP key, regardless
of the incoming preference.
Incoming Preference
Incoming preference
(automatic incoming sei-
zure)
Although the MULAP settings determine the incom-
ing preference, this setting applies to a particular
telephone. If more than one MULAP is connected to
a telephone, an incoming preference can be set for
each MULAP. Only the last setting entered for the
incoming preference applies to the telephone.
If incoming preference is deactivated, a call cannot
be answered by going off-hook or pressing the
speaker key; the system attempts to execute an out-
going seizure.
If No incoming preference is selected for a tele-
phone, the setting applies to all incoming calls to
this telephone. Calls to the local station number can
be answered only by pressing a station number,
DSS or general call key.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-281
Features
Outgoing Calls
Initiating an outgoing call An outgoing call can be initiated by going off-hook,
pressing the speaker key, or pressing a call, digit, MU-
LAP, station number or DSS key.
When an outgoing call is initiated, a station number is
assigned and the called party is displayed. In the default
configuration (device without MULAP), the local station
number is assigned when the line is seized. If seizure is
via a MULAP, the MULAP group number is assigned.
Outgoing Preference
Outgoing preference
(automatic outgoing sei-
zure)
Each station is assigned an outgoing preference.
The primary stations in the MULAP groups and the
executives in the executive MULAP groups are as-
signed the MULAP group number as a preference.
Primary stations and executives always have the
same preferences.
If the outgoing preference for a primary station or
executive changes, it is also changed for the other
primary stations and executives in this MULAP
group.
When the user goes off-hook, presses the speaker,
station number, MUSAP or general call key, or dials
while on-hook, the preference is assigned as a sta-
tion number for the outgoing seizure.
If the MULAP preference is busy when the user
goes off-hook or presses one of the above-men-
tioned keys, an overflow to the local station number
is possible only on analog, CMI and optiset E entry
telephones. Other optiset E and optiPoint 500 tele-
phones must select a free trunk.
Application: An executive CMI goes off-hook. The
executive MULAP (its outgoing preference) is still
seized by the secretary. The executive CMI receives
a dial tone (overflow) for the local station number. At
the end of dialing, the station number of the execu-
tive MULAP appears in the display of the called par-
ty.
If the user presses a MULAP key, the outgoing pref-
erence is not used. Instead, the group number of
the MULAP key is used.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-282 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Busy Signaling
If one MULAP group member presses the MULAP key
or seizes the MULAP by preference (goes off-hook,
presses the speaker key or dials while on-hook), MU-
LAP keys indicate the busy state on all the stations in
the MULAP group.
Station Number Key, DSS Key
The destination of a station number key can be a
station number or a group number.
An outgoing seizure using a station number key is
output to the outgoing preference. If the outgoing
preference is a MULAP, the MULAP is also seized.
If a station number key is activated during a call on
a MULAP, the call is placed on consultation hold.
The station number is always entered as the desti-
nation of a DSS key. It is also possible to configure
destinations that do not belong to a basic or execu-
tive MULAP group.
Differences:
A DSS key bypasses the outgoing preference
and the local station number is always output (a
MULAP is not seized).
A DSS key switches lines (for U.S. only) or ini-
tiates consultation hold (not for U.S.) if the ac-
tive call is being conducted on a MULAP.
At the destination, a DSS key bypasses call
management and ring transfer but follows call
forwarding.
DSS on executive or primary station:
The executives in the executive MULAP group or
the primary stations in the basic MULAP group
have the free status as a group; in other words, as
soon as one is busy, the DSS and station number
keys indicate busy.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-283
Features
Line Switchover
Line switchover is possible only from the call state.
Otherwise, the line is released.
A line switchover is always executed between two
MULAP keys.
Between a MULAP and a DSS key,
A line switchover is executed = for U.S. only
Consultation hold is activated = not for U.S.
The setting is selected by means of the switch lines
for DSS option, which is part of the country default
settings.
After pressing the hold key, the party initiating hold
receives a dial tone (on the outgoing preference)
and can set up an outgoing call or answer an incom-
ing call on another line key.
If a user presses another free, calling or held MU-
LAP key (line switchover) during a call (outgoing or
incoming) on a MULAP key (call state), the first MU-
LAP is also placed on exclusive hold.
The party who initiated hold can retrieve a MULAP
on exclusive hold at any time by pressing the MU-
LAP key. The active call is then placed on exclusive
hold.
Both external and internal calls can be placed on
hold. All the members of the MULAP can retrieve a
MULAP on common hold at any time.
Call Pickup
Calls to MULAP groups are not signaled in any call pick-
up group and cannot be picked up.
Night, Intercept and Overflow Destinations
MULAP groups can be used as night, intercept and
overflow destinations.
Telephone Directory
Administration (Assistant T/HiPath 3000 Manager E) in-
dicates which station number or name will appear when
the directory is displayed.
Call Forwarding
CF destination A MULAP group can also be a call forwarding destina-
tion.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-284 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Call forwarding per MU-
LAP group
After dialing the CF-per-MULAP code, the user
must enter the MULAP number. optiset E and opti-
Point 500 telephones with a display and CMI tele-
phones use the same menu system as a CF device.
The user must also enter the MULAP number when
programming a CF-per-MULAP key. The menu sys-
tem is the same as for a CF key.
Instead of entering the MULAP number, the user
can press the MULAP key.
A partially programmed (with MULAP number, with-
out CF destination) or fully programmed (with MU-
LAP number and CF destination) CF-per-MULAP
key can also be programmed.
For each MULAP, a CF-per-MULAP key with an in-
ternal or external destination can be configured for
each telephone.
Call forwarding via asso-
ciated services
In this case, the MULAP number must be entered twice,
once to indicate the source and once to indicate the
trunk.
Execution of call for-
warding
When a forwarded MULAP is seized, a special dial
tone is activated.
When a call is forwarded, a CF device has priority.
A call is forwarded to the station CF destination. If
CF per MULAP is activated, the call is forwarded to
the MULAP CF destination.
There is no parallel signaling on the MULAP and CF
destination. Only the call forwarding destination is
called.
Secretarial function
transfer
Using the ring transfer function, the secretary can switch
calls to the executive and initiate a secretarial function
transfer by means of CF per MULAP. The deputy can
override call forwarding (caller is a CF destination), in
which case the executive is called directly on the MU-
LAP. The executive can receive calls directly by deacti-
vating CF per MULAP.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-285
Features
Results and signaling of
a CF device and CF per
MULAP
If a CF device is activated for a primary station or
executive, this state is indicated by a special dial
tone on all the primary station or executive tele-
phones within the same MULAP. The CF device can
be deactivated from any primary station or execu-
tive telephone.
The CF destination is stored in the telephone that
initiated call forwarding. CF is signaled (LED, dis-
play and special dial tone) on all primary stations or
executives.
If CF per MULAP is activated, this state is indicated
by the LED for the CF-per-MULAP key (fully and
partially programmed) of all the members of the
MULAP group (no continuous display). Any mem-
ber of the MULAP group can deactivate CF per MU-
LAP.
If a MULAP is entered as a CF destination, this
state is indicated by the CF device LED (slowly
flashing) of the primary stations in the MULAP
group and by the CF-per-MULAP LED of all the
members.
If a member attempts to activate CF per MULAP
and a primary station has already activated a CF
device, a warning is issued. The action is not exe-
cuted until the primary station deactivates the CF
device.
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-286 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Number/Name Display
When an outgoing call is set up, a station number is
assigned (local station number or MULAP group
number).
When an incoming MULAP call is answered, the
MULAP group number is assigned.
In the case of calls to a MULAP:
Before the call is answered, the display of the
calling party shows the MULAP name and/or
MULAP number being called.
After the call is answered, the display of the
calling party shows the station name and/or
MULAP number of the answering party.
In the case of calls from a MULAP station (MULAP
key or preference), the display of the called and an-
swering parties always shows the station name
and/or MULAP number.
The following generally applies to outgoing sei-
zures: If a station conducts a call using the local sta-
tion number and the outgoing preference differs
from the local station number, the display of the
called party always shows the station number of the
outgoing preference.
Consultation Hold, Recall, Conference
Consultation hold state The following activities are among the options available
in the menu in the consultation hold state:
Return to held call
To g g l e
Transfer
Conference
When the user goes on-hook, the call is transferred or
an immediate recall is performed.
Consultation hold on lo-
cal MULAP
If a MULAP group member is a primary station, it can
reach the other members of the same MULAP by acti-
vating consultation hold and then dialing the local MU-
LAP number. This is useful if no station number key or
DSS key is configured or if the station number of the
member is unknown.
Example of an application: An executive wishes to trans-
fer the call to his or her CMI or conference corner tele-
phone. The executive activates consultation hold on the
local executive MULAP. Only the executive stations ring
because ring transfer within the executive MULAP is ig-
nored. The executive can pickup the call on his or her
CMI or conference corner telephone.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-287
Features
Unscreened and
screened transfer (im-
portant Top feature)
If a member of the local MULAP is called while on con-
sultation hold (by dialing the local station number, press-
ing the station number key or pressing the DSS key (not
for U.S.)), the ring/call continues to be signaled/conduct-
ed on the MULAP after the transfer. Before the transfer,
common hold is signaled on both MULAP members
and the held call can be picked up.
Recall after transfer,
hold or immediately after
going on-hook during
consultation hold
This function is signaled only on the MULAP station ini-
tiating consultation hold or hold. The MULAP LED indi-
cates a call (busy indication on all other MULAP sta-
tions). The call is always signaled by an acoustic ring
and display (MULAP ring and group call are ignored).
Consultation hold on
second line
Consultation hold on a second line occurs when a sec-
ond MULAP line is activated after consultation hold is
initiated from a MULAP line.
This function is useful when activating features that can
only be activated from consultation hold (such as trans-
fer and conference).
Once a second line has been placed on consultation
hold, the first line is released.
Example of an application: A call is being conducted on
MULAP M1. By pressing a trunk key, the user switches
the line to MULAP M2, thus placing M1 on exclusive
hold. A new connection is set up on M2. In order to add
the party on M1 to a conference, the user must press
consultation hold, M1 (M2 is released) and conference.
The conference continues on M1.
Instead of being added to a conference, the call can be
transferred. In this case, the two parties are intercon-
nected and M1 is released.
Conference A conference can always be initiated or expanded (to
maximum five participants).
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-288 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Callback, Message Waiting, Caller List
Callback and Message Waiting are station-related
features. If a member of a MULAP initiates a call-
back or sends a text message, the sender (i.e. only
the initiating station in the MULAP) is called back.
When the callback is initiated on a busy MULAP, it
is executed as soon as the MULAP is released.
When the callback is initiated on a free MULAP, the
primary stations of the basic MULAP or the execu-
tives of the executive MULAP are monitored. The
callback is not executed until a primary station or
executive has been activated.
The MULAP is always called when the callback is
executed. This means that a callback initiated on a
free executive MULAP will also call the executive
MULAP when it is executed.
When a user sends a text message to a MULAP, the
message is delivered to all the primary stations in
the basic MULAP or all the executives in the execu-
tive MULAP.
The message waiting LED for the mailbox is also
activated on all the primary stations in the basic
MULAP or executives in the executive MULAP.
MULAP calls are indicated only in the caller list of
the primary stations and executives.
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-289
Features
3.11.15 Storing Procedures on Procedure Keys
Definition
This feature allows the user to configure procedure keys and to program them with
procedures. The programming (storing) follows the same steps as the normal execu-
tion of a procedure.
If you use a procedure key during a call, DTMF signals are automatically sent in the
B channel. A consultation hold is not initiated.
Procedures can contain internal and external station numbers and additional informa-
tion. Some of the possibilities are:
Trunk group code number + ACCT + destination station number
Trunk flash code + destination station number
Code numbers for control of services + destination station number
(such as send/query message (Message Waiting): * 68 + station number + text
number)
Digit combination for Voice Mail or for answering machine
Call waiting or busy override when destination station is busy
Initiation of a callback when destination station is idle or busy
The following table shows which services (features) can be programmed on proce-
dure keys. The table also shows any conditions that apply to the use of the procedure
keys.
Feature Use of the procedure key not possible Comments
in the digit input-
state (no digit
dialed)
in the digit input-
state (at least 1
digit dialed)
in the busy state
in the talk state
during outgoing
call
during incoming
call
Account code (ACCT)
Account code ACCT in
prefix
XX XX
Advisory message on X X Key with toggle
function
Associated dialing
Associated services X X
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-290 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Automatic wake-up sys-
tem: activate appoint-
ment
Key with toggle
function
Automatic wake-up sys-
tem: deactivate appoint-
ment
Key with toggle
function
Callback requests - dis-
play or delete
X X X X X Key with toggle
function
Call forwarding, internal
or external, on
XX
Call forwarding, external,
on (not for tenant servic-
es)
X X Key with toggle
function
Call forwarding, logon X X Key with toggle
function
Call forwarding, night
destination on
X X Key with toggle
function
Call forwarding per MU-
LAP
Dial station speed dialing X X
Dial system speed dialing X X
Directed call pickup X X X X
Door opener via adapter
box
DTMF transmission X X X X X
DTMF transmission in the
talk state using proce-
dure key
Flash on analog trunk
Group ringing off X X Key with toggle
function
Group ringing on X X Key with toggle
function
Night answer off X X Key with toggle
function
Feature Use of the procedure key not possible Comments
in the digit input-
state (no digit
dialed)
in the digit input-
state (at least 1
digit dialed)
in the busy state
in the talk state
during outgoing
call
during incoming
call
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-291
Features
Night answer on X X Key with toggle
function
Park on X X Key with toggle
function
Parked call retrieval X X X X X Key with toggle
function
Radio paging system, an-
swer
Radio paging system,
page
Release trunk (emergen-
cy trunk access)
XX
Retrieval of an external
call from common hold
Send messages (mes-
sage waiting)
XX
Silent monitoring X X X X
Speaker call X X X X
Switch relays off X X
Switch relays on X X
System telephone book X X X X
Telephone Data Service
TDS
XX
Voice selections
Feature Use of the procedure key not possible Comments
in the digit input-
state (no digit
dialed)
in the digit input-
state (at least 1
digit dialed)
in the busy state
in the talk state
during outgoing
call
during incoming
call
Other Features
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-292 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.2 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Procedure length A maximum of 32 characters can be stored in a proceudre
key.
optiClient Attendant It is not possible to configure procedure keys.
Second key level No procedures can be configured on the second key level
(Shift).
Pause A pause can be inserted in the programming process by
pressing the redial key.
Suffix-dialing Procedure keys can be used in suffix-dialing.
PIN It is not possible to program procedures that require a PIN
(such as activating or deactivating an individual telephone
lock).
Other Feature
s
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-293
Features
3.11.16 Customer-Specific Display (V3.0 and later)
Definition
The feature allows you to make customer-specific adjustments to the optiPoint 400
CorNet-IP-TS, the optiClient 130, and the optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephone dis-
plays when the telephones are in the idle state.
You can change only the right portion (maximum of 15 characters) of the second dis-
play line, which displays HiPath as a default. For example, you can enter a company
identification or hotel name here. The text lines up with the left part of the date if the
length of the text allows it.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Figure 3-15 Default Display in Idle State
Figure 3-16 Example of a Customer-Specific Display in Idle State
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
V3.0 or
later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Display The display appears only when the telephone is in the idle
state.
16:53 Th 07 FEB 02
123456 HiPath >
16:53 Th 07 FEB 02
123456 Sea View Hotel >
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-294 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12 Networking
In private and public networks, switching operations are performed by trunk interfac-
es, numbering plans, least cost routing functions, and station number translations.
HiPath 3000 provide networking on digital trunks using the CorNet-N (from Section
3.12.4) or QSig (Section 3.12.19) networking protocol.
CorNet-N is a data protocol from Siemens AG for digital communication between Hi-
Path 3000 and Hicom 300 E and other private communications servers from
Siemens AG.
QSig is a data protocol for digital communication between HiPath 3000 and Hicom
300 E and the communications servers of other manufacturers.
The HiPath 3000 systems (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500) can
be connected to other Communications Servers to form private networks. The system
can use analog tie lines (TIEL board in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700) or digital T1
services (TST1 in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500, TMST1 in HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700) to support network call traffic. Varying degrees of network functionality, from
basic call routing to transparent user features, can be achieved, depending on the sig-
naling format. Software features for basic connectivity through advanced CorNet-N
ISDN networking come standard in the basic HiPath 3000 system.
Satellite Tie Line
HiPath 3000 systems can be configured for basic call handling between other com-
munications systems supporting common E&M signalling protocol. The HiPath 3000
LCR features can be implemented to support a coordinated dialing plan in simple net-
work designs. The HiPath 3000 support off-premise call forwarding over these types
of tie-trunk circuits and can be used to route inbound call traffic to remote answering
destinations.
While this simple network design does not afford feature transparency, economical
call routes using analog E&M tie lines or standard T1/D4 tie lines can be used. The
HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 do not support an analog tie-line interface card.
In addition to the capability described here, to network HiPath 3000 systems using
CorNet-N and QSig, for V1.0 and later you can also use IP Networking (HiPath
3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300). HiPath
HG1500 makes this possible. For information on the startup and configuration, refer
to the HiPath HG1500 Administration Instructions.
For examples of maximum possible distances from the CO for CorNet-N direct net-
working, refer to Table 2-42 on page 2-97.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-295
Features
CorNet-N call traffic and signalling (for U.S. Only)
CorNet-N is a point-to-point (peer-to-peer) protocol and requires an ISDN link for
signalling and call traffic between connected systems. A standard clear channel
T1 facility is required between systems to support the CorNet-N application. No
ISDN signalling or ISDN feature of the public-switched telephone network
(PSTN) is used in a CorNet-N network.
CorNet-N call information (digitized voice or data) is handled over 64-Kbps B
channels. The call setup and call intelligence are communicated between sys-
tems over an associated D channel. This technique is called Message-Oriented
Signaling/Common Channel Signaling (CCS/MOS). A T1/DS0 facility used for
CorNet-N ISDN calls has a capacity of 23 B channels + 1 D channel. Multiple T1
links can be configured in a logical call route using the systems LCR feature.
CorNet-N and international links
The HiPath 3000 can be configured at installation to be used in either US mu-law
or international a-law digital PCM formats. Digital T1 interface cards cannot be
used in a system defined for a-law use and E1 cards cannot be used in a mu-law
system. External transmission equipment capable of handling both a-law and
mu-law formats is required to support matching the two international PCM for-
mats. Exchange carriers handling international traffic can often supply this ser-
vice.
Whereas T1 interfaces offer 24 channels (23+1) at a total bandwidth of 1.544
Mhz, an E1 interface (also known internationally as an S2 interface) provides 32
channels (31+1) with a total bandwidth of 2.048 Mhz.
In an international network between a T1 equipped system and an E1 equipped
system, only 23 B channels can be used. The remaining 9 channels of the E1
interface are not used.
CorNet-N on fractional T1
The HiPath 3000 support fractional T1 service, which can be used in a CorNet-
N, PRI or analog T1 (non-ISDN) environment. Any of the B channels that have
been disabled in the HiPath 3000 configuration can be used for other T1 applica-
tions. External multiplexing equipment is required to provide mapping of the al-
ternate applications T1 channels into the unused B channels of the CorNet-N
link. (Refer to CorNet-N Configuration and Sales Positioning guides).
CorNet-N and data applications
ISDN data applications are supported over CorNet-N links using the STLS4,
STMD8, ILAN card and ISDN adapter.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-296 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
CorNet-N network topologies
The HiPath 3000 can be configured in point-to-point, star, or mesh network con-
figurations, with other HiPath 3000 systems (HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3750 only)
and/or with other Siemens ICN systems. (Refer to CorNet-N Configuration and
Sales Positioning guides for details).
CorNet-N network and HiPath 3000 system feature compatibility
All the following CorNet-N features are supported between HiPath 3000 systems.
Refer to the CorNet-N Configuration and Sales Positioning guides for complete
feature compatibility between the HiPath 3000 and other Siemens Communica-
tions Systems.
3.12.1 Satellite CS Capability
Definition
Users can connect the HiPath 3000 system to an existing communications server
(CS) as a satellite CS and use the functions of the second CS.
Tie trunk traffic can be processed via direct connections between the CSs as well as
via public trunks and dedicated lines. In addition, with HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700,
users can process tie trunk traffic via E&M trunks.
Basic interconnection of two communication systems can be formed by connecting
analog station interfaces from one system to loop start analog trunks of the other sys-
tem. This type of connection provides only basic connectivity between systems. To
support such connectivity, the HiPath 3000 provide a configurable trunk flash which
changes the flash from a ground signal to an open loop to signal the other system.
The Assistant T parameter
CO
or
PBX
or the HiPath 3000 Manager E
Trunk Type
pa-
rameter changes the flash from long to short.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-297
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements Digital
trunk
board or
analog
tie trunk
board
Digital
trunk
board
Digital
trunk
board
––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Closed numbering With closed numbering, trunk group codes must be delet-
ed for CorNet trunk groups, although trunk access codes
remain.
Least cost routing
(LCR)
In a CS with CO access, LCR must be active to handle
transit calls.
CorNet-N trunk
groups
On CorNet-N trunk groups that can seize a trunk in the re-
mote CS, the second discriminating digit in the trunk group
must be entered from the remote CS.
Analog trunks On analog external trunks, a flash (not ground) signals the
main CS.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-298 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.2 Tie Trunk Via TIEL
Definition
The TIEL (Tie Line Ear & Mouth) board supports tie traffic with other private commu-
nication systems and contains four two-way analog tie trunks with E&M signaling for
HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700. Each tie trunk has eight connections: two incoming
speech paths, two outgoing speech paths, two incoming signaling paths, and two out-
going signaling paths.
The speech paths can switch between four-wire and two-wire modes. To ensure high-
quality transmission, a four-wire connection should be used for analog networks. The
advantage of providing separate speech paths for incoming and outgoing calls is that
it helps maintain call stability (echo). Repeaters in the transmission equipment can
also compensate for attenuation losses.
The E&M signaling paths exchange signals that control connection setup and clear-
down. Depending on the requirements of the remote system or the transmission
equipment, you can use different types of interfaces that have a different number of
wires or different potentials.
Before placing a tie trunk in service, you must determine which interface type the two
participating systems should share.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in x––––
HW requirements TIEL
board
––––
SW requirements V1.0 or
later
––––
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-299
Features
3.12.3 Closed Numbering
Definition
In private networks, users can assign station numbers, trunk access codes, and fea-
ture codes according to a customer-defined numbering plan.
HiPath 3000 support both closed and open numbering. If unique extension numbers
are used within the network, any user in the network can call another extension by
dialing its extension number.This is a closed numbering plan.
CorNet-N dial plans support extension numbering. In the CorNet-N network, users
assign unique private extension numbers of up to six digits. This type of numbering
is also called closed numbering.
An open numbering plan is also supported for networks that use a leading digit and
a common system dial plan for each location.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Numbering Users can change internal numbering only using HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-300 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.4 Toll Restriction with CorNet-N
Definition
HiPath 3000 support satellite CS traffic via CorNet-N. The system can be operated
as a node (CS without CO access, CorNet-N trunk group only), transit node (CS with
at least two CorNet-N trunk groups, no central office), and gateway (CS with CO and
CorNet-N trunk groups).
In addition to the basic call functions (outgoing and incoming calls), the CorNet-N sys-
tem supports the toll restriction feature.
If users operate the HiPath 3000 in networked environments, the users toll restriction
is checked, transmitted, or received in the incoming direction (class-of-service trans-
fer) when a CorNet-N trunk is seized. To a gateway system, the system performs
standard class-of-service toll restrictions for outgoing calls and when an extension
answers.
A stations toll restriction class of service (COS) is passed from communication server
to communication server within a CorNet-N network. When a call originating in a re-
mote system is destined for an external trunk route, the HiPath 3000 perform COS
checking of the calling party before allowing the call to proceed.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Restrictions Host/client
(master/slave)
Client
(slave)
––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Classes of service The following 15 classes of service exist for class-of-ser-
vice transfer:
Internal access only (0)
Outward restricted trunk access (1)
Local public network (2-13, including 11 allowed/de-
nied lists)
Unrestricted trunk access (14)
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-301
Features
Classes of service for
two networked sys-
tems
When there is an external seizure of a station from the sat-
ellite CS (with COS 2-13) over the main CS, the main CSs
first denied list always does the seizing.
For this reason, keep the first denied line of the main CS
free for the assessment of the stations from the satellite
CS.
The system keeps COS 0, 1 and 14 of the satellite CS.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-302 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.5 Call Detail Recording With Networking
Definition
In a networked environment, each system records call details locally. Networking
does not affect call detail recording in HiPath 3000. Call details continue to be record-
ed for outgoing calls provided they are transmitted by the main CS. In environments
with satellite CSs without a separate central office, the main CS centrally records call
details that originate within the main CS (call detail recording central [CDRC]).
In addition, CDRC logs call detail information received for incoming calls (for example,
transfer of a toll call from a networked system).
In networked environments, a centralized call accounting device can be used to
record all calls originated or in transit through the hub system.
Each system can only record calls that are routed through its own trunks or transit
calls. A centralized CDR device can be used to collect CDR data from each individual
systems RS-232 interface.
CDR data that originates in one node is not transmitted to another network node. The
secondary CDR collecting devices located at each node are typically polled by a main
CDR device located at the main node to collect the stored data. Siemens responsi-
bility is limited to the data provided out of the RS-232 port. Integration of external de-
vices must be confirmed with Siemens ICN prior to installation.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Buffer box If a system in a network has local trunk accesses, a local
buffer box can be used for the call charges.
Call via the trunk gate-
way of the remote CS
If a station in a CS conducts an outgoing call via the CO
access of the remote CS, the call details that apply to the
CS in which the trunk is seized are output as call type 6 (di-
rect outward dialing).
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-303
Features
3.12.6 Incoming Call
Definition
CorNet-N handles incoming calls the same way as any other internal calls. Users can
configure digit analysis in the networked system so that they can reach all HiPath
3000 extensions by dialing the prefix.
The extension number corresponds to the external numbering plan and is analyzed
accordingly. When the connection is made, the following information is passed to the
remote CS placing the call:
Toll restriction
Extension number
Station name
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-304 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.7 Consultation Hold/Transfer/Pickup
Definition
When users activate consultation hold between a HiPath 3000 station and a station
in a networked system, the consultation hold is initially set up via a second B channel.
Whenever possible, the connection is set up by path replacement (path replacement
activates after connection). If path replacement is not possible, the connection re-
mains on the second B channel.
When an external call is transferred to a station connected via CorNet-N, the station
number, name, and class of service for the A and C stations are transmitted.
Users can pick up from the networked system if the call is identified as a consultation
call. If the consulted party picks up the call, the request from the main CS causes the
call to be switched in transit, and the system disconnects the consulting party. If the
consulted party disconnects the consultation call, the consultation is automatically re-
connected to the last call on hold.
Unscreened transfer is possible to a busy or idle station in a remote node.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Unscreened transfer Unscreened transfer is possible on a free or busy station in
a networked system.
Call pickup groups
with fractional T1s
If you are using a portion of B channels on a T1 for data
applications (for example, with a data server), you must bar
the data B channels from being used for call pickup
groups. Do this by deselecting the B channel modes
in-
coming
and
outgoing
in HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-305
Features
3.12.8 Recall
Definition
The system initiates a recall if the network cannot perform an unscreened transfer.
The recall applies locally and not network-wide.
In homogeneous HiPath 3000 networks, an unanswered call from one node to anoth-
er recalls the initiating station in the originating node.
In non-homogeneous networks, an unanswered call to a non-HiPath 3000 system re-
calls at the transferring systems intercept position or originator, depending on the
system configuration.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-306 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.9 Call Waiting
Definition
Networked systems handle call waiting the same way as internal call waiting.
Corresponding D channel messages are generated for waiting calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-307
Features
3.12.10 Distinctive Ringing in the Network
Definition
The calls are evaluated in the network and signaled accordingly.
CorNet-N calls are handled and signaled the same as internal calls.
Distinctive internal and external ring types are provided over CorNet-N.
Network station-to-station calls provide internal ringing patterns, whereas external
trunk calls routed over CorNet-N provide external ringing patterns.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-308 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.11 Callback on Free/Busy
Definition
Users can activate the callback feature across systems. The user interface is the
same as for internal callback. Instead of the internal extension number, the number
of the networked station is stored and displayed.
If an open-numbering scheme is used, this feature only operates in a CorNet-N net-
work of two HiPath 3000 systems, where at least one system is an HiPath 3750 or
HiPath 3700.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-309
Features
3.12.12 Station Number/Name Display
Definition
In addition to the calling stations number, HiPath 3000 transmit the calling stations
name via CorNet-N. When a name is available for incoming calls, the station displays
the name instead of the station number.
This feature supports both uppercase and lowercase letters. In addition, users can
configure whether the telephone display shows the callers name or station number.
The HiPath 3000 send both the calling station number and calling station name (if ap-
plicable) via the ISDN D channel.
If external and internal calls are routed via CorNet-N to another node, it is necessary
to split the B channels of a T1 span for internal and external traffic. This can lead to
the situation that for certain calls not all 23 B channels are available.
In an incoming call from another nodes ISDN trunk, the calling partys Caller ID is re-
ceived on the HiPath 3000 optiset E or optiPoint 500.
An ISDN trunk call transferred or redirected from the HiPath 3000 (either by a station
or by a voice processing device) passes the calling partys Caller ID to the next node.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Station number sup-
pression
Each user can use the station number suppression func-
tion to activate or deactivate station number and name dis-
play.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-310 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.13 Call Forwarding With Rerouting
Definition
Calls can be rerouted for call forwarding via CorNet-N to optimize B channel utiliza-
tion.
For example, station A in CS 1 calls station B in CS 2. Station B then forwards the call
to station C in CS 1. The two B channels between CSs 1 and 2 are released. This
means that the connection is set up directly within CS 1. For this to be possible, both
CSs must activate rerouting.
HiPath 3000 users can forward their incoming internal and/or external calls to users
within their own system, to a node within the private network, or off-site (if the feature
is allowed in the system administration). Call forwarding-no answer is possible using
Call Management pseudo ports in the HiPath 3000 system.
Pseudo numbers are used for identification and steering purposes. A pseudo number
is a call number/DID number assigned to a port not associated to a physical device.
The pseudo numbers are assigned in the
Set up station
screen (HiPath 3000 Manag-
er E) and can be configured with a name and Call Management steering information.
Pseudo numbers cannot be programmed as Repertory Dial (Repdial) keys on the op-
tiset E or optiPoint 500 telephones. Pseudo numbers can be forwarded using the As-
sociated Services feature code (*83) from a station with the Associated Services au-
thorization flag activated.
Route optimization can be defined in the database as follows:
Rerouting is deactivated
Reroute only if the route is known
Rerouting is always activated
Refer to the CorNet-N Configuration Notes for the proper setting.
This option is only available for CorNet-N networking, and must be activated in the
same way in both networked systems.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-311
Features
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-312 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.14 Toggle
Definition
The conditions described under Section 3.1.3, Toggle also apply to networked sys-
tems. That is, station users can use the Toggle feature to toggle between callers, in-
cluding those originated or received on CorNet-N call routes.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call hold A station on hold cannot toggle between calls.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-313
Features
3.12.15 Conference
Definition
The conditions described in Section 3.1.6, Conference also apply to networked sys-
tems.
Voice station users on the HiPath 3000 can establish internal and external conference
calls using local and CorNet-N call routes as needed. The system limits the number
of conferees in a conference to five. A party in another node connected to the confer-
ence via CorNet-N is allowed to add additional parties within its own node using its
own conference circuit. Members of a conference within another node will not be up-
dated with the conference display information (number of conferees in the confer-
ence) of the HiPath 3000 system.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Conference A conference can be set up between voice stations only.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-314 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.16 Central Attendant Console
Definition
A central attendant console supports the switch and recall functions in the network.
A local intercept position can redirect intercepted calls via a networked station (with
call forwarding).
Pseudo numbers can also be entered that are forwarded to a remote system for cen-
tralized answering applications. The Associated Service feature must be used to call
forward the pseudo number to the target location.
The console display shows the calling party number if available. There is no indication
specific display for interceptsame display as for incoming external calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-315
Features
3.12.17 Sharing System Speed Dialing in a Gateway System
Definition
Satellite CSs can share the system speed-dialing destinations in a gateway system.
However, the local telephone directory cannot display the system speed-dialing num-
bers of the gateway system.
There are some restrictions, depending on the type of system in the network. Refer
to the Configuration Notes prior to installation.
The satellite station user must dial the gateway systems speed-dialing number. Ser-
vice code conflicts must not exist between the nodes. The service code is analyzed
via LCR and sent to the destination node
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-316 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.18 Sharing a Central Voice Mail Server
Definition
Users in a networked system can program call forwarding to a central voice mail serv-
er. HiPath 3000 stations are informed of calls received by means of the message wait-
ing indication (either the optiset E or optiPoint 500 LED, the optiset E or optiPoint 500
display, or the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 analog telephones broken dial tone or
message).
The central voice mail server can be queried in DTMF mode.
In a homogeneous HiPath 3000 networks, the centralized voice mail system must be
located at the HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700 system. Special attention should be taken
during the presales investigation concerning the amount of traffic from all nodes to
the voice mail server. The HiPath 3000 support a maximum of 8 VMIe analog ports
connected from the voice mail server to the HiPath 3750 or HiPath 3700.
With the Siemens PhoneMail system, users can assign one mailbox to up to six inde-
pendent telephones so that the Message Waiting indication is turned on at all tele-
phones assigned to this mailbox. These telephones can be part of different systems
that are served by the same PhoneMail system. The
Plus Feature
package is re-
quired for this function. The PhoneMail SW level must be 6.3 or above.
If external and internal calls are routed via CorNet-N, it is necessary to split the Cor-
Net-N link B channels for internal and external traffic. This can lead to a situation
where, for certain calls, not all B channels are available.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Follow the configuration guidelines.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-317
Features
3.12.19 QSig (Not for U.S.)
Definition
CorNet-N is usually the protocol used for networking HiPath CS with each other.
QSig, the cross-vendor signaling protocol, is used for networking HiPath and non-Hi-
Path CS. In homogeneous networks, HiPath 3000 supports the following basic fea-
tures.
In QSig environments, you can operate HiPath 3000 as an end node, transit node, or
gateway.
You can use the QSig protocols, which are based on the following specifications:
ECMA V1.0 and ECMA V2.0 (for the MWI feature only)
with the partial specifications
ETS 300172: Basic Call/ECMA 143
ETS 300239: Generic Functions / ECMA 165
ISO partial specifications
ISO 11572: Basic Call, ID Identifications (CLIP, CLIR, COLP, COLR)
ISO 13868: Name Identification
ISO 13869: Call Transfer
ISO 13870: Call Completion (Call Completion Busy, Call Completion No Reply)
ISO 13873: Call Forward Unconditional
ISO 15506: Message Waiting Indication
These networked systems collectively act like a single system, transmitting the follow-
ing over the S0 trunk:
Callback option
Station number
Name
Party category
Transit counter
Called parties with toll restriction 0 (no direct trunk access) for a QSig trunk, cannot
answer an incoming QSig call for another station (call pickup, trunk key). However, di-
rect calls and forwarded calls to the B party are possible.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-318 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Interworking With Other Protocols
CorNet-N
All existing features implemented for both CorNet-N and QSig support interwork-
ing in the QSig direction and vice-versa. The only exceptions are the callback fea-
ture (CCBS/CCNR) and the message waiting indication (MWI) because the mes-
sage flows between the two protocols and the ones between two nodes are too
different.
ETSI
The requirements for interworking between CorNet-N and ETSI apply here as
well.
3.12.19.1 Basic Features
Numbering plan
ISDN numbering plan
The system does not support a private numbering plan.
Call detail recording
Direct inward dialing (external)
In the local system: Same as before.
There is no transfer of call charges in transit traffic.
Consultation hold
In the local system: Same as before.
To remote system:
Consultation calls over a second trunk are possible, that is the calls are switched
from the local system over two B channels, and they can be transferred. When a
user releases the call, the call last placed on hold becomes active.
Callback
Users can activate completion of calls - no reply (CCNR) or completion of calls
to busy subscribers (CCBS) to the remote system. They can activate CCNR if the
other party does not answer or if a call is waiting. They can activate CCBS in the
following situations: The other party is busy with one or multiple calls, engaged
in a consultation call or a conference, or has activated do not disturb.
Users cannot set a callback to a call forwarding destination, a member of a group
call or hunt group, a room monitor, or an entrance telephone.
Callback calls are deleted manually, when the CS is reset, a trunk fails, a port is
reprogrammed. The same applies to calls from A94B and from B94A.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-319
Features
Call forwarding
The system supports only the CFU (call forwarding unconditional) QSig version.
To optimize B channel usage a forwarded call to a telephone of the main PBX is
handled in accordance with the specifications for
Call Forwarding/Partial Rerout-
ing
. If
partial rerouting
is rejected,
forward switching
is used.
If HiPath 3000 is a gateway
, forward switching
is implemented.
Name display
Only UPPERCASE letters are transferred. Users can specify whether a trans-
ferred name or the callers station number is displayed.
3.12.19.2 Central Attendant Position/Attendant Console
This function is available in transit only.
3.12.19.3 Intercept
For operation in networked environments, users can configure an external station
number as the attendant console or intercept position in HiPath 3000. If an intercept
occurs in a CS, based on the locally valid intercept criteria, the call is forwarded to the
external station number programmed in the CS or discarded.
The central attendant console intercepts calls according to the CINT (call intercep-
tion) QSig specification. The cause of the intercept, which is transferred in encoded
format, is an important item of data.
The attendant always intercepts calls via a second B channel, because problems
could otherwise occur in a network with different CSs.
3.12.19.4 Originator of the Intercept
The dialed digits or the station number of the party originating the intercept can be
sent to the intercept destination as the originator of the intercept.
In the HiPath 3000 systems, users specify only the number of the station where the
intercept originated. In the case of call forwarding and hunt groups, this is the original
station dialed. No information is transferred if the caller dials an incorrect or incom-
plete number.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-320 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.19.5 Busy Override
An authorized network station (such as the central attendant position or a HiPath
3000 station with override authorization) can override a call being conducted at a
busy station in the network. Users cannot override conference calls in HiPath 3000.
The feature is implemented according to QSig specification CI (call intrusion).
The HiPath 3000 systems handle a busy override according to QSig in a network just
like an internal busy override. This means that every user who is authorized to over-
ride busy calls is authorized to do so throughout the network. The override operation
transforms a two-party call into a three-party call.
3.12.19.6 Recall
This feature activates a recall to the originating station in the network, for example if
a transfer was unsuccessful. The feature is implemented according to QSig specifi-
cation RE (recall).
3.12.19.7 Message Waiting Indication (MWI)
This feature allows you to activate and delete the
Mailbox
key (callback signaling).
It supports the sending of messages (using the service menu or a code) from the idle,
ringing, busy and talk states, and message reception. You cannot select text messag-
es. Because the protocol does not support the transmission of text information, the
receiving end always receives and displays the Please call back message.
A central voice mail server in the QSig network can also initiate a message. In this
case, the name administered for this voice mail server for callback access is dis-
played. It is not possible to send a message to voice mail.
In the case of Octopus E 300/800, message waiting indication is supported either for
voice mail or for other stations. If the feature is activated for voice mail, it must be de-
activated for other stations.
Networkin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-321
Features
3.12.19.8 Central Cross-System Busy Signaling
This feature is supported only in the direction of an Octopus E 300/800 system (A6,
Release 6.3 or later) from Deutsche Telekom AG. The destination of cross-system
busy signaling can only be the central Octopus E 300/800 attendant console (AC).
Systems in the QSig network can report the operating states of selected stations to
the central attendant console of a CS (can be main CS or satellite CS). The following
operating states can be signaled for the telephones:
Free
Busy internally
Busy externally
Defective
The numbering plan in this network must be closed and it must be possible to access
the CS via the first administered QSig port on the remote system.
Operating states cannot be transmitted via CSs functioning as gateway or transit
nodes.
3.12.19.9 System Telephone Lock-Reset Code (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Manufacturer-specific expansions to the QSig protocol (QSig+) allow the individual
telephone lock code of a station networked over QSig+ to be reset to the default value
00000.
Initiate the reset with the code System telephone lock/Reset code or by selecting
the correct entries in the service menu. The system then prompts you to enter the sta-
tion number (with the leading trunk group code, if needed)

Requirements for resetting the telephone lock code:
The telephone number of the telephone that you are using to initiate the reset
must be entered as a station for system telephone lock (system settings).
The system must be networked over the QSig+ protocol with the ISO-QSig pro-
tocol version.
Networking
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-322 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.12.19.10 COS Changeover (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Manufacturer-specific expansions to the QSig protocol (QSig+) allow you to activate
the telephone lock of a station networked over QSig+ with the System telephone
lock/COS changeover feature.
The effects on the telephone are the same as for the individual telephone lock: the
trunk access is reduced to the COS set system-wide (default = 1).
Initiate the COS changeover with the code System telephone lock or by selecting
the correct entry in the service menu. Then the system prompts you to enter the sta-
tion number (with the leading trunk group code, if needed)



 
!
"
#
Requirements for COS changeover:
The telephone number of the telephone that you are using to initiate the
changeover must be entered as a station for system telephone lock (system
settings).
The system must be networked over the QSig+ protocol with the ISO-QSig pro-
tocol version.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-323
Features
3.13 Features for Call Detail Recording
3.13.1 Silent Reversal at Start and End of Call (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Many countries use silent reversal to mark the beginning and end of outgoing calls
on loop start trunks. These criteria are used for time recording within central call detail
recording. This is particularly important when exact tracking of call charges is re-
quired (as in a hotel).
The feature can be configured per circuit.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements TML8W TLA2/4/8 + GEE12
TLA4R
––
SW requirements V1.0 or later ––
General requirements Loop start trunk ––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Silent Reversal In countries where silent reversal is not signaled at the end
of a call, the call duration is determined by the calling party
hanging up the phone.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-324 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.2 Advice of Charges at Station During Call (AOC-D) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Call charge information can be recorded on both analog and digital trunks.
Call charge evaluation for connections on loop start trunks is performed using the call
charge pulses transmitted from the trunk in countries where call charge pulses are
used.
In the case of digital trunks, the display on the users telephone shows the call detail
information received during an external call with the AOC (advice of charges) fea-
ture, assuming that the carrier provides this information.
The following types of AOC are supported in the public network:
AOC-S - Advice of charges at call setup
Call charge display on the telephone is the same as for AOC-D.
The charges are not displayed if the call was not fully set up or if HiPath 3000
is unable to evaluate the call detail information of a service provider.
AOC-D = Advice of charges during call
AOC-E = Advice of charges at end of call
As long as the user has not initiated another action, the final call charges for a call are
displayed for a specific period of time at the end of a call and then added up in call
charge memory.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 3.13.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-325
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Loop start:
GEE8;
optiset E
or opti-
Point 500
telephone
with dis-
play
Loop start:
GEE12/16/50;
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements Call charge information from public network
Subject Requirement or Condition
Analog telephone On analog telephones, call charge pulses can be updated
using a relay and a call charge counter.
Loop start Loop start trunks require a separate call metering receiv-
ing equipment board.
Transfer In the case of AOC-D, the station to which a call is trans-
ferred receives only those call charges that have accrued
since the transfer.
Recall If a call is returned as a recall for unscreened transfer, the
overall amount is displayed and calculated.
Toggle Call charges for the current call are always displayed.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-326 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.3 Call Duration Display on Telephone
Definition
A call duration display is provided for external calls (outgoing or incoming) when no
call charge information is available.
The starting point for call detail recording is set for analog trunks by means of a timer
(5 seconds after end of dialing). The timer used is
Artificial end-of-selection.
In the case of digital trunks, recording is started when the call is received (at
connect
).
The Call Duration is displayed on the display line above the feature prompts. The for-
mat is
HH:MM:SS
.
The dialed number is displayed until the Connect message is received (ISDN trunks)
or until the end of the pseudo-answer timer. Post-dialed digits are displayed for ap-
proximately 5 seconds, then the Call Duration display is returned to the display. When
the user goes on-hook, the idle state display is presented:
Current time and date
.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
S0 / cordless tele-
phone
The system does not support the call duration display fea-
ture on S0 and cordless telephones (not for U.S.).
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-327
Features
3.13.4 Call Detail Recording at Station (CDRS) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Every optiset E, optiPoint 500, analog telephone, S0 (or MSN), and cordless tele-
phone in the system has two storage devices:
A call charge summation memory (call detail memory)
At the end of an external call, the system adds the final charges to the charg-
es already stored in the call detail memory on the station. optiset E and op-
tiPoint 500 users with a display can display their current charges by entering
a code.
An individual call memory
The system adds up the charges incurred during a call in this memory, even
if the call consists of individual call segments, as in the case of the toggle fea-
ture. At the beginning of a new call, the individual call memory is reset to 0.
The contents of the individual call memory appear first. A short time later, the
contents of the cumulative call charge memory are displayed.
You can use the system telephone (phone with programming authorization) as a
charge display station. The user of this station can use the system administration
to:
Display the cumulative call charge memory for one station.
Display the cumulative call charge memory for all stations (organized by sta-
tion numbers).
Reset the cumulative call charge memory memory for a specific station.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 3.13.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
From the system telephone, you can print the latest CDRS data on a printer connect-
ed to the V.24 interface, thereby priting the cumulative call charges for all stations con-
nected to the system.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-328 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
CDRS Data Output to UP0/E Port
You can also output the CDRS data to a UP0/E port. To do this, an optiset E control
adapter, to which you can attach a printer or terminal, must be connected to this port.
The system supports only one adapter per call data output. You can configure the out-
put as follows:
On the communications server, set call data output to adapter.
Enter the telephone number.
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
The transmission rate is permanently set to 9600 baud.
GET Data Output via LAN Interface
You can transfer CDRS data to external applications via the LAN interface (Ethernet)
(for more information, refer to Chapter 4).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Loop start:
GEE8;
optiset E
or opti-
Point 500
telephone
with dis-
play
Loop start:
GEE12/16/50
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements Call detail information from the public network
Subject Requirement or Condition
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-329
Features
3.13.5 Call Detail Recording, Attendant (CDRA) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
The CDRA feature enables you to selectively record the call details for incoming and
outgoing voice calls for which at least one call charge pulse has accumulated.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 3.13.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
If a V.24 (RS-232) port was programmed for CDRA in the customer database, the call
details are output to the printer. If the telephone is an optiset E or optiPoint 500 tele-
phone with display that has a programmed CDRA display key, the charges are also
signaled on the station.
CDRA Data Output to UP0/E Port
You can also output the CDRA data to a UP0/E port. To do this, an optiset E control
adapter, to which you can attach a printer or terminal, must be connected to this port.
The system supports only one adapter per call data output. You can configure the out-
put as follows:
On the communications server, set call data output to adapter.
Enter the telephone number.
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
The transmission rate is permanently set to 9600 baud.
CDRA provides the following data at the end of each call segment:
Internal station number or name of the station.
The external station number dialed (for outgoing calls) or the station number of
the calling party (for incoming calls).
Time (beginning of call) in hours, minutes, and seconds.
Call duration in hours, minutes, and seconds.
Amount due in local currency.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-330 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The data is entered at the beginning of each call segment and at the end of the call.
Up to 20 call segments can be logged simultaneously. This data is stored in the sys-
tem until it is output to the printer and deleted from the attendant console using a pro-
cedure. If an overflow occurs, the oldest entry is overwritten first. The stored data is
lost if there is a power failure.
Signals on the CDRA display key:
LED lights up continuously:
New CDRA call details that have not yet been displayed are waiting.
LED off:
Either CDRA call details that have been displayed at least once are waiting, or no
entry was made.
Configuring a station as a pay phone (automatic CDRA):
If an internal station is configured as a pay phone, all chargeable calls are automati-
cally identified as CDRA calls. A call that is transferred to another station from the pay
phone is logged as a CDRC or CDRA call, depending on how the pay phone is con-
figured.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements
(call detail recording)
Loop start:
GEE8
Loop start:
GEE12/16/50
––
HW requirements
(telephone)
optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements Call details from the public network
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call charges Each call segment is assigned to the user who picked up
the segment.
Conference In a conference, each external connection is recorded sep-
arately as a single segment.
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-331
Features
Pay phone A user can always display the call charges of only those
call segments which were conducted from the assigned
pay phones
.
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-332 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.6 Call Detail Recording Per Trunk (CDRT) (Not for U.S.)
Definition
The system has a cumulative memory function for call charge amounts accrued per
trunk. One memory area is permanently assigned to each trunk.
A system telephone can display and delete the cumulative memory via the system
administration. Call charge deletion requires confirmation. The current CDRT data
can be printed out via system administration. The printout contains a list of CDRT
data for all trunks connected to the system. The current CDRT data can be printed
out on a printer connected to one of the V.24 (RS-232) interfaces on the system.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 3.13.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
CDRT Data Output to UP0/E Port
You can also output the CDRT data to a UP0/E port. To do this, an optiset E control
adapter, to which you can attach a printer or terminal, must be connected to this port.
The system supports only one adapter per call data output. You can configure the out-
put as follows:
On the communications server, set call data output to adapter.
Enter the telephone number.
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot in the
telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Printer
Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2 mode.
The transmission rate is permanently set to 9600 baud.
CDRT Data Output via LAN Interface
You can transfer CDRT data to external applications via the LAN interface (Ethernet)
(for more information, refer to Chapter 4).
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-333
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Loop start:
GEE8
optiset E
or opti-
Point 500
telephone
with dis-
play
Loop start:
GEE12/16/50
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
optiset E or optiPoint
500 telephone with
display
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements Call details from the public network
Subject Requirement or Condition
Adapter in API2 mode If an optiset E control adapter is in API2 mode, you cannot
switch it to Printer Pipe mode.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-334 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.7 Account Code (ACCT)
Definition
This feature enables you to assign call charges for a specific project to an account
code so that call charges for specific projects can be printed out.
Users can enter an ACCT from any station.
ACCT offers two procedures and three options:
Procedures:
Mandatory ACCT:
Users must enter an ACCT before the start of a call (after a trunk group is seized).
For incoming calls, the ACCT entry is optional. The system applies the ACCT ac-
cording to the option selected. If least cost routing is active, a flag in the dial plan
signals that you need to enter an ACCT after the access code. The system treats
this input as a mandatory ACCT.
A mandatory ACCT can be defined in the dial plan (LCR).|
Optional ACCT:
Users can enter an optional ACCT from any telephone before the start of a call.
During an incoming or outgoing call, users can enter the ACCT from Upn tele-
phones only. You can enter an ACCT during a call from optiset E entry, optiset E
basic, and optiPoint 500 entry telephones only if the ACCT feature was pro-
grammed on a key or if automatic DSS system-wide has been turned off.
The account code feature is used together with central call detail recording (CDRC).
LCR Active LCR Inactive
Mandatory Dial Plan
(35-8-3)
Mandatory ACCT TG Set
ENB ACCT requested ACCT requested
SSD
ISD
Redial
Caller list
DSS key
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-335
Features
Options:
ACCT not checked:
The system does not check for an ACCT, which means you can enter an 11-digit
ACCT. If the ACCT is less than 11 digits long, press # to mark the end of the pro-
cedure. If the ACCT is 11 digits long, you can dial another number immediately
afterward (depending on the option, you need to enter the trunk group code or
the station number).
On analog (DP) and ISDN telephones, the not checked option can be used only
if the ACCT is 11 digits long. Otherwise, the system will not complete dialing. You
cannot use the # key or the substitution code to mark the end of input on these
telephones.
ACCT list checked:
The system checks the ACCT against a list of verifiable ACCTs and accepts only
valid entries. You can enter 11-digit ACCTs in the list. After entering a valid ACCT,
you can dial another number immediately (depending on the option, you need to
enter the trunk group code or the station number). Do not press # to mark the end
of the input. The system rejects invalid ACCTs by outputting a negative confirma-
tion tone.
Number of ACCT digits checked:
The system checks an ACCT entry only to determine the number of digits. The
number of digits (11 max.) to be checked is set in the system. After the system
checks the number of ACCT digits, you can dial another number immediately (de-
pending on the option, you need to enter the trunk group code or the station num-
ber).
Account codes are not printed out of call detail recording (CDRC) if the RS-232 output
is connected directly to a printer because the printer format does not have a sufficient
number of columns. However, if a call-accounting device is used, the compressed for-
mat of CDRC will include the account code information.
The ACCT is assigned to all subsequent parts (even if transferred or forwarded to an-
other station) of the current call for CDRC.
There are 1000 possible account code entries; only digits 0-9 are allowed in an ac-
count code number.
If an optiset E or optiPoint 500 user finds that during a call the current account code
applied to a call is incorrect or that a different account code is needed, the user can
enter a different code number. The system will overwrite the currently flagged account
code. CDRC sends a call record after each segment; therefore, previously completed
call segments will be identified with the old account code number.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-336 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
The
non-verified
and
forced
parameters determine, per trunk group, whether an ac-
count code is optional (non verified) or mandatory (forced). There are 16 possible
trunk groups for the HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 sys-
tems, and eight for the HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300 system. The default setting is
non-verified
(optional).
With the
Check number of characters
option, the contents of the account code num-
ber are not checked. You determine how many digits are permitted by using the drop-
down list box
Characters to be checked
in HiPath 3000 Manager E, or
Code Length
in Assistant T. The number of digits checked can be from one to eleven digits.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
If you select forced for a trunk group, all stations using that trunk group are required
to use account codes to dial out. If you want some users to use account codes and
other users not to use account codes, you need to program different trunk groups.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Number of ACCTs in
the system
1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Max. length of ACCT 11 11 11 11 11
Subject Requirement or Condition
DISA, external CF,
callback, transit
The system does not query the mandatory ACCT.
Electronic notebook
(ENB)
You can program ACCT code + ACCT + station number in
the ENB.
Conference An ACCT entered during a conference with external sta-
tion is assigned to all participating calls and trunks.
Redial For V1.2 or later, an ACCT entered can also be stored in
redial memory. This requires that you set the appropriate
system-wide flag (refer to Section 3.6.1, Last Number Re-
dial (LNR)).
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-337
Features
Least cost routing
(LCR)
Mandatory ACCT is possible with or without LCR.
Telephones Users of telephones without displays must dial the seizure
code after the ACCT.
On system telephones with displays, a prompt to enter the
ACCT appears on the screen.
S0 telephones If the unchecked ACCT option is selected on S0 tele-
phones, you must always enter the full number of digits
(you cannot press #).
If the ACCT is checked, or a fixed number of digits is en-
tered, the system detects the end of the ACCT.
ACCT while on a call Only optiset E and optiPoint 500 users can enter an ac-
count code while engaged in a call.
When to enter ACCT You can enter an account code from any type of terminal
(optiset E, optiPoint 500, analog) before the call begins
(before line seizure). Only an optiset E or optiPoint 500
telephone (includes optiClient Attendant) can enter an ac-
count code during an incoming or outgoing external call.
No check
option This option is not possible if there are trunk groups flagged
with the
forced
(mandatory) entry procedure. That is, the
parameter
forced
and the option
No check
are mutually ex-
clusive.
Invalid entry If the ACCT entry is incorrect, the user sees the display
In-
valid entry
and the call is dropped.
Non-display tele-
phones
If an account code is required, the user hears silence after
dialing the trunk group access code. If the user does not
dial an account code within 30 seconds (this timer is not
variable), the user receives a busy tone, and the call is
dropped. If the correct entry is made, confirmation tone
(three short bursts of tone) is heard and the user can pro-
ceed with dialing.
Subject Requirement or Condition
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-338 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.8 Call Detail Recording Central (CDRC)
Definition
The HiPath 3000 can transmit consecutive call detail recording central (CDRC) infor-
mation for each call segment completed or for each incoming call to a connected de-
vice. The device is normally a PC for analyzing the received data or a printer.
In V1.2 and later, call data records can be recorded for external calls that were not
completed. For example, this gives the party calling proof that the destination station
did not accept the attempted call (marked in the output log with the call time
00:00:00). The CDRC outgoing without connection feature applies to digital exter-
nal traffic using ISDN and CorNet-N/Qsig and to all stations. With analog external traf-
fic (loop start), a call data record is always recorded, no matter whether CDRC out-
going without connection has been configured or not.
Call charge pulses are converted to monetary amounts on the basis of the call charge
factor defined as a currency amount (including any extra charges that may apply) per
call charge unit or pulse (refer to Section 3.13.11, Call-Charge Display With Currency
(Not for U.S.)).
The following options are available for exporting the data to an external output de-
vice:
Application programming interface (V.24) (RS-232)
CDRC data is exported to call detail recording applications such as Teledata.
PC attendant console port
Users can also forward the CDRC data to a optiClient Attendant (PC attendant
console port). This transfers the call data to the Charge.dat file, which is created
or updated whenever a new record is entered. You can use software to evaluate
this data. The PC attendant console supports the optiset E control adapter, op-
tiset E data adapter, and UP0/E card.
UP0/E port
An optiset E control adapter, to which you can attach a printer or PC, must be
connected to the UP0/E port. The system supports only one adapter per call data
output. You can configure the output as follows:
On the communications server, set call data output to adapter.
Enter the telephone number.
If only one optiset E control adapter is connected, you can choose any slot
in the telephone.
If two optiset E control adapters are connected, set the right adapter to Print-
er Pipe Mode for call data output. The other adapter is used in API1 or API2
mode.
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-339
Features
The transmission rate is permanently set to 9600 baud.
LAN interface (Ethernet)
CDRC data can be exported to external applications via the LAN interface (Ether-
net) (for more information, refer to Chapter 4).
The CDRC output can be in two different formats:
Compressed format (via V.24 / via LAN) for PC or call charge computer
The system outputs all data (including ACCT) without separating spaces, without
headers, and without form feed. Call charge pulses, call charge amounts or arith-
metic units are output.
Long format for printer
The system outputs all data (except ACCT) separated by spaces, with header (in
the language selected for the system) and form feed. The call charge amount is
output.
The following rules apply to the line format:
The carriage return (CR) and line feed (LF) control characters are transmitted at
the end of each record.
Data not supplied and unused fields are filled with spaces.
In compressed format, the data output is consecutive. No form feed (FF) is trans-
mitted.
In long format, each page contains a one-line header followed by a blank line. Af-
ter 62 characters are printed, a form feed automatically executes.
The output contains the following information:
Date (at end of call), 8 characters
Time (at end of call), 8 characters
Number of seized trunk, 3 characters
Internal station number (max. 6 digits)
Incoming ring duration
Call duration, 5 characters
External station number (up to 25 digits if available)
Call charge pulse/amount, 11 characters (blank in U.S.)
Additional information (such as incoming call, outgoing call, transferred call, con-
ference, DISA, call setup charges), 2 characters
The following data is always compressed prior to output:
ACCT (up to 11 digits)
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-340 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
MSN used (up to 11 digits for multi-device connections)
LCR access code (trunk access code, 6 digits)
LCR route used (path table, 2 digits)
Additional data in U.S.:
PRI Nodal Service
PRI WATS band
PRI Carrier Identification Code
Information elementcontains the following call information:
Incoming connection, voice/3.1khz audio
Outgoing connection, voice/3.1kHz audio.
Incoming connection, other services
Outgoing connection, other services
Incoming connecting forwarded
Outgoing connection forwarded
Int/ext/ext conference with incoming connection/transit through external transfer
Conference with outgoing connection/transit through external transfer
Outgoing connection via call forwarding to external destination
Call information is output immediately when an incoming call is receivedonly used
in external applications.
The above information elements have a special designation if DISA was involved in
the call.
Options
The last four digits of the destination number can be suppressed in the call
record. If selected, the last four spaces are filled with the symbol
?
.
The Call Duration field can be suppressed from the record. If selected, this field
is blank.
Incoming calls can be recorded. The default value is
No
(only outgoing calls are
recorded.
A call record is started as soon as an incoming call starts ringing into the system.
All fields are predefined and cannot be changed except for the options mentioned
in this section.
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-341
Features
Other configurable parameters: which RS-232 port is to be used for the CDRC
output and the baud rate (2400, 9600, or 19200).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
General requirements Printer, call charge computer
Number of calls buff-
ered
300 150 50 50 50
Subject Requirement or Condition
PC/printer failure,
buffer full
If the connected device fails, some records are buffered in
the system and transmitted when the device is reactivated.
If the buffer is full, all additional data records are lost.
Timer for analog
trunks
A system pseudo-answer timer (
Artificial End-of-Dial
) is
used when the call is placed over analog trunks without an-
swer supervision to determine the beginning of the call
record
CDRC outgoing with-
out connection
No logging takes place
for call attempts that are not allowed (LCR, denied
lists).
for premature termination of the call attempt.
Charges before con-
nect
If charges arise even before the connection is made (such
as occurs in Austria), these are recorded, regardless of
whether or not CDRC outgoing without connection has
been selected.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-342 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Output formats
Compressed Output Format for Call Details Output via Application Program-
ming Interface (V.24) (RS-232)
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 Date (8 characters)
| 2 Time (8)
| | 3 Trunk (3)
| | | 4 Internal station number (6)
| | | | 5 Ring duration (5)
| | | | | 6 Call duration (8)
| | | | | | 7 Station number (25)
| | | | | | | 8 Call charge pulses (11) (blank in U.S.)
| | | | | | | | 9 Information element (2)
| | | | | | | | | 10 ACCT (11)
| | | | | | | | | | 11 MSN (11)
| | | | | | | | | | | 12 Seizure code (5)
| | | | | | | | | | | | 13 LCR route (2)
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
V V V V V V V V V V V V V
11.12.0008:23:23 4 16 00:05:2302317324856 12 2 902725 841 (1)
11.12.0009:12:45 3 18 00:01:23834756 34 212345678901 2 (2)
11.12.0009:25:34 2 1100:34 1 (3)
11.12.0010:01:46 1 12 00:12:5383726639046287127384 5 2
11.12.0010:03:42 2 14 05:42:4338449434444495598376 245 2
11.12.0010:23:24 2 15 00:02:221234567890123412???? 83 2 (4)
11.12.0011:12:45 3 18 00:01:23834756 34 2
12.12.0012:23:34 3 1200:1500:03:12 1 (5)
12.12.0012:23:50 4 11 00:03:583844733399 7 2
12.12.0013:23:54 3 17 00:02:233844733399 8 5 (6)
12.12.0014:05:24 3 18 00:01:23834756 31 2
12.12.0014:38:43 2 12 00:03:242374844 63 2 (7a)
12.12.0014:43:33 3 12 00:00:255345545556 5 2 (7b)
12.12.0014:44:12 2 12 00:12:122374844 12 8 (7c)
12.12.0014:44:12 3 12 00:12:125345545556 10 8 (7d)
12.12.0014:56:24 2 12 00:23:462374844 84 2 (7e)
13.12.0009:43:52 1 5 00:01:0539398989983 76 4 (8)
14.12.0012:23:34 1 600:1400:02:3427348596872347569036 3 (9)
** 100 calls lost ** (10)
15.12.0009:44:34 4 15 00:02:12189???? 23 2
15.12.0009:56:33 3 14 00:05:451283394495 28 2
15.12.0012:20:26 1 12 0230298007766 0 (11a)
15.12.0012:23:34 1 1200:3400:02:340230298007766 1 (11b)
15.12.0013:43:25 3 15 00:05:2408972212345 1 (12a)
15.12.0013:43:25 4 15 00:05:240231471154321 74 9 (12b)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 18 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 32 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 16 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:46:18 4 1600:50 0230298007252 1 (13b)
15.12.0013:49:28 4 16 00:00:0002317324856 2 (14)
01.01.0000:00:00 8 23 2 (15)
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-343
Features
Explanation of the sample entries shown on page 3-342:
(1) Outgoing connection from stn 16 on trunk 4 using the MSN 902725. End of
call at 8:23:23 on 12/11/00. Duration of the call: 5 minutes, 23 seconds.
Called number: 02317324856. Accrued call charge pulses (blank in U.S.):
12. The seizure code 841 was used for call setup.
(2) Outgoing connection with 11-digit account code (ACCT) 12345678901.
Route 2 was used for LCR.
(3) Unanswered incoming call without station number (missing origin address,
active station number suppression CLIR at calling station).
(4) Outgoing connection with suppression of the last 4 digits.
(5) Incoming connection with ringing and call duration.
(6) Forwarded call.
(7) Int/ext/ext conference:
(7a) Stn 12 sets up a first external call on trunk 2 (2374844),
(7b) Stn 12 sets up a second external call on trunk 3 (5345545556),
(7c) Stn 12 is involved in a conference with trunk 2 and
(7d) with trunk 3.
(7e) Trunk 3 drops out of the conference. The call on trunk 2 is treated like a
normal outgoing call.
(8) Outgoing connection (other services).
(9) Incoming connection (other services).
(10) Loss message: 100 records were lost.
Due to a problem such as the following:
Connected device is turned off or suffers a power failure
Printer is out of paper
Printer is offline
Printer has a paper jam
CDRC output is interrupted by CDB output
Interface cable is defective or incorrect
In these or similar cases, the call records accumulated during this time are
buffered in the system. The first 300 (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700), 150 (Hi-
Path 3550 and HiPath 3500) or 50 (HiPath 3350, HiPath 3300 and HiPath
3250 [not for U.S.]) records can be buffered.
Additional records are only counted by the system and then discarded. If the
connection can be restored to the connected device, a loss message indicat-
ing the number of lost records (that is,100 calls lost) is issued after the buff-
ered records are output.
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-344 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
(11) Incoming call with transmitted caller station number:
(11a) Caller list: When the call arrives, an information line is immediately out-
put indicating the date, time, trunk, station number, incoming external station
number (if available), and information element 0 (used, for example, with a
PC: start database search -> message appears on stations monitor).
(11b) Station 12 accepted the call after a ringing duration of 34 seconds. This
line is output at the end of the call.
(12) Call forwarding with an external destination:
(12a) Incoming call for station 15 on trunk 3 with transmitted station number,
no ringing duration due to call forwarding (see 12b),
(12b) Call forwarded (12a) to trunk 4 for station number 0231471154321, 74
call charge pulses (not for U.S.) have accrued for the forwarded call.
(13) Incoming call to subscriber group (stations 18, 32, and 16):
(13a) The three entered stations are called simultaneously; they are listed in
the order in which they were entered in the group (the second station is listed
first).
(13b) The call was not accepted by any group member. After the call has
ended, a line is output indicating the ringing duration for the last called or en-
tered station.
(14) Outgoing connection attempt (CDRC outgoing without connection) from Stn
16 on line 4 at 13:49:28 (1:49:28 p.m.) on December 15, 2000. Number
called: 02317324856.
(15) Output after a power failure or reset: 23 call detail units on trunk 8 were
present before the power failure.
When a power failure or reset occurs, the call charges accrued for each trunk
are stored in nonvolatile system memory (CDRT).
The system checks for consistency between the output and internally stored
data following a power failure or system restart. The system also checks to
determine whether call charges are still stored that have not yet been output
via the V.24 (RS-232) interface. If this is the case, the system outputs a data
line using the format illustrated in the example (15) for each affected trunk:
(output does not include station number).
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-345
Features
Compressed Output Format for Call Details Output via LAN Interface
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 Date (8 characters)
| 2 Time (8)
| | 3 Trunk (3)
| | | 4 Internal station number (6)
| | | | 5 Ring duration (5)
| | | | | 6 Call duration (8)
| | | | | | 7 Station number (25)
| | | | | | | 8 Call charge pulses (11) (blank in U.S.)
| | | | | | | | 9 Information element (2)
| | | | | | | | | 10 ACCT (11)
| | | | | | | | | | 11 MSN (11)
| | | | | | | | | | | 12 Seizure code (5)
| | | | | | | | | | | | 13 LCR route (2
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
V V V V V V V V V V V V V
13.12.99;08:23:23;4;16;;00:05:23;02317324856;12;2;12345678901;902725;841;;
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Call detail records can be output via a LAN interface using two different settings:
DOS mode (carriage return (CR), line feed (LF)) = default or UNIX mode (line
feed (LF)) at the end of a call data record.
Separators (; = default or |) between the logical elements of a call data
record; the record is no longer position-oriented.
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 1 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
1 1 to 8 Date at end of call: DD.MM.YY
(DD = day, MM = month, YY = year)
8 Left
2 9 to 16 Time at end of call segment or an unan-
swered incoming call: hh:mm:ss
(hh = hours: value range 00 - 23, mm =
minutes: value range 00 - 59, ss = sec-
onds: value range 00 - 59)
8 Left
3 17 to 19 Trunk: Trunk number
Value range 1 - 120
3Right
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-346 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
4 20 to 25 Station: Internal station number
Value range: 000000 - 999999 (missing
digits are replaced by spaces.)
In the case of unanswered calls, this is the
last station called (as in a hunt group, call
forwarding, call forwardingno answer).
With group call, this is the last station en-
tered. In the case of answered calls, it is the
station that accepted the call. A pro-
grammed SNO prefix (with networking
only) is not output.
If the internal numbering was converted to
a maximum 6-digit numbering plan, the
converted station number is output.
6Right
5 26 to 30 Ringing duration of an incoming external
call: mm:ss
(mm = minutes: value range 00 - 59, ss =
seconds: value range 00 - 59)
The system displays all incoming calls as
long as the output of ringing duration has
been configured in the system. If a counter
overflow occurs (duration > 59:59), 59:59
is output. A change in date or time during
system operation can result in this situa-
tion.
5Left
6 31 to 38 Duration of the call or call segment:
hh:mm:ss
(hh = hours: value range 00 to 23,
mm = minutes: value range 00 to 59,
ss = seconds: value range 00 to 59)
If a connection has not been established for
an incoming call, 8 spaces are output here.
If a counter overflow occurs (duration >
23:59:59), 23:59:59 is output.
8Left
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 2 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-347
Features
7 39 to 63 Dialed or received external station number
(if available):
nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
(n = dialed or received characters: value
range: 0 - 9, *, #, ?)
Output occurs for incoming and outgoing
calls (if available). With outgoing calls, the
dialed station number or, if available, the
station number transmitted via COLP is dis-
played. In the case of an active data protec-
tion function, the last four digits dialed are
replaced by the symbols
????
. If no station
number information is available, 25 spaces
are output.
25 Left
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 3 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-348 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
8 64 to 74 Call charge pulses for a call segment:
zzzzzzzzzzz (blanks in U.S.)
(z = digit: value range 0 - 9)
You can select either call charge pulses or
call charge amounts.
Use the call charge factor, which is defined
as a currency amount (including a manda-
tory surcharge) for each call charge unit or
pulse, to convert call charge pulses to mon-
etary amounts (see Section 3.13.11, Call-
Charge Display With Currency (Not for
U.S.)).
Setting the call charge factor:
With calculation detail: call charge fac-
tor = 100% + mandatory surcharge
Without calculation detail: call charge
factor = amount/unit + mandatory sur-
charge
The system records the call charges with or
without a surcharge depending on the cal-
culation detail (Section 3.13.11):
The system outputs the data whenever
charges accrue for the call segment (even
when calls are transferred). If no call
charge information is available, these 11
positions remain blank.
11 Right
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 4 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Call Charge
Display
Calculation Detail
With Without
Pulses HiPath arithmetic
units output with-
out surcharge
Call charge
pulses output
without sur-
charge
Amounts HiPath arithmetic
units output with
surcharge
Monetary
amounts output
with surcharge
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-349
Features
9 75 to 76 Information element: additional information
Value range: 0 - 9
Meaning:
1 = Incoming connection (voice/
3.1 kHz audio call)
2 = Outgoing connection (voice/
3.1 kHz audio call)
3 = Incoming connection (other servic-
es)
4 = Outgoing connection (other servic-
es)
5 = Incoming connection forwarded
6 = Outgoing connection forwarded
7 = Int/ext/ext conference with incom-
ing connection/transit through external
transfer
8 = Conference with outgoing connec-
tion/transit through external transfer
9 = Outgoing connection via call for-
warding to an external destination
0 = Call information (caller list) is out-
put immediately when an incoming call
is received (output can be sup-
pressed). This can be used, for in-
stance, for a database search by a PC.
When multiple stations are called, a
line is output for each individual station
(without ring duration, call duration, call
detail information).
2Right
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 5 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-350 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Continua-
tion of 9
75 to 76 +20 = Offset as a code for call setup
charges (connection setup without call
duration)
+30 (HiPath 3000 V1.0 and later) = off-
set as an ID for a follow-up data record
in the case of
call duration > 24 h.
contiguous call segments with the
same line/station number (for ex-
ample, after transferring a call, af-
ter clearing a conference).
Can occur in combination with offset
+40.
+40 = Offset for a data record with tran-
sit code (by an extension in the sub-
system). Can occur in combination
with offset +30.
+50 = Offset as a code for DISA calls
+70 = combination of offsets +30 and
+40
2Right
10 77 to 87 Account code (ACCT) entered by the user
for this call: ppppppppppp
(p = ACCT digit: value range 0 - 9)
If an ACCT has not been entered, 11 spac-
es are output. If the ACCT is shorter than
11 digits, the remaining characters are
filled with spaces.
11 Left
11 88 to 98 MSN used: mmmmmmmmmmm
(m = MSN digit: value range 0 - 9)
Information is displayed if the user has pro-
grammed an MSN key. Non-existent char-
acters are replaced by spaces. If MSN in-
formation is not available (as in a point-to-
point connection), 11 spaces are output in-
stead of these characters.
11 Right
12 99 to 103 Seizure code used, access code: bbbbb
(b = digit of the seizure code: value range 0
- 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
5Right
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 6 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-351
Features
13 104 to
105
LCR route used: rr
(r = digit of the dialed route: value range 0 -
9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
2Right
14 106 to
107
PRI nodal service: nn
(n = digit: value range 0 - 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
2Right
15 108 PRI WATS band: w
(w = digit: value range 0 - 9)
If no information is available, a space is out-
put.
1
16 109 to
112
PRI Carrier Identification Code (CIC): cccc
(c = CIC digit: value range 0 - 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
4Right
14 106 to
107
U.S.-specific fields are filled with blanks in
other countries.
2Right
15 108 1
16 109 to
112
4Right
17 113 to
114
End of line control character
(carriage return [CR], line feed [LF])
2
Table 3-10 Compressed Output FormatExplanation of Output Fields (Sheet 7 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-352 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Long Output Format for Call Data
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Date Time Trk Stn Call Duration Station number Amount I
11.12.93 08:23:23 4 16 00:05:23 02317324856 20,23 2
11.12.93 09:12:45 3 18 00:01:23 834756 0,69 2
11.12.93 09:25:34 2 11 00:34 1
11.12.93 10:01:46 1 12 00:12:53 83726639046287127384 413,69 2
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The header in the long output format (Figure 3-16) is output in the language used
across the system.
After 62 lines have printed (including header), a form feed (FF) is carried out and
the next page begins with a header.
Table 3-11 Long output format - explanation of output fields
Field Fields Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Date 1 to 8 See Table 3-10, Field position 1 8 Left
Time 10 to 17 See Table 3-10, Field position 2 8 Left
Trk 19 to 21 See Table 3-10, Field position 3 3 Right
Stn 23 to 28 See Table 3-10, Field position 4 6 Right
Call 30 to 34 See Table 3-10, Field position 5 6 Left
Duration 36 to 43 See Table 3-10, Field position 6 8 Left
Station
number
45 to 64 Dialed or, if available, the received external
station number:nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
(n = dialed or received character: value
range 0 - 9, *, #, ?)
See also Table 3-10, field position 7
20 Left
Amount 66 to 76 Call charge amount for a call segment:
zzzzzzzzzzz (blank spaces in U.S.)
(z = digit: value range 0 - 9)
Output always occurs when call charges
accrue for the call segment (even with
transferred calls). If no call detail informa-
tion is available, these 11 characters are
filled with spaces. A comma (,) separates
the amount from the decimal places.
11 Right
I 78 to 79 See Table 3-10, field position 9 2 Right
80 to 81 End of line control character
(carriage return [CR], line feed [LF])
2
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-353
Features
3.13.9 Toll Fraud Monitoring
Definition
This feature can provide the customer with protection against toll fraud.
In the case of trunk-to-trunk connections, the customer can detect a possible fraudu-
lent use by monitoring outgoing trunk calls.
When connection times exceed a defined duration, an indication is displayed on the
attendance console (AC). If necessary, the connection can be released by means of
a procedure.
No default time (
Toll Fraud monitoring
timer) is specified for this feature; that is, the
attendant console will not be alerted unless the timer is set to a specific value.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-354 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.13.10 Printer Pipe Mode (V.24 [RS-232] Range Extension for Call Data)
Definition
This feature outputs call charges to the optiset E control adapter. Only
one
printer
pipe mode can be active in a system, and only
one
call detail recording (CDR) output
can be supported in a system (via RS-232 or the optiset E control adapter).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Settings The parameters for call data output to the optiset E control
adapter are permanently set to 9600,N, 8, 1.
Features for Call Detail Recordin
g
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-355
Features
3.13.11 Call-Charge Display With Currency (Not for U.S.)
Definition
Call charge information received with the AOC (advice of charges) feature during ex-
ternal calls on digital trunks appears on the telephone display, provided that the car-
rier makes this information available.
The public network supports the following AOC types:
AOC-D = Charging information during the call
AOC-E = Charging information at the end of a call
AOC-S = Charging information at call setup
With AOC-D and AOC-S, digital exchanges can also transmit currency amounts that
are then added to the call data evaluated in the system. These amounts are not mul-
tiples of the call charge pulses or call detail units; they are actual currency amounts.
The new
calculation accuracy
parameter helps avoid inaccuracies from arising when
recording the call data. It determines
The number of decimal points the system uses for evaluating the call data = min-
imum currency amount.
The maximum number of currency amounts added up in memory = maximum to-
tal currency amount.
Set the
Calculation accuracy
parameter so that the system accuracy is equal to the
accuracy of the currency amounts transmitted by the ISDN exchange. If the maximum
of three decimal places is insufficient, the system automatically rounds up the number
to the next unit. The following values are possible:
If you set
Calculation accuracy = delete
, the system switches back to evaluating call
data in the form of call-charge pulses.
Calculation Accuracy Minimum Currency
Amount
Maximum Currency
Amount
3
(Pounds Sterling)
1 x 103 = 0.001 1 x 103 x (232 1) =
around 4.3 million
21 x 10
2 = 0.01 1 x 102 x (232 1) =
around 43 million
11 x 10
1 = 0.1 1 x 101 x (232 1) =
around 430 million
0
(Italian Lira)
1 x 100 = 1 1 x 100 x (232 1) =
around. 4.3 billion
Features for Call Detail Recording
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-356 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
You cannot use HiPath arithmetic units if the digital exchange supplies call charge
pulses.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Plus Products Select the factor for converting call detail units to currency
amounts as follows:
Conversion factor =
(call charge factor in %) / (100 x 10calcuation accuracy)
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-357
Features
3.14 Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Definition
The HiPath 3000 system complies with the DSS1 standard, which specifies the re-
quirements for the uniform communication structure standardized by ETSI through-
out Europe.
Euro-ISDN provides users with various features that can be activated either perma-
nently in the trunk or by means of a procedure. It is not necessary to configure the
feature specifically.
The features available with Euro-ISDN and HiPath 3000 are listed below.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
Long S0 bus Not available with TA-S0 and STMD8 (HiPath 3750 and Hi-
Path 3700).
Features Operation for features is the same as for analog stations.
Control is by means of information elements in the proto-
col.
PC connected to S0A PC can be connected to the internal S0 applications bus
using an ISDN S0 card.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-358 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.1 Direct Inward Dialing (DID)
Definition
This feature allows a direct connection via the public network to an extension in a
communications server using the ISDN numbering plan.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature ––––
Subject Requirement or Condition
DID The extensions in the communications server must have at
least outward restricted class of service, and direct inward
dialing must be permitted.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-359
Features
3.14.2 Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN)
Definition
Multiple subscriber numbers enable you to assign several different station numbers
on the same S0 basic access (bus or multi-device connection). You can assign each
terminal an MSN up to 11 digits long so that it can be called selectively.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk board
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
MSN MSNs can be up to 11 digits long.
If an MSN is too long, the system evaluates the first 11 dig-
its, beginning at the right.
MSN The system activates features based on MSNs.
CDRC Call detail recording central is possible.
MSN If the MSN for a
Setup
is missing or invalid, a default MSN
appropriate to the situation is used. When a station num-
ber is specified that is already in use (optiset E or optiPoint
500), the
Setup
is rejected.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-360 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.3 Default Station Number Instead of Multiple Subscriber Number (MSN)
Definition
This feature was created to increase security and to settle call charges (in a hotel en-
vironment, for example). Previously, the system was able to automatically configure
each valid MSN. This meant that the settlement of call charges and call detail record-
ing took place under a number which the CS operator did not necessarily enter.
In addition to dialing an MSN, users now have the option of dialing the internal default
station number instead.
Below is a brief explanation:
The system assigns a sequential default number to each port, and therefore each
telephone, in ascending order (starting with 101 in the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
system). This means that each ISDN S0 bus is assigned a default number. For an
ISDN adapter, the default number is identical to the number of the logical port in the
client (secondary) optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone. The system assigns valid sta-
tion numbers by default, although they can be changed with HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Every station number is always assigned to one logical port number.
The default numbers can be used as follows:
Outgoing call setup:
The system sets up the call using the default number, regardless of the MSN sent
by a telephone or application. Customers are billed on the basis of the default
number (in a hotel environment, this can be the room number), combined with a
fixed number combination.
Incoming call setup:
When a customer equates the MSN of an application (which may be installed on
a notebook computer and connected to the hotel telephone network via an ISDN
adapter) with the default number of a hotel room (combined with a fixed number
combination), callers can reach the PC directly from the outside by direct inward
dialing.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-361
Features
3.14.4 Calling Line Identification Presentation (CLIP)
Definition
This feature transmits the callers own station number to the called party, where it can
be displayed if proper equipment is available. The public network must support station
number transmission.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with display
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CLIP Must be released by the carrier.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-362 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.5 Calling Line Identification Restriction (CLIR)
Definition
This feature suppresses the transmission of the calling partys station number. The
public network must support suppression (temporary or permanent).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Co feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CLIR Calling line identification restriction can be defined across
the system.
CLIR HiPath 3000 Manager E can be used to ignore an activated
CLIR setting across the system, allowing the calling partys
station number to be displayed (on the development level
only). This can be useful for emergency calls and in similar
situations.
CLIR Calling line presentation restriction per station:
*86 = activate
#86 = deactivate
It is not possible to ignore an activated CLIR setting per
station.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-363
Features
3.14.6 Connected Line Identification Presentation (COLP)
Definition
This feature allows the calling party to determine whether the connection has actually
been connected to the station called or whether it was picked up by a different station.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 with display
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
COLP Must be released by the carrier.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-364 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.7 Connected Line Identification Restriction (COLR)
Definition
This feature suppresses transmission of the called partys station number to the call-
ing station. Called parties can use COLR to prevent their numbers from being dis-
played on a calling station.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
COLR Same CDB entry as CLIR.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-365
Features
3.14.8 Advice of Charge (AOC)
Definition
This feature offers the user call detail information and must be provided by the pubic
network. The information is transmitted in three ways:
AOC-S - Advice of charges at call setup
Call charge display on the telephone is the same as for AOC-D.
The charges are not displayed if the call was not fully set up or if HiPath 3000
is unable to evaluate the call detail information of a service provider.
AOC-D - Advice of charges during the call.
AOC-E - Advice of charges at the end of the call.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
AOC Some countries transmit call charge pulses instead of the
amount. In this case, the received pulses are converted to
currency amounts using a call charge factor (as on analog
trunks).
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-366 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.9 Call Forwarding (CF)
Definition
There are three different call forwarding types:
Chaining call forwarding unconditional
Users can activate variable call forwarding or call forwarding preset by key pro-
gramming (unconditional, immediate) for the following call types:
Incoming internal calls only
Incoming external calls only
All calls
This is possible even if the same station is already set as a forwarding destination
or if the forwarding destination has already activated call forwarding.
The message Chaining invalid no longer appears when you enter a second call
forwarding destination during programming.
When a user forwards a dialed party to a station which already activated uncon-
ditional, immediate call forwarding to another station, the system monitors the
number of call forwarding operations allowed. A preprogrammed counter limits
the number of call forwarding operations to a total of 5.
The following example clarifies this procedure:
Stn A activated call forwarding to stn B: 1. CFU
Stn B activated call forwarding to stn C: 2. CFU
Stn C activated call forwarding to stn D: 3. CFU
Stn D activated call forwarding to stn E: 4. CFU
Stn E activated call forwarding to stn F: 5. CFU
Stn F activated call forwarding to stn G: 6. CFU (not possible)
If stn X calls stn A, the call reaches stn F, not stn G.
The system forwards the counters with CFU, but not with CFB or CFNR.
Call forwarding busy (CFB))
Same as CFU but only if the line is busy.
Call forwarding no reply (CFNR))
Same as CFU, but only if the call is not answered within 15 seconds (time is con-
figurable).
Use call management to define the lines for
busy
and
no reply
.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-367
Features
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CF Not possible with an S2M line.
CF In the case of a point-to-point connection, the entire line is
forwarded. In the case of a point-to-multipoint connection,
only the MSN assigned to the extension with programming
authorization is forwarded. If no MSN is assigned to this
station. call forwarding cannot be activated.
CF Call forwarding is always executed for the first basic ac-
cess, that is the first S0 port must also be available in the
system.
Internal to S0Internal stations support CFU only (to prevent conflicts
with call management).
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-368 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.10 External Call Forwarding
Definition
Any user who has an MSN as a DID number can activate and deactivate external call
forwarding for this MSN, provided that the user is authorized to use external call for-
warding. A total of 10 multiple subscriber numbers can be forwarded.
If you have assigned an MSN to a subscriber group, any member of the group can
activate and deactivate external call forwarding for this MSN.
Users can enter only one forwarding destination per MSN.
There are three different versions of the feature:
Call forwarding unconditional (CFU)
The carrier forwards all calls to this MSN directly, regardless of the MSN status.
Call forwarding busy (CFB)
Calls are forwarded only if the MSN dialed is busy.
Call forwarding no reply (CFNR)
Calls are forwarded only if the destination does not answer the incoming call with-
in a preset period of time, such as 15 seconds (time is configurable).
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CFU External call forwarding has a higher priority than night an-
swer.
CFU The number of MSNs for external call forwarding cannot
exceed 10.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-369
Features
3.14.11 Call Deflection (CD)
Definition
If a station has activated external call forwarding, HiPath 3000 attempt to forward calls
to the trunk using this feature. In this case, the new call destination and the station
number of the forwarding station are provided to the trunk in the call deflection acti-
vation message when the call arrives. If external call forwarding by call deflection is
not possible, the system handles call forwarding.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature –––––
Subject Requirement or Condition
Call detail information When call deflection is used, HiPath 3000 receive no call
detail information for the forwarded call.
Customers are billed by their local Telecom.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-370 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.12 Subaddressing (SUB)
Definition
Subaddressing allows the addressing capacity to be expanded regardless of the
ISDN station number or additional information to be transmitted to the station dialed.
This makes it possible to initiate certain procedures.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
SUB The flow of information is in one direction only.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-371
Features
3.14.13 Malicious Call Identification (MCID)
Definition
This feature makes it possible to identify unwanted callers. The feature is activated in
the public network, and the callers station number and name are also stored in the
public network. With each incoming call, the release of the connection to the called
station is delayed for a specific period of time after the caller hangs up, enabling the
called station to activate this feature. Release is delayed only if the feature has been
requested from the carrier or facility provider.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
MCID Malicious call ID is supported only on a direct trunk con-
nection and not in tie traffic (QSig or CorNet-N).
MCID Trunk release is delayed.
MCID The
malicious call ID
class of service can be programmed
for individual stations.
MCID internal to S0Activation is forwarded to the trunk.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-372 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.14 Competition of Calls to Busy Subscribers (CCBS)
Definition
This feature sets automatic callback from an external station that is busy. When the
station becomes free, the trunk attempts to set up a connection between the two sta-
tions.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CCBS The feature must be supported by the trunk and the remote
station.
CCBS Does not function with 1TR6.
CCBS A callback option to the networked system is generated
within networked communications servers.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-373
Features
3.14.15 Call Hold (CH)
Definition
Users can interrupt a call in progress without releasing it. Doing so places the call on
hold. Call hold (CH) is important in conjunction with other features such as call wait-
ing, consultation hold, toggle, and three-party conference. The ISDN port on hold re-
ceives an indication of the hold state and retrieval of the call.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CH The feature is available only on multi-device connections.
In communications servers, the call is held in the server.
The information element is sent to the trunk.
CH Non-ISDN stations do not receive an advisory announce-
ment (except that the station is placed on hold in the CS).
CH A call can be placed on hold only in the active phase or
during connection setup.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-374 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.16 Three Party Service (3PTY)
Definition
A three-party (3PTY) conference is possible with a multi-device connection. The con-
ference status is indicated at the ISDN port.
On the user side, note that the other conference participants join the conference in
the system, that is, only one B channel is needed for the S0 applications bus.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
Conference For multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, the
conference is executed in the CS. The information element
is transmitted to the trunk.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-375
Features
3.14.17 Call Waiting (CW)
Definition
When a busy party receives a call, a call waiting tone indicates that another call has
arrived and may be answered. The call waiting status is transmitted to the trunk.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
CW (call waiting) For multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, call
waiting is executed in the CS. The information element is
transmitted to the trunk.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-376 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.18 Telephone Portability (TP)
Definition
This feature allows a user to park a call on the bus, unplug the telephone, plug it in
again at another location on the bus, and resume the parked call. The parked station
receives a message indicating that the user is porting. The user has three minutes to
move the telephone.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk board
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature xxxxx
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
TP At multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, the
external station is parked in the CS. The information ele-
ment is transmitted to the trunk.
TP The call must be resumed within 3 minutes.
TP This feature cannot be used with services such as fax,
teletex and data transmission.
TP internal to S0In the case of a Gigaset ISDN, this feature is used for a
handover between two radio cells and for implementing the
call park feature. Implementation is by the system.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-377
Features
3.14.19 User to User Signaling (UUS1)
Definition
This feature allows users to exchange messages during connection setup. The net-
work transmits the messages transparently; checking only the length. Three UUS
services are available:
UUS1: Information is exchanged in control messages for connection setup and
during connection release.
USS2: Information is exchanged during the ringing phase. The number of mes-
sages is limited to two per trunk group. USS2 is available for telecommunications
ports only.
USS3: Information is exchanged during the active state of a connection.
HiPath 3000 currently support only UUS1.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature x x x x x
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
USS1 In the case of a multi-device connection, the user must en-
sure that only one device transmits a message to an in-
coming call.
USS1 HiPath 3000 currently support only UUS1
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-378 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.20 Explicit Call Transfer (ECT)
Definition
A station with two calls can connect the other two call parties to one another. One of
the calls must have already been set up. Transfer before and after answering is pos-
sible.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 trunk connection
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature –––––
Station feature x x x x x
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-379
Features
3.14.21 Point-to-Point Connection on the User Side
Definition
It is possible to configure an S0 port on the user side as a point-to-point connection,
for example to use a connected fax server. The port is assigned a station number that
supports direct inward dialing. Call forwarding can also be programmed at this port.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 subscriber line
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature –––––
Station feature x x x x x
Subject Requirement or Condition
PtP Only the DID, CLIP, CLIR, and AOC features are support-
ed.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-380 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.22 Programming National and International Codes for Outgoing Calls
Definition
The callers station number, including the trunk access code (0, for example), the na-
tional prefix (0, for example) or the international prefix (00, for example), appears in
the optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephone display, the caller list, and dialing aids (such
as Smartset).
Carriers are reached by dialing a separate national prefix (1 digit) or international pre-
fix (2 digits). If a HiPath 3000 system provides access to more than one carrier (sep-
arate port or shared port), it is not possible to determine the carrier from which incom-
ing calls arrive.
To represent a prefix, this feature enables you to configure the national and interna-
tional access codes (national and international prefixes). A number between 0 and 9
can be used as the values for the programmable digits.
This allows calls to be answered with the help of caller lists and Smartset even when
carriers are used. The existing prefixes are also used for the carriers.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements S0 board ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
CO feature –––––
Station feature xxxxx
Subject Requirement or Condition
National or interna-
tional prefix
Only one national or international prefix exists for the entire
system. The programmed prefix (and the carrier codes)
can be up to 2 digits long.
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-381
Features
3.14.23 Caller ID After Release (Police)
Definition
This feature places the calling partys number in caller list 0 after the call is released.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements –––––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Euro-ISDN Features (Not for U.S.)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-382 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.14.24 Collect Call Barring for ISDN Trunks (V3.0 and later)
Definition
This feature allows the automatic release of incoming collect calls in the network; oth-
er calls are not changed.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements Digital trunk connection
SW requirements V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
V3.0
or later
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-383
Features
3.15 U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Definition
In the United States, ISDN is offered by most local telephone companies. ISDN is an
all-digital voice and data transmission technology. In contrast to analog transmis-
sions, ISDN uses B (bearer) channels to carry voice and data traffic and a D (data)
channel to carry customer call data and control signals. There are two basic types of
ISDN interfaces. These interfaces are the primary rate interface (PRI) and the basic
rate interface (BRI).
A PRI is for large commercial telephony operations and consists of 23 B channels and
1 D channel. A BRI is for smaller or residential-type telephony needs and consists of
2 B channels and 1 D channel. To configure these ISDN interfaces, users must know
the type of HiPath 3000 system that they are configuring. The following are the ISDN
interfaces that were designed to work with the HiPath 3000 system:
BRI with the HiPath 3350 and HiPath 3300
Both PRI and BRI with the HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500
PRI with the HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
The ISDN features are activated at the central office (CO).
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-384 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.15.1 PRI
Introduction
The HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 systems can be con-
figured to support Primary Rate services from the public network. A primary rate in-
terface (PRI) consists of 23 bearer (B) channels and 1 data (D) channel. Each chan-
nel supports 64 Kbps of bandwidth.
The HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700 support a maximum of five T1 interfaces (TMST1)
that can be configured as primary rate interfaces. A Channel Service Unit (CSU) is
required for each interface connected to the public network. (Siemens ICN supports
certain models of CSU that have been tested with the HiPath 3000. Contact your Si-
emens ICN representative for the model numbers). The HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700
support a maximum of four Call by Call (CBC) groups. Each group can be configured
with a maximum of eight CBC trunk groups.
The HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 support one T1 interface (TST1 module) that can
be configured as a primary rate interface. A CSU is required for each interface con-
nected to the public network. The HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 support a maximum
of one CBC group. The group can also be configured with a maximum of eight CBC
trunk groups. Typically, the entire T1 span is placed in a single trunk group, but de-
pending on the application, the primary rate channels can be separated into discrete
route groups. This may be required for applications where a portion of the channels
can be separated out for non-system data applications.
A span or spans must be selected as the reference interface for the Central Office. A
hierarchical table is provided for assigning four reference-clock points. If the primary
clock source fails, the next clock source specified is used as the reference. When the
primary clock source returns, the system automatically resynchronizes to this clock.
A maximum of four reference clocks can be defined per system.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements TMST1 TST1
Number of T1 mod-
ules per system
51
Number of CBC
groups per system
41
Number of trunk
groups per CBC group
88
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-385
Features
Depending on the PRI providers requirements, users need to configure some or all
of the following for PRI setup:
Signal, protocol, and emulation type
Frame/line/encoding
B channel allocation mode and identifier
Number of B channels
Trunk group calling service
For networking with PRI, customers can use either tie trunks or the public-switched
telephone network.
Protocol type allows customers to select the interface between the HiPath 3750, Hi-
Path 3550, HiPath 3700 or HiPath 3500 and the PRI provider. Protocols are different
for local exchange carriers (LECs) and for inter-exchange carriers (IECs). Customers
might prefer an IEC, for example, if they want to place calls on a tie trunk using station
numbers without going through the local exchange.
Customers can choose a different carrier and protocol for each PRI span. The HiPath
3000 systems support seven commonly used LEC protocols and seven commonly
used IEC protocols.Table 3-12 and Table 3-13 on page 3-386 show the protocols
available for each slot.
LEC Protocols
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Table 3-12 Supported LEC Protocols
LEC Carrier Switch Protocol
AT&T 5ESS Custom
AT&T 5ESS NI-2
Bell Canada DMS100 Custom
GTE GTT5 NI-2
Nortel DMS100 Custom
Siemens EWSD Custom
Siemens EWSD NI-2
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-386 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
IEC Protocols
Emulation type is determined by the protocol. Users need to select the emulation
type that matches the ISDN service they have ordered: Super Frame (SF) or Extend-
ed Super Frame (ESF).
The data format for SF emulation is inverted high-level data link control (HDLC); The
data format for ESF is normal HDLC.
Frame/line/encoding allows customers to select the type of encoding used on the D
channel. The choices are normal or inverted. Normal is the default. The type of frame
and line encoding depends on the protocol. HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3500 automati-
cally set the correct type of frame and line encoding according to the protocol.
B channel allocation mode and identifier allows customers to select the system
method of finding an available B channel when needed. The choices are high and low.
High begins searching at the highest-numbered B channel of the highest-numbered
T1 span in the PRI trunk group and continues in descending order. Low begins
searching at the lowest-numbered B channel of the lowest-numbered T1 span in the
PRI trunk group and continues in ascending order.
Select the opposite mode from that used by the CO; this will avoid collisions when
both the CO and the HiPath 3000 are trying to seize a channel.
Number of B channels allows users to enter the number of B channels for the sys-
tem, so that the system knows where to begin searching for channels to allocate. The
number entered here depends on the number of B channels that the customer has
ordered.
Table 3-13 Supported IEC Protocols
IEC Carrier Switch Protocol
AT&T 4ESS Custom
MCI DMS250 AT&T 4ESS emulation
MCI DEX600 AT&T 4ESS emulation
Sprint DMS250 AT&T 4ESS emulation
Westinghouse DMS250 AT&T 4ESS emulation
GSA DMS250 DMS250
GSA FTS 2000 5ESS 5ESS
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-387
Features
Trunk group calling service allows users to select the type of service for each trunk
group. The HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath 3300 support 36
types of trunk group service. Customers select the type of service according to the
service ordered from the ISDN provider.
The following tables outline the voice and data services available through the public
network providers in the North American market.
If you are unsure the trunk group calling service, consult the ISDN provider for more
information.
Table 3-14 Inter-Exchange (IEC) Protocol Calling Services
ATT 4ESS MCI
DMS250/
MCI
DEX600
SPRINT
DMS250
Westing.
DMS250
FTS2000
DMS/5ESS
In-WATS
(800)
Megacom
800-TFM
MCI 800 ULTRA 800 WICN-In-
WATS
N/A
Out-WATS Megacom MCI Prism-
WATS
SPR Ultra
WATS
WICN-Out-
WATS
N/A
In-WATS
(900)
Multiquest MC!/900 N/A N/A N/A
Intl IN-WATS Inter-800 MCI 800 N/A N/A N/A
PVN AT&T SDDN MCI VN-VS SPRINT-
VPN
N/A N/A
Intl VPN AT & T S D N -
GSDN
N/A SPRINT-
VPN
N/A N/A
SDS 56 Accu-SDS NONE Accu-SDS Accu-SDS N/A
SDS 94-c/r Accu-SDS NONE Accu-SDS Accu-SDS N/A
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-388 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Table 3-15 Local Exchange (LEC) Protocol Calling Services
AT&T
5ESS/
Siemens
EWSD
Nortel
DMS100
Bell Cnd
DMS100
Generic NI2
Siemens NI2
AT&T 5ESS NI2
In-WATS (800) Megacom DMS100 In-
WATS
NI2 InWATS
Out-WATS Megacom DMS100 Out-
WATS
NI2 OutWATS
In WATS (900) N/A N/A N/A
Intl InWATS (800) N/A N/A N/A
PVN N/A DMS100 PV N/A
Multiband OutWATS Megacom DMS100 Out-
WATS
NI2 OutWATS
Access to LEC operator None None None
Access to default IEC op-
erator
None None None
Equal access to IEC Long
Distance services
Megacom DMS100 Out-
WATS
NI2 OutWATS
Basic CO access None None None
Access to IEC operator None None None
SDS-56 None None None
SDS-64 c/r None None None
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-389
Features
3.15.2 BRI
Introduction
To set up the HiPath 3000 for BRI ISDN, users must receive service profile identifier
designator (SPID) numbers from the telephone company (telco). SPID numbers iden-
tify the type of ISDN service and the variety of features that customers receive. In ad-
dition, to allow direct access to specific devices, some BRI interfaces can be set up
with CACH EKTS. Depending on the central office (CO) switch type, users have to
configure either call appearance identification (CAID) values (also known as CACH
values) or phantom direct inward dialing (PDID) numbers for all devices that make ex-
ternal calls.
Depending on the central office (CO) protocol selected, users need to configure some
or all of the following parameters for BRI setup:
CO protocol
SPID administration
CAID administration (AT&T or EWSD)
PDID administration (DMS100)
Feature identification number (FIN) for message waiting
CO Features (Transfer/Conference/Drop)
Feature identification number (FIN) for Transfer, Conference and Drop
CACH EKTS flag (AT&T or EWSD)
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-390 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
CO protocol is the interface between the HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300 and the CO of the BRI provider. Select the protocol that the BRI provider
uses. support the following CO protocols:
AT & T N I 1
AT & T C u s t o m
Siemens NI1
Nortel NI1
Nortel NI1 requires PDID values instead of CAID values; for more information refer to
PDID administration on page 3-391.
SPID administration allows customers to set service profile identification designator
values. Each BRI line is assigned two SPID values. The HiPath 3000 systems support
a maximum of eight SPID values. The SPID values can be assigned to any combina-
tion of digital stations or digital data terminals and could be required for some data
terminals. SPID numbers are used by the CO to identify each terminal for features
such as message waiting, call transfer, and conference. Customers must configure
the numbers in sequence according to the order of the stations in the system. A pri-
mary directory number is assigned to each SPID address number.
Consult the BRI provider for specific SPID number information.
CAID administration allows customers to set call appearance identification values
when the CO switch type is AT&T or EWSD. CAID values are one or two digits that
are assigned by the central office to the primary and secondary system numbers. A
CAID value represents a talk path from a voice station or a data terminal to a BRI
channel. A station must have at least one associated CAID value programmed to
place or receive an external call directly without attendant intervention. Each device
in the system can have up to four CAID values.
Multiple CAID values must be assigned to a station to allow for external telephone
functions, such as to answer camp-on calls and conference calls. CAID values are
used to simulate multiple call handling at a single desktop station. That is, each CAID
number simulates an additional extension (a call appearance), but the additional ex-
tension numbers do not actually represent outside trunk lines.
If you are unsure of the CO protocol, consult the ISDN provider.
Some COs do not assign CAID values to ISDN data terminals. If you do not know
the CAID numbers assigned to the system, consult the BRI provider.
U.S. ISDN (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-391
Features
PDID administration allows customers to set phantom direct inward dialing identifi-
cation numbers (PDIDs). PDID numbers take the place of CAID values in the Nortel
DMS100 NI1 CO only. Customers can assign PDID numbers to all voice and data ter-
minals in the system. This allows incoming calls to be routed to the specified station
or ISDN terminal without attendant intervention.
The PDID number can be from 1 to 7 digits in length, corresponding to a traditional
seven-digit phone number.
PDIDs or directory numbers (DNs) are assigned by the ISDN provider.
FIN for message waiting allows users to set the feature identification number (FIN)
for the BRI message waiting feature provided by the LEC. The LEC assigns FIN val-
ues to associate the feature with specific HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 or
HiPath 3300 stations; contact the LEC to obtain the FIN values for the stations.
The message waiting FIN value can only be assigned to stations with primary direc-
tory numbers.
With FIN for message waiting, customers must enter a FIN value for each station. Ev-
ery station must have a FIN value assigned; however, each station can have the same
number.
CO features (Transfer/Conference/Drop) allows the customer to enable the CO fea-
tures Transfer, Conference, and Drop.
FIN for Transfer, Conference and Drop allows customers to set the feature identifi-
cation numbers (FIN) for the BRI Transfer, Conference, and Drop features provided
by the LEC in the case of NI1 (AT&T NI1, Siemens NI1, or Nortel NI1). The FIN must
be the same for all the BRI interfaces; contact the LEC to obtain the FIN values for
these features.
CACH EKTS flag allows customers to indicate which of the BRI interfaces are con-
figured within the LEC as CACH EKTS.
CACH is one of the methods used to have BRI emulate an analog hunt. Although
there is a CACH setting in the NT DMS, it does not react in the same manner; the
CACH setting in the DMS does not allow the sharing of DNs. Administration of CACH
values in the HiPath 3000 is referred to as CAID (Call Appearance IDentification) ad-
ministration.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-392 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16 U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
3.16.1 Multi-Device Connection
Definition
An ISDN multi-device connection enables users to connect multiple ISDN terminals
(such as Internet and ISDN video devices) on an ISDN S0 applications bus. You can
use the direct inward dialing (DID) number field to assign multiple subscriber numbers
(MSNs) that will uniquely identify the devices.
Related Topics
Section 3.16.10, Multiple Subscriber Number, on page 3-401
Model-Specific Data
Requirements and Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements STMD8
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement or Condition
ISDN terminals Any parallel-connected ISDN terminals must be given an
MSN to ensure call assignments.
Trunk groups with PP
and PMR
If you connect different basic access points (point-to-point
and point-to-multipoint) to the system, they must be en-
tered in different trunk groups, and Prime Line must be de-
activated.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-393
Features
3.16.2 Call-By-Call Service Selection
Definition
Call-by-Call service selection (CBC) lets the user select a different type of service for
each channel, such as INWATS channels and some OUTWATS channels within the
same trunk group.
The following are the four main features provided through call-by-call (CBC):
Foreign Exchange Non-ISDN Facility
This trunk type enables users to originate or terminate calls as if there was a local
CS in the foreign (remote) central exchange office. Access to the foreign ex-
change (FX) is possible via LCR or trunk group access codes.
Tie Trunk Non-ISDN Facility
This trunk type enables users to connect to a privately leased analog Tie Trunk
network. Access for originating calls is possible through LCR. Terminating Tie
Trunk calls are routed according to the called party number (CdPn).
OUTWATS Facility
This feature allows customers to place calls to certain areas at special lower
rates.
INWATS Facility
This feature supports the 800 area code that provides callers toll-free access to
the terminating party. This is a terminating only service.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements/Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement/Condition
Simulated Facility
Groups (SFG)
FX and Tie Trunk incoming and outgoing calls require an
SFG access code, which is assigned by the telephone
company at the time of subscription.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-394 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.3 Dedicated (Pre-Provisioned) Service Selection
This feature simplifies the service ordering process by supplying ordering codes that
tell the central office how to configure the HiPath 3000.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-395
Features
3.16.4 Transfer
Definition
This feature allows calls to be transferred the same as non-ISDN calls.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-396 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.5 Camp-On
Definition
This feature allows calls to be camped-on until the busy line is free. Once the line is
free, the user call is signaled through.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-397
Features
3.16.6 Conference Call
Definition
This feature allows multiple callers to communicate simultaneously.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-398 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.7 Equal Access
Definition
This feature complies with the FCC requirement to provide equal access to alternate
carriers.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-399
Features
3.16.8 Special Access Selection
Definition
With this feature users can select specific access codes. HiPath 3000 systems sup-
port the following four options:
Local Exchange Carrier (LEC) Operator Access
The system routes calls through the PRI to the network after the user dials 0
to
connect to the LEC operator.
Inter-exchange Carrier (IEC) Operator Access
After the user dials an operator access code, a carrier identification code (CIC),
and a 0, the system routes the call through the PRI and to the network, connect-
ing the call to the IEC operator.
Operator Assisted Credit Card Call Access
This feature routes PRI calls to the network using an operator access code, a 0
or 01, and a called party number (CdPn), allowing operator assisted calls with a
calling card.
N11 Access
Most commonly used for 911 access, this feature routes PRI calls to the network
via an operator access code and N11, where N is any digit from 1 to 9.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-400 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.9 Direct Inward Dialing
Definition
The basic electronic key telephone system (EKTS) supports the sharing of directory
numbers over several ISDN lines, allowing for direct inward dialing (DID).
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements STMD8 STLS 4 STLS 4
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
DID The extensions in the CS must at the very least be outward
restricted and direct inward dialing must be permitted.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-401
Features
3.16.10 Multiple Subscriber Number
Definition
Multiple subscriber numbers (MSNs) are used to identify ISDN terminals connected
to an S0 bus in the HiPath 3000 systems. MSNs are 11 digits in length. They are en-
tered in the DID number field in system administration.
You can assign each ISDN terminal one or two MSNs, depending on the application.
A device requiring 64 Kbps of bandwidth must be assigned one MSN; a device requir-
ing 128 Kbps of bandwidth must be assigned two MSNs. The call number associated
with the MSN is dialed to reach the device during an internal data or voice transaction.
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xxx
HW requirements STMD8 or
ISDN adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
STLS4
STLS4R
or ISDN
adapter
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
MSN MSNs are assigned in the DID number field for each ISDN
terminal. This number is used as the internal SPID for the
device.
Primary Directory
Number (PDN)
The PDN associated with public network BRI link must be
entered in the DID field for the ISDN terminal to initiate
calls to the external network.
MSN for internal use
only
Enter a seven-digit number not associated with the PDN in
the DID field.
External SPIDs The public network SPIDs for the ISDN links can be as-
signed to any station in the system.
B channels The number of external data calls is limited to the number
of B channels installed in the system.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-402 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
Access B channels are dedicated to the specific ISDN terminal
and should be placed in a separate trunk group to ensure
access if more than one BRI trunk is installed.
MSN If the MSN for a Setup is missing or invalid, a default MSN
appropriate to the situation is used. When a station num-
ber is specified that is already in use (optiset E or optiPoint
500), the Setup is rejected. If an MSN is too long, a right-
justified evaluation of the digits is performed.
Subject Dependency/Limitation
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-403
Features
3.16.11 Calling Line Identification Presentation
Definition
The calling line identification presentation (CLIP) feature transmits the callers own
station number to the interface called. The station number can be displayed on suit-
able telephones. Station number transmission must be supported in the public net-
work.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements optiset E or optiPoint 500 telephone with dis-
play
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-404 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.12 Call Forwarding
Definition
All calls for the ISDN port can be forwarded. Three different types of call forwarding
(CF) are available:
Call forwarding unconditional (CFU)
All calls for the ISDN port are immediately forwarded to any port.
Call forwarding busy (CFB)
Same as CFU but only for busy trunk.
Call forwarding no reply (CFNR)
Same as CFU but only if the call is not answered within a specified period (15 s).
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
CF Forwarding is always performed for the first basic access,
necessitating that the first S0 port is present in the system.
CF This service is activated telephony, speech, and 3.1 kHz
audio only.
Internal to S0Only CFU is supported for internal station, otherwise, con-
flicts with call management would occur.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-405
Features
3.16.13 Call Hold
Definition
Call hold (CH) is important in conjunction with other features such as call waiting, con-
sultation hold, toggle, and three-party conference. The ISDN port on hold receives an
indication of the hold state and retrieval of the call.
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
CH Possible at multi-device connections only. In the case of
PABXs, the connection is placed on hold in the CS. The in-
formation element is transmitted to the trunk.
CH Non-ISDN stations do not receive an advisory announce-
ment (except that the station is placed on hold in the CS).
CH A call can be placed on hold only in the active phase or
during connection setup.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-406 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.14 Three-Party Service
Definition
A three-party (3PTY) conference is possible with a multi-device connection. The con-
ference status is indicated at the relevant ISDN port.
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
3PTY At multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, the
conference is executed in the CS. The information element
is transmitted to the trunk.
3PTY internal to S0The other conference participants are connected in the
system; therefore, only one channel is required to the S0
bus.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-407
Features
3.16.15 Call Waiting
Definition
If a station is busy and a second call is pending, the busy station receives call waiting.
The call waiting (CW) status is transmitted to the trunk. The busy station has the op-
tion of answering the waiting call.
Model-Specific Data
Dependencies/Limitations
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Dependency/Limitation
CW At multi-device connections only. In the case of CSs, call
waiting is executed in the CS. The information element is
transmitted to the trunk.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-408 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.16 Connected Line Identification Presentation and Restriction
Definition
The Connected Line Identification (COLI) Presentation and Restriction feature pro-
vides the user with a display of the number called, or it restricts the users network-
provided number from being displayed to the calling party.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-409
Features
3.16.17 Dialed Number Identification Service
Definition
The Dialed Number Identification Service (DNIS) feature translates an external users
CO LEC/IEC number to a customer-defined DNIS number.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-410 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.18 B Channel Selection
Definition
This feature searches the low-low B channel selection algorithm for an available B
channel, starting each new search at the lowest numbered B channel of the lowest
numbered DS1 facility in the PRI trunk group, and it continues in ascending order. In
addition, this feature searches the high-high B channel selection algorithm for an
available B channel, starting each new search at the highest numbered B channel of
the highest numbered DS1 facility in the PRI trunk group, and it continues in descend-
ing order.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-411
Features
3.16.19 Originating B Channel Selection Implementation
Definition
For originating calls, this feature specifies a preferred B channel to the CO. If the pre-
ferred B channel is not available, the CO responds with an alternate B channel.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-412 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.20 Terminating B Channel Selection
Definition
For terminating calls, the CO specifies the B channel it has selected. If the HiPath
3000 determines that the requested B channel is not available and that it is not exclu-
sive, the HiPath 3000 responds with an alternate B channel.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements/Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement/Condition
No appropriate
B-channel
If the HiPath 3000 cannot accept the call on an appropriate
B channel, it rejects the call with cause value #34,
channel
congestion
, or cause value #44,
requested channel not
available
.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-413
Features
3.16.21 B Channel Cut-Through Operation Mode
Definition
North American ISDN PRI most often requires that the B channel voice path cut-
through to the network before connecting. This cut-through operation is different than
most other parts of the world. For this reason, the ISDN service providers often pro-
vide in-band tones or announcements that require a cut-through of the voice path.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-414 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.22 Digital Keypad to DTMF Conversion on PRI
Definition
This feature converts digital keypad information to dual-tone multifrequency (DTMF)
signals and sends the signals in-band over the PRI B channel.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-415
Features
3.16.23 En-Bloc Sending
Definition
With this feature, the HiPath 3000 sends and receives blocks of data (complete tele-
phone numbers) to and from the public network. The numbers are stored in the sys-
tem and not forwarded to the network until the user finishes dialing.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-416 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.24 Data Calls
Definition
This feature transfers data over the PRI. Facility type and LEC/IEC calling service in-
fluence this service. Refer to the specific vendor for specific requirements for PRI data
transmission.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-417
Features
3.16.25 Basic Electronic Key Telephone System
Definition
Electronic Key Telephone System (EKTS) is a National ISDN-1 standard that sup-
ports call appearances according to the directory number. This group-sharing capa-
bility associates a telephone on any interface with a particular directory number.
EKTS enables sharing of telephone features like call management, caller ID, confer-
ence calling, and call forwarding.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-418 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.26 Call Appearance Call Handling Electronic Key Telephone System
Definition
Call Appearance Call Handling Electronic Key Telephone System (CACH EKTS) sim-
ulates multiple call handling at a single desktop station. Users can receive multiple
calls for the same directory on several ISDN lines using one of the call appearance
IDs that is assigned to the directory number. With this feature, the CO can offer a call
on multiple interfaces because the directory number call appearances are shared.
This allows the HiPath 3000 to respond to the call with an idle interface. CACH is
called call appearance identification (CAID) in the HiPath 3000.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements/Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement/Condition
Call appearance iden-
tification (CAID) val-
ues
In a basic EKTS system CAID values are not supported.
The AT&T 5E and Siemens EWSD central offices support
the CAID format. The Northern Telcom central offices use
phantom DID numbers instead of CAID values.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-419
Features
3.16.27 Called and Calling Party Display
Definition
With called and calling party number display services like dialed number identification
service (DNIS) and automatic number identification (ANI) are provided by the net-
work. DNIS is for T1 digital trunks and ANI is for PRI trunks. The calling party number
(CPN) is displayed on a suitable display telephone.
With this feature, the system performs the following functions:
$ %#&'(&')#
2. Translates the digits into an account number, customer name, or company name
3. Routes the call
4. Displays the information on the telephone display
Users can override this feature system wide.
Model-Specific Data
Requirements/Conditions
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx x
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Subject Requirement/Condition
T1 Trunks T1 trunks support DTMF signaling only.
Protocols The protocols for processing ANI and DNIS digits depends
on the service and the carrier.
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-420 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.28 Connected Party Display
Definition
For users calling from a HiPath 3000 telephone, this feature displays the connecting
party number through the BRI if the public network provides it. If the connected party
number information is
restricted
, the HiPath 3000 does not forward or use the con-
nected party number for any purpose.
Users can override this feature system wide.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only
)
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-421
Features
3.16.29 Message Waiting
Definition
This feature indicates that there is a message waiting through one of the following in-
dicators:
Displaying a message on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display
Signaling with a flashing LED
After lifting the handset for analog telephones
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements –– –
SW requirements V1.0 or later
U.S. ISDN Features (for U.S. Only)
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-422 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
3.16.30 Internal Voice Mail
Definition
When the HiPath 3000 systems forward a call arriving over the ISDN/Central Office
interface to the local voice mail system, the control information specifies where the
forwarded call originated. The system alerts users that they have a message waiting
through the following methods:
Displaying a message on optiset E and optiPoint 500 telephones with display
Signaling with a flashing LED
Picking up the handset
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
Feature available in xx
HW requirements ––
SW requirements V1.0 or later
Host Link Interfac
e
3000sb3.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 3-423
Features
3.17 Host Link Interface
Definition
Communication between HiPath 3000 and the applications running on host comput-
ers (Plus Products) is facilitated by:
the V.24 (RS-232) application programming interface (CSTA protocol,
19200 baud)
Customers must use a converter to support Plus Products that use ACL-H2.
The converter converts all messages and message procedures based on the
ACL-H2 protocol to the CSTA protocol and vice versa. The converter has
been implemented as a driver that runs under Microsoft Windows 95/98.
Plus Products that support the CSTA protocol standardized by ECMA can be
connected directly (for example, Hicom Agentline Office V1.1 CSTA).
An S0 interface configured as a station (ISDN/USBS)
An optiset E ISDN adapter or optiPoint ISDN adapter (TA S0) (ISDN/USBS)
the LAN interface (Ethernet)
For more information on this subject, refer to Chapter 4.
the PSTN interface.
For more information on this subject, refer to Chapter 4.
HiPath 3000 support CSTA Phase II and CSTA Phase III.
The connected application determines whether CSTA Phase II or Phase III will be
used for connection setup.
Contact your local service center for up-to-date information about the applications
supported in the different countries.
Host Link Interface
Features
G281-0788-00, April 2002
3-424 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb3.fm
HiPath 3000 Interfaces for Applications
Figure 3-17 HiPath 3000 - Interfaces for Applications
Host (Plus product)
Device
driver
ACL-H2
CSTA
Application
Data
V.24 application interface
Converter connec-
tion
Direct connection
COM
Host (Plus product)
CSTA
CSTA
CSTA
S0 interface, ISDN adapter
Host (Plus product)
CSTA
CSTA over USBS
COM
Host (Plus product)
IP client
CSTA over IP
CDRC over IP
Admin over IP
COM
COM
COM
Host (Plus product)
IP client
Data
VCAPI
CSTA over IP
CDRCover IP
Admin over IP
PSTN interface COM
Host (Plus product)
IP client
Plus product administra-
tion over PPP
Administration over PPP
Data
LAN interface:
HiPath 3000 (LIM)
HiPath 3750, Hi-
Path 3550, HiPath
3350, HiPath 3700,
HiPath 3500, Hi-
Path 3300 (HiPath
HG1500 board)
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-1
Overvie
w
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4 HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.1 Overview
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the topics listed in the table.
Topic
LAN Connecting Capabilities page 4-2
IP Trunking page 4-7
IP Payload Switching page 4-17
Workpoint Clients page 4-19
Wireless LAN page 4-24
Applications over IP page 4-31
Administration & Fault Management page 4-35
LAN Connecting Capabilities
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.2 LAN Connecting Capabilities
4.2.1 LAN Connection using an LIM board
Implementation of the LIM submodule on a central board in the HiPath 3000 systems
allows the following applications for example:
Administration
APS update (TFP)
Back up CDB on TFTP server
Fault monitoring (maintenance)
Call charge output
TAPI 3rd-party applications supported
Data is transferred by using the SNMP protocol. Internet connection (routing) and
Voice over IP are not available with the LIM board.
Figure 4-1 LAN Connection using the LIM Board
HiPath 3000
e.g. PC with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
Central Board
LIM
Customer
LAN
e.g. PC for
Network Management
SNMP
LAN Connecting Capabilitie
s
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-3
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.2.2 LAN Connection using HiPath HG1500
4.2.2.1 Overview
Figure 4-2 LAN Connection using HiPath HG1500
HiPath 3000
Central Board
ISDN Board
HG1500
Customer
LAN
ISDN
tele-
communications
network
HiPath 3000
Central Board
HG1500
Customer
LAN
ISDN Board
e.g.optiClient 130 PCs for Internet connection, VoIP,
administration etc.
Voice over IP Voice over IP
e.g. optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS
LAN Connecting Capabilities
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.2.2.2 Definition
HiPath HG1500 is a voice and data gateway that can be implemented in HiPath 3000
(HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3700, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300).
This allows you to connect your system directly to Ethernet LANs (10/100 Mbps); in
turn the communications system can be connected to the communications server in
the LAN. Voice, fax and data communication is available over the ISDN operator net-
work from every PC that is networked over the LAN.
HiPath HG1500 includes a H.323 gateway, which supports voice communication over
IP networks in compliance with standards.
The communications server HiPath 3000 thus forms the interface to the companys
internal Ethernet LAN, where communications solutions and applications with multi-
user capability can be implemented as follows:
optiClient 130 with optiset E functionalities
LAN-LAN link over ISDN
Remote LAN access/teleworking
RAS accesses now also using analog and GSM modems
Access to the Internet
Data communications services such as fax transmission and Euro file transfer
Computer Telephony Integration (CTI) over TAPI and CAPI
Supports TAPI 3rd Party Applications (CSTA over LAN)
SNMP support
Improved serviceability with initial installation
Unified Messaging with the ixiServer Siemens Package
Fax server application for LAN users, can be integrated into MS-Outlook/Postof-
fice with fax receipt/dispatch and SMS dispatch.
Voice networking over IP connections (IP trunking)
Supports QoS standards
Windows 2000 support
LAN Connecting Capabilitie
s
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-5
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.2.2.3 Hardware Notes
HiPath HG1500 is a HXGM2 board in HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700, the HXGS2
board in HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 and the HXGSR2 board in HiPath 3500 and
HiPath 3300. The power supply comes from the system.
The board includes a V.24 interface for initial startup. You will require a special adapt-
er cable for initial startup with SLIP (Serial Line Interface Protocol). An RJ45 jack has
been provided for connecting to the LAN.
4.2.2.4 System Requirements
HiPath 3000 V1.0 or later
At least one Euro-ISDN basic access (connection to the network or another com-
munications system)
At least one free slot in the basic system
Requirements for the LAN PC
Pentium III with at least 166 MHz, 64-MB SDRAM
Windows 95, 98 or 2000 or WindowsNT 4.0 Client PC
Network protocol TCP/IP or IPX/SP
4.2.2.5 System Environment
Shared/switched LAN 10/1000 Base T
Client/server and peer-to-peer networks with TCP/IP protocol
Networks with Novell Netware and IPX/SPX protocol
4.2.2.6 Interfaces and Protocols
Up to 48 channels (16 channels per HG1500) can be used (for system-depen-
dent capacities see Table 2-1)
Ethernet 10/100 Mbps autosense
SNMP
CAPI 2.0 interface
TAPI 2.0 interface
Support of the PAP/CHAP/MS-CHAP security protocols
H.323 (ITU standard)
G.711, G.723.1 voice coding
LAN Connecting Capabilities
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
PV.23bis for analog remote access PP and PPP multilink protocol
V.110 bit rate adaptation for remote access using GSM
QoS to DIFFSERV and IEEE 802.1p
4.2.2.7 Supported Voice over IP Clients
optiClient 130
Standard H.323 Client
optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS
4.2.2.8 Determining the number HiPath HG 1500 boards necessary
The following table shows the number of HiPath HG 1500 boards (B-channels) nec-
essary based on the existing IP workpoint clients.
A prerequisite for value calculation is that a station must spend 10% of its working
time in call status. Provisions should be made for more B-channels (HiPath HG 1500
boards) in high traffic volume environment (e.g. call centers).
The HiPath HG 1500 boards HXGM / HXGM2 each feature max. 16 B-channels.
HXGS / HXGS2 / HXGSR / HXGSR2 boards each feature max. 8 B-channels per
board. Within this context, B-channels stand for DSP resources, one of which is re-
served for music-on-hold.
Table 4-1 Number of required B-channels (HiPath HG 1500 boards)
IP Workpoint Clients in the system Required number of B-channels
0 32
4 12 4
13 16 6
17 38 8
39 54 10
55 70 12
71 86 14
87 96 16
Recommendation for over 100 IP workpoint clients:
an additional two B-channels must be provided for every 15 IP workpoint clients.
IP Trunkin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-7
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.3 IP Trunking
4.3.1 Overview
The implementation of IP telephony between the HiPath 3000 communications plat-
forms has several advantages for our customers such saving on expensive leased
lines for telephony only, the convergence of communications networks for voice and
data over several locations, a standard contact partner for the infrastructure and other
advantages.
The main advantage for users of IP telephony is a significant saving on costs by using
a single infrastructure for data and voice. This advantage can be even further ex-
panded by using the voice compression procedure, which allows existing lines to be
used much more effectively. For example, up to three calls can be conducted simul-
taneoulsy on a single ISDN channel if an optimized compression algorithm is used.
A considerable reduction in costs can be expected particularly for companies that al-
ready have a broad-band intranet. IP Trunking is available over the integrated ISDN
router HiPath HG1500 voice/data (Hicom Xpress@ LAN 1.1 Data/Voice).
max. 16 channels per HG1500
max. 16 nodes for 1000 subscribers per network
Figure 4-3 IP Trunking
HiPath 3000
S0 Board
HG1500
Customer
LAN
ISDN
tele-
communications
network
HiPath 3000
HG1500
S0 Board
CorNet tunneling over IP
IP Trunking
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
HiPath HG1500has been extended to include the following features:
Quality of Service (IEEE 802.1d)
Type of Service (RFC 791)
Differentiated Services (RFC 2474)
Assured Forwarding, AF (RFC 2597)
Expedited Forwarding, EF (RFC 2598)
Compression to ITU G.723.1 or ITU G.711, adjustable
Note:
Compression to ITU G.723.1 and QoS IEEE 802.1 d can be adjusted for each board.
The B channels used for networking, the channels for routing and the channels pro-
vided for the IP clients are shared out amongst the total number of available B chan-
nels.
4.3.2 Features of IP Networking
Transparency for End Users
Special workpoint clients (terminals) are not required because voice data is not
converted into IP packages in the workpoint client, but rather in the LAN gateway.
Network-wide features are transferred which means that use of the workpoint cli-
ents has not changed and consequently, the user-friendliness of the telephone
has not been affected.
MFV tones are supported. Consequently, you can perform suffix-dialing or listen
to your voicemail over the IP network.
Fax (Group 3) and analog Modem as well as Data Transmission with X.75 over IP
Implementation of the integrated router HiPath HG1500 means that analog fax and
modem connections as well as data connections of the type X.75 can be transmitted
between IP-networked communications platforms without the need for additional
hardware. The system recognizes the connection type required on the basis of the
configured station type (fax, modem or language) and automatically establishes a
connection in the IP network.
The following connection types are supported:
Realtime fax transmission is supported in accordance with the ITU-T standard
T.30 (fax group 3). Faxes are transmitted between the networked communica-
tions platforms at a maximum speed of 14.4 kbps (V.17).
IP Trunkin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-9
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
Data can be transmitted via modem over the IP network at a speed of 33.6 kbps
using the ITU-T standard V.42.
Data transmission to the ITU-T standard X.75
Support of Network-wide Features
The CorNet-NSUB protocol is supported in an IP network which means that CorNet-
N-specific features are transmitted over the IP network (tunnelling).
Overall, the features that are transmitted today in the HiPath 3000 Corporate Net-
work, are also transmitted in the IP network although the old network has been en-
hanced in certain respects (see Section 4.3.3, Network-wide Features with IP Net-
working).
Central Attendant Console
A central, system-wide attendant console can be configured within the IP network.
The option to have a busy signal across the communications platform is new.
Note:
The busy signal across the communications platform is only available with optiClient
Attendant.
Automatic Routing
Automatic routing to a backup or alternative network can be executed for new con-
nections. A voice network (ISDN, for example) can also operate as a backup network.
This ensures that the high availability of the HiPath 3000 will not be affected when IP
networks are being used by voice and fax connections. Automatic routing is initiated if
the communications platform called is not available (due to faults or an overload
in the IP network for example)
no more capacity available in LAN accesses (maximum number of B-channels
for LAN gateway exceeded)
explicitly requested for connections (fax or modem connections, for example).
Note:
ISDN lines are required as trunk connections for routing data connections or VoIP
connections over the integrated ISDN routers.
IP Trunking
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Standard Numbering Plan
Telephone numbers are converted into the IP addresses of the remote communica-
tions platform (nodes) within the LAN access (HiPath HG1500). To ensure that the IP
address of the correct target node is implemented, a routing table must be created
which assigns the correct IP address to each telephone number or respective tie
trunk or prefix number. A standard numbering plan is required for this purpose. To
make it easy to use and to reduce service costs, we recommend that numbering goes
according to communications platforms. This means that the internal telephone num-
bers of all platforms are the same length, but begin with different digits.
Standard Compliance
Connection protocol
Voice over IP to ITU H.323
Voice transmission - Audio Codecs
ITU G.711
ITU G.723.1
Echo suppression to ITU-T G.165
Prioritization of data Quality of Service (QoS)
IEEE 802.1d
RFC2474 Differentiated Services (DiffServ)
RFC791 Type of Service (TOS)
IP Trunkin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-11
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.3.3 Network-wide Features with IP Networking
New features have been added to the functionality of networking over digital leased
lines via CorNet-N.
Table 4-2 Services Provided Across the Communications Platform with
Networking
Function Name Description of the Function
Network-wide features
using CorNet-N-Subset/
IP Networking
Connection setup
Direct inward dialing in the network
Different rings (internal/external)
Transmission of number and name
Number or name shown on display
Callback on busy/free
Advice of charges output at subscriber line (AOC-D)
Call forwarding
Call forwarding (rerouting for optimization of B-chan-
nel use.)
Message waiting indicator for callbacks and voice-
mail messages
Call waiting
Network-wide class-of-service (max. 4 classes of
service)
Additional system
services
Network-wide shared numbering plan
Display of name and number suppressed
Consultation hold (over second B-channel)
Transfer (over second B-channel with release of tie
trunk when station transferred)
Conference with max. 5 stations (display function not
universal)
To g g l e
Hunt group and group call across all nodes)
Directed joining and leaving a group, across all
nodes
Hunt group overflow
Call detail recording for all nodes (communications
platforms) in the network (central solution)
IP Trunking
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Outside IP Networking, HiPath 3000 provide an option for conventional networking
over CorNet-N and QSig (ECMA V1.0 and ECMA V2.0). For information on this topic,
please refer to Section 3.12, Networking.
Additional system ser-
vices (continued)
Transit traffic
Least cost routing (LCR)
Call pickup (call pickup with subscribers from other
nodes (systems))
Follow Me
Chain call forwarding (maximum number of stations
monitored over several nodes)
Activate and deactivate features in IP-networked
communications platforms with user prompts at opti-
Point 500 and optiset E workpoints.
(night answer, for example)
Central attendant console (optiClient Attendant) with
busy signal (the states free, internal/external busy
and faulty are signalled for stations in IP-networked
communications platforms.)
Central attendant console functions (forward, as-
sign, recall, hold)
Use of only one B-chan-
nel over CorNet N sub-
set
The following features cannot be used over a dedicated
line if a B-channel has already been seized:
Consultation hold
Transfer
Toggle
Conference
Table 4-2 Services Provided Across the Communications Platform with
Networking
Function Name Description of the Function
IP Trunkin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-13
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.3.4 Requirements of the IP Network
Requirements of the Bandwidth
In general, voice quality is heavily dependent on the quality of the IP network and its
components such as switches and routers, for example. In networks that can provide
QoS (see page 4-16), customers have reported that the voice quality is extremely
good despite compression using ITU G723.1.
However, to achieve this voice quality, the criteria described below must be fulfilled
with regard to bandwidth and delay.
Required Connection Bandwidth
The customer network must fulfill the following requirements to ensure perfect trans-
mission of voice over LAN:
Switched LAN with 100 Mbps
Separate port at the switch for each component involved in the IP network (no
hubs used as concentrators)
All components involved in voice transmission must support IEEE 802.1d at least
(layer 2).
In addition, all components involved must use routing to DiffServ standard RFC
2474 and the ToS standard (Type of Service) RFC 791.
Implementation in shared environments is possible but has not been released and is
not recommended as quality cannot be guaranteed.
IP Trunking with HiPath 3000 can also be operated in networks that have routing com-
ponents.
IP Trunking
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Bandwidth
The bandwidth for voice must be available in the network at all times. Consequently,
the network must be analyzed prior to installation of the components. The following
data is required to calculate the required bandwidth for voice transmission in an IP
network in relation to the number of simultaneous connections:
All values refer to the lowest packaging level.
Bandwidth required by supplementary services
The specified bandwidth represents the load with respect to a maximum volume of
calls with 1400 BHCA (this is the maximum traffic with connected ACD application.).
Accordingly, the minimum bandwidth required is as follows:
Type Bandwidth per connection
in the Ethernet
Bandwidth per connection
in the WAN
Voice with ITU
G.723.1
44 Kbps 19 Kbps
Voice with ITU
G.711
180 Kbps 83 Kbps
Type Record size Bandwidth required
Busy signal (optiCli-
ent Attendant)
300 Byte 3 Kbps
Call data record 200 Byte 1 Kbps
ACD information 3.5 K 10 Kbps
Required bandwidth Formula [Kbps] (approximate values)
With ITU G.711 N x 180/83 (voice)
+ N x 4 (BLF+CDR)
+ 10 (ACD)
With ITU G.723.1 N x 44/19 (voice)
+ N x 4 (BLF+CDR)
+ 10 (ACD)
N = number of simultaneous voice connections
IP Trunkin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-15
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
When configuring fax or modem transmissions using the formula described above
(outband transmission) the following are also required for each configured connec-
tion
approximately 20 Kbps for fax group 3 (V.17, 14 Kbps)
approximately 40 Kbps for modem connections (V.34, 33.6 Kbps).
Requirements of Delay Times
To achieve natural communication, the delay time in a voice connection (network de-
lay) should not exceed 50 ms (one-way delay). Delays of more than 50 ms in one di-
rection impair natural communication. The effect is similar to that experienced with
voice connections over satellite. The maximum number of HOPs must not exceed 15.
The delay can be reduced particularly effectively by means of priority control.
Caution is advised if the network is operated over lines with low bit rates (connection
of a branch office to the head office using 128 Kbps). If the trunk lines are overloaded,
delays may occur thus causing the quality of the voice transmission to deteriorate. We
therefore recommend that you provide higher bandwidths (reserves) or that you im-
plement the G.723.1 Codec.
Maximum Package Losses
Package losses must not exceed 3 %. Deterioration in voice quality which is linked to
package losses is more severe with G.723.1 than with G.711.
Minimization of Broadcast/Multicast Traffic
In accordance with the rules of good network design, broadcast/multicast traffic
should be kept to a minimum. This can be achieved by structuring the network (VPN
for example) using routers/layer 3 switches and by implementing layer 2 switches,
which recognize multicasting.
IP Trunking
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Provision of QoS in Data Networks
The required Quality of Service (QoS) discussed in the previous sections can be
guaranteed in a data network by means of the following:
Network design,
by reserving bandwidth for voice in an IP network (PVC in ATM, B-channels
in the ISDN network, for example), or
by means of bandwidth reservation procedures (such as RSVP) in an IP net-
work
by configuring VPNs
by overdimensioning the network capacity.
By giving priority to voice over data:
Quality of Service (QoS) to IEEE 802.1d
Type of Service (ToS) to RFC 791
Differentiated Services (DiffServ - DS) to RFC 2474
By means of the following extra options:
Switch/router gives priority to voice ports over data ports, or
Switch/router gives priority to all packages with an IP address for the com-
munications platforms.
IP Payload Switchin
g
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-17
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.4 IP Payload Switching
Introduction
IP payload switching optimizes communication between LAN-based IP workpoint cli-
ents.
In the past, two B-channels (with two DSP resources) in the HiPath HG 1500 and Hi-
Path 3000-internal switching network were seized for internal network calls.
In HiPath 3000 V3.0 and later, VoIP voice data (payload) is transferred directly be-
tween two IP workpoint clients in the network. When this happens, both IP workpoint
clients have full access to all system features.
Payload switching is also implemented for IP networking (PBX routing).
By ceasing to use B-channels, we have managed to preserve HiPath HG 1500 re-
sources and facilitate a higher volume of network-internal call traffic.
A B-channel is still required on the HiPath HG 1500 for connections to the following
stations and lines:
UP0/E stations (optiset E, optiPoint 500)
Analog stations
ISDN stations
Trunks and tie lines (MSI, S0, S2M)
Example: a consultation call to an optiPoint 500 telephone is set up during an existing
connection between two IP workpoint clients. A HiPath HG 1500 B-channel is neces-
sary for this consultation call.
In the case of conferences, the number of B-channels seized corresponds to the num-
ber of stations and IP workpoint clients involved.
A HiPath HG 1500 DSP resource (no B-channel) is permanently reserved for playing
music-on-hold.
Example: a license was acquired for two B-channels and six clients. Six optiPoint 400
standard CorNet-IP-TSs are logged on. The following scenario is possible in this
case: two stations can conduct an external call, while two stations are listening to
MoH and two stations are talking to each other.
IP Payload Switching
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Prerequisites
The following components are necessary for using payload switching:
IP workpoint clients
optiClient 130 V2.0
optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS V3.0 (CorNet-IP-TS protocol variant)
optiPoint 300 advance and the optiPoint IPadapter (supported up to and including
V1.2) are not supported.
HiPath HG 1500 boards with Digital Signal Processor DSP (voice and data).
Payload switching can be configured using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Workpoint Client
s
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-19
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.5 Workpoint Clients
4.5.1 optiClient 130
Definition
The optiClient is a computer-based approximation of optiset E telephone functionality.
Through the use of VoIP and support of the H.323 standard all of the main CorNet-
TS features are available to the customer directly on the PC when the client is being
used in conjunction with HiPath 3000. You can communicate with all voice terminals
that are connected through the gateway HiPath HG1500 which is integrated in the Hi-
Path 3000 systems. The client is a simple software solution. Figure 4-4 shows two
possible applications for the optiClient 130
Implementation of the optiClient 130 at the LAN of the HiPath 3000 V1.2
Implementation of the optiClient 130 as a home workstation using remote access
Figure 4-4 Options for Implementing the optiClient 130
HiPath 3000
Central Board
ISDN Board
HG1500
Customer
LAN
ISDN
tele-
communications
network
optiClient 130
Internet
connection
Implementation
as home work-
station for
example
optiClient 130
with remote access
ISDN
Workpoint Clients
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Features
optiClient 130 uses optiset E functionalities in conjunction with HiPath 3000. In addi-
tion, the client is also equipped with ACD functions.
ACD keys/displays
ACD, logon
ACD, log off
ACD, available
ACD, not available
ACD, night service on
ACD, night service off
ACD, night destination on
ACD, night destination off
ACD, call queue status
Code lock, on/off/change
Reset services for own station
Electronic directory (private)
Electronic directory (global)
Terminal ID
Fault indicator
Home workstation (remote access with G.723)
Message (message waiting) - send/read/answer
Call charge display for active connection
Call charge display for own station
Minimum Requirements of the PC
Pentium II 233 MHz
128-MB RAM
200-MB free hard disk space
Workpoint Client
s
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-21
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
System Components
Software solution on CD-ROM
Documentation on CD-ROM
Operating system: Windows NT V.4.0 and Windows 98 (Windows 2000 in prepa-
ratory stages)
Properties
Supports all of the main features in accordance with CorNet-TS
Voice compression: G.711, G.723.1
Standard LAN protocols (Ethernet, IP, UDP, TCP, RTP...)
H.323 protocol
Interoperability with Microsoft NetMeeting via T 120
H.323 Client with H.323/H.320 gateway support
Technical Data
Usable transmission bandwidth for voice connections: max. 64 Kbps
Audio compression: G.711, G.723.1 (software codec)
Workpoint Clients
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.5.2 optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS
The IP telephone optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS allows the user to carry out
telephone calls in the same old simple way over a data network.
All HiPath 3000 features that are offered in the display dialog, in the service menu,
and on function keys are available (except for Relocate).
Advantages of the IP Telephone
Quick and error-free dialing directly from the address book of a PC application
(for example, MS Outlook) using CTI (TAPI).
Simple and convenient administration because it uses the standard protocols
DHCP, SNMP, HTTP.
Software updates and upgrades of the features possible using FTP.
The use of the H.323 standard allows the telephone to communicate with other
H.323-compatible systems.
The two switching Ethernet interfaces and Internet protocol (IP) allow the user to
telephone on both the companys internal Intranet and the public Internet.
Figure 4-5 optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS
Workpoint Client
s
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-23
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
Main Features
12 function keys with LEDs
Alphanumeric LCD display (swivel) with 2 lines, 24 characters each
3 dialog keys for interactive user prompts: Ye s , Back, and Next
Full duplex speakerphone mode with echo suppression for adapting to the room
2 settings keys (plus/minus) for ringer volume, ringer pitch, alerting tone, speaker
quality
Interfaces:
10/100 Mbps Ethernet port (self-configuring) for LAN connection
10/100 Mbps Ethernet port (self-configuring) for PC connection
Suitable for wall mounting
Wireless LAN
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.6 Wireless LAN
4.6.1 HiPath Wireless BreezeNET
The HiPath Wireless BreezeNET product is a network platform for the cordless net-
working of PCs, notebooks and local subnetworks (LAN). Furthermore, the product
can also be used in the HiPath environment for mobile networking of IT terminals
(handheld phones, mobile IP telephones, clients, ...).
The radio components are fully compatible with HiPath products and consequently
make all LAN solutions offered in the HiPath environment available as mobile units.
Transmission speeds of up to 11 Mbps and full compatibility with traditional, corded
Ethernet networks mean that employees in a company can call up e-mails, docu-
ments, databases and the Internet/intranet from any location within the radio range
using cordless solutions.
HiPath Wireless BreezeNET consists of two main components:
the access point = sending station of the wireless LAN and
the mobile client = notebook with PCMCIA.
The access point is the interface to the outside world and is connected to the corded
company LAN. The mobile client is the networked terminal on which the data and
voice applications that are offered can be used.
Examples of the Wireless LAN Implementation
Wireless offices
Small networks with several PCs can be set up completely without any cables, in
offices rented on a temporary basis for example.
Wireless LAN hotspots
In meeting rooms or in the area of workstations for employees in the field.
Full-coverage installation of Wireless LAN in a company
Full-coverage provision with Wireless LAN is the perfect solution if a company is
spread over several branch offices and employees often have to travel from one
location to another. Using Wireless LAN you can use your notebook to connect
to your companys LAN at any time and in any branch office without the need for
extra cables.
Networking buildings
Distances of up to 10 km can be bridged using a Wireless LAN bridge. This al-
lows fast and economical network connection between buildings without expen-
sive excavation work or without having to lease carrier services.
Wireless LA
N
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-25
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
Networking two HiPath 3000
Using a Wireless LAN bridge two systems can be networked with one another
over TCP/IP. This network is a good solution if the systems are located in two dif-
ferent buildings and there is no direct cable or network connection between the
buildings.
4.6.2 Implementation Scenarios
4.6.2.1 Mobile optiClient 130
The optiClient 130 offers users a high degree of flexibility and full ease of communi-
cation regardless of the users location.
In the solution illustrated in Figure 4-6 the optiClient 130 is installed on a notebook.
This notebook must be equipped with a PCMCIA slot and the relevant sound card to
support the optiClient 130 software. The wireless network connection to the Wireless
LAN is established using the WLAN-PCMCIA card.
HiPath 3000 is connected using the HiPath HG1500 gateway.
Figure 4-6 Mobile optiClient 130
Wireless LAN
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.6.2.2 Wireless LAN Network Between Two HiPath 3000
Two HiPath 3000 systems can be networked quickly and economically using the
Wireless LAN network. The entire range of HiPath functions is transmitted (tunneled)
via the radio link using the TCP/IP protocol.
The systems networked over the Wireless LAN appear to the user as a large HiPath
system. Not only is the voice connection set up via the radio link, but the networked
systems are also administered and the optional HiPath AllServe server PC accessed.
Each HiPath 3000 system requires a HiPath HG1500 board which is connected to the
Wireless LAN bridges for networking.
Depending on the antennas used, distances of up to 10 km can be bridged. The 15-
dBi antenna used in the standard package permits distances of up to 3 km.
Figure 4-7 Wireless LAN Network
Wireless LA
N
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-27
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.6.3 Main Components of HiPath Wireless BreezeNET
Additional accessories such as special wall brackets, antenna clips, various amplifi-
ers for antenna signals are available for the following components.
4.6.3.1 Access Point PRO.11
The access point is the master station in the HiPath Wireless platform and, in turn,
the central Wireless LAN access node.
The access point creates a WLAN radio cell in which the WLAN station adapter and
WLAN PCMCIA-PC cards (and thus the connected workpoint clients) can communi-
cate with one another and gain access to the corded Ethernet LAN.
To cover more extensive areas, several access points whose radio areas must over-
lap have to be installed. These are installed in the same way as those in DECT base
stations.
The following variants with one Ethernet connection each are available:
AP-10 PRO.11 (Figure 4-8) with two integrated omnidirectional antennas.
AP-10D PRO.11 for the connection of high-gain external antennas.
AP-10DL PRO.11 for the connection of high-gain external antennas for imple-
mentation in Europe in compliance with the ETSI standard.
The devices described operate using the frequency hopping procedure in the 2.4
GHz range and are thus largely protected from interference.
Figure 4-8 Access Point AP-10 PRO.11
Wireless LAN
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.6.3.2 PCMCIA-PC Card PRO.11
WLAN PCMCIA PC cards allow wireless communication between notebooks and
PDAs with PCMCIA II compatible slots and an Access Point PRO.11 and, as a result,
access to the corded Ethernet LAN.
The capacity to create an effective and cordless connection makes the WLAN PCM-
CIA PC cards perfect for implementation in environments in which users are constant-
ly on the move. Examples are companies, hospitals, trade and university campuses.
Two variations of the PC card are available:
SA-PCR PRO.11 (Figure 4-9) with two integrated retractable omnidirectional an-
tennas.
SA-PCD PRO.11 with two connections for external antennas.
4.6.3.3 Station Adapter PRO.11
The station adapter converts a device with an Ethernet interface (desktop computers,
printers and other devices for example) into a cordless LAN workstation.
This workstation communicates with another cordless workstation within the same ra-
dio cell supply area and accesses all network resources over the Access Point
PRO.11 such as file servers, corded workstations, printers and shared databases, for
example.
Every device with an Ethernet interface regardless of manufacturer or operating
system can be connected quickly and transparently with a Wireless LAN. Special
drivers or configurations need not be installed.
Figure 4-9 PCMCIA-PC Card SA-PCR PRO.11
Figure 4-10 Station Adapter SA-10 PRO.11 and SA-40 PRO.11
Wireless LA
N
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-29
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
The following versions and variations of the station adapter are available:
Single station adapter with an Ethernet connection:
SA-10 PRO.11 with two integrated 2dbi omnidirectional antennas.
SA-10D PRO.11 for implementation with external antennas.
SA-10DL PRO.11 for connecting high-gain external antennas, for implemen-
tation in Europe in compliance with the ETSI standard.
Four port station adapter with four Ethernet connections:
SA-40 PRO.11 with two integrated omnidirectional antennas.
SA-40D PRO.11 for implementation with external antennas.
SA-40DL PRO.11 for connecting high-gain external antennas, for implemen-
tation in Europe in compliance with the ETSI standard.
4.6.3.4 Workgroup Bridge PRO.11
The workgroup bridge establishes a second extended cordless network, which con-
nects locations to corded networks up to 9.6 km apart. In Europe this distance is re-
stricted to 2.5 km as a result of ETSI regulations. In areas that are not subject to reg-
ulations, this distance can extend to up to 60 km.
This allows a central Ethernet LAN to be connected with the LANs in one or more
branch offices.
Three variations of the workgroup bridge are available:
WB-10 PRO.11 with two integrated 2dbi omnidirectional antennas.
WB-10D PRO.11 (Figure 4-11) with two connections for external antennas.
WB-10DL PRO.11 for connecting high-gain external antennas, for implementa-
tion in Europe in compliance with the ETSI standard.
Figure 4-11 Workgroup Bridge WB-10D PRO.11
Wireless LAN
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.6.3.5 Wireless Base Unit BU-DS.11
The BU-DS.11 is a base station in compliance with IEEE 802.11b, which is used ei-
ther to connect an individual remote location or several remote locations with a central
server or an Internet connection.
4.6.3.6 Wireless Bridge RB-DS.11
RB-DS.11 connects a remote Ethernet network with a BU-DS.11 Wireless base unit
to a central server or an Internet location.
4.6.4 Extension of a Wireless LAN Network
Existing Wireless LAN networks support modular expansion. In the case of an expan-
sion, a distinction must be made between the integration of additional workpoint cli-
ents and the expansion of the actual radio network.
Additional workpoint clients can easily be integrated into an existing WLAN network.
To do this, a PCMCIA-WLAN PC card is simply implemented in a notebook or a sta-
tion adapter is connected to the Ethernet port on the new device. When you enter the
ESS-ID and the optional WEP key you can communicate in the Wireless LAN network
area.
To extend a WLAN network to include additional radio cells, extra access points have
to be set up at the appropriate positions. The existing network has to be precisely
planned and analyzed (radio coverage) before locations for the access points can be
selected and before they can be incorporated into the existing radio network. These
tasks must be performed by specially trained personnel.
Applications over I
P
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-31
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.7 Applications over IP
4.7.1 Call Detail Recording Central (CDRC) via IP
In HiPath 3000, you can start up the central call data output function only once, which
means that it is available to only one application at a time. Three different modes exist
to support the various requirements of the different applications.
Model-Specific Data
4.7.1.1 TFTP Client in HiPath 3000
Controlled by a programmable timer and a fixed threshold value determining the call
data buffer capacity (around 80 percent of the call data buffer full), the TFTP client
(HiPath 3000) sends call data to the TFTP server (external application). If the system
cannot set up a connection to the TFTP server, it addresses an alternative server. If
this server is also unavailable, it outputs an SNMP trap or error message (Unable to
output data). The system tries to set up another connection every 60 seconds. A call
data buffer overflow causes an error message to be entered in the error history file.
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
LIM LIM
SW requirements V1.2 or later
Figure 4-12 CDRC via IP - TFTP Client in HiPath 3000
TFTP
client
HiPath 3000 External
application
TFTP protocol TFTP
server
Alternative
server
Applications over IP
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-32 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.7.1.2 TCP Client in HiPath 3000
When call data records accumulate, the TCP client (HiPath 3000) sets up a TCP/IP
connection to an external TCP server (external application) and transmits the data.
The connection remains active continuously so that the system can send any further
accumulated data, transmitting each data record separately.
4.7.1.3 TFTP Server in HiPath 3000
The external application (TFTP client) requests output of the call data records. To do
this, the application must set up a connection and indicate the service (GET gez.txt),
after which it receives all accumulated call data records. It releases the connection
after the transfer.
The applications request for call data can be controlled automatically or using an
SNMP trap (see Section 4.8.2). HiPath 3000 sends the SNMP trap (data available)
to the external application, generating the trap using a programmable threshold value
determining the call data buffer capacity (0 to 80 percent of the call data buffer full).
Figure 4-13 CDRC via IP - TCP Client in HiPath 3000
Figure 4-14 CDRC via IP - TFTP Client in HiPath 3000
TCP
client
HiPath 3000 External
application
TCP protocol TCP
server
TFTP
server
HiPath 3000 External
application
TFTP protocol TFTP
client
TFTP
client
Applications over I
P
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-33
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.7.2 CSTA via IP
HiPath 3000 uses the Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) for CSTA via IP, detecting
and automatically correcting lost data packets over a permanent connection.
A total of three CSTA clients or applications can connect to HiPath 3000 simulta-
neously via the LAN, and thus can use CSTA via IP simultaneously. Restrictions may
apply to applications that use certain services. For example, only one application at
a time can start the message registration function.
For an external application to address HiPath 3000, it must know the TCP port (7001)
of the TCP/IP server implemented in HiPath 3000 as well as the IP address.
Data packets sent from an application to HiPath 3000 -- that is, packets containing the
HiPath IP address, TCP port 7001, and protocol type TCP -- are accepted for further
processing.
Figure 4-15 HiPath 3000 - CSTA via IP
TCP/IP
server
HiPath 3000 CSTA
client
CSTA
client
CSTA
client
CSTA
client
Up to 3 CSTA cli-
ents (external ap-
plications) can be
served simulta-
neously.
External
applications
LAN
Applications over IP
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-34 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxx––
HW requirements LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
––
SW requirements V1.2 or later ––
Administration & Fault Managemen
t
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-35
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.8 Administration & Fault Management
4.8.1 Overview
HiPath 3000 with a LIM or a HiPath HG1500 board can be administered centrally over
a LAN connection from one or more PCs using SNMP. The following functionalities
can be implemented:
Administration and fault management of a system (SNMP)
APS update (TFP)
CDB backup on TFTP server
Network management
Figure 4-16 HiPath 3000 - Administration over LAN
e. g. PC with
HiPath 3000 Manag-
er E
SNMP
HiPath 3000
Central Board
LIM
Customer
LAN
e. g. PC with
Network Management
e. g. PC with
Network Management
e. g. PC with
HiPath 3000 Manag-
er E
HiPath 3000
Central Board
LIM
HiPath 3000
Central Board
LIM
HiPath 3000
Central Board
LIM
Administration & Fault Management
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-36 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.8.2 SNMP Functionality
4.8.2.1 Introduction
As part of the TCP/IP protocol family, the Simple Network Management Protocol (SN-
MP) is an easy-to-use platform for performing management tasks in the HiPath 3000
system software. SNMP is used as a kind of management agent in HiPath 3000, mak-
ing it possible to monitor and administer LAN components (including HiPath 3000 it-
self) from a central location. This involves
addressing HiPath 3000 via the TCP/IP protocol family.
allowing external management applications, such as HP Open View and IBM
Tivoli, to access data in HiPath 3000 (using SNMP messages, such as GET, SET,
TRAP)
implementing remote maintenance tasks (online port status, enabling and dis-
abling ports, determining free ports)
transmitting service-related class B errors
visualizing the operating status of HiPath 3000 systems.
4.8.2.2 Overview of SNMP Functions
Management Information Bases (MIBs)
MIBs define the volume of data that can be administered via SNMP. They are data
models that describe the network elements to be administered in a very specific form.
HiPath 3000 supports
standard MIB II (according to the RFC1213 Internet standard), which provides In-
ternet and router functions;
parts of the RMON 1/2 standard MIBs (RFC 1757, RFC 2021), which support
Error history
Trap configuration
TFTP configuration
General system information
Administration & Fault Managemen
t
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-37
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
a user-specific MIB that processes HiPath-specific statistic data (feature
counters) and internal error messages (error history), covering the following ar-
eas:
ControlGroup status variables, general configuration, supplementary
TFTP configuration data
SystemInfoGroup system configuration and status
StatisticsGroup statistic data on features
ErrorHistoryGroup Error history in HiPath format
Error messages are forwarded in the form of SNMP traps via the LAN to a
specific external management application. The SNMP traps form the error
history data structure (time stamp, error class, error description).
These components use the IP protocol according to OSI layer 3 and the UDP protocol
according to layer 4. The SNMP protocol stack uses port numbers. The system sup-
ports the SNMP protocol version 1.0.
SNMP Messages
The following commands control SNMP messages for communication between the
SNMP management agent (HiPath 3000) and external applications:
GET retrieve data from agent
GET NEXT read out data sequentially
SET write data
TRAP alarm messages issued by the SNMP agent
There is an integrated mechanism for generating SNMP traps in the event of class B
errors. The SNMP management agent evaluates the error messages. In the case of
defined errors, it generates specific traps and transmits them in the form of IP data
records to a configurable IP address (a total of five SNMP V1.0-compatible applica-
tions are supported, including HP Open View Network Node Manager).
Administration & Fault Management
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-38 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.8.3 Administering HiPath 3000 via the LAN Interface
You can administer HiPath 3000 via a computer connected to the LAN.
Model-Specific Data
Figure 4-17 HiPath 3000 - Administration via the LAN Interface
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
LIM LIM
SW requirements V1.2 or later
HiPath 3000
PC with
HiPath 3000 Manager E
Central Board
LIM *
Customer
LAN
* A HiPath HG1500 board can be used instead of the LIM board: HXGM, HXGM2 for HiPath 3750
and HiPath 3700, HXGS, HXGS2 for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 or HXGSR, HXGSR2 for HiPath
3500 and HiPath 3300.
Administration & Fault Managemen
t
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-39
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
4.8.4 Remote Administration of HiPath 3000 via PPP
You can administer multiple HiPath 3000 systems from a central service center via
PPP (point-to-point protocol). Each HiPath 3000 is addressed via its PSTN (public
switching telephone network) interface.
You must enter a router call number (DID number) for every PSTN interface in the ser-
vice center for external access to HiPath 3000. This number is not the station number
previously used for administration via an integrated digital modem (B channel) or in-
tegrated analog modem (IMODC).
You can establish a connection between the service center and HiPath 3000 via the
integrated digital modem (B channel) or the integrated analog modem (IMODC). The
point-to-point protocol (PPP) is used in both cases for data exchange.
If the connection is established via callback, HiPath 3000 first of all denies a connec-
tion request from the service center (HiPath 3000 Manager E). A callback is then set
up to the service centers calling party number transferred via the PSTN connections
D channel.
Model-Specific Data
Figure 4-18 Remote Administration of HiPath 3000 via PPP
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements CBCPR CBCC or
CBRC
CBCC or
CBRC
SBSCO SBSCS
SW requirements V1.2 or later
HiPath 3000
Service center
service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E
Central Board
Modem
PSTN
(analog or
digital tele-
communications
network)
PSTN
interface
Administration & Fault Management
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-40 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
4.8.5 Remote Administration of Plus Products via PPP
You can use HiPath 3000 to administer Plus Products from a central service center.
HiPath 3000 only provides the transmission medium for this. The actual Plus Product
administration is performed via special software programs, such as pcANYWHERE.
HiPath 3000 is addressed from the service center via its PSTN (public switching tele-
phone network) interface. The Plus Products connected to a LAN can be reached via
the HiPath 3000s LAN interface (LIM). In this case, HiPath 3000 acts like a router.
You must enter a router call number (DID number) for every PSTN interface in the ser-
vice center for external access to HiPath 3000.
You can establish a connection between the Plus Product and the service center via
the integrated digital modem (B channel) or the integrated analog modem (IMODC).
The point-to-point protocol (PPP) is used in both cases for data exchange.
Figure 4-19 Remote Administration of Plus Products via PPP
HiPath 3000
Plus Products
Service center
service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E
Central Board
Modem
LIM *
Customer
LAN
PSTN
(analog or
digital tele-
communications
network)
PSTN
interface
* A HiPath HG1500 board can be used instead of the LIM board: HXGM, HXGM2 for HiPath 3750
and HiPath 3700, HXGS, HXGS2 for HiPath 3550 and HiPath 3350 or HXGSR, HXGSR2 for HiPath
3500 and HiPath 3300.
Administration & Fault Managemen
t
3000sb4.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 4-41
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
Access Mechanism
A ist of up to twenty remote structures controls access from the service center to the
customer LAN and vice versa. Each remote structure contains the following informa-
tion:
The IP address of the service center (= PSTN partner in the service center) for
setting up connections from the customer LAN to the service center and for the
automatic transmission of error messages (SNMP traps).
The DID number (part of the numbering plans) for direct identification of this re-
mote structure.
Up to five PSTN remote numbers marked as incoming (for identifying the remote
structure - when dialing the router call number) and/or outgoing (for use as call-
back address).
Short hold mode yes/no
If Short hold = yes is selected, an inactive PSTN connection is cleared
down after a set time *+'
#*
+"#
%
If Short hold = no is selected, a ,)"& remains permanently ac-
tive until the end criterion is received.
Short hold (sec.)
This parameter describes the length of time in seconds after which an inactive
PSTN connection is cleared down.
Callbk yes/no
If Callbk = yes is selected, a connection request is first of all denied. Then
the first station number marked as outgoing in the remote structure found is
called back. Three attempts are made to set up the connection, then the next
outgoing station number is used. The system stops trying to set up the call-
back after three unsuccessful attempts.
If Callbk = no is selected, the connection is set up immediately.
Remote analog modem
If you select yes, the V.34 protocol in the B channel is used for an outgoing con-
nection via the ISDN line.
If a Plus Product supports SNMP traps, these can be transferred from the HiPath
3000 to the service center.
Administration & Fault Management
HiPath 3000 in the LAN Network
G281-0788-00, April 2002
4-42 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb4.fm
IP mapping yes/no
If a number of different customers have the same IP address, you can use ad-
dress mapping to achieve unique IP address assignment in the various customer
LANs.
If IP mapping = yes is selected, you can map an IP address which is as-
signed to multiple customers to a unique virtual IP address. You can per-
form IP mapping for up to twenty address entries.
Examples:
IP data transfer from the customer LAN to the service center via the PSTN
interface: IP customer LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000 into an IP virtual
LAN.
IP data transfer from the service center to the customer LAN via the PSTN
interface: IP virtual LAN is transformed by HiPath 3000 into an IP customer
LAN.
If IP mapping = no is selected, IP address mapping is not available.
Security mechanisms for connection setup
Use the PAP (PPP authentication protocol) and/or CHAP (challenge-handshake
authentication protocol) to determine whether
the Plus Product (client) must be authenticated at HiPath 3000 (host) or
the HiPath 3000 (host) must be authenticated at the Plus Product (client).
Authentication is based on the user ID and the password.
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xxxxx
HW requirements LIM
or
HiPath HG1500 board
LIM LIM
SW requirements V1.2 or later
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-1
Overvie
w
Serviceability
5 Serviceability
5.1 Overview
Introduction
This chapter describes the options available to the service technician and the cus-
tomer for
performing system administration tasks on site
performing system administration tasks from a remote location (remote opera-
tion)
performing service and maintenance tasks
identifying faults
Chapter Contents
This chapter discusses the topics listed in the table.
Topic
System Administration Options page 5-2
System Administration from a System Telephone page 5-3
System Administration using the Service PC page 5-3
Administration of the HiPath HG1500 page 5-5
Options in the Service Department page 5-6
Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup) page 5-6
Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS) page 5-7
Diagnosis Options page 5-9
Error Messages page 5-17
Correcting Errors page 5-18
Remote Service page 5-20
Access Security page 5-24
Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures page 5-31
System Administration Options
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.2 System Administration Options
Overview
Figure 5-1 System Administration Options
Minor system adjustments
by
customer
Limited system adjustments
by
service technician
Limited system adjustments
and administration
by customer
Complete system adjust-
ments and administration
by service technician
Complete system adjust-
ments and administration
by service technician,
APS transfer
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↵←
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
Customer
Technician
Technician
Assistant TC
Access with user name and
password
Assistant T
Access with user name and
password
HiPath 3000 Manager C
Access with customer ID and
password
HiPath 3000 Manager E
Access with technician ID
and password
HiPath 3000 Manager E
(customized for remote cen-
ter)
Access via callback with
technician ID and password
Customer
Technician
Administration on site
Administration from a re-
mote location
System Administration Option
s
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-3
Serviceability
5.2.1 System Administration from a System Telephone
All systems in the HiPath 3000 product family can be administered to the full extent
via a system telephone. The rights of individual user will determine the extent to
which he or she can perform administration tasks. Information on the various user
groups and their access rights is contained in Section 5.3.7.2.
Administration by the Technician using Assistant T
This data area is password-protected to limit access to trained service technicians.
With just a few exceptions, all system settings are available. Assistant T gives you the
ability to make changes spontaneously on site, that is, without requiring any other
tools.
You can only enter the service menu with a user ID and password.
Administration by the Customer using Assistant TC
This gives customers the option to perform a defined range of system settings them-
selves. These include, for example, configuring and changing speed-dialing destina-
tions, assigning names for stations and lines.
To protect individual customer data such as speed-dialing destinations or call detail
information, it is not possible to enter the service menu unless you have user ID and
password.
5.2.2 System Administration using the Service PC
Service tools with Windows user interface and integrated help functions are available
for the economical modification of larger volumes of data and for setting specific sys-
tem data. The rights of the individual user will determine the extent to which he or she
can perform administration tasks. Information on the various user groups and their
access rights is contained in Section 5.3.7.2.
You can access the communications platform using:
ISDN adapter on the system telephone (64 kbps B-channel access)
V.24 (RS-232) interface on the system (9600/1200 baud)
Internal S0 bus (64 kbps/CAPI 2.0)
Remote access over an ISDN trunk (64 kbps B-channel access)
Remote access over an analog trunk (integrated 14400 baud modem)
System Administration Options
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
Technical Requirements for the Service PC
To implement the different service tools, the PC used must meet the technical listed
in the following table.
Administration by the Customer using HiPath 3000 Manager C
This allows the customer to administer customer-specific data using a PC. The user
interface has been adapted from the HiPath 3000 Manager E interface and the help
functions have been adjusted to the needs of the customer.
Administration by the Technician using HiPath 3000 Manager E
"#-
Acquiring and generating customer data (including off-line generation)
Copying and backing up customer data
Loading system software (APS transfer)
Displaying stored error messages with error history
Service orders, such as restarting boards
Resetting activated features
Table 5-1 Technical Requirements for the Service PC
PC Component Requirement
CPU PC must fulfill the minimum requirements of the operating
system.
Monitor VGA
RAM PC must fulfill the minimum requirements of the operating
system.
Hard disk 50 MB free capacity (minimum)
Floppy drive 3,5, 1.44 MB
Serial interface COM1, (COM2)
Mouse Microsoft-compatible mouse
Printer Any Windows-compatible printer
Operating system Windows 95/98/2000/NT
System Administration Option
s
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-5
Serviceability
Creation and printing of:
Key labels for optiPoint 500 and optiset E telephones
Customer data printouts
Main distribution frame layout
User and password administration for after sales service.
Database conversion routine.
Access to the system using HiPath 3000 Manager E is only available with a valid user
name and associated password that have been entered in the system.
##.'
"
Because sensitive system data can be processed, users are required to undergo the
relevant training course before using the HiPath 3000 Manager E.
5.2.3 Administration of the HiPath HG1500
Assistant I allows you to administer the voice and data gateway HiPath HG1500. It is
provided in the basic HiPath HG1500 package.
Users (customers and technicians) can modify all of the main functions to their indi-
vidual requirements directly over the LAN (for example numbers and IP addresses of
external partners, assignment of B-channels, timer settings, security mechanisms
(firewalls)).
Consequently, the system can be administered (initially) directly over the LAN inter-
face using the PC and Hicom Assistant I Office. For information on the procedure
please refer to the administration instructions for HiPath HG1500.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3 Options in the Service Department
5.3.1 Customer Database Backup (CDB Backup)
Definition
CDB backup means that a backup copy of the customer database (CDB) is saved on
the Multimedia Card MMC. The Run LED signals that a CDB backup, which takes
about 30 s, is in progress on the MMC by repeatedly switching off for a short time.
5.3.1.1 Automatic Customer Data Backup
The HiPath 3000 provides a dual-level system that guarantees complete customer
data backup. A complete CDB backup version can be found on the MMC at any time.
Deltas to this backup are stored in an SRAM area (with battery backup) in the central
control board. If the SRAM area is full, the customer data is automatically backed up.
This means that the entire CDB, including SRAM content, is copied from the SDRAM
in the central control board to the MMC. The current CDB is simultaneously stored on
the MMC along with the old CDB, which is not deleted until the current CDB is com-
pletely stored on the MMC.
In case of a power outage, the SDRAM content that has no battery backup is com-
pletely lost. However, by reaccessing the CDB backup on the MMC, the systems da-
tabase can be restored to the state it was in prior to the power outage.
Regardless of the volume of changes to the database, HiPath 3000 always performs
an automatic complete CDB backup at midnight, system-time.
5.3.1.2 Manual Customer Data Backup
You can perform a manual CDB backup using Assistant T or HiPath 3000 Manager E
(in online mode).
However, be aware that it is not possible to deliberately abort a manual backup that
is initiated using Assistant T. Once the CDB backup process starts, it should be end-
ed because the backup continues to run in the background.
The CDB, including the call detail data, can also be restored from the MMC manually.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-7
Serviceability
5.3.2 Relocate/Transfer Application Processor Software (APS)
Two memory areas for the application processor software are reserved on the MMC.
To be able to store two complete APS and to keep the transfer time as low as possible,
part of an APS is stored in a compressed format. The APS is decompressed after it
has been transferred from the MMC into the SDRAM area of the central control board.
5.3.2.1 Transferring an APS by Replacing the MMC
The simplest way of transferring an APS is to exchange the MMC with the old APS
for the MMC with the new APS.
The MMC can be replaced with and without interrupting the power:
No power interruption: CDB of the system remains intact.
With power interruption: systems CDB incorporated onto the MMC.
5.3.2.2 APS Transfer
Options
The APS Transfer feature is available with the HiPath 3000 Manager E. It facilitates
an on-site APS transfer by connecting directly using
the V.24 interface
The transfer takes about 30 minutes.
an ISDN adapter (not compatible with HiPath 3150) or an S0 subscriber port.
Transfer times with this option are about 25 minutes.
an APS transfer using remote service from a central service center using
the integrated analog or digital modem or
a LAN (see Chapter 4).
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
Function
This feature transfers the new APS in its entirety and stores it in the available area of
the MMC. After the transfer has been completed, the system analyzes the checksum
and subsequently reports whether or not
an error was found.
If so, you have to delete the transferred APS.
the APS transfer was successful.
You can then activate the APS immediately or at a later time.
Resetting the system initiates the changeover from the old APS to the new APS. If
problems occur during this process, the old APS is reactivated. Once the changeover
is successful, the old APS is deleted from the MMC.
In case of power outage, the SDRAM content that has no battery backup is complete-
ly lost. By reaccessing the current APS on the MMC, the system can be restored to
the state it was in prior to the power outage.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-9
Serviceability
5.3.3 Diagnosis Options
5.3.3.1 Recording Board Status
5.3.3.1.1 Central Control Boards
Run LED
A Run LED that displays the systems operating capacity is located on all central con-
trol boards of the HiPath 3000 product line.
Options Available?
You can call up the following options using the HiPath 3000 Manager E:
CMA
CMS
LIM
IMODC
MPPI, AM (only with HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150), UAM (only with HiPath 3550,
HiPath 3350) or UAMR (only with HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300)
The presence of one of these announcement and music modules is displayed as
Option 5. The ALUM4 option cannot be displayed.
Table 5-2 Run LED - Meaning of the LED Status
Run LED Meaning
off Power outage
on Reset key quickly pressed
off Reset key pressed longer than 5 s (LED disappears as ver-
ification for initiating a reload.)
on System boot
off
for 0.1 s
Loading operation: APS in SDRAM/Loadware/Card data
blinking
0.5 s on/0.5 s off
Normal operating condition (zero load)1
1 The blinking rhythm depends on the load. The higher the load, the slower the blinking rhythm.
blinking
0.1 s on/0.1 s off
MMC removed or defective
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.3.1.2 Power Supplies
5.3.3.1.3 Peripheral Boards
View Status of Peripheral Boards
You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E or Assistant T to view the statuses of all periph-
eral boards. Display is limited to the following statuses per board:
Board not inserted
Board defective (not loaded)
Board disabled
Board enabled (active)
Board busy (at least one station or line from this board is disconnected, is being
called, or is busy).
For ISDN boards, the status of the reference clock is displayed:
No reference clock
Reference clock for clock generator is created.
When viewing the status of the board using the HiPath 3000 Manager E, all peripheral
boards integrated into the system are presented in a table. The status display is up-
dated every 3 seconds.
Table 5-3 Power Supply Status Displays
Board Status Display
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700
UPSM The LED displays the operating status (on or off).
HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500, HiPath 3300
PSUC, PSUCR The LED displays the 5 V output voltage.
PSUP, PSUPR The LED displays the 5 V output voltage.
UPSC-D, UPSC-DR A green LED displays the 5 V output voltage.
A yellow LED displays the additional power of 48 V
output voltage provided by an external power supply
unit (EPSU2 or EPSU2R).
HiPath 3250, HiPath 3150
PSU One The LED displays the operating status (on or off).
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-11
Serviceability
With the Assistant T, you can only view the status of one board at a time. You can also
update the status display by pressing a key.
You cannot perform additional activities with the HiPath 3000 Manager E and Assis-
tant T while viewing the status of a board.
HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700: LEDs on Peripheral Boards
All peripheral boards are equipped with LEDs for displaying the status of a board or
port.
Locking out and Releasing Boards and Ports
Using the HiPath 3000 Manager E and Assistant T, you can lock out a complete sta-
tion or trunk module. Lockout prevents the connection from being seized again after
the current connection has ended. Lockout or release settings are also retained after
a reset.
You cannot lock out the first SLMO/SLU board because administration through the
Assistant T uses its first two ports.
If you try to lock out the last active trunk, you will be notified that remote service
through the service center is no longer possible.
Table 5-4 HiPath 3000 Manager E - Example of Status Display of Peripheral
Boards
Slot Board Not insert-
ed
Defective Locked
out
Idle Busy Clock
source
1STLS2 X X X
2SLU8 X
3SLA4 X X
4TLA8 X
5
6
7TS2 X X
8 SLA16 X
9
10 SLMO24 X
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.3.2 Recording Trunk Status
HiPath 3000 records the current status of each individual trunk in a table. If the status
changes, the new status along with the time stamp is entered. You can use HiPath
3000 Manager E to view the trunk status, in which case the following information is
provided.
Data Content
Date Date of the event (as stored in system)
Time Time of the event (as stored in system)
Trunk number Number of the trunk
Slot/Port Slot and port number
Status Trunk status:
Inactive
Incoming call
Outgoing call
Trunk-to-trunk connection
Trunk disabled (using lockout switch or HiPath
3000 Manager E)
Trunk failure
Number of the connected station
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-13
Serviceability
5.3.3.3 Recording Station Status
HiPath 3000 records the current status of each individual station in a table. You can
use HiPath 3000 Manager E to view the station status, in which case the following in-
formation is provided.
Data Content
Station name Name of the selected station
Slot/Port For example: 7-1
Telephone model For example: optiPoint 500 advance
Telephone status Active/inactive
DID number External number of the selected station
Language Menu language of selected station
Connection status Inactive: The telephone is idle.
Busy: The telephone is off the hook, but
not yet dialed.
Waiting: The telephone call is in the
queue.
Connected: The telephone is connected
to a second telephone with a trunk or a
hunt group member.
Holding: The telephone is on hold.
Error: The connection cannot be estab-
lished due to an error (invalid telephone
number).
Call: The telephone is called.
Connected to The number of the connected station or trunk
Forwarding status Off: No call forwarding activated.
Internal: Call forwarding activated only for
internal calls.
External: Call forwarding activated only
for external calls.
All: Call forwarding activated for all calls.
Destination Number of call forwarding destination
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.3.4 Recording the Status of the V.24 Interface
You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to view the current status of the V.24 interface,
in which case the following information is provided.
Status of the trunks (1 = active trunk, 0 = inactive trunk)
The individual trunks are assigned as follows:
DTR = HiPath 3000
DSR = Telephone
RTS = HiPath 3000
CTS = Telephone
Viewing the status of the V.24 interface enables falsely connected or damaged
cables to be recorded (For more information on this, refer to Help in the HiPath
3000 Manager E.).
V.24 Monitoring
The number of sent or received bytes within a time period to be selected can be
recorded and then displayed or saved using a text editor
(default = MS WordPad®).
Activated features Status of activated features (on or off):
Do not disturb
Call forwarding (device status)
Advisory text
Room monitor
Code lock
Station number suppression
Group ringing
Ringer connection
Hunt group
Silent call waiting
Handsfree answerback
Call waiting release
Transfer of ringing (only for MULAP)
Call forwarding MULAP (only for MULAP)
Connected station List of the connected stations
Data Content
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-15
Serviceability
5.3.3.5 Trace Options
Tracing ISDN Activities
This feature enables ISDN telephones and ISDN trunks to be traced in real-time.
ISDN activities are routed to HiPath 3000 Manager E and saved in a trace file. Only
the ISDN sequences are displayed on the monitor, not the content of the ISDN mes-
sages.
For recording errors, the Tracestop can be
coupled to a certain error number.
activated using remote access.
activated manually from a telephone (if the customer discovers an error such as
double connections).
If the trace session is over, you can start the ISDN Message Decoder (ISDN Tracer)
and use it to convert the trace file into a readable format (only English). You can also
read out the trace data using remote service.
The ISDN Message Decoder is a 32 bit application which converts the ISDN layer 3
messages and information elements into a readable format. Since you cannot find out
from the trace file whether it deals with an information element from a Euro ISDN or
a QSig configuration, you have to select the protocol. You may select the following
settings from the main menu:
Raw (default setting)
Euro ISDN
QSig V1
With the Raw setting, the Hex values are only decoded, not interpreted. With the
other two settings, the Hex values are decoded and interpreted per feature (CC, AOC,
...).
Tracing Call-related Activities
You can trace all activities from any telephone, trunk, etc., that is released by a call.
These include consultation calls, conference calls, hunt groups, for example.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.3.6 Error History
HiPath 3000 provides an error history where accrued errors are classified according
to error class and error number. It also includes the date and time the error occurred.
You can use HiPath 3000 Manager E to read out the error memory.
Section 5.3.4 provides information on error classification.
5.3.3.7 Testing Telephones
After startup and country adaptation, you can activate the telephone test on any op-
tiPoint 500 and optiset E telephone using a code or the service menu. This test
checks the display (your number is displayed), LEDs, and calls. The tests ends auto-
matically after a period of time.
During the test, you can satisfy yourself that the visual and audio components func-
tion properly.
5.3.3.8 Analyzing System-wide Use of Feature
HiPath 3000 has counters that record the system-wide use of features, such as caller
list, call forwarding, busy override. You can view the counter statuses using HiPath
3000 Manager E.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-17
Serviceability
5.3.4 Error Messages
Classification
Accrued errors are classified according to error class and error number. The three dif-
ferent error classes are described below:
Error Class A = Customer-related error
HiPath 3000 Manager E fails to issue a signal or message. Class A errors are
indicated on the optiPoint Attendant display. The customer can correct them with-
out service support.
The only error messages currently included are: Printer alarm (caused by emp-
ty paper tray), Fan failure (caused by the fan breaking down in the HiPath 3500
and HiPath 3300 housing) and Revisor alarm (caused by an overflow in the
MMC log area).
For U.S. only: INVALID SPID (HiPath 3550, HiPath 3350, HiPath 3500 and HiPath
3300) signals that the service profile identifier (SPID) for BRI ISDN is incorrect.
Error Class B = Service-related errors
The HiPath 3000 Manager E signals Class B errors, which can be automatically
forward to a service center.
Errors of this class are caused by failure of the boards, individual ports, or trunks.
You can generally correct these errors by replacing the hardware, reconfiguring
the customer database, or by working together with the carrier.
Error Class C = Development-related errors
HiPath 3000 Manager E fails to issue a signal/message.
Class C errors require diagnosis and problem analysis by specialists.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.5 Correcting Errors
5.3.5.1 Automatic Error Correction
One of the below recovery actions is assigned to each error in the error memory.
These recovery actions are programmed to automatically correct errors that occur.
Hard restart
Reload board
Reload CDB backup
Port lockout
Power failure transfer (loop start)
None
A watchdog activates continuous loops.
If no recovery measure is assigned or if the one that is assigned fails, a service tech-
nician has to correct the error manually.
5.3.5.2 Manual Error Correction Without HiPath 3000 Manager E
Manually Activating Restart (Reset)/Reload
Pressing the reset button on the central control board
initiates a Reset (Hard restart of the entire system with the current CDB) if the
button is pressed for less than 5 seconds. The Run LED lights up when the Reset
button is pressed.
initiates a Reload if the button is pressed longer than 5 seconds. The Run LED
disappears after approximately 5 seconds as verification that the reload has
been initiated. The entire content of the customer database is replaced by its de-
fault version. All country and customer-specific settings are lost.
Locking out and Releasing Boards and Ports
You can lock out and release ports using the lockout switch located on the board.
Lockout prevents renewed seizure after the current connection has finished. It cre-
ates
a port lockout in an outgoing direction on analog trunk boards.
a port lockout in outgoing and incoming directions on trunk boards.
a lockout of the entire board for subscriber line modules.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-19
Serviceability
5.3.5.3 Manual Error Correction With HiPath 3000 Manager E
Initiating Restart (Reset)
This initiates an immediate hard restart of the entire system with the current CDB.
Initiating Reload Card
This the single board (loading Loadware) to reload.
Locking out and Releasing Boards and Ports
HiPath 3000 Manager E enables you to lock out an entire subscriber line module or
line circuit module and individual ports. The lockout prevents renewed seizure after
the current connection has finished. Release or lockout settings are retained after a
reset.
However, you cannot lock out the first SLMO/SLU board because administration
through Assistant T runs on its first two ports.
When attempting to lock out the last active trunk, you are subsequently notified that
remote service through the service center is no longer possible.
You cannot use HiPath 3000 Manager E to release boards and ports locked out with
the lockout switch.
Power Failure Transfer
You cannot initiate a power failure transfer to analog telephones using HiPath 3000
Manager E.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.6 Remote Service
Definition
Remote service is described as communication between the service center and Hi-
Path 3000 using public telecommunications networks to fulfill service tasks. These
tasks are
remote system administration,
remote administration of Plus products via the system,
remote correction of system software (APS transfer),
automatic signaling of error messages.
Remote service facilitates the administration and maintenance of various communi-
cation systems from a central location. An integrated digital modem (B channel) or an
integrated analog modem ((IMODC) can be used to connect to the system.
Figure 5-2 Example of Remote Service
HiPath 3000
Plus Products
Service center
Service PC
with
HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E
Central Board
Modem
LIM
Customer
LAN
PSTN
(analog or
digital
telecommunica-
tions network)
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-21
Serviceability
Integrated Analog Modem (IMODC)
This modem enables remote access to all systems (not HiPath 3250 and HiPath
3150) in the HiPath 3000 product line. Access is achieved using any trunks, tie trunks,
and all subscriber lines. The IMODC is designed as a plug-in card.
The IMODC is treated as a pseudo port. It receives a number in the system that can
be reached internally through direct internal dialing (DID). You can cancel the DID
number manually to prevent external access.
The following codes and parameters apply when the analog modem is in operation:
Transmission to V.22bis (2400 Bd), V.32 (9600 Bd), V.32bis (14400 Bd)
Error correction to V.42, MNP 2-4
Data compression to V.42bis, MNP 5
Integrated digital Modem (B Channel)
An integrated B channel modem is available with all systems in the HiPath 3000 prod-
uct line. This type of modem facilitates remote access using both digital trunks, tie
trunks, as well as S0 subscriber lines. Data transmission is supported according to
Protocol X.75.
The digital modem is treated as a pseudo port. It receives a number in the system
that can be reached internally and through direct internal dialing. You can cancel the
DID number manually to prevent external access.
Access to the analog/digital modem
The customer must enable the access to both modems by entering a 6-digit PIN
code. If the service center is to make a connection to the HiPath 3000 over a modem,
it may be necessary to enter this individual code. It depends on which trunk type is
used for the modem access. The following applies to the system default:
Access over ISDN trunk = enable procedure: customer must enter PIN code.
Access over another trunk = login without code: PIN code is not necessary.
If necessary, the system administration (only by using Assistant T) can reset the PIN
code back to the default value.
Caution
Be sure to disconnect the system from the power supply before removing or insert-
ing integrated analog modems (IMODC).
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.6.1 Remote System Administration
5.3.6.1.1 Remote Administration with HiPath 3000 Manager E
To establish a remote connection between HiPath 3000 and the service center (Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E), the following options are available:
Callback
Service call using a code
Automatic error signaling
Any one of these options establishes a connection using the integrated digital modem
(B channel) or the integrated analog modem (IMODC).
Callback
HiPath 3000 can manage up to 6 different callback indices (callback passwords and
their relevant callback numbers), in which case the first callback connection is also
the destination of the automatic error signaling. For each callback connection, you
can select either the digital modem (B channel) or the analog modem (IMODC).
Service Call Using a Code
You can use any telephone to initiate a HiPath 3000 service call to the service center
by selecting the connection setup option Service call using a code and activating
the feature Remote access immediately after installation. In contrast to the usual
callback procedure, this callback (service call) is not activated by HiPath 3000 Man-
ager E itself, but by any telephone you choose. Callback initialization is essentially
skipped.
The service call destinations are the six callback indices that also apply to callback.
You are not required to enter the relevant passwords.
Automatic Error Correction
Error Class B errors can be transferred to a service center automatically. For more
information on this, see Section 5.3.6.3.
5.3.6.1.2 DTMF Remote Administration
This feature facilitates remote system administration by transmitting DTMF signals.
The user interface (menu prompt) is the same as that of the Assistant T for system
administration on site. DTMF remote administration can be performed using either
the analog or digital trunks.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-23
Serviceability
5.3.6.2 Remote Correction of System Software (APS)
The service center performs the APS transfer (see Section 5.3.2.2).
5.3.6.3 Remote Error Signaling
Error Class B errors can be automatically transferred to a service center. To do this,
the Error signaling flag has to be activated and a number entered under the callback
index 1.
The error report consists of one header and the error information that is transmitted
in binary form. The header contains a unique identifier that recognizes the customer
system that sent the error reports.
5.3.6.4 Remote Administration and Access Using PPP
You can establish a connection between the system/Plus product and the service
center using either the integrated digital modem (B channel) or the integrated analog
modem (IMODC). Data is exchanged in both cases using Point-to-Point-Protocols
(PPP).
For more detailed information on the possible functions, see Chapter 4, HiPath 3000
in the LAN Network.
5.3.6.4.1 Remote System Administration
You can also operate HiPath 3000 Manager E in conjunction with the relevant infra-
structure (RDT network, router) using PPP.
For more information on this, see Section 4.8.4.
5.3.6.4.2 Remote Administration of Plus Products
You can manage Plus products from a central location using HiPath 3000. However,
HiPath 3000 only provides the means of transmission. Actual administration of the
Plus product is done using special software programs like pcANYWHERE.
For more information on this, see Section 4.8.5.
5.3.6.4.3 Remote Error Signaling Using SNMP
Plus products and the HiPath 3000 can transmit error messages (SNMP traps) to the
service center.
For more information on this, see Section 4.8.2.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.7 Access Security
5.3.7.1 Logon With User Name and Password
Security
To ensure that authorized users have access to the HiPath 3000 and to prevent un-
authorized accesses, users must be identified by a user name and authorized by a
password. This applies to all local and remote administration and maintenance pro-
cedures using HiPath 3000 Manager E, Assistant T, HiPath 3000 Manager C, Assis-
tant TC, and AMHOST.
After the first system startup and during country initialization, you can select between
the following security options:
variable password (default)
fixed password
Variable Password
Up to 16 users can be assigned their own user ID with individual name, password,
and a user group consisting of six pre-determined user groups (in Table 5-5). Only the
data authorized for the relevant user group can be read and administered.
During the first login, the system requests the identity of the user and asks for a new
password (max. 15 characters from the optiPoint 500 character set). This then over-
writes the default user name (31994) and default password (31994). This first user is
then automatically assigned to the user group System Maintenance. The system in-
forms the user that no user is configured in the system and that the user has been
assigned with System Maintenance authorization. Using HiPath 3000 Manager E or
Assistant T, additional users and their passwords can be configured in the user ad-
ministration.
If a user forgets a password, it has to be deleted and reconfigured by a different au-
thorized user. If all authorized users forget their passwords, the system must be re-
generated.
Fixed Password
When using the fixed password, only fixed user groups with unchangeable default
user names and default passwords are used. Also, new users cannot be configured
in the user administration.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-25
Serviceability
Changing Password Types
Only with Assistant T can you change from a variable password to a fixed password
type and vice versa. To do this, you have to re-initialize the country settings. This
switches the entire content of the customer database (including user names and
passwords) to a default state.
If you perform country initialization in a system with a variable password, the previ-
ously created user names and passwords remain intact as long as you do not subse-
quently change the password type.
If a CDB is read from a system in which the default user names and passwords were
changed, this CDB cannot be loaded into a HiPath 3000 system that was changed to
a fixed password type. Before reading this CDB, you have to set up a user (user name
and password) in the system that matches a user group with a fixed password. Once
this user has been set up, the CDB can be read from the HiPath 3000. With this user
name and ID, you can now load the CDB into the system switched to the fixed pass-
word type.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.7.2 Pre-determined User Groups and Their Access Rights
User Groups With a Variable Password
The following table shows the six pre-determined user groups and their access rights.
Table 5-5 Variable Password: Pre-determined User Groups and Their Access
Rights
No. User groups
User rights
User
admin.
Audit
System maint.
(Service)
Customer admin.
(Customer)
Accounting
Development
1. Setting up/deleting users
Assigning users to user groups XX
1
1 As long as no user is assigned to the User Administration user group.
2. Assessing and archiving backup-related log files
Reader rights to system data (for example, error mem-
ory), not including confidential customer information
XX
2
2 As long as no user is assigned to the Audit user group.
3. Access rights to all system data (not including develop-
ment access rights) as long as no users are assigned
to other user groups.
X
4. Access rights to confidential customer information
Executing customer actions (for example, printing cer-
tain lists)
X3
3 As long as no user is assigned to the Customer administration user group.
X
5. Access rights to non-confidential customer information XX
6. Access rights to parameters and call detail recording
actions (not including interface parameters for output
device)
X3, 4 X4
4 As long as no user is assigned to the Accounting user group.
X
7. Access rights of the System Maintenance user group
Setting and reading certain parameters to which no
other user group has access.
X
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-27
Serviceability
User Groups With a Fixed Password
The following table shows the unchangeable user groups and their rights.
Table 5-6 Fixed Password: Fixed User Groups and Their Access Rights
No. User groups
User rights
System maint. (Service)
Name/Password=
31994/31994
Customer admin. (Cust.)
Name/Password:
Assistant TC=*95/(Password
not necessary)
Assistant C=office/office
Development
1. Assessing and archiving backup-related log files
Reader rights to system data (for example, error memory),
not including confidential customer data
XX
2. Access rights to all system data (not including development
access rights) XX
3. Access rights to confidential customer information
Executing customer actions (for example, printing out certain
lists)
XXX
4. Access rights to non-confidential customer information XXX
5. Access rights to parameters and call detail recording actions
(not including interface parameters for the output device) X
6. Setting up and reading certain parameters to which no other
user group has access. X
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.7.3 System Access Options
The users access rights, meaning the data that the user may read or manage, always
depend on the user group to which the user is assigned.
Service Tools
Assistant T and Assistant TC
Log in by entering your user name and password (regardless of code lock)
The system can only be accessed using the first two UP0/E connections from the
first SLMO/SLU board in the system.
HiPath 3000 Manager E and HiPath 3000 Manager C (local)
Log in by entering your user name and password.
HiPath 3000 Manager E (remote), direct connection
Log in by entering your user name and password.
The system can be accessed directly using the integrated digital modem (B
channel) or the integrated analog modem. However, the user is required to es-
tablish a 5 digit access code beforehand.
HiPath 3000 Manager E (remote), callback connection
Log in by entering your user name and password.
The system can be accessed using the integrated digital modem (B channel) or
the integrated analog modem. However, you have to set up a callback index be-
forehand.
AMHOST
The AMHOST (Administration and Maintenance via HOST) feature allows Plus prod-
ucts to read certain system information and to change it, if necessary. To enable Plus
products to access the system, you have to set up a user without a user group in the
HiPath 3000 default user administration. Enter AMHOST as the user name and
77777 as the default user password.
You can only change this password if the system is configured using a variable pass-
word. In this case, delete the AMHOST user and reconfigure the system with the
same user name and a new password.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-29
Serviceability
Chip Card Reader (only for Deutsche Telekom AG)
This feature allows for additional security measures due to an identification and au-
thentication procedure that ensures proper access to Deutsche Telekom AG commu-
nication systems and prevents unauthorized access.
You can activate this feature by using a chip card. The service PCs at Deutsche Tele-
kom AG are equipped with chip card readers that allow the PCs to boot only if the chip
card recognizes the technicians individual chip card ID and if the password is entered
correctly. The chip card is also configured to recognize whether or not access to the
Octopus E system family exists.
To permit access to both user groups as well as individual technicians, you can de-
cide, when logging on, whether you want to log on using the group ID in the chip card
or your individual ID. In both cases, the logon information is entered in a log file to
ensure that you, the chip card, user can be directly retraced.
Each Octopus system is provided with a default name and default password. When
you first log in, if
no chip card is recognized, you have to access the service PC using the default
name and password.
a chip card is recognized, the user administration starts up immediately.
In both cases, when logging on for the first time, you are required to enter the follow-
ing in the user administration:
User name
User group (User Administration, Audit, System Maintenance, Administration,
Accounting, Development)
Password
These entries overwrite the default name and default password.
You can enter additional chip card users in the user administration manually or using
the chip card.
You cannot switch to a fixed password if using a system from Deutsche Telekom AG.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.7.4 Customer Data Security
When saving a customer database on the hard disk, a user table (part of the user ad-
ministration) with user name and encrypted passwords are also saved. This guaran-
tees access security when the customer database is opened offline later on.
When opening the customer database offline, you are requested to enter your user
name and password. The data that you enter is compared to the data in the user ta-
ble. In this case, the user group verified during this process also determines the ac-
cess rights.
When loading an offline customer database into HiPath 3000, the user table that goes
with it should not be loaded into the system. Otherwise, the system-specific user ad-
ministration would be distorted.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-31
Serviceability
5.3.8 Automatic Logging of Administration Procedures
Definition
All accesses to customer-related data in the HiPath 3000 are automatically logged in
an area of the MMC (LOG area) reserved for this purpose. The information recorded
includes who the user is, the data manipulated by the user, and the time. An autho-
rized user (member of the Audit user group) can transfer the system data to a PC
and assess it.
5.3.8.1 Logging
A log entry contains the following information:
Date and time
User name and user group
Type of activity (format identification) and activity (command entry)
5.3.8.1.1 Format Identification and Command Entry
The following format information is logged:
Assistant T (1)
All activities are logged, regardless of system access. The respective code with
the most important parameters is recorded as the command entry (for example,
station, number).
Assistant TC (2)
Same as Assistant T (1)
Session Information (3)
The system access is logged, regardless whether it is logged using Assistant T,
HiPath 3000 Manager E, or other HiPath systems. Possible command entries
are:
A0-1 = Login procedure
A0-2 = Logout procedure
A0-3 = Unauthorized login attempt
HiPath 3000 Manager E Database (4)
Access to the database is logged using HiPath 3000 Manager E. Possible com-
mand entries are:
A1-1 = Database read
A1-2 = Regeneration of CDB (Load CDB into the system)
A1-3 = Write database
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-32 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
Program Systems (5)
APS transfers and system boots (for example, first bootup) are recorded. Possi-
ble command entries are:
A2-1 = APSXF started
A2-2 = APSXF ended
A2-3 = APS boot (APS stamp also included)
HiPath 3000 Manager E Maintenance (6)
Maintenance activities which can be assigned with the following command en-
tries are logged:
B1-1 = Read error memory
B1-2 = Delete error memory
B2-1 = Out of service
B3-1 = Read Direct Memory Access
B3-2 = Write Direct Memory Access
B4-1 = Delete base station status overload
B4-2 = Delete base station restart
B5-1 = Digital loopback change
B6-1 = Trunk rolling change
B7-1 = Read trunk status
B8-1 = Delete trunk error counter
Simulated or pseudo Assistant T format (7)
The HiPath 3000 Manager E records the offline changes of a CDB as a simulat-
ed Assistant T command. For data areas subject to change by HiPath 3000
Manager E, pseudo areas are generated. When loading an offline CDB into the
system, the following simulated commands are logged as command entries:
C1 = Pseudo area System parameter
C1-1 System fags/CMI
C1-2 System intercept/AC
C1-3 Tones and calls
C1-4 Direction flag special (Variable direction#)
C1-5 System settings
C1-6 Host Link Interface
C1-7 Relocate activation
C2 = Pseudo area System timer
C2-1 System timer
C3 = Pseudo area S0 configuration
C3-1 Station bus
C3-2 Line supervision
C3-3 Mode
C4 = Pseudo area Lines
C4-1 Loop start parameter (Variable Slot/Line#)
C5 = Pseudo area Digit analysis
C5-1 Internal number (Variable Stn#, Grp#)
C5-2 Service codes
C6 = Pseudo area Summer time
C6-1 Summer time
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-33
Serviceability
C7 = Pseudo area Directions
C7-1 Direction flags (Variable direction#)
C8 = Pseudo area Door setup
C8-1 Door setup (Variable door#)
C9 = Pseudo area UCD Flags
C9-1 UCD Flags
C10 = Pseud area Delete system counter
C10-1 Delete system counter
HiPath 3000 Manager E online (8)
Archives from the log file and the user administration are logged. Possible com-
mand entries are:
D1-1 = Archive
D2-1 = New user
D2-2 = Delete user
D3-1 = Change password
Logging External Accesses (Solutions, Applications)
Plus products used with AMHOST can only make limited changes. Because these
changes automatically run simultaneously (for example Check In and Check Out
for hotel solutions), these are not logged. Only the session information (user name
is amhost) with the command entries Login procedure and Logout procedure
are logged.
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-34 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
5.3.8.2 Issuing and Saving Log Data
Data is automatically logged in an area (LOG area) on the MCC reserved for this pur-
pose. It cannot be switched off.
If approximately 80 % of the MMC log area capacity is exceeded, a Class A error is
issued. This error is dealt with like all Class A errors and is displayed on the optiPoint
Attendant as Revisor Alarm.
The log should now be read out and archived, meaning it should be saved in an ar-
chive file (file extension = arc). If an archive is not created, the oldest datablock is
overwritten if there is a danger of overflow.
You can only issue log entries using HiPath 3000 Manager E. You cannot retrieve the
log entries from the system until you have logged on as a user with Revisor rights.
Archive
If you request an archive (storage), the system checks whether or not there is already
an archive file (file extension = arc). If it is a file with log data from a previous archive,
the file must match the current customer. In case of a positive result, the system log
entries are retrieved and attached to the existing data in the archive file. At the same
time, the data in the system is deleted.
If malfunctions occur during this procedure (for example, line interruption), the entire
procedure ends and the archive has to be restarted.
If no archive is requested, the revisor can retrieve, view, and print the log entries.
However, log entries remain in the system.
Multimedia Card MMC
When replacing the multimedia card, the following applies:
If the memory area for logging data is empty, logging restarts.
If the memory area for logging data is not empty, logging continues.
Options in the Service Departmen
t
3000sb5.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 5-35
Serviceability
Example of a Log Printout
The following assumption applies as an example: The first system boot up has taken
place and customer-specific programming was completed.
The sample printout (without consideration of headers and footers) refers to the fol-
lowing information concerning administration procedures:
The Revisor (rev user in R (Revision) user group) has generated an initial ar-
chive.
The Service (serv user in S (system maintenance) user group) has read out
the system database, changed 20 station names, and written them again to the
system.
The Customer (pnkm user in A (Administration) user group) has changed two
additional station names.
The Revisor has retrieved the most recent log entries and printed them out.
1050 00-11-25 15:57:10 rev(R) (6)D1-1 Archive
1051 00-11-25 15:58:22 rev(R) (3)A0-2 Logout procedure
1052 00-11-26 09:20:15 serv(S) (3)A0-1 Login procedure
1053 00-11-26 09:21:35 serv(S) (4)A1-1 Database read
1054 00-11-26 09:21:52 serv(S) (7)14-12-*(20) Station name
1055 00-11-26 09:22:45 serv(S) (4)A1-3 Write database
1056 00-11-26 09:23:25 serv(S) (3)A0-2 Logout procedure
1057 00-11-26 10:10:15 pnkm(A) (3)A0-1 Login procedure
1058 00-11-26 10:11:15 pnkm(A) (2)14-12-30Station name
1059 00-11-26 10:11:35 pnkm(A) (2)14-12-31Station name
1060 00-11-26 10:12:15 pnkm(A) (3)A0-2 Logout procedure
1061 00-11-27 11:20:30 rev(R) (3)A0-1 Login procedure
Options in the Service Department
Serviceability
G281-0788-00, April 2002
5-36 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb5.fm
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-1
Overvie
w
Desktop Products
6 Desktop Products
6.1 Overview
This chapter describes the desktop products of the HiPath 3000 system.
This chapter discusses the topics listed in the table.
Topic
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later) page 6-2
Accessories for optiPoint 500 Telephone Solutions page 6-17
optiset E page 6-19
Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions page 6-34
Telephones for HiPath cordless page 6-35
Attendant Consoles page 6-46
LAN Telephones/Adapters page 6-53
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.2 optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Introduction
optiPoint 500 telephones handle the digital communication of voice and data (voice
communication only for optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy). The three di-
alog keys and the display guarantee convenient and interactive operation. Further-
more, the key lamp principle visualizes the activated functions.
With the exception of optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy, the optiPoint
500 telephones have a USB 1.1 interface. This allows for PC-supported telephoning
and Internet access over the USB interface of a PC.
The add-on devices optiPoint key module and optiPoint BLF allow you to increase the
number of available function keys.
The different optiPoint 500 adapters provide a flexible extension to the telephone
workstation. Additional devices (such as personal computers, fax equipment, tele-
phones, headsets) can be connected quickly because it is easy to build them on to
the bottom of the telephones (not optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 economy)
and because the adapters are plugnplay.
You can find information not contained in this chapter in the optiPoint 500 Service
Manual.
Market Introduction
The market introduction of the optiPoint 500 telephones, adapters and add-on devic-
es takes place in two steps:
Step 1, release 12/01: Contains all optiPoint 500 telephones, adapters and add-
on devices, described in this chapter and not included in step 2.
Step 2, release probably 03/02: Contains optiPoint 500 entry, optiPoint 500 econ-
omy, optiPoint acoustic adapter, optiPoint ISDN adapter, optiPoint recorder
adapter and optiPoint BLF.
The optiPoint 500 telephones described in this section are compatible with the op-
tiset E telephones. It is possible to operate both telephone families on one UP0/E
board. You can also use telephones from the two families in mixed host-client con-
figurations (earlier called the master-slave or primary-secondary configuration).
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-3
Desktop Products
The optiPoint 500 product family includes the following telephones:
Key Programming
HiPath 3000 < V3.0 does not automatically detect optiPoint 500 telephones; it treats
them as if they were optiset E telephones:
Because optiPoint 500 advance has more function keys (4 + 15) than any optiset E
telephones (max. 4 + 8), the system generates an optiset E advance plus/comfort
with optiset E key module for the optiPoint 500 advance. HiPath 3000 Manager E also
recognizes this combination.
Table 6-1 optiPoint 500 Telephones
Telephone (product name) Remark
optiPoint 500 entry Telephone without display
optiPoint 500 economy Telephone with display
optiPoint 500 basic Telephone with display
optiPoint 500 standard (optiPoint 500 standard SL
(for U.S. only))
Telephone with display
optiPoint 500 advance Telephone with display
Double key assignments
The programmable function keys of the optiPoint 500 telephones and the optiPoint
key modules can have double assignments. First define any key as the Shift key.
Only external phone numbers for outgoing dialing can be saved on the second
level that this provides.
LED signaling applies to the first key level only.
When the Shift function is pressed, the LED lights the Shift key. This signals that the
phone numbers on the second key level are available. The Shift function is deacti-
vated after 5 s or after you press a phone number or if the you press the Shift key
again.
The optiPoint BLF function keys cannot have double assignments.
optiPoint 500 tele-
phones
Generation/detection by HiPath 3000 and Hi-
Path 3000 Manager E
optiPoint 500 entry > optiset E basic
optiPoint 500 economy > optiset E advance plus/comfort
optiPoint 500 basic > optiset E advance plus/comfort
optiPoint 500 standard > optiset E advance plus/comfort
optiPoint 500 advance > optiset E advance plus/comfort + optiset E key
module
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Use the 4 + 8 function keys of the optiset E advance plus/comfort and the first 7 keys
of the optiset E key module to program the 4 + 15 function keys of the optiPoint 500
advance.
6.2.1 optiPoint 500 Telephones without Display
optiPoint 500 entry
- probably available from 03/02 on -
The optiPoint 500 entry telephone is an eco-
nomical entry-level model for access to the dig-
ital technology of the HiPath 3000 system. It is
designed for common areas and users who re-
quire minimal features. The optiPoint 500 entry
model has:
Eight preassigned function keys with LEDs
(can be reprogrammed with HiPath 3000
Manager E)
Open listening (speaker)
Two settings keys (plus/minus) for ringer
volume, ringer pitch, alerting tone, open lis-
tening
Wall mounting
No modularity (no connecting capability for
adapters or add-on devices), no display
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-5
Desktop Products
6.2.2 optiPoint 500 Telephones with Display
The following optiPoint 500 telephones include alphanumeric displays and provide in-
teractive prompting while a call is in progress. Interactive prompting means that you
are offered only functions that are relevant to the current call status. You can access
these features using three optiGuide dialog keys: OK, Next and Previous (see
Figure 6-1).
For clarity, the functions are arranged in submenus.
You can also select the features directly by using the service key to enter their codes.
You can also assign functions or function loops (macros) to the specific function keys.
Figure 6-1 The User Interface for the optiPoint 500 Telephone with Display
Invoke Conference? >
Peter Parker
Consultation? >
Invoke Transfer? >
Display
Select Display
Dialog keys
Scroll
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
optiPoint 500 economy (not for U.S.)
- probably available from 03/02 on -
optiPoint 500 basic
The optiPoint 500 economy is an entry-
level display telephone with a compre-
hensive function package, including the
following features:
12 function keys with LEDs (4 that
can be programmed with HiPath
3000 Manager E, 8 freely program-
mable)
LCD swivel display (2 lines x 24
characters).
Three dialog keys for interactive
prompting (OK, Next, and Previous)
Open listening (speaker)
Two settings keys (plus/minus) for
ringer volume, ringer pitch, alerting
tone, open listening
Wall mounting
No modularity (no connecting capa-
bility for adapters or add-on devic-
es)
The optiPoint 500 basic is a professional
telephone with all the features of the op-
tiPoint 500 economy, plus:
Interfaces and slots:
1 USB 1.1 interface
1 adapter slot (option bay)
1 interface for max. 2 add-on
devices
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-7
Desktop Products
optiPoint 500 standard / optiPoint 500 standard SL (for U.S. only)
Remark: optiPoint 500 standard and standard SL (for U.S. only) function exactly the
same on the HiPath 3000 systems.
optiPoint 500 advance
The optiPoint 500 standard is a profes-
sional telephone with all the features of
the optiPoint 500 basic, plus:
Full duplex speakerphone mode
with echo suppression for adapting
to the room
The optiPoint 500 advance is a profes-
sional telephone with all the features of
the optiPoint 500 standard, plus:
19 function keys with LEDs (4 that
can be programmed with HiPath
3000 Manager E, 15 freely pro-
grammable)
Interfaces and slots:
1 integrated USB 1.1 interface
2 adapter slots (option bays)
1 interface for max. 2 add-on
devices
1 headset connection (121
TR9-5)
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.2.3 Comparison of Features on all optiPoint 500 Telephones
Table 6-2 Comparison of Features on all optiPoint 500 telephones
Feature optiPoint 500 telephone
entry economy basic standard advance
Function keys with LEDs: variable
using HiPath 3000 Manager E)
84 44 4
Function keys with LEDs: program-
mable
888 15
12-element keypad (0 - 9, #, *) x x x x x
Two settings keys (plus/minus) x x x x x
Open listening x x x x x
Full duplex speakerphone mode –– –xx
Adapter slots (bay options) –– 11 2
USB interface –– 11 1
Three dialog keys xxx x
Display 2 x 24 2 x 24 2 x 24 2 x 24
Connection for optiPoint key module –– xx x
Connection for optiPoint BLF –– xx x
Optional wall mounting x x x x x
Dimensions in mm:
Width
Depth
Height
159
220
64
214
220
68
214
220
68
214
220
68
214
220
68
Maximum length of the connecting
line in meters:
Without plug-type AC adapter
With plug-type AC adapter
500
1000
Maximum length of connecting line
between primary and secondary
telephone (through phone adapter)
in meters
100
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-9
Desktop Products
6.2.4 optiPoint 500 Add-On Devices
You can use the optiPoint key module and optiPoint BLF add-on devices to increase
the number of available function keys on the optiPoint 500 basic, optiPoint 500 stan-
dard, and optiPoint 500 advance telephones.
The user usually installs the add-on devices. The installation instructions are on the
Electronic Operating Instructions CD.
Refer to Section 3.9.2 for model-dependent data for the optiPoint key module and the
optiPoint BLF.
optiPoint key module
Warning
Always disconnect the line cord before connecting add-on devices to the telephone.
The optiPoint key module is an add-on device that
should be mounted on the side of the telephone; it
provides an additional 16 keys, LEDs and labelling
areas for all purposes. Figure 6-2 shows the possi-
ble configurations.
It is possible to perform double assignment for the
keys. Only external numbers for outgoing dialing
can be saved on the second key level that is then
available (see page 6-3).
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
optiPoint BLF
- probably available from 03/02 on -
Programming Add-On Devices
An inserted add-on device automatically registers with the system and is then ready
for operation. You can program keys with HiPath 3000 Manager E or Assistant T. If
you replace the device, the information programmed under the keys is maintained
(stored in the customer database).
If a configuration other than the one shown in Figure 6-2 is used, the LEDs and keys
may not function correctly. You must update the database with HiPath 3000 Manager
E.
Example: You replace configuration E by configuration C. You must use HiPath 3000
Manager E to remove the optiPoint key module 2 from the database so that the LEDs
and keys function correctly.
You can also use Assistant T to delete optiPoint BLFs and optiPoint key modules.
The first optiPoint BLF that is initially connected to HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath
3700, or HiPath 3500 automatically receives standard key assignments (default) for
the first 90 system ports. No standard assignment is made if you already configured
an optiPoint BLF with HiPath 3000 Manager E or if other optiPoint BLFs are connect-
ed.
The optiPoint BLF is an add-on
device that provides 90 addi-
tional keys, LEDs and labeling
areas for all purposes.
The connection to the telephone
or to an optiPoint key module is
made over an interface cable
with the following connectors:
input MW6 (RJ11), output MW8
(RJ45). Figure 6-2 shows the
possible configurations.
An local power supply (C39280-
Z4-C58, C39280-Z4-C70 =
USA, C39280-Z4-C66 = UK) is
inserted for the power; it can
supply a maximum of two opti-
Point BLFs.
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-11
Desktop Products
Possible Configurations for the Add-On Devices
Figure 6-2 optiPoint 500 - Possible Configurations for Add-On Devices
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
key
module
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
BLF
optiPoint
BLF
A
B
C
D
The configurations C and D are only
possible in HiPath 3750 and HiPath
3700.
optiPoint 500 basic,
optiPoint 500 standard or
optiPoint 500 advance
optiPoint
key
module
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.2.5 optiPoint 500 Adapter
The different optiPoint 500 adapters (not optiPoint 500 entry and optiPoint 500 econ-
omy) allow flexible expansion of the telephone workstation by providing additional de-
vice connections (such as PC, fax equipment, telephones, headsets).
The adapters, which are to be mounted on the bottom of the telephone, are
plugnplay. When a new telephone-adapter configuration is plugged in, it generates
a reset; a setup message notifies the system of the new configuration.
Option bays
Figure 6-3 optiPoint 500 - Option bays (Adapter Slots)
Option bays (adapter
slots):
2 x for optiPoint 500
advance (shown
here)
1 x for optiPoint 500
basic and optiPoint
500 standard
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-13
Desktop Products
optiPoint analog adapter
optiPoint acoustic adapter
- probably available from 03/02 on -
The optiPoint acoustic adapter is used for connecting
Active Speakerbox
Desk microphone
Headset, see Table 6-4 on page 6-18
Busy indication/door opener
Secondary bell/visual paging (with separate power supply over floating contact)
optiPoint recorder adapter
- probably available from 03/02 on -
The optiPoint recorder adapter allows an external recorder or second headset to be
connected. Attention: The other party to the conversation must be informed that the
the conversation is being recorded.
The optiPoint analog adapter allows an analog
device (such as telephone (DTMF only),
group 3 fax, modem, cordless telephone) to be
connected to the optiPoint 500 telephone.
The connected analog device can send and re-
ceive calls on the UP0/E interface to the system
regardless of the connection status of the opti-
Point 500 telephone, as long as a B channel is
available.
The adapter must always have a local power
supply for operating the connected analog de-
vice.
T/R interface properties:
Supply current: 30 mA
Busy signal when both B channels are busy
Ring sequence: 2.2
Supports only DTMF with Flash
No ground signaling allowed
Does not support: VoiceMail server with T/
R interface, message waiting lamp, dictat-
ing equipment, speaker, announcement de-
vice (such as start/stop).
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
optiPoint ISDN adapter
- probably available from 03/02 on -
optiPoint phone adapter
The optiPoint ISDN adapter provides the basic
ISDN access for S0 devices (max. 2), such as
S0-PC card, group 4 fax equipment, or video
communication devices (such as videoset or
videokit).
S0 telephones must have their own power sup-
ply for connection.
S0 interface properties:
Supports point-to-point and passive bus
connections
Wired for short passive bus configurations
Cable lengths
Maximum 100 m (328 feet) with a cable
impedance of 75 ohms
Maximum 200 m (656 feet) with a cable
impedance of 150 ohms (complies with
CCITT recommendation I.430)
The NT terminating resistors are integrated
into the ISDN adapter. Additional terminat-
ing resistors are included in the accessory
pack.
The optiPoint phone adapter is used for con-
necting a second optiPoint 500 telephone (client
telephone) with its own power supply.
The system treats the client telephone as an in-
dependent telephone with a separate phone
number and its own B channel. The client tele-
phone can send and receive calls regardless of
the connection status of the host telephone.
The maximum range between the host and cli-
ent telephones is approximately 100 m (328
feet) (for J-Y (ST) 2x2x0.6, 0.6 mm).
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later
)
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-15
Desktop Products
6.2.6 Restrictions for Using optiPoint 500 Adapters
Adapter Categories
Each UP0/E port in the system provides two B channels. This means that you can con-
nect two telephones, each with a separate phone number, to one UP0/E port.
Category 1 optiPoint 500 adapters
Each of the following adapters needs both B channels and can therefore only be used
once on a host telephone.
optiPoint analog adapter
optiPoint ISDN adapter
optiPoint phone adapter
If one of these adapters is used in the optiPoint 500 advance, only a category 2 adapt-
er can be operated in the second slot.
Category 2 optiPoint 500 adapters
The following adapters can be used on the host and client telephones. This is also
true if a category 1 optiPoint 500 adapter is already connected.
optiPoint acoustic adapter
optiPoint recorder adapter
Number of adapters and add-on devices allowed by the system
see Table 8-1
optiPoint 500 (V3.0 SMR-3 and later)
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-16 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.2.7 Comparison of optiset E adapters and optiPoint 500 adapters
Table 6-3 Comparison of optiset E and optiPoint 500 adapters
optiset E optiPoint 500
analog adapter analog adapter
phone adapter phone adapter
data adapter integrated USB interface
control adapter
ISDN adapter ISDN adapter
acoustic adapter acoustic adapter
contact adapter
headset adapter
headset plus adapter recorder adapter
Accessories for optiPoint 500 Telephone Solution
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-17
Desktop Products
6.3 Accessories for optiPoint 500 Telephone Solutions
6.3.1 Local Power Supplies
You may need a local power supply if you are using large configurations or if you need
to extend the range.
You can connect the local power supply (part numbers in Table 6-4 on page 6-18) to
the line cords of a host or client telephone using two MW6 jacks and the connecting
cable supplied.
Data for local power supply AUL:06D1284:
Line voltage: 220 (230) Vac (U.S.: 120 Vac)
AC line frequency: 47 to 53 Hz
Output voltage: Max. 50 V, min. 30 V
Output current: Max. 250 mA
6.3.2 Headsets
A headset replaces the telephone handset, which means that the users hands are
free when telephoning.
You can use the headsets listed in Table 6-4 on the optiPoint 500 advance or over an
optiPoint acoustic adapter.
Figure 6-4 Headset
Accessories for optiPoint 500 Telephone Solutions
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-18 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.3.3 Part Numbers
The current sales information contains the complete overview of all certified and de-
liverable products.
Table 6-4 Part Numbers for optiPoint 500 Telephones and Accessories
Telephone / Accessories Color Part Number
optiPoint 500 entry arctic S30817-S7101-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7101-A107-*
optiPoint 500 economy arctic S30817-S7108-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7108-A107-*
optiPoint 500 basic arctic S30817-S7102-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7102-A107-*
optiPoint 500 standard arctic S30817-S7103-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7103-A107-*
optiPoint 500 advance arctic S30817-S7104-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7104-A107-*
optiPoint key module arctic S30817-S7105-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7105-A107-*
optiPoint BLF arctic S30817-S7107-A101-*
manganese S30817-S7107-A107-*
optiPoint phone adapter arsenic S30817-K7110-B108-*
optiPoint analog adapter arsenic S30817-K7110-B208-*
optiPoint ISDN adapter arsenic S30817-K7110-B308-*
optiPoint acoustic adapter arsenic S30817-K7110-B408-*
optiPoint recorder adapter arsenic S30817-K7110-B508-*
optiPoint 500 entry wall bracket arsenic C39363-A328-C338
optiPoint 500 basic wall bracket arsenic C39363-A329-C338
Local power supply AUL:06D1284
Local power supply, UK AUL:06D1287
Local power supply, 110 V USA AUL:51A4827
Headset Encore monaural L30460-X1282-X1
Headset Encore binaural L30460-X1282-X2
Headset Tristar L30460-X1282-X3
Headset Supra L30460-X1282-X4
Headset DuoSet L30460-X1282-X5
Headset Profile monaural L30460-X1283-X1
Headset Profile binaural L30460-X1283-X2
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-19
Desktop Products
6.4 optiset E
The optiset E family of telephones supports digital voice and data communication
(voice only in the case of optiset E entry and standard). optiset E telephones with dis-
play also offer ease of use through the interactive user interface.
Add-on devices can add either 16 or 90 additional keys to an optiset E advance plus/
comfort, optiset E advance conference/conference, or optiset E memory telephone.
optiset E adapters connect additional equipment such as PCs, analog telephones,
ISDN terminals, headsets, speakers, or recorders to optiset E telephones. optiset E
adapters are plug-and-play ready. This means that the system detects and activates
them automatically.
All telephone models are available in gray, and the optiset E memory and optiset E
advance plus/comfort telephones also come in black. The sockets for the connection
to the system and the power supply unit use MW (RJ) connectors.
The optiset E product family includes the following telephones:
Dual key assignments:
You can assign dual functions to the programmable function keys on the optiset E
telephones and the optiset E key modules. To do this, you first have to define one
key as the Shift key. The second key level that this provides can contain only exter-
nal numbers for outgoing dialing.
The LED applies only to the first key level.
Activating the Shift function causes the LED on the Shift key to light up. In this state,
you can access the station numbers on the second key level. Press a station number
key, press the Shift key again or wait five seconds to deactivate the shift function.
You cannot assign two functions to the Hicom Attendant busy lamp fields (BLFs).
Table 6-5 optiset E Telephones
Telephone (product name) Remark
optiset E entry Telephone without display
optiset E basic Telephone without display
optiset E standard Telephone with display
optiset E advance plus/comfort Telephone with display
optiset E advance conference/conference Telephone with display
optiset E memory Telephone with display
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-20 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.4.1 optiset E Telephones Without Display
optiset E entry
optiset E basic
The optiset E entry telephone is an economical
entry-level model for access to the digital tech-
nology of the HiPath 3000 system. It is de-
signed for common areas and users who re-
quire minimal features. The optiset E entry
model has:
Three preassigned function keys with
LEDs (can be reprogrammed with HiPath
3000 Manager E)
Two volume control keys
Wall mounting
Function keys for the park, toggle, accept wait-
ing call, and conference features can be pro-
grammed.
The optiset E basic model has the same capa-
bilities as optiset E entry, with the following ad-
ditional features:
One slot for optiset E analog, data, ISDN or
phone adapter
Open listening (speaker)
On-hook dialing
Eight preassigned function keys with LEDs
(can be reprogrammed with HiPath 3000
Manager E)
Function keys for the park, toggle, accept wait-
ing call, and conference features can be pro-
grammed.
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-21
Desktop Products
6.4.2 optiset E Telephones with Display
The optiset E telephones with display include alphanumeric displays and provide in-
teractive prompting while a call is in progress. Interactive prompting means that you
are offered only functions that are relevant to the current call status. You can access
these features using three optiGuide dialog keys: OK, Next and Previous (see
Figure 6-5).
For clarity, the functions are arranged in submenus.
You can also select the features directly by using the service key to enter their codes.
You can also assign functions or function loops (macros) to the specific function keys.
Figure 6-5 The User Interface for the optiset E Telephone with Display
Invoke Conference? >
Peter Parker
Consultation? >
Invoke Transfer? >
Display
Select Display
Dialog keys
Scroll
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-22 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
optiset E standard
optiset E advance plus/comfort
The optiset E standard is an entry-level display
telephone with a comprehensive function pack-
age, including the following features:
Three optiGuide dialog keys for interactive
prompting (OK, Next, and Previous)
12 function keys with LEDs (including 4 that
can be programmed with HiPath 3000
Manager E)
LCD swivel display (2 lines x 24 charac-
ters).
Speakerphone mode and open listening
2 keys (plus and minus) for adjusting the
volume and setting the volume of call sig-
naling for incoming calls
Wall mounting
The optiset E advance plus/comfort is a profes-
sional telephone package, with all the features
of the optiset E standard model plus:
Two adapter slots
Connection for up to four optiset E key
modules and Hicom Attendant BLF
Chinese versions of the optiset E standard and optiset E advance plus/comfort tele-
phones are available with high-resolution displays.
optiClient Attendant: The professional PC attendant console connects to an optiset
E advance plus/comfort via an optiset E data adapter or optiset E control adapter.
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-23
Desktop Products
optiset E advance conference/conference
optiset E memory
This telephone is an optiset E advance plus/comfort telephone with a full duplex
speakerphone.
The optiset E advance conference/conference
is a professional telephone with all the features
of the optiset E standard, plus:
Full duplex speakerphone mode and open
listening
Two adapter slots
Connection for up to four optiset E key
modules and Hicom Attendant BLF
The optiset E memory is ideal for heavy
telephone use, such as for telemarket-
ing and call center representatives.
Features include:
Three optiGuide dialog keys for in-
teractive prompting (OK, Next, and
Previous)
12 function keys with LEDs (includ-
ing 4 that can be programmed with
HiPath 3000 Manager E)
Alphanumeric keypad with integrat-
ed ENB functionality
Memory for approximately 350 ENB entries (such as name, address, and tele-
phone number)
Swivel display (8 lines x 24 characters). Lines 1 through 6 are for the electronic
notebook and menu items; lines 7 and 8 are for interactive prompting.)
Two keys (plus and minus) for controlling the volume at the handset and setting
the volume of call signaling for incoming calls
Speakerphone mode and open listening
Two adapter slots
Connection for up to four optiset E key modules and Hicom Attendant BLF
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-24 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.4.3 Comparison of Features on all optiset E Telephones
Table 6-6 Comparison of Features on all optiset E telephones
Feature optiset E Telephone
entry
basic
standard
advance plus/comfort
advance conference/
conference
memory
Function keys with LEDs: variable using
HiPath 3000 Manager E)
38444
Function keys with LEDs: programmable) ––888
12-element keypad (0 - 9, #, *) X X X X X
Two keys (plus/minus X X X X X
Open listening XXXX
Speakerphone mode ––XXX
Adapter slot 122
Three dialog keys ––XXX
Display ––2 x 24 2 x 24 8 x 24
Connection for optiset E key module ––– XX
Connection for an optiset E BLF ––– XX
Alphanumeric keypad with integrated ENB
functionality
––– X
Optional wall mounting X X X X
Dimensions in mm:
Width
Depth
155
253
155
253
216
253
216
253
299
253
Maximum length of the connecting line in
meters:
Without plug-type AC adapter
With plug-type AC adapter
500
1000
500
1000
500
1000
500
1000
500
1000
Maximum length of connecting line be-
tween primary and secondary telephone
(through phone adapter) in meters
100 100 100 100 100
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-25
Desktop Products
6.4.4 optiset E Add-On Devices
The following add-on devices are available for the optiset E advance plus/comfort, op-
tiset E advance conference/conference and optiset E memory telephones:
optiset E key module
Hicom Attendant BLF
You can connect the Hicom Attendant BLF to the telephone or to an optiset E key
module using an interface cable with the following connectors: Inlet MW6, outlet
MW8. Figure 6-6 shows several possible configurations. An optiset E local power
supply can supply power to up to two Hicom Attendant BLFs.
Programming Add-On Devices
Once it is connected, an add-on device automatically logs onto the system and is then
operational. You can program keys using either HiPath 3000 Manager E or Assistant
T. The information that you programmed on the keys remains when you replace add-
on devices (it is stored in the customer database).
The optiset E key module is an add-on
device with additional dual assignment
function keys for optiset E telephones.
Features include:
32 programmable function keys
with LEDs
Up to 4 optiset E key modules per
telephone (connected using MW
(RJ) cables)
The Hicom Attendant BLF for optiset E
telephones is an add-on device with ex-
tra easily programmable function keys.
Features include:
90 programmable function keys
with LEDs
Refer to Section 3.9.2 on page 3-
212 for model-specific data relating
to the Hicom Attendant BLF.
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-26 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
After changing one of the configurations shown in Figure 6-6 with another, the LEDs
and keys may no longer work properly. You must therefore update the database using
HiPath 3000 Manager E.
Example: You replaced configuration E with configuration C. To make sure that the
LEDs and keys function properly, you must remove optiset E key module 2 from the
database using HiPath 3000 Manager E.
You can use Assistant T to clear Hicom Attendant BLFs and optiset E key modules.
The first Hicom Attendant BLF, which is connected to HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, Hi-
Path 3700 or HiPath 3500 for the first time, has default key assignments for the first
90 system ports. It does not have these default assignments if the Attendant BLF was
preconfigured using HiPath 3000 Manager E or if you connect additional Attendant
BLFs.
Add-On Devices: Possible Configurations
Figure 6-6 optiset E - Add-On Devices: Possible Configurations
optiset
E key
module
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
optiset
E key
module
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↵←
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
optiset
E key
module
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
optiset
E key
module
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
optiset
E key
module
optiset
E key
module
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
Hicom
Attendant
BLF
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↵←
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
A
B
C
D
E
F
Configurations B, D and F are possible
only with HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700.
optiset E advance plus/comfort
or advance conference/confer-
ence or memory
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-27
Desktop Products
6.4.5 optiset E Adapters
optiset E data adapter
The optiset E data adapter provides for the connection of a PC. This adapter can be
used for the following applications: Dialing from a PC, telemarketing, caller recogni-
tion, company-wide telephone book, caller logging, startup of a Microsoft Windows
application using the callers station number, and call lists. The data adapter can be
used together with the optiset E acoustic adapter.
The connection of TAPI applications via an external TAPI 3.0 driver is supported.
optiset E acoustic adapter (not for U.S.)
The optiset E acoustic adapter provides for the connection of accessories (such as a
loudspeaker unit, microphone, or second receiver). It can be used with all other
adapters.
optiset E analog adapter
The optiset E analog adapter connects analog telephones and can be used together
with the optiset E data and acoustic adapters.
optiset E ISDN adapter
The optiset E ISDN adapter provides for the connection of standard ISDN S0 non-
voice telephones (DSS1 protocol1). It can be used with the optiset E data and acous-
tic adapters.
The optiset E basic has only one adapter slot, which can be used for optiset E ana-
log, ISDN, data, or phone adapters. The optiset E basic telephones do not support
headsets.
The optiset E entry and optiset E standard telephones do not support adapters.
The optiset E telephone adapters are plug-in
modules that enhance system performance
and versatility with additional applications such
as PC and fax connections.
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-28 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
optiset E phone adapter
The optiset E phone adapter provides for the connection of an additional system tele-
phone that callers can reach under a separate, programmable station number. All op-
tiset E telephones can be connected. The phone adapter can be used in a configura-
tion with primary and secondary telephones.
Note: When you use the optiset E phone adapter, take into account the capacity lim-
its of the system, and make sure that cables can be connected between the primary
and secondary telephone (if the second telephone is not in the same room).
optiset E contact adapter (not for U.S.)
The optiset E contact adapter has two floating connections (maximum 60 V/5 watts).
These contacts control external devices, such as lamps or secondary bells.
Port 1 signals the following telephone states that are displayed collectively on an ex-
ternal busy lamp. It is not possible to provide a separate lamp for each state:
Handset is taken off hook
Line key is activated
Loudspeaker is switched on
Headset is active.
Port 2 signals an incoming call and can control a secondary bell.
optiset E headset adapter
The optiset E headset adapter provides for the connection of two headsets to the tele-
phone.
optiset E headset plus adapter
The optiset E headset plus adapter provides for the connection of two headsets and
a tape recorder to the telephone.
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-29
Desktop Products
optiset E privacy module
The optiset E privacy module prevents unauthorized users from listening in on phone
conversations. Both parties in a call need to have a privacy device. To connect the
privacy module between the telephone and handset, simply reconnect the line cord.
The optiset E privacy module comes with the plug-type AC adapter needed for oper-
ation.
optiset E control adapter
The optiset E control adapter offers the same functionality as the optiset E data
adapter but does not support data transfer. This adapter also supports one headset
and the optiClient Attendant functionality.
optiPoint IPadapter
see Section 6.8.3, optiPoint IPadapter (supported up to and including V1.2)
optiLog 4me
optiLog 4me is a digital, single-channel speech recording device designed for opera-
tion with the HiPath 3000. Its design matches that of the optiset E telephone and it
can record up to 2900 hours of telephone calls.
Observe the embargo regulations (import/export restrictions) that apply to the op-
tiset E privacy module!
Figure 6-7 optiLog 4me
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-30 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
You can set the optiLog 4me to the following modes in both digital and analog tele-
phones:
Start Recorder
Recording begins when you press the Start key.
Trader Recorder
Records and stores all calls.
Malicious Call Recorder
Stores calls in their entirety when you press any button during the call.
Third Party Monitoring (not currently available with HiPath 3000)
optiLog 4me should be installed at the central station of the system. Recording
starts when you press the Monitor key on the telephone.
Furthermore, you can use the recorder to record conference calls using an external
microphone.
The optiLog 4me can be connected between the optiset E telephone and the hand-
set. It can also be connected to the recorder output on the optiset E headset plus
adapter or on the optiset E data adapter. The optiset E local power supply is included
in the delivery.
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-31
Desktop Products
6.4.6 Restrictions for Using optiset E Adapters
The table below shows the adapters (maximum of two) that can be used simulta-
neously in an optiset E advance plus/comfort, optiset E advance conference/confer-
ence, and optiset E memory telephones.
Table 6-7 Available optiset E adapter configurations
optiset E
acoustic
adapter
analog
adadapter1
contact
adapter
control
adapter1
data
adapter
headset
adapter
headset plus
adapter
ISDN
adapter1
phone
adapter1
acoustic adapter
(not for U.S.)
XXXXXXXX
analog adadapter1
1 used in primary telephone
X X ––XX––
contact adapter
(not for U.S.)
XX XXXXXX
control adapter1XX––X––
data adapter XXXX––
headset adapter XXXXXX
headset plus adapter XXXXXX
ISDN adapter1XX––XX
phone adapter1XX––XX
Adapters provide flexible and easy enhancements to the telephone.
optiset E
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-32 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Adapter Implementation in Primary and/or Secondary Telephone
Number of adapters and add-on devices allowed by the system
see Table 8-1
Table 6-8 Adapter Implementation in Primary and/or Secondary Telephone
optiset E Primary Secondary Station Number
phone adapter Yes No from secondary
analog adapter Yes No from secondary
ISDN adapter Yes No from secondary
or set MSN
acoustic adapter (not for U.S.) Ye s Ye s
data adapter Yes Yes
control adapter Yes No
headset adapter Yes Yes
headset plus adapter Yes Yes
contact adapter (not for U.S.) Ye s Ye s
optiset
E
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-33
Desktop Products
6.4.7 Electronic Notebook
The Electronic Notebook (ENB) allows the users of an optiset E memory telephone
to store data, such as names, telephone numbers, company names, and fax num-
bers, and display them on the first five lines of the telephone display.
Customers can add, edit, delete, and search for the stored data.
They can also store frequently used system features in the ENB. Customers who
have programmed all function keys but want to add more system features, such as
mute, call forwarding, or telephone lock, can add these features to the ENB.
Figure 6-8 Display of an ENB Entry (Example)
Parker Peter
00498972246730
Siemens AG, IC S BC 69
Fax:00498972212358
........................
08:29 FR 16.APR 01
Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-34 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.5 Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions
The certified products that can be delivered are listed in the Sales information.
Table 6-9 Accessories for optiset E Telephone Solutions
Headset Headsets to 121 TR 9-5 (Siemens type):
Encore
Encore binaural
Tr i s t a r
Supra
Profile
Profile binaural
Recorder One RJ11 jack for 600-ohm recorders. The following prod-
ucts have been tested successfully:
Atis CG 302 document recorder, IR 30 and IR 30E dig-
ital recorders
Grundig DT 3400 recording and playback station
Secondary bell Connects to contact adapter at 24 V-60 V (max. 5 W) or via
a relay at higher power values.
External optical call
signaling with lamp
Connects to contact adapter at 24 V-60 V (max. 5 W) or via
a relay at higher power values.
Desk microphone The desk microphone replaces the speakerphone integrat-
ed into the telephone and provides optimum support for
speakerphone mode.
It also allows you to move about freely when making phone
calls.
External speaker You can improve the sound quality in speakerphone mode
by replacing the speaker integrated into the telephone with
this external speaker. The speaker can be set up by itself
or mounted on the wall. Use the slider on the external
speaker to set the basic volume, then adjust the call volume
on the telephone itself.
Second handset An additional earpiece can help avoid disturbances caused
by background noise or enable another person to listen in
on the conversation.
Wall brackets For mounting the optiset E entry, basic, standard, advance
plus/comfort, and advance conference/conference tele-
phones on the wall.
Plastic cover For covering empty adapter slots.
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-35
Desktop Products
6.6 Telephones for HiPath cordless
6.6.1 Gigaset 2000C Feature Handset
The Gigaset 2000C feature handset has elements that allow the user to easily set up
and release voice connections as well as initialize and invoke procedures and en-
hanced features.
There is also a Tango version (country variant for certain Latin American countries
that use a different frequency range) of the Gigaset 2000C.
Main Features
12-button alphanumeric keypad (0-9,*,#)
3 function keys:
1 menu key for menu selection
2 dual-mode keys for up to four soft key functions
Seizure key (on-hook)
Release key (off-hook)
Hookswitch (register recall)
On/Off/Protect key
Figure 6-9 Feature Handset Gigaset 2000C
Telephones for HiPath cordless
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-36 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Illuminated graphical display (up to 4 lines and 16 columns)
Enhanced user prompting with on-screen messages (multilingual)
Handset phone book for around 100 entries. Redial of the last five numbers.
Connection for a headset (Gigaset 2000H)
A Tango version of the Gigaset 2000C feature handset is also available.
Technical Specifications
Power supply by two battery cells:
NiCd (600 mAh is supplied): Talk time up to 7 hours, standby time up to 70
hours
NiMH (1100 mAh): Talk time up to 11 hours, standby time up to 110 hours
NiMH (1300 mAh): Talk time up to 13 hours, standby time up to 130 hours
Weight, including battery: around 165 g
Dimensions: 160 x 55 x 25 mm (L x W x D)
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-37
Desktop Products
6.6.2 Gigaset 2000C pocket Feature Handset
The Gigaset 2000C pocket feature handset has elements that allow the user to easily
set up and release voice connections as well as initialize and invoke procedures and
enhanced features.
A Tango version of the Gigaset 2000C pocket feature handset is not available.
Main Features
12-button alphanumeric keypad (0-9,*,#)
3 function keys:
1 menu key for menu selection
2 dual-mode keys for up to four soft key functions
Seizure key (on-hook)
Release key (off-hook)
Hookswitch (register recall)
On/Off/Protect key
Illuminated graphical display (up to 4 lines and 16 columns)
Figure 6-10 Feature Handset Gigaset 2000C pocket
Telephones for HiPath cordless
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-38 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Differences over the Gigaset 2000C feature handset:
External antenna
S 10-like illuminated keypad
No headset interface
Technical Specifications
Power supply by means of NiMH flat cells (880 mAh): Talk time up to 9 hours,
standby time up to 90 hours
Weight including battery: around 125 g
Dimensions: 137 x 43 x 20 mm (L x W x D)
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-39
Desktop Products
6.6.3 Gigaset active Robust Handset
The Gigaset active robust handset was specifically designed for use in heavy duty in-
dustrial surroundings. A special explosion-proof model is available for work areas
where explosions may occur. A Tango version is not available.
Main Features
The Gigaset active has the same controls, indicators, and features as the Gigaset
2000C.
Vibration- and crack-resistant, dustproof housing
Key shape has been modified so that even users who wear protective gloves can
easily operate them.
Spray-resistant according to EN 60529 Cl .IP 64
Connection for a headset
Call acoustics adapted to industrial environment (including increased volume)
EX version meets explosion protection standards according to EN 50014/ 50020
with classification (EEx ib IICT4)
Figure 6-11 Robust Handset Gigaset active
Telephones for HiPath cordless
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-40 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Technical Specifications
Power supply by two battery cells:
NiCd (600 mAh is supplied): Talk time up to 7 hours, standby time up to 70
hours
NiMH (1100 mAh): Talk time up to 11 hours, standby time up to 110 hours
NiMH (1300 mAh): Talk time up to 13 hours, standby time up to 130 hours
Weight including battery: around 160 g
Dimensions: 160 x 55 x 25 mm (L x W x D)
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-41
Desktop Products
6.6.4 Gigaset 3000 Comfort Feature Handset
The Gigaset 3000 Comfort feature handset has elements that allow the user to easily
set up and release voice connections as well as initialize and invoke procedures and
enhanced features.
A Tango version of the Gigaset 3000 Comfort feature handset is not available.
Main Features
12-button alphanumeric keypad (0-9,*,#)
3 function keys:
1 menu key for menu selection
2 dual-mode keys for up to four soft key functions
Seizure key (on-hook)
Release key (off-hook)
Hookswitch (register recall)
Speakerphone
Illuminated graphical display (up to 4 lines and 16 columns)
Enhanced user prompting with on-screen messages (multilingual)
Handset phone book for around 100 entries. Redial of the last five numbers.
Figure 6-12 Feature Handset Gigaset 3000 Comfort
Telephones for HiPath cordless
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-42 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Technical Specifications
Power supply by two battery cells:
NiCd (700 mAh is supplied): Talk time up to 10 hours, standby time up to 100
hours
NiMH (1100 mAh): Talk time up to 15 hours, standby time up to 160 hours
NiMH (1500 mAh): Talk time up to 20 hours, standby time up to 220 hours
Weight, including battery: around 165 g
Dimensions: 60 x 50 x 28 mm (L x W x D)
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-43
Desktop Products
6.6.5 Gigaset 3000 Micro Feature Handset
The Gigaset 3000 Mikro feature handset has elements that allow the user to easily
set up and release voice connections as well as initialize and invoke procedures and
enhanced features.
Main Features
12-button alphanumeric keypad (0-9,*,#)
3 function keys:
1 menu key for menu selection
2 dual-mode keys for up to 4 soft key functions
Seizure key (on-hook)
Release key (off-hook)
Hookswitch (register recall)
Illuminated graphic display (up to 4 lines and 16 columns)
Enhanced user prompting with on-screen messages (multilingual)
Handset phone book for approximately 100 entries. Redial of last five numbers.
Figure 6-13 Feature Handset Gigaset 3000 Micro
Telephones for HiPath cordless
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-44 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Technical Specifications
Weight, including battery: Approx. 98 g
Dimensions: Approx. 122 x 43 x 18 mm (L x W x H)
6.6.6 Gigaset 2000L Charger
Charging option for Gigaset 2000C and Gigaset active handsets.
6.6.7 Gigaset 2000L pocket Charger
Charging option for the Gigaset 2000C pocket handset.
Warning
The Gigaset 2000L charging unit must not be implemented in environments where
there is a risk of explosion.
Main Features
Easy wall or desktop mounting
Charging option for 2 spare battery cells in battery
charging compartment
Visual display indicating the charging status of hand-
sets and spare battery cells
Charging times:
For NiCd cells (600m Ah): 4 to 5 hours (in the
handset), 24 hours (in the battery compartment)
For NiMH cells (1100/1300 mAh): 8 to 10 hours (in
the handset), approximately 40 hours (in the bat-
tery compartment)
Main Features
Easy wall or desktop mounting
Visual display indicating the charging status of the
handset
No charging option for spare battery packs
Comes with 220V local power supply
Approximately 7 hours charging time for NiMH batter-
ies in handsets
Telephones for HiPath cordles
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-45
Desktop Products
6.6.8 Gigaset 3000L Charger
Charging option for the Gigaset 3000C handset.
6.6.9 Gigaset 3000L Micro Charger
Charging option for the Gigaset 3000 Micro handset.
Main Features
Easy wall or desktop mounting
Visual display indicating the charging status
Charging times:
For NiCd cells (600m Ah): 4 to 5 hours (in the
handset)
For NiMH cells (1100/1300 mAh): 8 to 10 hours
(in the handset)
Main Features
Visual display indicating the charging status
Approximately 5 hours charging time for NiMH-Power
Pack (600 mAh) in handsets
Attendant Consoles
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-46 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.7 Attendant Consoles
6.7.1 HiPath Attendant B Braille Console
Definition
The HiPath 3750, HiPath 3550, HiPath 3700 and HiPath 3500 systems include a con-
venient, user-friendly braille console as an attendant position for visually impaired at-
tendants.
optiClient Attendant (PC attendant console) is required to operate the HiPath Atten-
dant B braille console.
The braille output line (40 characters) of the braille console displays the current opti-
Client Attendant status information. The keys on the braille console provide access
to nearly all optiClient Attendant functions, enabling visually impaired users to per-
form most of the same switching tasks as their non-visually impaired colleagues.
At power-on, the console starts in auto-information mode, providing the user with in-
structions on the main functions for orientation purposes. For further instructions, the
attendant can activate an information mode that provides extensive operating infor-
mation on the braille output line.
The braille console automatically uses the language set in optiClient Attendant and
currently supports German and English. Other languages are under preparation.
Figure 6-14 Connecting a Braille Console to optiClient Attendant
optiClient Attendant
Braille Console
HiPath Attendant B
Attendant Console
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-47
Desktop Products
Model-Specific Data
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
Hardware require-
ments
Braille console –––
Software require-
ments
V1.0 or later ––
Number of connect-
able braille consoles
11–––
The HiPath Attendant B braille console can be ordered directly from:
Winkler Kommunikationstechnik
Ahornstrasse 12
26180 Rastede/Ipwege
Germany
Tel.: ++49-89-4402-929292
Fax: ++49-89-4402-929294
Ordering designation: BT-H150 Office-PCVF-001-A
Delivery time is roughly six weeks after receipt of order.
Attendant Consoles
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-48 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
6.7.2 optiClient Attendant
Definition
optiClient Attendant
provides a user-friendly and representative PC attendant con-
sole (PC-VPL) for the communications system family HiPath 3000. Consequently,
various applications such as Attendant, CDR and Electronic Telephone Directory, for
example, are available on a shared PC.
Popup menus with the features that are relevant to the individual state are displayed
on the PC monitor. Furthermore, you can call up attendant console features using
softkeys and the user interface can be adapted to suit the needs of the individual user.
Additional support is also available using the extensive help functions.
The electronic telephone directory helps the operator set up calls quickly and also
handle incoming ISDN calls by displaying the name of the caller (the numbers are
stored in the electronic telephone directory).
Main Features
Visual display of the AC operators tasks
Multitasking with other Windows applications
Ability to display station names or numbers on the busy lamp field
Busy indication for ISDN stations on the S0 bus
Busy indication for internal and external calls
MULAP feature (possible with optiClient Attendant Release 3.26 and later)
Electronic directory
Additional functions for optiClient Attendant, Version 5.0 and later
Expanded busy lamp field
Quick search with function key F12
Connection of an optiPoint 500 telephone over the USB interface
Connection as IP client
Attendant Console
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-49
Desktop Products
New features with HiPath 3000 V1.2 and later:
Identification of recall from Call Parking
In case of a recall due to a parked call, in addition to the call information, the po-
sition of the parked call is also displayed in the list box for waiting calls. After the
recall is accepted, the parking position appears for a short time in the system sta-
tus line.
Connection of a parked call or an external held call to the party of an
attendant PC
After the attendant PC has announced the call, an external held call or a parked
call can be connected to the internal or external party of the attendant PC.
Caller ID for intercept and recall (in call state)
Caller ID from the connected or virtual optiset E telephones appears in the sys-
tem status line of the attendant PC.
Additional displays for call forwarding (in ringing state)
In case of an outgoing call to a forwarded station, the status of the desired station
appears in the system status line. If a call is forwarded to an attendant PC, the
status of the attendant PC appears in the system status line.
Model-Specific Data
In addition, internal calls (e. g. from the auto attendant/voicemail systems) to the
PC-AC can be assigned the same call priority as external calls. This can be per-
formed by introducing a new flag at each port. If the flag is set
internal calls have the same priority as external calls and
the calling party immediately hears the ring tone rather than the busy tone (see
also Section 3.2.3, Call Waiting Tone/Call Waiting on page 3-46).
Subject HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
Feature available in xx––
Hardware require-
ments
see
System Require-
ments on page 6-50
–––
Software require-
ments
V1.0 or later ––
No. of optiClient Atten-
dants
66–––
Attendant Consoles
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-50 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
System Requirements
PC for optiClient Attendant (for U.S. only: UL Listed)
Without additional applications: Pentium 133 MHz with 16 MB RAM
With call detail applications or other applications: Pentium III 300 MHz with
32 MB RAM
64 MB RAM
Minimum screen resolution of 1024 x 768 pixels
Sound card with loudspeakers for signaling incoming calls
Microsoft-compatible mouse
CD-ROM drive or DVD drive
HiPath 3000
Operating system Windows®95, Windows®98, Windows®ME, Windows®NT,
Windows®2000 or Windows®XP
The operating system used depends on the type of installation (e. g. USB not
possible with Windows®95).
Other Requirements for Installation with
optiClient 130 V2.0
an operational installation of optiClient 130 V2.0 software
USB
optiPoint 500 basic, optiPoint 500 standard or optiPoint 500 advance
an operational USB connection, i.e.: a USB cable connected to a PC USB
port with a virtual COM port driver installed
optiset E control/data adapter
a free V.24-(RS-232) interface (COM port 1 4)
UP0/E PCI card
3.5disk drive
a free long PCI slot for UP0/E PCI card
For U.S. only: optiClient Attendant consists of three parts:
UP0/E PC card (Siemens Part Number S30807-Q5474-X100)
Handset (Siemens Part Number C39363-A7007-B10-3-ZSYS)
Handset cradle (Siemens Part Number C39363-A7007-A4)
WARNING (for U.S. Only)
optiClient Attendant is a UL Listed I.T.E. Accessory (2Z02) for use only in UL Listed
computers.
Attendant Console
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-51
Desktop Products
6.7.3 optiPoint Attendant
Definition
Switching services can be performed in HiPath 3000 using a specially configured
telephone. This optiPoint Attendant (AC) also serves as an intercept position at the
same time. At the AC all calls accumulate if there is no direct inward dialing option, or
if a station could not be contacted using the call allocation algorithm in Call Manage-
ment (intercept). The operator then forwards the incoming calls to the relevant sta-
tions.
The system telephones optiset E standard, optiset E advance plus/comfort, optiset E
advance conference/conference, optiset E memory, optiPoint 500 basic, optiPoint 500
standard and optiPoint 500 advance can be configured as a optiPoint Attendant sys-
tem.
The function keys of the system telephone used for optiPoint Attendant are preset as
follows and can be changed by the service technician if necessary:
Night answer (switches night answer on/off)
Telephone directory (opens the internal telephone directory)
Held calls (provides information on the number of held calls)
Busy override (goes into a busy connection)
Hold (holds a party)
External 1 (first external call, incoming/outgoing)
External 2 (second external call, incoming/outgoing)
Disconnect (disconnect or connect a call)
Depending on the individual customers requirements, optiPoint Attendant can be
equipped with key modules and/or with busy lamp fields (optiPoint BLF). The number
of function keys is increased accordingly (particularly the internal name keys) (see
Ta b l e 6 - 1 0 ) .
For information on the model-dependent data of the optiPoint Attendant, please re-
fer to Section 3.1.12 on page 3-37.
Attendant Consoles
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-52 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
When a total of 2 key modules and 2 optiPoint BLFs are connected up a maximum of
212 internal name keys (with internal station number) with busy lamp indicator can be
shown.
Table 6-10 optiPoint Attendant - Total Number of Function Keys after Addition
of Key Modules and BLFs
Total number of keys 16 32 48 64 90 106 122 180 196 212
Number of key modules 12341212
Keys on key modules 16 32 48 64 16 32 16 32
Number of BLFs (opti-
Point BLF)
––––111222
Keys on BLFs (optiPoint
BLF)
––––90 90 90 180 180 180
LAN Telephones/Adapter
s
3000sb6.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 6-53
Desktop Products
6.8 LAN Telephones/Adapters
6.8.1 optiClient 130
(see Section 4.5.1, optiClient 130)
6.8.2 optipoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS
(see Section 4.5.2, optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS)
6.8.3 optiPoint IPadapter (supported up to and including V1.2)
This adapter, which is accommodated in a housing the same as the PNT, allows the
connection of optiPoint 500 and optiset E telephones over the LAN. The power supply
is provided by an local power supply.
The adapter has the following 2 MW (RJ) jacks
1 UP0/E connection for the optiPoint 500 or optiset E telephone (including. power
supply unit)
1 LAN connection - standard cable length is 5 m (max. 100 m possible)
Before the adapter is put into operation it must be set for the relevant mode by means
of the appropriate administration tasks.
These administration tasks can be carried out using the optiPoint 500 or optiset E
telephone that is connected to the adapter (basic settings only) and over the LAN us-
ing a PC (HTTP client, in which case all settings can be executed).
Figure 6-16 illustrates the main connections for the optiPoint IPadapter.
Figure 6-15 Jacks for optiPoint IPadapter
LAN Telephones/Adapters
Desktop Products
G281-0788-00, April 2002
6-54 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb6.fm
Figure 6-16 Main Connections for the optiPoint IPadapter
optiPoint 500 or optiset E
telephone
optiPoint IPadapter
RJ11
RJ45
digital
jack
MW jack
0
ABCDEF
MNOGHI
PQRSTUV
←→
↑↓
123
456
789
0
ABCDEF
MNOJKLGHI
PQRSTUVWXYZ
HiPath 3000
HiPath HG1500-
board
LAN
optiset E local power supply
3000sb7.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 7-1
Plus Products and Applications
7 Plus Products and Applications
The functionality of the HiPath 3000 systems can be enhanced by adding Plus prod-
ucts and applications. These Plus products include automatic call distribution (ACD),
hotel applications, voice messaging services, call charge computing, video confer-
encing and mobile communication.
Communication between HiPath 3000 and the applications running on host comput-
ers (Plus Products) is facilitated by:
the V.24 (RS-232) application programming interface (CSTA protocol,
19200 baud)
Customers must use a converter to support Plus Products that use ACL-H2.
The converter converts all messages and message procedures based on the
ACL-H2 protocol to the CSTA protocol and vice versa. The converter has
been implemented as a driver that runs under Microsoft Windows 95/98.
Plus Products that support the CSTA protocol standardized by ECMA can be
connected directly (for example, Hicom Agentline Office V1.1 CSTA).
An S0 interface configured as a station (ISDN/USBS)
An ISDN adapter (TA S0) (ISDN/USBS)
the LAN interface (Ethernet)
For more information on this subject, refer to Chapter 4.
the PSTN interface.
For more information on this subject, refer to Chapter 4.
HiPath 3000 supports CSTA Phase II and CSTA Phase III.
The connected application determines whether CSTA Phase II or Phase III will be
used for connection setup.
For additional information, please refer to Section 3.17 on page 3-423.
Plus Products and Applications
G281-0788-00, April 2002
7-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb7.fm
List of certified Plus products and applications (date: 12.13.01)
The current list of the certified Plus products and applications is available on the in-
tranet (keyword is system connections):
http://netinfo4.wit.siemens.de/wnbs_home/se/organisation/team/se5/organisation/
appl/appl_d.htm#Applikationen/Produkte
Details on specific products and applications are available in the relevant data sheets
and product documentation.
In Table 7-1 the functioning of the Plus products/applications is confirmed on the
systems marked with Ye s .
For information on which Plus product and which application is available in which
country, please contact the relevant office.
Before entering into any sales commitments, you should have the availability
and sales release for a product confirmed by the division in your region.
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
Voice Mail Systems
Memo for Hicom Rel. 3.00 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Infovoice Rel. 4.0 Yes Yes Yes
PhoneMail S  Yes Yes Yes
Hotel Voice Mail System
(CHCS)
 Yes Yes Yes
Hotel Voice Mail System
(CHCS)
 Yes Yes ––
Memo CDA for Hicom Rel. 3.00 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Hicom Office PhoneMail
Entry
 Yes Yes
Hicom Office PhoneMail
Entry
 Yes Yes
Hicom Office PhoneMail  Yes Yes Yes
Hicom Office PhoneMail  Yes Yes Yes
CAS 500  Yes Yes ––
Call Xpress  Yes –––
Teleserver Memo Pro  Yes Yes Yes
Smartphone  Yes Yes Yes Yes
D2000  Yes Yes Yes Yes
D3000  Yes Yes Yes Yes
3000sb7.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 7-3
Plus Products and Applications
D5000  YesYesYesYes
Infobox  Yes Yes ––
Mini-Mail  YesYesYesYes
Memophone/Memo-
phone twin
 Yes Yes Yes
Call charge computer
TeleData D/J  Yes Yes Yes
WinAccount  Yes Yes ––
WinAccount  Yes Yes Yes
Cosima TC for DOS  YesYesYesYes
Cosima TC for Windows  YesYesYesYes
TeleData Pro  Yes Yes Yes
TeleData Pro A  Yes Yes ––
TeleData Office  YesYesYesYes
TeleData Office A  Yes Yes ––
MS16/32, S16 not used Yes Yes Yes Yes
Tabs Windows  YesYesYesYes
TeleData Office IP  Yes Yes Yes
TeleData Office S  YesYesYesYes
Hotel connections
Tabs (ACL)  Yes –––
Fidelio (direct connec-
tion)
not used Yes Yes ––
Caracas Inn  Yes Yes ––
Caracas Inn  Yes Yes ––
Caracas Inn  Yes Yes ––
Caracas Link  Yes Yes ––
Caracas Link  Yes Yes Yes
Caracas Desk  Yes Yes
Caracas Desk  Yes Yes Yes
Hospital connections
Himed for Windows  Yes Yes ––
Nursing home connections
Residenz  Yes Yes ––
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
Plus Products and Applications
G281-0788-00, April 2002
7-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb7.fm
ACD systems
Taskline 200  Yes Yes ––
Taskline 200  Yes Yes ––
Agentline 200  Yes –––
Agentline Office  Yes Yes ––
Agentline Office  Yes Yes ––
Office Look  Yes Yes Yes
Office Look  Yes Yes Yes
HiPath ProCenter Office  Yes Yes ––
Web Interaction Center
Office
 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Fax connections
Fax 550  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Fax 690  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Fax 790  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Robofax  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Robofax AVI  Yes Yes Yes Yes
ixiServer  Yes Yes Yes
David (DIIE)  Yes Yes ––
Modems/DCIs
DCI 740  Yes Yes Yes
Pico-TI 14.4 Modem  Yes Yes Yes Yes
ELSA Microlink 56k Basic  Yes Yes Yes Yes
3Com U.S. Robotics  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Announcement devices
Musiphone 2000 MS  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Musiphone Multimax  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Musiphone Midimax M/S  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Musiphone Midimax vA  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Mozart MC  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Mozart MC  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Mozart CD  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Sissy 200/400  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
3000sb7.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 7-5
Plus Products and Applications
Genius  YesYesYesYes
Genius ST  Yes –––
Super Genius  Yes ––
Music and announce-
ment module
 –––Yes
Universal module Hicom
150E
 Yes Yes
Ratiotel  YesYesYesYes
SLA  YesYesYesYes
VOICE  YesYesYesYes
proMOH  YesYesYesYes
XMU  YesYesYesYes
MOO –––Yes
MPPI Yes Yes
Musiphone Pro/
Pro@LAN
 Yes Yes ––
Musiphone 500 CC  YesYesYesYes
Cordless connections
Cordless 150E  Yes ––
Cordless S (Gigaset
1054i)
  Yes Yes Yes
Comsat radio converter  Yes Yes Yes
Ecotel GSM900  Yes Yes Yes
Ecotel ISDN/ISDNtwin  Yes Yes Yes
Gigaset 3000 Comfort  Yes Yes ––
Sinus 45 K  Yes Yes ––
Gigaset 3000 Micro  Yes Yes ––
SpectraLink 150 WTS  Yes ––
Time recording systems
Phone Control System
(V24)
! Yes ––
Phone Control System
(ACL)
! Yes ––
Video telephones
PCTL 4000  Yes Yes Yes
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
Plus Products and Applications
G281-0788-00, April 2002
7-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb7.fm
Videokit (PCS 100)  Yes Yes Yes
Videokit Basic (PCS 50)  Yes Yes Yes
Videoset Standard (Ven-
ue 2000)
 Yes Yes Yes
Teles Vision B/P  Yes –––
I-View  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Live 200  Yes –––
Hicom Xpress@LAN  Yes Yes Yes
HiPath HG 1500  Yes Yes Yes
HiPath HG 1500  Yes Yes Yes
CSA 120 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Radar B "Yes Yes Yes
Radar B  #$Yes Yes Yes
Radio paging equipment
Profi 200  Yes –––
ANT D6500  Yes –––
Ascom Tateco  Yes –––
Multitone Access 3000  Yes –––
Adaptors
TFE Adapter  Yes Yes Yes Yes
NovaTec Adapter  Yes Yes Yes
Telrad V24 Adapter  Yes Yes Yes
Telrad X31 Adapter  Yes Yes
Elmeg ISDN-Adapter  Yes –––
EX PBX Adapter  Yes Yes Yes Yes
TFE4  Yes Yes Yes Yes
CTI systems
Smartset  Yes Yes Yes
Smartset % Yes Yes Yes Yes
Smartset 2000  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Attendant P Office  Yes Yes ––
Hicom Attendant P  Yes Yes ––
ComDial (CD16)  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
3000sb7.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 7-7
Plus Products and Applications
ComDial (CD32)  YesYesYesYes
Hicom CTI TAPI 3P V1  Yes Yes ––
Hicom CTI TAPI 3P V2  Yes Yes ––
Hicom CTI TAPI 3P V2  Yes Yes Yes
HiPath TAPI 170  Yes Yes Yes
OrgAnice  YesYesYesYes
Act  Yes ––
Hicom CTI TAPI  YesYesYesYes
Hicom CTI TAPI  YesYesYesYes
Adress Plus  Yes –––
WinPhone  Yes –––
Office Edition Advanced  Yes Yes ––
XPhone  Yes ––
Exchange Telephone
Manager
 Yes Yes ––
TeleButler  Yes Yes Yes
CapiButler  YesYesYesYes
AnNo Text EuroStar  YesYesYesYes
Snapware  Yes Yes ––
Theseus  YesYesYesYes
Personal Call Manager
(PCM)
 Yes Yes Yes
PC cards
AVM S0 PC card A1/B1  YesYesYesYes
ITK S0 PC card  YesYesYesYes
Tina S0 PC card  Yes –––
Teles S0 PC card  YesYesYesYes
Diehl PC card  YesYesYesYes
Diehl PCMCIA card  YesYesYesYes
Datev S0 PC card  YesYesYesYes
I-Talk YesYesYesYes
I-Talk  YesYesYesYes
I-Surf  Yes ––
I-Surf  YesYesYesYes
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
Plus Products and Applications
G281-0788-00, April 2002
7-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb7.fm
I-Surf USB  Yes Yes Yes Yes
I-Surf USB  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Network connections
Datus 20S  Yes Yes Yes
RAD Kilomux 2000  Yes Yes Yes
Simux 3612  Yes Yes Yes
RAD Kilomux 2100  Yes Yes ––
Miscellaneous
Private Network Termina-
tor E
 Yes Yes Yes Yes
PCopti Converter  Yes Yes Yes Yes
PCopti E Converter  Yes Yes Yes Yes
GD Cash Card System  Yes Yes Yes Yes
TelePassport ! Yes Yes Yes
Braille terminal for Op-
tiset
 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Siedle entrance tele-
phone
&%'( Yes Yes Yes Yes
TopSec 702/703  Yes Yes ––
Patton Modell 2035  Yes Yes
Euroset 2010  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Euroset 2015  Yes Yes Yes Yes
CN Netcom Headset  Yes ––
Smartset BLF  Yes Yes Yes
EPOS 710/812/Dect70  Yes Yes Yes Yes
phoneboard for Hicom  ) Yes Yes ––
DoorCom Analog  Yes Yes Yes Yes
Table 7-1 List of Certified Plus Products and Applications for HiPath 3000
Plus Product/Application HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
Name Version
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-1
Capacities
8 Capacities
Table 8-1 on page 8-1 = feature capacities
Table 8-2 on page 8-13 = hardware capacities
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Agents
Agent IDs in system - - - 150 150
Agents active simultaneous-
ly in system
- - - 150 150
Agents active simultaneous-
ly on a telephone
---11
Total agents in system - - - Unlimited
Toll restriction:
Number of allowed lists 6 6 6 6 6
Number of denied lists 6 6 6 6 6
Allowed list, short (10 en-
tries with 25 digits each)
55555
Allowed list, long (100 en-
tries with 25 digits each)
11111
Denied list, short (10 entries
with 25 digits each)
55555
Denied list, long (50 entries
with 25 digits each)
11111
Trunks:
Total trunks (B channels) in
system
1 4 16 60 120
Max. number of loop start
(analog) trunks (dep. on
configuration)
- - 16 60 120
Maximum number of S0 in-
terfaces
1283060
Maximum number of S2M
boards
---14
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
Number of tie line analog
trunk boards (4 E&M lines
per board)
----18
Call waiting:
Number of external waiting
calls per station
16 16 16 16 16
Number of internal waiting
calls per station
16 16 16 16 16
Caller list:
Number of entries in a list 10 10 10 10 10
Total lists in system 100 100 100 100 650
Number of lists per tele-
phone with display or sub-
scriber group
11111
Number of digits per entry 25-digit station number + trunk group code
Call pickup groups:
Number of telephones per
group
8883232
Total groups per system 8 8 8 32 32
Call forwarding:
All calls: Active simulta-
neously
20 20 20 50 150
External: Number of CFW
keys per telephone
11111
External: Number of digits 25-digit station number + trunk group code
Announcement before answering:
Number of callers for whom an
announcement can be played si-
multaneously
32 32 32 32 32
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-3
Capacities
Announcement devices:
Number of stations at which
the announcement can be
played simultaneously
32 32 32 32 32
Total devices in system 1 1 1 4 16
optiClient Attendant:
Number of Hold keys per op-
tiClient Attendant
---44
Total per group - - - 6 6
Total per SLU8, SLMO8,
SLMO24 board
---66
Groups in the system - - - 6 6
Overflow: Number of calls in
the queue
---3030
Battery (lithium):
Service life of the real-time clock 10 years
Classes of service:
Total classes in system 15 15 15 15 15
Matrix size - day and night -
number of trunks
30 30 30 30 30
Allowed and denied lists 15 15 15 15 15
Executive/secretary system:
Number of executives or
secretaries per configura-
tion
22222
Configurations in the system 4 4 4 10 16
Telephone lock:
Number of digits in a PIN 5 5 5 5 5
CSTA:
Number of applications that
can be connected per sys-
tem (server)
---44
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
Number of simultaneous
tasks
---1650
Number of TDS codes - - - 10 10
DSS:
Total key modules in system 30 30 30 100 100
Number of key modules per
cabinet
----50
Number of key modules per
telephone
44444
Number of key modules per
SLMO24 board
---9696
Number of keys on a key
module
16 16 16 16 16
Destinations in the system Unlimited
Total keys per system Unlimited
DID numbers:
Length in digits 11 11 11 11 11
Remote administration:
Number of callback destina-
tions
66666
Length of PIN 5 5 5 5 5
Call detail recording:
Number of entries in the buffer 50 50 50 150 300
Call keys:
Number of keys per optiset E
telephone (memory, advance)
10 10 10 10 10
Group call:
Group call: Number of groups 20 20 20 150 150
Hotline/hotline after a timeout (code blue):
Number of destinations 1 1 1 6 6
Conference:
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-5
Capacities
Number of participants per
conference
55555
Total conferences in system 3 3 3 6 6
Maximum number of trunks
in a conference
44444
Station speed dialing (ISD):
Total entries in system 300 300 300 2000 2000
Number of entries per tele-
phone
10 10 10 10 10
Number of digits per entry 25-digit station number + trunk group code
System speed dialing (SSD):
Total entries in system 300 300 1000 1000 1000
Number of digits per entry 25-digit station number + trunk group code
Length of names 16 16 16 16 16
LCR:
Number of digits dialed 32 32 32 32 32
Number of digits checked 25-digit station number + trunk group code
No. of dial plans (each with
max. 10 fields)
514 514 514 514 514
No. of outdial rules per trunk
group
254 254 254 254 254
Number of routes in a path
table
16 16 16 16 16
Number of path tables. 254 254 254 254 254
Number of time zones per
day
88888
Number of digits per outdial
rule
40 40 40 40 40
Trunk queuing (not S0):
Number of simultaneous entries 4 4 4 32 32
Multiple subscriber numbers:
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
Number of digits 5 6 6 6 6
DTMF DID:
Number of simultaneous DID ac-
tions
33336
MUSAP keys:
Total keys per telephone 10 10 10 10 10
Messages:
Total advisory messages in
system
10 10 10 10 10
Number of messages re-
ceived on an optiPoint 500
or optiset E telephone with
display
5+1 5+1 5+1 5+1 5+1
Number of messages re-
ceived on an optiPoint 500
or optiset E telephone with-
out a display
1+1 1+1 1+1 1+1 1+1
Total text messages in sys-
tem
10 10 10 10 10
Text messages: Total mes-
sages sent in system
15 15 15 50 50
Length of the text in a cus-
tomer-defined message
24 24 24 24 24
Length of the text generated
by an optiset E memory tele-
phone
24 24 24 24 24
Mailbox: Total messages ac-
tive simultaneously in sys-
tem (text messages and ad-
visory messages)
30 30 30 100 100
Name display:
Internal stations and sub-
scriber groups: Length in let-
ters
16 16 16 16 16
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-7
Capacities
System speed-dialing en-
tries: Length in letters
16 16 16 16 16
Trunk groups: Length in let-
ters
10 10 10 10 10
optiPoint 500 telephones:
Total telephones in system
(primary)
2 4 16 48 384
Total per cabinet (bracketed
value applies to UPSM op-
eration)
----120
(144)
Cable length (0.6 mm [.024
in.] in diameter) in meters
1000m
optiPoint acoustic adapter:
Total in system Unlimited
optiPoint analog adapter:
Total in system 4 4 8 24 125
optiPoint recorder adapter:
Total in system Unlimited
optiPoint ISDN adapter:
Number of S0 telephones
per adapter
22222
Total in system 4 4 8 50 50
Total per cabinet - - - - 50
optiPoint phone adapter:
Total in system 16 16 16 48 250
Total per telephone 1 1 1 1 1
Total per SLMO24 board - - - 24 24
optiPoint key module:
Total in system 32 32 32 100 100
optiPoint BLF:
Total in system - - - 6 12
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
optiset E telephones:
Total telephones in system
(primary)
2 4 16 48 384
Total per cabinet (bracketed
value applies to UPSM op-
eration)
----120
(144)
Cable length (0.6 mm [.024
in.] in diameter) in meters
1000m
optiset E analog adapters:
Total in system 4 4 8 24 125
optiset E control adapters:
Total in system (per optiset E) Unlimited
optiset E data adapters:
Total in system 4 4 8 50 50
optiset E speech adapters:
Total in system Unlimited
optiset E privacy modules:
Total in system Unlimited
optiset E ISDN adapters:
Number of S0 telephones
per adapter
22222
Total in system 4 4 8 50 50
Total per cabinet - - - - 50
optiset E key modules:
Total in system 32 32 32 100 100
Hicom Attendant BLFs:
Total in system - - - 6 12
optiset E phone adapter:
Total in system 16 16 16 48 250
Total per telephone 1 1 1 1 1
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-9
Capacities
Total per SLMO24 board - - - 24 24
Park slots:
Total in system 10 10 10 10 10
Account codes:
Number of verifiable digits Up to 11
Total digits in system 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Relays:
Total in system - - 4 4 4
Trunk groups:
Total in system 4 4 8 16 16
Trunk group overflow:
Total per trunk group 1 1 1 1 1
Callback:
Number of entries per trunk 4 4 4 32 32
Number of entries per sta-
tion
33333
Call forwarding (permanently configured in Call Management):
Number of CFW busy/no
answer operations per tele-
phone
11111
Number of CFW destina-
tions per station
33333
Group ringing:
Number of extensions in call
ringing group
55555
Internal S0 bus:
Number of active calls per
bus
22222
Number of telephones per
bus
88888
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
Hunt groups:
Number of linear hunt
groups
20 20 20 150 150
Number of UCD hunt groups - - - 60 60
Number of circular hunt
groups
20 20 20 150 150
Sensors:--44-
Languages:
Total languages active si-
multaneously in system
44444
Total languages in system 4 4 4 4 4
Stations:
Number of analog stations 4 4 12 84 250
(384)
Number of digital stations
(without phone adapters)
2 4 16 48 250
Number of stations in sys-
tem (primary)
12 12 20 92 250
Subscriber groups:
Length of names 16 16 16 16 16
Stations per group 8 8 8 20 20
Number of groups for group
call, hunt groups, announce-
ment zones
20 20 20 150 150
Station numbers:
Total station numbers in sys-
tem (incl. group numbers)
60 60 60 650 650
Number of station numbers
in system for analog, ISDN,
phone, and data adapters
20 20 20 100 250
Number of station numbers
in system for hunt groups/
group call
20 20 20 150 150
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-11
Capacities
Number of station numbers
in system for extensions
40 40 40 500 500
Length of station numbers 6 6 6 6 6
Length of station numbers
(default setting)
22233
Internal directory:
Number of simultaneous ac-
cesses
55555
Door opener:
Number of attempts to enter
an invalid password before
deactivation
55555
Length of password (in dig-
its)
55555
UCD:
Number of priority levels per
call type
---1010
Number of announcements
per group
---77
Number of groups in system - - - 60 60
Overflow: Number of waiting
calls per group
---33
Queue: Number of calls in a
queue
---7272
Relocation function:
Simultaneous relocation actions
in system
11111
V.24 (RS-232) interfaces: 11222
Networking:
Number of trunk group
codes
- - 10 10 10
Length of a trunk group
code
- - 666
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
Expanded redial:
Number of entries on an opti-
Point 500 or optiset E telephone
with a display
3
Last number redial (LNR):
Number of entries on an op-
tiPoint 500 or optiset E with-
out a display
1
Number of digits stored 25-digit station number + trunk group code
Music on hold::
Number of external connections
on the SLA board
--111
Destination keys:
Total destinations in system 300 300 300 2000 2000
Destination key/station speed dialing:
Number of destinations 300 300 300 2000 2000
Number of digits 25-digit station number + trunk group code
Table 8-1 Expansion Limits and Capacities for HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
PARAMETERS SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
3000sb8.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 8-13
Capacities
Table 8-2 Hardware Capacities HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0
Hardware Capacity Data SYSTEM
HiPath 3150
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3250
(not for U.S.)
HiPath 3350
HiPath 3300
HiPath 3550
HiPath 3500
HiPath 3750
HiPath 3700
Maximum number of cabinets: 11113
Available board slots:
Total slots per cabinet - - 2 7/6 7
Total per expansion cabinet - - - - 8
Clock:
Battery capacity in hours 100
PCM bus:
Number of 32-channel bus-
es (for peripheral boards)
---214
Number of 32-channel bus-
es (for SPX and IMOD)
---12
Tone generators:
Total in system 5 5 5 5 5
Dial tone receivers:
Total in system 1 1 1 2 2
DTMF transmitters:
Total in system 1 1 1 1 2
DTMF receivers:
Total in system 33 3 3 3 6
Max. power input (watts):
One cabinet, fully equipped
with PSU
25 W 25 W 60 W - -
One cabinet, fully equipped
with UPS
- - 90 W 180 W 430 W
Weight (In kgs):
One cabinet, fully equipped 0.7 0.7 6 8 22
Dimensions in mm:
Width 365 365 460/440 460/440 410
Height 293 293 450/88 450/155 490
Depth 67 67 128/380 200/380 390
Capacities
G281-0788-00, April 2002
8-14 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb8.fm
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-1
Introductio
n
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
9 Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
9.1 Introduction
While the HiPath 3000 systems are in operation, CDRC call details for each complet-
ed section of a call or for each incoming call can be sent to a connected device on an
ongoing basis. This device is normally a PC, which evaluates the data received, or a
printer.
Options for Exporting the Data to an External Output Device:
Application programming interface (V.24) (RS-232)
CDRC data is exported to call detail recording applications such as Teledata.
PC attendant console port
Users can also forward the CDRC data to a optiClient Attendant (PC attendant
console port). This transfers the call data to the Charge.dat file, which is created
or updated whenever a new record is entered. You can use software to evaluate
this data.
UP0/E port
An optiset E control adapter, to which you can attach a printer or PC, must be
connected to the UP0/E port. The system supports only one adapter per call data
output.
LAN interface (Ethernet)
CDRC data can be exported to external applications via the LAN interface (Ether-
net) (for more information, refer to Section 4.7, Applications over IP).
Output Formats
The CDRC output can be in two different formats:
Compressed format (via V.24/via LAN) for PC or call charge computer
The system outputs all data (including ACCT) without separating spaces, without
headers, and without form feed. Call charge pulses, call charge amounts or arith-
metic units are output.
Long format for printer
The system outputs all data (except ACCT) separated by spaces, with header (in
the language selected for the system) and form feed. The call charge amount is
output.
For further information, please refer to Section 3.13.8, Call Detail Recording Cen-
tral (CDRC) on page 3-338.
Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
9.2 Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output via Application Programming Interface (V.24) (RS-232)
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 Date (8 characters)
| 2 Time (8)
| | 3 Trunk (3)
| | | 4 Internal station number (6)
| | | | 5 Ring duration (5)
| | | | | 6 Call duration (8)
| | | | | | 7 Station number (25)
| | | | | | | 8 Call charge pulses (11) (blank in U.S.)
| | | | | | | | 9 Information element (2)
| | | | | | | | | 10 ACCT (11)
| | | | | | | | | | 11 MSN (11)
| | | | | | | | | | | 12 Seizure code (5)
| | | | | | | | | | | | 13 LCR route (2)
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
V V V V V V V V V V V V V
11.12.0008:23:23 4 16 00:05:2302317324856 12 2 902725 841 (1)
11.12.0009:12:45 3 18 00:01:23834756 34 212345678901 2 (2)
11.12.0009:25:34 2 1100:34 1 (3)
11.12.0010:01:46 1 12 00:12:5383726639046287127384 5 2
11.12.0010:03:42 2 14 05:42:4338449434444495598376 245 2
11.12.0010:23:24 2 15 00:02:221234567890123412???? 83 2 (4)
11.12.0011:12:45 3 18 00:01:23834756 34 2
12.12.0012:23:34 3 1200:1500:03:12 1 (5)
12.12.0012:23:50 4 11 00:03:583844733399 7 2
12.12.0013:23:54 3 17 00:02:233844733399 8 5 (6)
12.12.0014:05:24 3 18 00:01:23834756 31 2
12.12.0014:38:43 2 12 00:03:242374844 63 2 (7a)
12.12.0014:43:33 3 12 00:00:255345545556 5 2 (7b)
12.12.0014:44:12 2 12 00:12:122374844 12 8 (7c)
12.12.0014:44:12 3 12 00:12:125345545556 10 8 (7d)
12.12.0014:56:24 2 12 00:23:462374844 84 2 (7e)
13.12.0009:43:52 1 5 00:01:0539398989983 76 4 (8)
14.12.0012:23:34 1 600:1400:02:3427348596872347569036 3 (9)
** 100 calls lost ** (10)
15.12.0009:44:34 4 15 00:02:12189???? 23 2
15.12.0009:56:33 3 14 00:05:451283394495 28 2
15.12.0012:20:26 1 12 0230298007766 0 (11a)
15.12.0012:23:34 1 1200:3400:02:340230298007766 1 (11b)
15.12.0013:43:25 3 15 00:05:2408972212345 1 (12a)
15.12.0013:43:25 4 15 00:05:240231471154321 74 9 (12b)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 18 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 32 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:45:28 4 16 0230298007252 0 (13a)
15.12.0013:46:18 4 1600:50 0230298007252 1 (13b)
15.12.0013:49:28 4 16 00:00:0002317324856 2 (14)
01.01.0000:00:00 8 23 2 (15)
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Compressed Output Format for Call Detail
s
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-3
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
Explanation of the sample entries shown on page 9-2:
(1) Outgoing connection from stn 16 on trunk 4 using the MSN 902725. End of
call at 8:23:23 on 12/11/00. Duration of the call: 5 minutes, 23 seconds.
Called number: 02317324856. Accrued call charge pulses (blank in U.S.):
12. The seizure code 841 was used for call setup.
(2) Outgoing connection with 11-digit account code (ACCT) 12345678901.
Route 2 was used for LCR.
(3) Unanswered incoming call without station number (missing origin address,
active station number suppression CLIR at calling station).
(4) Outgoing connection with suppression of the last 4 digits.
(5) Incoming connection with ringing and call duration.
(6) Forwarded call.
(7) Int/ext/ext conference:
(7a) Stn 12 sets up a first external call on trunk 2 (2374844),
(7b) Stn 12 sets up a second external call on trunk 3 (5345545556),
(7c) Stn 12 is involved in a conference with trunk 2 and
(7d) with trunk 3.
(7e) Trunk 3 drops out of the conference. The call on trunk 2 is treated like a
normal outgoing call.
(8) Outgoing connection (other services).
(9) Incoming connection (other services).
(10) Loss message: 100 records were lost.
Due to a problem such as the following:
Connected device is turned off or suffers a power failure
Printer is out of paper
Printer is offline
Printer has a paper jam
CDRC output is interrupted by CDB output
Interface cable is defective or incorrect
In these or similar cases, the call records accumulated during this time are
buffered in the system. The first 300 (HiPath 3750 and HiPath 3700), 150 (Hi-
Path 3550 and HiPath 3500) or 50 (HiPath 3350, HiPath 3300 and HiPath
3250 [not for U.S.]) records can be buffered.
Additional records are only counted by the system and then discarded. If the
connection can be restored to the connected device, a loss message indicat-
ing the number of lost records (that is,100 calls lost) is issued after the buff-
ered records are output.
Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
(11) Incoming call with transmitted caller station number:
(11a) Caller list: When the call arrives, an information line is immediately out-
put indicating the date, time, trunk, station number, incoming external station
number (if available), and information element 0 (used, for example, with a
PC: start database search -> message appears on stations monitor).
(11b) Station 12 accepted the call after a ringing duration of 34 seconds. This
line is output at the end of the call.
(12) Call forwarding with an external destination:
(12a) Incoming call for station 15 on trunk 3 with transmitted station number,
no ringing duration due to call forwarding (see 12b),
(12b) Call forwarded (12a) to trunk 4 for station number 0231471154321, 74
call charge pulses (not for U.S.) have accrued for the forwarded call.
(13) Incoming call to subscriber group (stations 18, 32, and 16):
(13a) The three entered stations are called simultaneously; they are listed in
the order in which they were entered in the group (the second station is listed
first).
(13b) The call was not accepted by any group member. After the call has
ended, a line is output indicating the ringing duration for the last called or en-
tered station.
(14) Outgoing connection attempt (CDRC outgoing without connection) from Stn
16 on line 4 at 13:49:28 (1:49:28 p.m.) on December 15, 2000. Number
called: 02317324856.
(15) Output after a power failure or reset: 23 call detail units on trunk 8 were
present before the power failure.
When a power failure or reset occurs, the call charges accrued for each trunk
are stored in nonvolatile system memory (CDRT).
The system checks for consistency between the output and internally stored
data following a power failure or system restart. The system also checks to
determine whether call charges are still stored that have not yet been output
via the V.24 (RS-232) interface. If this is the case, the system outputs a data
line using the format illustrated in the example (15) for each affected trunk:
(output does not include station number).
Compressed Output Format for Call Detail
s
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-5
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
Output via LAN Interface
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
12345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890123456789012345678901234567890
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 Date (8 characters)
| 2 Time (8)
| | 3 Trunk (3)
| | | 4 Internal station number (6)
| | | | 5 Ring duration (5)
| | | | | 6 Call duration (8)
| | | | | | 7 Station number (25)
| | | | | | | 8 Call charge pulses (11) (blank in U.S.)
| | | | | | | | 9 Information element (2)
| | | | | | | | | 10 ACCT (11)
| | | | | | | | | | 11 MSN (11)
| | | | | | | | | | | 12 Seizure code (5)
| | | | | | | | | | | | 13 LCR route (2
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
| | | | | | | | | | | | | ...
V V V V V V V V V V V V V
13.12.99;08:23:23;4;16;;00:05:23;02317324856;12;2;12345678901;902725;841;;
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Call detail records can be output via a LAN interface using two different settings:
DOS mode (carriage return (CR), line feed (LF)) = default or UNIX mode (line
feed (LF)) at the end of a call data record.
Separators (; = default or |) between the logical elements of a call data
record; the record is no longer position-oriented.
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
1 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
1 1 to 8 Date at end of call: DD.MM.YY
(DD = day, MM = month, YY = year)
8Left
2 9 to 16 Time at end of call segment or an unan-
swered incoming call: hh:mm:ss
(hh = hours: value range 00 - 23, mm = min-
utes: value range 00 - 59, ss = seconds: val-
ue range 00 - 59)
8Left
3 17 to 19 Trunk: Trunk number
Value range 1 - 120
3 Right
Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
4 20 to 25 Station: Internal station number
Value range: 000000 - 999999 (missing dig-
its are replaced by spaces.)
In the case of unanswered calls, this is the
last station called (as in a hunt group, call for-
warding, call forwardingno answer). With
group call, this is the last station entered. In
the case of answered calls, it is the station
that accepted the call. A programmed SNO
prefix (with networking only) is not output.
If the internal numbering was converted to a
maximum 6-digit numbering plan, the con-
verted station number is output.
6 Right
5 26 to 30 Ringing duration of an incoming external call:
mm:ss
(mm = minutes: value range 00 - 59, ss =
seconds: value range 00 - 59)
The system displays all incoming calls as
long as the output of ringing duration has
been configured in the system. If a counter
overflow occurs (duration > 59:59), 59:59 is
output. A change in date or time during sys-
tem operation can result in this situation.
5Left
6 31 to 38 Duration of the call or call segment:
hh:mm:ss
(hh = hours: value range 00 to 23,
mm = minutes: value range 00 to 59,
ss = seconds: value range 00 to 59)
If a connection has not been established for
an incoming call, 8 spaces are output here. If
a counter overflow occurs (duration >
23:59:59), 23:59:59 is output.
8Left
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
2 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Compressed Output Format for Call Detail
s
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-7
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
7 39 to 63 Dialed or received external station number (if
available):nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
(n = dialed or received characters: value
range: 0 - 9, *, #, ?)
Output occurs for incoming and outgoing
calls (if available). With outgoing calls, the di-
aled station number or, if available, the sta-
tion number transmitted via COLP is dis-
played. In the case of an active data
protection function, the last four digits dialed
are replaced by the symbols
????
. If no sta-
tion number information is available, 25
spaces are output.
25 Left
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
3 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
8 64 to 74 Call charge pulses for a call segment:
zzzzzzzzzzz (blanks in U.S.)
(z = digit: value range 0 - 9)
You can select either call charge pulses or
call charge amounts.
Use the call charge factor, which is defined
as a currency amount (including a mandato-
ry surcharge) for each call charge unit or
pulse, to convert call charge pulses to mone-
tary amounts (see Section 3.13.11, Call-
Charge Display With Currency (Not for
U.S.)).
Setting the call charge factor:
With calculation detail: call charge factor
= 100% + mandatory surcharge
Without calculation detail: call charge
factor = amount/unit + mandatory sur-
charge
The system records the call charges with or
without a surcharge depending on the calcu-
lation detail (Section 3.13.11):
The system outputs the data whenever
charges accrue for the call segment (even
when calls are transferred). If no call charge
information is available, these 11 positions
remain blank.
11 Right
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
4 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Call Charge
Display
Calculation Detail
With Without
Pulses HiPath arithmetic
units output with-
out surcharge
Call charge puls-
es output without
surcharge
Amounts HiPath arithmetic
units output with
surcharge
Monetary
amounts output
with surcharge
Compressed Output Format for Call Detail
s
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-9
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
9 75 to 76 Information element: additional information
Value range: 0 - 9
Meaning:
1 = Incoming connection (voice/3.1 kHz
audio call)
2 = Outgoing connection (voice/3.1 kHz
audio call)
3 = Incoming connection (other servic-
es)
4 = Outgoing connection (other servic-
es)
5 = Incoming connection forwarded
6 = Outgoing connection forwarded
7 = Int/ext/ext conference with incoming
connection/transit through external
transfer
8 = Conference with outgoing connec-
tion/transit through external transfer
9 = Outgoing connection via call forward-
ing to an external destination
0 = Call information (caller list) is output
immediately when an incoming call is re-
ceived (output can be suppressed). This
can be used, for instance, for a database
search by a PC. When multiple stations
are called, a line is output for each indi-
vidual station (without ring duration, call
duration, call detail information).
2 Right
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
5 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Compressed Output Format for Call Details
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
Continu-
ation of
9
75 to 76 +20 = Offset as a code for call setup
charges (connection setup without call
duration)
+30 (HiPath 3000 V1.0 and later) = off-
set as an ID for a follow-up data record in
the case of
call duration > 24 h.
contiguous call segments with the
same line/station number (for exam-
ple, after transferring a call, after
clearing a conference).
Can occur in combination with offset
+40.
+40 = Offset for a data record with transit
code (by an extension in the sub-
system). Can occur in combination with
offset +30.
+50 = Offset as a code for DISA calls
+70 = combination of offsets +30 and
+40
2 Right
10 77 to 87 Account code (ACCT) entered by the user for
this call: ppppppppppp
(p = ACCT digit: value range 0 - 9)
If an ACCT has not been entered, 11 spaces
are output. If the ACCT is shorter than 11
digits, the remaining characters are filled with
spaces.
11 Left
11 88 to 98 MSN used: mmmmmmmmmmm
(m = MSN digit: value range 0 - 9)
Information is displayed if the user has pro-
grammed an MSN key. Non-existent charac-
ters are replaced by spaces. If MSN informa-
tion is not available (as in a point-to-point
connection), 11 spaces are output instead of
these characters.
11 Right
12 99 to 103 Seizure code used, access code: bbbbb
(b = digit of the seizure code: value range 0 -
9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
5 Right
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
6 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Compressed Output Format for Call Detail
s
3000sb9.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description 9-11
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
13 104 to
105
LCR route used: rr
(r = digit of the dialed route: value range 0 - 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
2 Right
14 106 to
107
PRI nodal service: nn
(n = digit: value range 0 - 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
2 Right
15 108 PRI WATS band: w
(w = digit: value range 0 - 9)
If no information is available, a space is out-
put.
1
16 109 to
112
PRI Carrier Identification Code (CIC): cccc
(c = CIC digit: value range 0 - 9)
Non-existent characters are replaced by
spaces.
4 Right
14 106 to
107
U.S.-specific fields are filled with blanks in
other countries.
2 Right
15 108 1
16 109 to
112
4 Right
17 113 to
114
End of line control character
(carriage return [CR], line feed [LF])
2
Table 9-1 Compressed Output Format - Explanation of Output Fields (Sheet
7 of 7)
Field
position
Fields
(V.24 out-
put only)
Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Long Output Format for Call Data
Output Formats for Call Detail Recording
G281-0788-00, April 2002
9-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sb9.fm
9.3 Long Output Format for Call Data
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Date Time Trk Stn Call Duration Station number Amount I
11.12.93 08:23:23 4 16 00:05:23 02317324856 20,23 2
11.12.93 09:12:45 3 18 00:01:23 834756 0,69 2
11.12.93 09:25:34 2 11 00:34 1
11.12.93 10:01:46 1 12 00:12:53 83726639046287127384 413,69 2
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The header in the long output format is output in the language used across the sys-
tem.
After 62 lines have printed (including header), a form feed (FF) is carried out and
the next page begins with a header.
Table 9-2 Long output format - explanation of output fields
Field Fields Definition Number of
characters
Orientation
Date 1 to 8 See Table 9-1, Field position 1 8 Left
Time 10 to 17 See Table 9-1, Field position 2 8 Left
Trk 19 to 21 See Table 9-1, Field position 3 3 Right
Stn 23 to 28 See Table 9-1, Field position 4 6 Right
Call 30 to 34 See Table 9-1, Field position 5 6 Left
Duration 36 to 43 See Table 9-1, Field position 6 8 Left
Station
number
45 to 64 Dialed or, if available, the received external
station number:nnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnnn
(n = dialed or received character: value
range 0 - 9, *, #, ?)
See also Table 9-1, field position 7
20 Left
Amount 66 to 76 Call charge amount for a call segment:
zzzzzzzzzzz (blank spaces in U.S.)
(z = digit: value range 0 - 9)
Output always occurs when call charges
accrue for the call segment (even with
transferred calls). If no call detail informa-
tion is available, these 11 characters are
filled with spaces. A comma (,) separates
the amount from the decimal places.
11 Right
I 78 to 79 See Table 9-1, field position 9 2 Right
80 to 81 End of line control character
(carriage return [CR], line feed [LF])
2
3000sbabb.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Y-1
Abbreviations
Abbreviations Y
The following list contains the abbreviations used in this manual.
A
ACCT Account Code
ACL-H2 Application Connectivity Link-Hicom 200
ALUM Trunk Transfer
AMHOST Administration and Maintenance via HOST
ANI Automatic Number Identification
AO Acoustic Option
APS System Program System
ATEA Ateliers de Téléphone et Electricité, Anvers
B
BC Basic Cabinet (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700)
BFSK Binary frequency shift keying
BLF Busy Lamp Field
BSG Battery Cabinet
BSG Add-on Device
C
Cablu Cabling Unit
CAS Centralized Attendant Service
CAS Channel Associated Signalling
CBCC Central Board with Coldfire Com
CBCPR Central Board with Coldfire Pro
CBRC Central Board Rack Com
CDB Customer Database
CDRC Call Detail Recording Central
CHAP Challenge-Handshake Authentication Protocol
CLIP Calling Line Identification Presentation (number indication in ISDN
CMA Clock Module ADPCM
Abbreviations
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Y-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbabb.fm
CMS Clock Module Small
CO Central Office
CR Code Receiver
CSTA Computer Supported Telecommunications Applications
CUC Connection Unit Com
CUCR Connection Unit Com Rack
CUP Connection Unit Point
CUPR Connection Unit Point Rack
D
DICS Dial-In Control Server
DSP Digital Signal Processor
E
EC1 First Expansion Cabinet (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700)
EC2 Second Expansion Cabinet (HiPath 3750, HiPath 3700)
ECR Expansion Cabinet 19’’ Rack
ECG Euro-ISDNCAS-Gateway
ECGM Euro-ISDN-CAS-Gateway Maintenance
ECMA European Computer Manufacture Association
EPSU External Power Supply Unit
eSHB Electronic Service Manual
ETS European Telecommunication Standard
ETSI European Telecommunications Standards Instituts
G
GCM Call Charge Computer/Manager
GEE Call Metering Receiving Equipment
H
HA Handset
HKZ Loop Start
I
ICMP Internet Control Message Protocol
IMOD Integrated Modem Card Columbus
IP Internet Protocol
3000sbabb.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Y-3
Abbreviations
ISDN Integrated Services Digital Network
ISO International Standards Organization
IVML Integrated Voice Mail Large
IVMS Integrated Voice Mail Small
IVMSR Integrated Voice Mail Small Rack
L
LDAP Lightweight Directory Access Protocol
LED Light Emitting Diode
LIM LAN Interface Module
M
MDFU Main Distribution Frame Universal
MDFU-E Main Distribution Frame Universal, Enhanced
MFC-R2 Multifrequency Code Signalling System R2
MIB Management Information Base
MMC Multimedia Card
MOH Music on Hold
MSN Multiple Subscriber Number
MULAP Multiple Line Appearance
N
NT Network Termination
O
OPAL Options Adapter Long
OPALR Options Adapter Long Rack
P
PA Phone Adapter
PAP PPP Authentication Protocol
PCM Pulse Code Modulation
PFT Power Failure Transfer
PMP Point-to-Multipoint Connection
PP Point-to-Point Connection
PPP Point-to-Point Protocol
PSE Radio Paging Equipment
Abbreviations
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Y-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbabb.fm
PSTN Public Switching Telephone Network
PSUC Power Supply Unit Com
PSUCR Power Supply Unit Com Rack
PSUP Power Supply Unit Point
PSUPR Power Supply Unit Point Rack
R
RDT Remote Data Transmission
REAL Relay Failure Transfer
S
SBSCO Single Board System with Coldfire One
SBSCS Single Board System with Coldfire Start
SELV Safety Extra-Low Voltage Circuit
SLA Subscriber Line Analog
SLA Subscriber Line Module Analog
SLAS Subscriber Line Module Analog Single Slic
SLC Subscriber Line Module Cordless
SLMO Subscriber Line Module Cost Optimized UP0/E
SLU Subscriber Line UP0/E
SLUR Subscriber Line UP0/E Rack
SMR Service Maintenance Release
SNMP Simple Network Management Protocol
SSD System Speed Dialing
STLS Subscriber Trunk Line S0
STLSR Subscriber And Trunk Line S0 Rack
STMD Subscriber And Trunk Module Digital S0
STRB Control Relay Module
STRB Control Relay Module Rack
T
TA Terminal Adapter
TC Telecommunication
TCP Transmission Control Protocol
TIEL Tie Line Ear & Mouth
3000sbabb.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Y-5
Abbreviations
TLA Trunk Line Analog
TLAR Trunk Line Analog Rack
TMAMF Trunk Module Analog for Multifrequency Code Signalling
TMCAS Trunk Module Channel Associated Signalling
TML8W Trunk Module Loop Start World
TMOM Trunk Module Outgoing Multipurpose
TMS2 Trunk Module S2M
TS2 Trunk Module S2M
TS2R Trunk Module S2M Rack
U
UCD Universal Call Distribution
UDP User Datagram Protocol
UPSC-D Uninterruptible Power Supply Com-DECT
UPSC-DR Uninterruptible Power Supply Com-DECT Rack
UPSM Uninterruptible Power Suppy Modular
USBS User to User Signalling Bearer Service
V
VMIE Voice Mail Interface Enhanced Protocol
Abbreviations
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Y-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbabb.fm
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-1
Index
Index Z
Numerics
3PTY
See
three-party service
A
access security 5-24
account code 3-334
ACCT
See
account code
ACD, see uniform call distribution 3-68
administration of Plus Products via PPP 4-40
administration options 5-2
administration via LAN 4-38
administration via PPP 4-39
advice of charge 3-365
advice of charges during a call (not for U.S.)
3-324
advisory messages 3-225
AICC 3-79
allocation mode 3-386
alternate carriers (U.S. only) 3-198
AMHOST 5-28
analog direct inward dialing with MFC-R2
3-142
analog modem 5-21
ANI4 (for U.S. only)
feature 3-43
announcement before answering 3-138
configuring 3-138
announcements 3-32
anti tromboning 3-304
AOC
See
advice of charge
AOC-D (not for U.S.) 3-324
applications 7-1
APS transfer 5-7
archive file (.arc) 5-34
assigning speed-dialing numbers to ITR
groups 3-174
associated dialing 3-247
associated services 3-248
attendant consoles
network 3-314
audible tone monitoring 3-159
automatic call completion on no reply (CCNR)
on the trunk interface 3-180
automatic call distribution, see uniform call
distribution 3-68
automatic callback when free or busy 3-215
automatic incoming call connection with UCD
3-79
automatic line seizure 3-156
B
B channel allocation 3-108
B channel modem 5-21
babyphone 3-229
base stations 2-86
basic MULAP groups 3-277
basic rate interface 3-383
CAID 3-389, 3-390
CO protocol 3-390
parameters 3-389
PDID 3-389
SPID 3-389, 3-390
basic-rate trunks
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
battery cabinet BSG 48/38 2-13, 2-61
B-channel allocation mode 3-386
B-channel cut-through operation mode 3-413
B-channel selection 3-410
originating 3-411
terminating 3-412
board slots
HiPath 3300 2-78
HiPath 3500 2-70
HiPath 3700 2-55
OfficeCom/HiPath 3550 2-22
OfficePoint/HiPath 3350 2-33
OfficePro/HiPath 3750 2-7
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-2 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
boards
central boards
HiPath 3300 2-79
HiPath 3500 2-71
HiPath 3700 2-59
OfficeCom/HiPath 3550 2-23
OfficeOne/HiPath 3250 2-46
OfficePoint/HiPath 3350 2-34
OfficePro/HiPath 3750 2-11
OfficeStart/HiPath 3150 2-51
peripheral boards
HiPath 3300 2-81
HiPath 3500 2-73
HiPath 3700 2-62
OfficeCom/HiPath 3550 2-25
OfficePoint/HiPath 3350 2-37
OfficePro/HiPath 3750 2-14
booking a line 3-169
braille console 6-46
BreezeNET 4-24
BSG 48/38 2-13, 2-61
busy lamp field 3-213
busy override 3-39
C
CACH EKTS
See
call appearance call handling elec-
tronic key telephone system
CAID
See
call appearance identification
calculation accuracy 3-355
call allocation 3-122
call appearance call handling electronic key
telephone system 3-418
call appearance identification 3-389
definition 3-390
call charges
display with currency 3-355
call deflection 3-369
call detail recording
at station 3-327
attendant (not for U.S.) 3-329
central 3-338
compressed output format 3-342, 9-2
compressed output format (LAN)
3-345, 9-5
long output format 3-352, 9-12
per trunk (not for U.S.) 3-332
call detail recording, attendant 3-329
call distribution
See
uniform call distribution (UCD)
call duration display on terminal 3-326
call forwarding 3-58, 3-366
U.S. ISDN 3-404
call forwarding busy and no answer 3-56
call forwarding unconditional (CFU) 3-368
call forwarding-no answer
after a timeout 3-53
call hold 3-19, 3-373
call keys 3-117
least cost routing and (U.S. only) 3-201
call management
announcement before answering 3-138
feature 3-48
call park 3-21
call pickup
answering machine 3-94
from an answering machine 3-94
within call pickup groups 3-91
call priority 6-49
call waiting 3-46, 3-375
U.S. ISDN 3-407
call waiting tone 3-46
call-by-call service 3-393
called and calling party number display ser-
vices 3-419
caller list/station number storage 3-89
calling line identification presentation 3-361,
3-403
calling line identification restriction 3-362
calls
data 3-416
calls in queue 3-82
camp-on
(U.S. ISDN only) 3-396
capacities 8-1
carrier access methods for LCR (U.S. only)
3-198
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-3
Index
carrier types (LCR) 3-184, 3-197
corporate network (CN) 3-187
dial-in control server (DICS) 3-186
Mercury Communications Limited Single
Stage (not for U.S.) 3-184
Mercury Communications Limited Two
Stage (not for U.S.) 3-185
primary carrier 3-187
carrier-select override (U.S. only) 3-200
least cost routing 3-205
CAS centralized attendant service 3-144
CBCC 2-23, 2-34
CBCPR 2-11, 2-59
CBRC 2-71, 2-79
CCBS
See
completion of calls to busy subscrib-
ers
CD
See
call deflection
CDB backup 5-6
CDRA
See
call detail recording, attendant
CDRC
See
call detail recording central
CDRC outgoing without connection 3-338
CDRC ticket without connect 3-338
CDRC via IP 4-31
CDRS
See
call detail recording at station
CDRT
See
call detail recording per trunk (not for
U.S.)
central board
HiPath 3300 2-79
HiPath 3500 2-71
HiPath 3700 2-59
OfficeCom/HiPath 3550 2-23
OfficeOne/HiPath 3250 2-46
OfficePoint/HiPath 3350 2-34
OfficePro/HiPath 3750 2-11
OfficeStart/HiPath 3150 2-51
central office protocol 3-390
central voice mail server, network 3-316
centralized attendant service CAS 3-144
CF
See
call forwarding
CFNA
See
call forwarding-no answer
CH
See
call hold
change display 3-293
changeover
individual telephone lock 3-101
system telephone lock 3-103
charger (Hicom Cordless EM)
Gigaset 2000L pocket 6-44
charger (HiPath cordless)
Gigaset 2000L 6-44
Gigaset 3000L 6-45
Gigaset 3000L Micro 6-45
chip card, chip card reader (only for Deutsche
Telekom AG) 5-29
class of service 3-163
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-200
CLIP
See
calling line identification presentation
CLIP no screening 3-181
CLIR
See
calling line identification restriction
closed numbering 3-299
CM
See
call management
codes for outgoing calls 3-380
collect call barring for ISDN trunks 3-382
collect call barring per station 3-141
collect call barring per trunk 3-140
COLP
See
connected line identification and pre-
sentation
COLR
See
connected line identification restric-
tion
completion of calls to busy subscribers 3-372
compliance
CE 2-99
compressed output format for CDRC 3-342,
9-2
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-4 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
compressed output format for CDRC via LAN
3-345, 9-5
conference 3-28, 3-374
trunk to trunk 3-28
conference calls
U.S. ISDN 3-397
configurable toll restriction 3-163
configurations HiPath 3000 2-4
conformity 2-99
connected line identification 3-408
connected line identification presentation
3-363
connected line identification restriction 3-364
connected party displays 3-420
consultation hold 3-34
converter (CSTA interface) 3-423, 7-1
CorNet-N
access for least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-198
call waiting 3-306
closed numbering 3-299
consultation hold 3-304
extension number 3-303
incoming calls 3-303
name display 3-309
number display 3-309
pickup 3-304
station name 3-303
toll restriction 3-300, 3-303
transfer 3-304
CorNet-N ranges 2-97
correcting errors 5-18
COS 3-163
credit card call access 3-399
CSO
see
carrier-select override
CSTA interface 3-423
CSTA via IP 4-33
currency
call charge display with 3-355
customer database backup 5-6
customer-specific display 3-293
CW
See
call waiting
D
data calls 3-416
data security 1-29
date 3-237
date and time display 3-237
D-channel encoding type 3-386
dedicated service 3-394
deferring a call 3-96
delete all station numbers 3-259
denied list for undialed trunks 3-173
diagnosis options 5-9
dial plan
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-202
dialed number identification service 3-409
dial-in control server access for least cost
routing (U.S. only) 3-199
DID
See
direct inward dialing
digital modem 5-21
direct inward dialing 3-128, 3-358
U.S. ISDN 3-400
direct inward system access
description 3-131
direct station selection 3-212
DISA
See
direct inward system access
display
called party 3-419
connected party 3-419, 3-420
date and time 3-237
number of stations with direct trunk ac-
cess (Austria only) 3-250
distinctive ringing 3-44
DND
See
do not disturb
DNIS
See
dialed number identification service
do not disturb 3-86
ringer cutoff 3-86
door opener 3-217
double key assignment 6-3
DSS
See
direct station selection
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-5
Index
DTMF or rotary pulse dialing
selecting in least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-201
DTMF tones
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
dual key assignments 6-19
dual-tone multifrequency
converting for PRI 3-414
dual-tone multifrequency direct inward dialing
3-136
dual-tone multifrequency transmission (DT-
MF) 3-99
E
E911 emergency call service for USA 3-178
ECR expansion cabinet rack 1-15, 2-69,
2-77, 2-85
ECT
See
explicit call transfer
editing station numbers 3-231
editing the telephone number 3-231
EKTS
See
electronic key telephone system
electrical environment and applications 2-1
electronic directory 6-48
electronic key telephone system
DID 3-400
U.S. ISDN 3-417
electronic notebook 6-33
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
emergency call service ECS 3-178
emulation type 3-386
en-bloc dialing 3-158
en-bloc sending 3-415
end-of-dialing recognition 3-161
enhanced radio paging equipment (not for
U.S.)
features 3-221
entrance telephones 3-217
environmental conditions 2-99
equal access 3-398
error history 5-16
error messages 5-17
Euro-ISDN features 3-357
executive MULAP groups 3-277
executive/secretary configuration, see Top
configuration 3-268
expansion cabinet rack ECR 1-15, 2-69,
2-77, 2-85
expensive route identification (U.S. only)
3-200
explicit call transfer 3-378
external call forwarding 3-368
external power supply EPSU2 2-31
F
fax waiting message/answering machine key
3-95
features
correlation with least cost routing (U.S.
only) 3-200
features in alphabetical order 3-2
flex call 3-106
flexible numbering 3-299
forced account codes
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
foreign exchange non-ISDN facility 3-393
frame/line/encoding 3-386
G
Gigaset 2000C 6-35
Gigaset 2000C pocket 6-37
Gigaset 3000 Comfort 6-41
Gigaset 3000 Micro 6-43
Gigaset active 6-39
group call 3-62
group call with busy signaling 3-64
group ringing 3-123
H
handset (HiPath cordless)
Gigaset 2000C 6-35
Gigaset 2000C pocket 6-37
Gigaset 3000 Comfort 6-41
Gigaset 3000 Micro 6-43
Gigaset active 6-39
handsfree answerback 3-218
Hicom Attendant BLF 6-25
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-6 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
Hicom cordless EM
base stations 2-86
single-cell BS 2-86, 2-91, 2-93
system configuration 2-91
HiPath 3150 2-49
HiPath 3250 2-43
HiPath 3300 2-78
HiPath 3350 2-33
HiPath 3500 2-70
HiPath 3550 2-21
HiPath 3700 2-54
HiPath 3750 2-6
HiPath Attendant B braille console 6-46
HiPath cordless 2-86, 6-35
HiPath HG 1500 boards, calculation of re-
quired number 4-6
HiPath Wireless BreezeNET 4-24
hold 3-19, 3-373
U.S. ISDN 3-405
Host Link Interface 3-423
hoteling 3-254
hotline 3-105
hunt group 3-65
I
IMODC 5-21
incoming calls
CorNet-N 3-303
night answer 3-126
incoming preference 3-280
individual telephone lock (changeover) 3-101
integrated modem 5-21
intercept conditions 3-133
intercept position
network 3-314
Intercept with telephone lock 3-175
inter-exchange carriers
CAC 3-197
CIC 3-197
operator access 3-399
protocols 3-385
Interfaces 2-95
interfaces
BRI 3-383
PRI 3-383
interface-to-interface ranges 2-97
internal directory 3-227
internal paging 3-218, 3-219
internal traffic 3-210
internal traffic restriction groups
feature 3-166
Intranet, information 1-28
INWATS facility 3-393
IP networking 1-3, 3-294, 4-17
IP payload switching 4-17
IP trunking 4-7
ISDN 3-383
CAID 3-389, 3-390
SDID 3-390
SPID 3-389
See also
U.S. ISDN or Euro-ISDN fea-
tures
ISDN message decoder 5-15
K
key assignment 6-3
key assignments 6-19
key programming 3-115, 3-117, 6-4
keypad
converting DTMF for PRI 3-414
keypad dialing 3-176
keys
DSS 3-212
redial 3-146
repdial 3-212
L
LAN connection 4-1
LAN connection via HiPath HG1500 4-3
LAN connection via LIM 4-2
LAN interface, PSTN interface 3-423
LAN network 4-1
language settings 3-245
languages, loading 3-245
last number redial (LNR) 3-146
LCR
See
least cost routing
least cost routing 3-183
alternate carriers (U.S. only) 3-198
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-7
Index
and basic-rate trunks (U.S. only) 3-201
and call keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and DTMF tones (U.S. only) 3-201
and electronic notebook (U.S. only) 3-201
and forced account codes (U.S. only)
3-201
and MUSAP keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and repertory dial keys (U.S. only) 3-201
and station redial (U.S. only) 3-201
and system speed-dialing (U.S. only)
3-201
and toll restriction (U.S. only) 3-201
carrier access methods (U.S. only) 3-198
carrier types 3-197
carrier-select override (U.S. only) 3-200,
3-205
CorNet-N (U.S. only) 3-198
correlation with other features (U.S. only)
3-200
dial plan (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-202
dial-in control server (U.S. only) 3-199
expensive route identification (U.S. only)
3-200
main carrier (U.S. only) 3-198
MCL single stage access (U.S. only)
3-198
MCL two stage access (U.S. only) 3-198
number handling (U.S. only) 3-200
operation (U.S. only) 3-208
outdial rules
letters (U.S. only) 3-205
parameters (U.S. only) 3-205
outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-199, 3-204,
3-205
primary rate access (U.S. only) 3-199
route table (U.S. only) 3-204
route table paths (U.S. only) 3-204
route table search order (U.S. only) 3-204
routing tables (U.S. only) 3-202
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing
(U.S. only) 3-201
time of day evaluation (U.S. only) 3-199
time table (U.S. only) 3-205
U.S. only 3-195
least cost routing class of service (U.S. only)
3-200
least cost routing overflow (U.S. only) 3-200
leave group call/hunt group (stop hunt) 3-67
leave UCD group 3-74
letters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-205
local exchange carriers
carrier types 3-197
operator access 3-399
protocols 3-385
local power supply 6-17
location identification number LIN 3-178
locking telephone
system 3-103
LOG area 5-31, 5-34
logging of administration procedures 5-31
long output format for CDRC 3-352, 9-12
M
main carrier for least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-198
malicious call identification 3-371
management information bases (MIB) 4-36
manager/secretary configuration, see Top
configuration 3-268
MCID
See
malicious call identification
MCL single stage carrier access (U.S. only)
3-198
MCL two stage carrier access (U.S. only)
3-198
message texts/mailboxes (information func-
tion) 3-222
message waiting 3-222
U.S. ISDN 3-421
voicemail 3-422
message waiting indication at the trunk inter-
face 3-121
MFC-R2 trunk 3-142
MIB 4-36
MMC
replace 5-7
mobile PIN 3-106
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-8 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
MSN
See
multiple subscriber numbers
MULAP 3-261, 3-277
multi-device connection 3-109, 3-392
multilingual text output 3-245
multiple subscriber numbers 3-359
configuring default station numbers in-
stead 3-360
U.S. ISDN 3-401
MUSAP keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
music on hold
internal/external source 3-30
relays 3-239
MWI at the trunk interface 3-121
N
N11 access 3-399
names
assigning to stations 3-214
called party display 3-419
calling party display 3-419
translating station numbers for speed dial-
ing 3-120
national and international codes for outgoing
calls 3-380
networking 3-294
call forwarding with rerouting 3-310
call waiting 3-306
callback on free/busy 3-308
CDR with networking 3-302
central attendant console 3-314
closed numbering 3-299
conference 3-313
consultation hold/transfer/pickup 3-304
distinctive ringing in the network 3-307
incoming calls 3-302, 3-303
open numbering 3-299
recall 3-305
satellite capability 3-296
sharing central voice mail server 3-316
sharing system speed-dialing in a gate-
way system 3-315
station number/name display 3-309
toggle 3-312
toll restriction with CorNet N 3-300
night answer 3-125
activating 3-126
night service 3-125
number of B channels for PRI parameters
3-386
numbering plan 2-98
O
OfficeCom 2-21
OfficeOne 2-43
OfficePoint 2-33
OfficePro 2-6
OfficeStart 2-49
offset 3-350, 9-10
open numbering 3-299
operating conditions 2-99
operation of least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-208
operator assisted credit card call access
3-399
optiClient 130 4-19
optiClient Attendant 6-48
optiLog 4me 6-29
optional control relay modules
relay 3-239
OptiPage 3-218
optiPoint 400 standard CorNet-IP-TS 4-22
optiPoint 500
adapter
acoustic adapter 6-13
analog adapter 6-13
configurations 6-15
ISDN adapter 6-14
option bays (adapter slots) 6-12
phone adapter 6-14
recorder adapter 6-13
adapters
key module 3-212
optiPoint BLF 3-213
BLF 6-10
key module 6-9
key programming 6-4
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-9
Index
power supply 6-17
telephones
accessories 6-17
advance 6-7
basic 6-6
economy 6-6
entry 6-4
standard 6-7
standard SL (for U.S. only) 6-7
optiPoint Attendant 3-37, 6-51
optiPoint BLF 3-213, 6-10
optiPoint IPadapter 6-29, 6-53
optiPoint key module 3-212, 6-9
optiset E accessories 6-34
optiset E acoustic adapter 6-27
optiset E advance conference/conference
6-23
optiset E advance plus/comfort 6-22
optiset E analog adapter 6-27
optiset E basic 6-20
optiset E contact adapter 6-28
optiset E control adapter 6-29
optiset E data adapter 6-27
optiset E entry 6-20
optiset E headset adapter 6-28
optiset E headset plus adapter 6-28
optiset E ISDN adapter 6-27
optiset E key module 6-25
optiset E memory 6-23
optiset E phone adapter 6-28
optiset E privacy module 6-29
optiset E standard 6-22
originating B-channel selection 3-411
outdial rules
least cost routing
letters (U.S. only) 3-205
parameters (U.S. only) 3-205
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204, 3-205
outdial rules for least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-199
outgoing calls
LNR 3-146
redial 3-146
outgoing preference 3-281
output formats for call detail recording 9-1
OUTWATS facility 3-393
overflow
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-200
overflow (UCD) 3-78
overload indication 3-41
P
paging 3-218
parameters
for LCR outdial rules (U.S. only) 3-205
park 3-21
password 5-24
path replacement 3-304
payload switching 4-17
PBX routing 1-3, 4-17
PCM segments for HiPath 3700 2-55
PCM segments for OfficePro/HiPath 3750
2-7
phantom direct inward dialing 3-389
assigning numbers 3-391
pickup
trunk key 3-116
Plus products 7-1
point-to-point connection 3-379
PRI carrier access for least cost routing (U.S.
only) 3-199
primary rate interface 3-383
B-channel allocation 3-386
D-channel encoding type 3-386
emulation type 3-386
frame/line/encoding 3-386
number of B channels 3-386
protocol type 3-385
trunk group calling service 3-387
priority calls 3-71
privacy 1-29
private trunk 3-168
procedure keys 3-289
programming the function keys 6-4
project calls 3-334
protocol type, primary rate interface 3-385
PSE
See
radio paging equipment (not for U.S.)
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-10 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
PSTN partner 4-41
PSU One 2-47, 2-52
PSUP 2-35
PtP
See
point-to-point connection
public network trunks
setting up in least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-201
Q
QSig 3-317
basic features 3-318
busy override 3-320
central attendant position 3-319
COS changeover 3-322
intercept by central attendant position
3-319
resetting the lock code 3-321
Quality of Service QoS 4-16
R
radio paging equipment 3-220
PSE simple 3-220
via ESPA 3-221
ranges
CorNet-N 2-97
trunk 2-97
recall 3-35
recorded announcement/music on Hold
(UCD) 3-76
reject calls 3-98
relays 3-239
reload 5-18
relocate 3-254
remote service 5-20
remote system administration 5-22
repdial
See
repertory dial keys
repertory dial keys
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
programming 3-212
reply text 3-225
reset 5-18
reset activated services 3-252
resetting services 3-252
restart 5-18
ringer cutoff 3-88
room monitor 3-229
route table
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
route table paths
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
route table search order
least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-204
router call number 4-39
routing tables (LCR) 3-188
routing tables (U.S. only) 3-202
S
SBSCO OfficeOne/HiPath 3250 2-46
SBSCS OfficeStart/HiPath 3150 2-51
screened transfer 3-26
search order
of LCR route table 3-204
security 5-24
selecting DTMF or rotary pulse dialing in LCR
(U.S. only) 3-201
selective seizure of a DID number via a MU-
SAP key 3-129
sending information text 3-222
sensors 3-243
service call using a code 5-22
service profile identifier 3-389
BRI 3-390
maximum values 3-390
serviceability 5-1
services in the talk state 3-251
setting the signaling method for analog sta-
tions 3-36
shared transfer switch 3-42
shift key 6-3, 6-19
signaling of direct inward dialing numbers for
incoming calls 3-130
silent monitoring 3-85
silent reversal at start and end of call 3-323
simple PSE
See
radio paging equipment
single-cell base station 2-86, 2-91, 2-93
SNMP 4-36
3000sbIX.fm
G281-0788-00, April 2002
HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description Z-11
Index
messages 4-37
traps 4-37
speaker call 3-218
special access 3-399
speech recording device optiLog 4me 6-29
speed dialing
network 3-315
station 3-154
system 3-149
station diagnosis 5-13
station number configuration via Assistant T
3-97
station numbers, deleting 3-259
station redial
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
station speed dialing in system 3-154
station status 5-13
stations
universal night answer 3-126
stimulus interface 3-176
storing procedures 3-289
SUB
See
subaddressing
subaddressing 3-370
subscriber groups 3-61
switch (relay) 3-239
system administration
activating services in the talk state 3-251
system administration, options 5-2
system capacities 8-1
System families 2-2
System number - incoming 3-181
System number - outgoing 3-181
system software upgrade 5-7
system speed dialing
network 3-315
outgoing external traffic 3-149
sharing in a gateway system 3-315
system speed-dialing
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
system speed-dialing in tenant systems
3-152
system telephone lock
changeover 3-103
system-related capacity limits 2-4
T
targeted call pickup outside of a PU group
3-93
Team configuration 3-261
example with 2 members 3-261
example with 8 members 3-264
Team keys 3-265
Team/Top 3-261
technical specifications 2-94, 2-99
Teilehmerrufnummer unterdrücken 3-181
telephone lock
individual 3-101
system 3-103
telephone testing 5-16
telephones
interface to interface ranges 2-97
temporary signaling method changeover
3-99
temporary station number display suppres-
sion 3-171
tenant services 3-232
configuring 3-233
terminal portability (TP) 3-376
terminating B-channel selection 3-412
text messages 3-222
three-party conference 3-374, 3-406
three-party service 3-374
tie trunk non-ISDN facility 3-393
TIEL 3-298
time 3-237
time of day evaluation for least cost routing
(U.S. only) 3-199
time table, LCR (U.S. only) 3-205
toggle 3-23
trunk key 3-116
toll fraud monitoring 3-353
toll restriction 3-163
and least cost routing (U.S. only) 3-201
Top configuration 3-268
example with 1 exec./1 secr. 3-268
example with 2 exec./2 secr. 3-270
Top keys 3-270
Index
G281-0788-00, April 2002
Z-12 HiPath 3000 V1.2-3.0, System Description
3000sbIX.fm
trace options 5-15
traffic restriction groups 3-166
transfer
U.S. ISDN 3-395
UCD groups 3-84
transfer from announcement 3-219
transfer of APS 5-7
transit traffic 3-118
translate station numbers to names for sys-
tem speed dialing 3-120
traps 4-37
TRGs
See
traffic restriction groups or internal
traffic restriction groups
trunk diagnosis 5-12
trunk group calling service 3-387
trunk groups 3-113
trunk keys 3-115
trunk queuing 3-169
trunk ranges 2-97
trunk seizure type 3-156
trunk signaling method 3-162
trunk status 5-12
trunks
setting up in least cost routing (U.S. only)
3-201
trunk-to-trunk conference 3-28
U
U.S. ISDN
B-channel allocation 3-386
BRI 3-383
CO protocol 3-390
D-channel encoding type 3-386
emulation type 3-386
frame/line/encoding 3-386
interfaces 3-383
multi-device connection 3-392
number of B channels (PRI) 3-386
PRI 3-383
protocol type 3-385
trunk group calling service 3-387
UCD
See
uniform call distribution
uniform call distribution 3-68
call prioritization 3-71
group status display 3-82
groups
AICC 3-79
home agent 3-83
night answer 3-81
queues 3-70
subscriber states 3-72
work 3-75
universal night answer position 3-126
unscreened transfer 3-24
upgrade of the system software 5-7
UPSC-D 2-24, 2-36
capacity and bridging period 2-30, 2-42
UPSC-DR 2-72, 2-80
capacity and bridging period 2-77, 2-85
UPSM 2-12, 2-60
user groups and their access rights 5-26
user to user signaling (UUS1) 3-59, 3-377
V
V.24
range extension for call data 3-354
voice channel signaling security 3-236
voice mail
central network server 3-316
voicemail 3-422
W
Wireless LAN 4-24
work time (UCD) 3-75

Navigation menu